1 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.ascd,v 1.1 2005/06/16 10:32:31 ph10 Exp $
4 This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an AsciiDoc document
5 that is converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing
6 and online formats. The markup used herein is traditional AsciiDoc markup,
7 with some extras. The markup is summarized in a file called AdMarkup.txt. A
8 private AsciiDoc configuration file specifies how the extra markup is to be
9 translated into DocBook XML. You MUST use this private AsciiDoc markup if you
10 want to get sensible results from processing this document.
11 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 I am abusing the <abstract> DocBook element as the only trivial way of getting
17 this information onto the title verso page in the printed renditions. A better
18 title page would be a useful improvement. The <abstract> element is removed by
19 preprocessing for the HTML renditions, and the whole <docbookinfo> element is
20 removed for ascii output formats.
21 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23 Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent
24 =============================================
25 :abstract: University of Cambridge Computing Service, New Museums Site, Pembroke Street, Cambridge CB2 3QH, England
27 :copyright: University of Cambridge
30 :doctitleabbrev: The Exim MTA
34 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35 ***WARNING*** Do not put anything, not even a titleabbrev, setting before
36 the first chapter (luckily it does not need one) because if you do, AsciiDoc
37 creates an empty <preface> element, which we do not want.
38 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 These are definitions of AsciiDoc "attributes" that are in effect "variables"
45 whose values can be substituted. The first makes index entries shorter. The
46 second avoids problems with literal asterisks getting tangled up with bold
47 emphasis quotes. The others are here for convenience of editing.
49 ***WARNING*** The positioning of these definitions, after the first Chapter
50 title, seems to be important. If they are placed earlier, they give rise to
52 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
54 :ACL: access control lists (ACLs)
56 :previousversion: 4.40
60 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
62 "x, see also y". It didn't seem worth inventing AsciiDoc markup for this,
63 because is it not something that is likely to change often.
64 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
66 ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
67 <indexterm role="concept">
68 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
69 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
71 <indexterm role="concept">
72 <primary>address</primary>
73 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
74 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
76 <indexterm role="concept">
77 <primary>CR character</primary>
78 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
80 <indexterm role="concept">
81 <primary>CRL</primary>
82 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
84 <indexterm role="concept">
85 <primary>delivery</primary>
86 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
87 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
89 <indexterm role="concept">
90 <primary>dialup</primary>
91 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
93 <indexterm role="concept">
94 <primary>exiscan</primary>
95 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
97 <indexterm role="concept">
98 <primary>failover</primary>
99 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
101 <indexterm role="concept">
102 <primary>fallover</primary>
103 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
105 <indexterm role="concept">
106 <primary>filter</primary>
107 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
108 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
110 <indexterm role="concept">
111 <primary>ident</primary>
112 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
114 <indexterm role="concept">
115 <primary>LF character</primary>
116 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
118 <indexterm role="concept">
119 <primary>maximum</primary>
120 <see><emphasis>limit</emphasis></see>
122 <indexterm role="concept">
123 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
124 <see>entry for xxx</see>
126 <indexterm role="concept">
127 <primary>NUL</primary>
128 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
130 <indexterm role="concept">
131 <primary>passwd file</primary>
132 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
134 <indexterm role="concept">
135 <primary>process id</primary>
136 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
138 <indexterm role="concept">
139 <primary>RBL</primary>
140 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
142 <indexterm role="concept">
143 <primary>redirection</primary>
144 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
146 <indexterm role="concept">
147 <primary>return path</primary>
148 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
150 <indexterm role="concept">
151 <primary>scanning</primary>
152 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
154 <indexterm role="concept">
155 <primary>SSL</primary>
156 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
158 <indexterm role="concept">
159 <primary>string</primary>
160 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
161 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
163 <indexterm role="concept">
164 <primary>top bit</primary>
165 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
167 <indexterm role="concept">
168 <primary>variables</primary>
169 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
171 <indexterm role="concept">
172 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
173 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
175 ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
178 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
179 OK, now we start with the real data for this first chapter.
180 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
182 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
183 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
184 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
185 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
187 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
188 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd, GNU/Linux,
189 HI-OSF (Hitachi), HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD, QNX, SCO, SCO
190 SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4, Tru64-Unix (formerly
191 Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware. Some of these operating
192 systems are no longer current and cannot easily be tested, so the configuration
193 files may no longer work in practice.
195 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
196 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
197 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
199 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
200 the file _NOTICE_. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
201 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file _LICENCE_.
203 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
204 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
205 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
206 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
207 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
209 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
210 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
211 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
212 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
213 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
215 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
216 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
217 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
218 _ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_, in which I have started recording the names of
225 [revisionflag="changed"]
226 cindex:[documentation]
227 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version {version} of Exim.
228 Substantive changes from the {previousversion} edition are marked in some
229 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
230 capable of showing a change indicator.
232 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
233 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
234 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
235 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
236 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
237 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
238 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
241 cindex:[books about Exim]
242 An ``easier'' discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
243 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled
244 'The Exim SMTP Mail Server', published by UIT Cambridge
245 (*http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/[]*).
247 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
248 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
249 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
250 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
252 cindex:[_doc/NewStuff_]
253 cindex:[_doc/ChangeLog_]
255 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
256 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
257 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
258 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
259 _doc/NewStuff_ in the Exim distribution.
261 Some features may be classified as ``experimental''. These may change
262 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
263 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
264 can be found in the file _doc/experimental.txt_.
266 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
267 change) are noted briefly in the file called _doc/ChangeLog_.
269 cindex:[_doc/spec.txt_]
270 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in _doc/spec.txt_ so
271 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the _doc_
275 `--------------------`------------------------------------------
276 _OptionLists.txt_ list of all options in alphabetical order
277 _dbm.discuss.txt_ discussion about DBM libraries
278 _exim.8_ a man page of Exim's command line options
279 _experimental.txt_ documentation of experimental features
280 _filter.txt_ specification of the filter language
281 _pcrepattern.txt_ specification of PCRE regular expressions
282 _pcretest.txt_ specification of the PCRE testing program
283 _Exim3.upgrade_ upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3
284 _Exim4.upgrade_ upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4
285 ----------------------------------------------------------------
287 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
288 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
289 <<SECTavail>> below tells you how to get hold of these.
297 The primary distribution site for Exim is currently the University of
298 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in 'Where to find the Exim
299 distribution' below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
300 %exim.org%. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
301 %exim.org% site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis Squared,
302 formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
304 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
305 differently formatted versions of the documentation, including the
306 cindex:[FAQ] FAQ in both text and HTML formats. The HTML version comes with
307 a keyword-in-context index. A recent addition to the online information is the
309 Exim wiki (*http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/[]*).
310 We hope that this will make it easier for Exim users to contribute examples,
311 tips, and know-how for the benefit of others.
317 cindex:[mailing lists,for Exim users]
318 The following are the three main Exim mailing lists:
321 `-------------------------------`----------------------------------------
322 'exim-users@exim.org' general discussion list
323 'exim-dev@exim.org' discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc.
324 'exim-announce@exim.org' moderated, low volume announcements list
325 -------------------------------------------------------------------------
327 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
328 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page. The
329 'exim-users' mailing list is also forwarded to
330 *http://www.egroups.com/list/exim-users[]*, an archiving system with searching
336 cindex:[training courses]
337 From time to time (approximately annually at the time of writing),
338 lecture-based training courses are run by the author of Exim in Cambridge, UK.
339 Details can be found on the web site
340 *http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/[]*.
346 cindex:[reporting bugs]
347 Reports of obvious bugs should be emailed to 'bugs@exim.org'. However, if
348 you are unsure whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is
349 to post a message to the 'exim-users' mailing list and have it discussed.
354 Where to find the Exim distribution
355 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
357 cindex:[distribution,ftp site]
358 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
361 *ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim[]*
367 *ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim[]*
370 The file references that follow are relative to the _exim_ directories at these
371 sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around the
372 world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called _Mirrors_.
374 Within the _exim_ directory there are subdirectories called _exim3_ (for
375 previous Exim 3 distributions), _exim4_ (for the latest Exim 4
376 distributions), and _Testing_ for testing versions. In the _exim4_
377 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
384 where 'n.nn' is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
385 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
386 The _.bz2_ file is usually a lot smaller than the _.gz_ file.
388 cindex:[distribution,signing details]
389 cindex:[distribution,public key]
390 cindex:[public key for signed distribution]
391 The distributions are currently signed with Philip Hazel's GPG key. The
392 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
393 also a copy in the file _Public-Key_. The signatures for the tar bundles are
397 _exim-n.nn.tar.gz.sig_
398 _exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.sig_
401 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
402 separate file in the directory _ChangeLogs_ so that it is possible to
403 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
405 cindex:[documentation,available formats]
406 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
407 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
408 inside the _exim4_ directory of the FTP site:
411 _exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_
412 _exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_
413 _exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_
414 _exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_
417 These tar files contain only the _doc_ directory, not the complete
418 distribution, and are also available in _.bz2_ as well as _.gz_ forms.
420 The FAQ is available for downloading in two different formats in these files:
424 _exim4/FAQ.html.tar.gz_
427 The first of these is a single ASCII file that can be searched with a text
428 editor. The second is a directory of HTML files, normally accessed by starting
429 at _index.html_. The HTML version of the FAQ (which is also included in the
430 HTML documentation tarbundle) includes a keyword-in-context index, which is
431 often the most convenient way of finding your way around.
437 A wish list is maintained, containing ideas for new features that have been
438 submitted. From time to time the file is exported to the ftp site into the file
439 _exim4/WishList_. Items are removed from the list if they get implemented.
445 cindex:[contributed material]
446 At the ftp site, there is a directory called _Contrib_ that contains
447 miscellaneous files contributed to the Exim community by Exim users. There is
448 also a collection of contributed configuration examples in
449 _exim4/config.samples.tar.gz_. These samples are referenced from the FAQ.
455 - cindex:[limitations of Exim]
456 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses
457 in RFC 2822 domain format only.
458 cindex:[bang paths,not handled by Exim]
459 It cannot handle UUCP ``bang paths'', though simple two-component bang paths can
460 be converted by a straightforward rewriting configuration. This restriction
461 does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to UUCP as a transport mechanism,
462 provided that domain addresses are used.
464 - cindex:[domainless addresses]
465 cindex:[address,without domain]
466 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
467 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
468 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
469 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
472 - cindex:[transport,external]
473 cindex:[external transports]
474 The only external transport currently implemented is an SMTP transport over a
475 TCP/IP network (using sockets, including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
476 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
477 and pipes, optionally in 'batched SMTP' format; these facilities can be used
478 to send messages to some other transport mechanism such as UUCP, provided it
479 can handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
481 - Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
482 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages ``delivered'' into files
483 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
486 - Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
487 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
488 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
489 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
490 a number of common scanners are provided.
496 Run time configuration
497 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
498 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
499 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
500 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
501 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
502 distribution, and is described in chapter <<CHAPdefconfil>> below.
508 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,command line interface]
509 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
510 can be a straight replacement for _/usr/lib/sendmail_ or
511 _/usr/sbin/sendmail_ when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
512 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
513 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
514 example, %-bp%, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
515 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
516 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter <<CHAPcommandline>>
517 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
518 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
520 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
521 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called 'eximon', which
522 displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
523 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
529 cindex:[terminology definitions]
530 cindex:[body of message,definition of]
531 The 'body' of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
532 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the 'header' (see
533 below) by a blank line.
535 cindex:[bounce message,definition of]
536 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
537 delivery failure message or a ``non-delivery report'' (NDR). The term 'bounce'
538 is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often called
539 'bounce messages'. This is a convenient shorthand for ``delivery failure error
540 report''. Such messages have an empty sender address in the message's
541 'envelope' (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give rise to
542 further bounce messages.
544 The term 'default' appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
545 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
546 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
549 The term 'defer' is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
550 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
551 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are 'deferred'
554 The word 'domain' is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
555 host's name. It is 'not' used in that sense here, where it normally
556 refers to the part of an email address following the @ sign.
558 cindex:[envelope, definition of]
559 cindex:[sender,definition of]
560 A message in transit has an associated 'envelope', as well as a header and a
561 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
562 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
563 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
564 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
565 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
567 cindex:[message header, definition of]
568 cindex:[header section,definition of]
569 The 'header' of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
570 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as 'From:', 'To:',
571 'Subject:', etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
572 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
575 cindex:[local part,definition of]
576 cindex:[domain,definition of]
577 The term 'local part', which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
578 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
579 @ sign is called the 'domain' or 'mail domain'.
581 cindex:[local delivery,definition of]
582 cindex:[remote delivery, definition of]
583 The terms 'local delivery' and 'remote delivery' are used to distinguish
584 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
585 TCP/IP to a remote host.
587 cindex:[return path,definition of]
588 'Return path' is another name that is used for the sender address in a
591 cindex:[queue,definition of]
592 The term 'queue' is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
593 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
594 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
595 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
597 cindex:[queue runner,definition of]
598 The term 'queue runner' is used to describe a process that scans the queue
599 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
600 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command %runq%, but in Exim
601 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
603 cindex:[spool directory,definition of]
604 The term 'spool directory' is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
605 messages on its queue -- that is, those that it is in the process of
606 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
607 mailboxes are stored, which is called a ``spool directory'' by some people. In
608 the Exim documentation, ``spool'' is always used in the first sense.
615 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
616 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
620 cindex:[incorporated code]
621 cindex:[regular expressions,library]
623 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
625 - Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the Exim
626 monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright (c) University
627 of Cambridge. The source is distributed in the directory _src/pcre_. However,
628 this is a cut-down version of PCRE. If you want to use the PCRE library in
629 other programs, you should obtain and install the full version from
630 *ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre[]*.
632 - cindex:[cdb,acknowledgement]
633 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
634 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
635 Online Ltd. which contains the following statements:
637 Copyright (c) 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
639 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
640 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
641 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
644 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
645 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
646 *http://www.pobox.com/{tl}djb/cdb.html[]*. This implementation borrows some code
647 from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license restrictions applied
650 The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
651 It does not link against an external cdb library.
653 - cindex:[SPA authentication]
654 cindex:[Samba project]
655 cindex:[Microsoft Secure Password Authentication]
656 Client support for Microsoft's 'Secure Password Authentication' is provided
657 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
658 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
662 cindex:['pwcheck' daemon]
663 cindex:['pwauthd' daemon]
664 Support for calling the Cyrus 'pwcheck' and 'saslauthd' daemons is provided
665 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
666 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
667 conditions expressed therein.
669 Copyright (c) 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
671 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
672 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
675 . Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
676 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
678 . Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
679 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
680 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
683 . The name ``Carnegie Mellon University'' must not be used to
684 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
685 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
686 details, please contact
689 Office of Technology Transfer
690 Carnegie Mellon University
692 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
693 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
694 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
697 . Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
700 'This product includes software developed by Computing Services
701 at Carnegie Mellon University (*http://www.cmu.edu/computing/[]*).'
703 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
704 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
705 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
706 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
707 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
708 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
709 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
714 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
715 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
716 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
717 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
719 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
720 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
724 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
725 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
726 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
727 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
728 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
729 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
730 software without specific, written prior permission.
732 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
733 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
734 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
735 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
736 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
737 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
740 . Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
741 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
742 contributors are happy to see their code incoporated into Exim under the GPL.
748 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
749 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
751 [titleabbrev="Receiving and delivering mail"]
752 How Exim receives and delivers mail
753 -----------------------------------
758 cindex:[design philosophy]
759 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
760 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
761 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
762 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
763 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
764 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
770 cindex:[policy control,overview]
771 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
772 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
773 ``open relays'' by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of unsolicited
774 junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible facilities for
775 specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
777 - cindex:[{ACL},introduction]
778 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
779 incoming mail by means of 'Access Control Lists' (ACLs). Each list is a
780 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
781 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
782 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at
783 the very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting
784 or rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at
785 these two points (see chapter <<CHAPACL>>). Denial of access results in an SMTP
788 - An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
789 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
791 - When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
792 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
793 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
794 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
796 - When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
797 host, but before the final acknowledgement has been sent, a locally supplied C
798 function called 'local_scan()' can be run to inspect the message and decide
799 whether to accept it or not (see chapter <<CHAPlocalscan>>). If the message is
800 accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
802 - Using the 'local_scan()' mechanism is another way of calling external
803 scanner software. The %SA-Exim% add-on package works this way. It does not
804 require Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
806 - After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
807 the form of the 'system filter' (see chapter <<CHAPsystemfilter>>). This runs
808 at the start of every delivery process.
814 cindex:[filter,introduction]
815 cindex:[Sieve filter]
816 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
817 setting up appropriate _.forward_ files in their home directories. See
818 chapter <<CHAPredirect>> (about the ^redirect^ router) for the configuration
819 needed to support this, and the separate document entitled 'Exim's interfaces
820 to mail filtering' for user details. Two different kinds of filtering are
823 - Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
826 - Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
827 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
829 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
834 Message identification
835 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
836 cindex:[message ids, details of format]
837 cindex:[format,of message id]
838 cindex:[id of message]
843 Every message handled by Exim is given a 'message id' which is sixteen
844 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
845 example `16VDhn-0001bo-D3`. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
846 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
847 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
848 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
849 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
852 cindex:[pid (process id),re-use of]
853 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
854 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
855 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
856 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
857 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
860 - The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
861 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
862 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
863 way of representing the date and time of day).
865 - After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
866 received the message.
868 - There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
870 . cindex:[%localhost_number%]
871 If %localhost_number% is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
872 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
873 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
874 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
876 . If %localhost_number% is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
877 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
880 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
881 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
882 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
883 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
884 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
889 cindex:[receiving mail]
890 cindex:[message,reception]
891 The only way Exim can receive mail from a remote host is using SMTP over
892 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are tranferred using
893 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
894 there are several possibilities:
896 - If the process runs Exim with the %-bm% option, the message is read
897 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
898 command line, or from the body of the message if %-t% is also used.
900 - If the process runs Exim with the %-bS% option, the message is also read
901 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
902 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
903 command. This is so-called ``batch SMTP'' format,
904 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
905 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
907 - If the process runs Exim with the %-bs% option, the message is read
908 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
909 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
910 This is ``real'' SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
911 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
913 - A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
914 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
915 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
916 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
919 cindex:[message sender, constructed by Exim]
920 cindex:[sender,constructed by Exim]
921 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
922 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
923 qualification domain (which can be set by the %qualify_domain% configuration
924 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
925 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
926 certain users (``trusted users'') to specify a different sender address
927 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
928 address. The %-f% option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
929 different addresses. See section <<SECTtrustedadmin>> for details of trusted
930 users, and the %untrusted_set_sender% option for a way of allowing untrusted
931 users to change sender addresses.
933 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
934 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
935 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
936 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
937 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
938 requirements are not met. The 'local_scan()' function (see chapter
939 <<CHAPlocalscan>>) is run for all incoming messages.
941 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
942 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
943 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
944 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
945 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
952 Handling an incoming message
953 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
954 cindex:[spool directory,files that hold a message]
955 cindex:[file,how a message is held]
956 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
957 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
958 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
959 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by `-H` for the
960 file containing the envelope and header, and `-D` for the data file.
962 cindex:[spool directory,_input_ sub-directory]
963 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
964 _input_ inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
965 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets very large; to
966 improve performance in such cases, the %split_spool_directory% option can be
967 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
968 whose names are single letters or digits.
970 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
971 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
972 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
973 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
974 first spool file is described in chapter <<CHAPspool>>.
976 cindex:[rewriting,addresses]
977 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
978 (see chapter <<CHAPrewrite>>) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
979 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
980 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
981 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
982 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
983 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
984 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
985 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
986 delivered (see chapters <<CHAProutergeneric>> and <<CHAPtransportgeneric>>).
992 cindex:[message,life of]
993 cindex:[message,frozen]
994 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
995 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
996 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
997 cannot proceed -- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
998 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked ``frozen'' on the
999 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1001 cindex:[frozen messages,thawing]
1002 cindex:[message,thawing frozen]
1003 An administrator can ``thaw'' such messages when the problem has been corrected,
1004 and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In addition, an
1005 administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message to be sent.
1007 cindex:[%auto_thaw%]
1008 There is an option called %auto_thaw%, which can be used to cause Exim to
1009 retry frozen messages after a certain time. When this is set, no message will
1010 remain on the queue for ever, because the delivery timeout will eventually be
1011 reached. Delivery failure reports (bounce messages) that reach this timeout are
1014 cindex:[%timeout_frozen_after%]
1015 There is also an option called %timeout_frozen_after%, which discards frozen
1016 messages after a certain time.
1018 cindex:[message,log file for]
1019 cindex:[log,file for each message]
1020 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1021 attempt to the main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1022 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter <<CHAPlog>>). The log lines
1023 are also written to a separate 'message log' file for each message. These
1024 logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally deleted
1025 along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1026 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1027 %no_message_logs%; this might give an improvement in performance on very
1030 cindex:[journal file]
1031 cindex:[file,journal]
1032 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1033 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1034 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1035 message id followed by `-J`. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1036 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the `-H` file)
1037 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1038 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1039 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1041 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1042 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1043 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1044 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1045 deliveries caused by crashes.
1050 Processing an address for delivery
1051 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1052 cindex:[drivers,definition of]
1053 cindex:[router,definition of]
1054 cindex:[transport,definition of]
1055 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called 'routers' and
1056 'transports', and collectively these are known as 'drivers'. Code for a
1057 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1058 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1059 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1061 cindex:[drivers,instance definition]
1062 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an 'instance'
1063 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1064 you can set up several different ^smtp^ transports, each with different
1065 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1066 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1067 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1068 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1069 the driver's features in general.
1071 A 'router' is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1072 its delivery should happen, by routing it to a specific transport, or
1073 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1074 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1077 A 'transport' is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1078 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a 'local'
1079 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1080 'remote' transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1081 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1082 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1084 cindex:[preconditions,definition of]
1085 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1086 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1087 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1088 detail shortly. As a simple example, the diagram below illustrates how each
1089 recipient address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three
1090 routers that are configured in various ways.
1092 To make this a more concrete example, we'll describe it in terms of some actual
1093 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1094 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1097 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1098 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1099 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1100 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1101 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do 'not'
1102 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1103 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1104 queued for a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1105 configured to fail the address.
1108 The example pictured could be a configuration of this type. The second and
1109 third routers can only be run for addresses for which the preconditions for
1110 the first router are not met. If one of these preconditions checks the
1111 domain, the second and third routers are run only for domains that are somehow
1112 special to the local host.
1115 The second router does redirection -- also known as aliasing and forwarding.
1116 When it generates one or more new addresses from the original, each of them is
1117 routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the router may cause an address
1118 to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the address, in which case the
1119 address is passed to the next router.
1121 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1122 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1123 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1124 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1125 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1126 the address is bounced.
1130 Processing an address for verification
1131 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1132 cindex:[router,for verification]
1133 cindex:[verifying address, overview]
1134 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1135 are also used for 'address verification'. Verification can be requested as
1136 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1137 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the %-bv% and
1138 %-bvs% command line options.
1140 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in ``verify mode''. This
1141 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1142 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1143 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1144 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1145 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1146 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the %no_verify% option
1147 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1153 Running an individual router
1154 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1155 cindex:[router,running details]
1156 cindex:[preconditions,checking]
1157 cindex:[router,result of running]
1158 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1159 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1160 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router 'are' met,
1161 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1164 - 'accept': The router accepts the address, and either queues it for a
1165 transport, or generates one or more ``child'' addresses. Processing the original
1167 cindex:[%unseen% option]
1168 unless the %unseen% option is set on the router. This option
1169 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1170 for keeping archive copies of messages). When %unseen% is set, the address is
1171 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an 'accept' return marks the
1174 cindex:[case of local parts]
1175 cindex:[address duplicate, discarding]
1176 If child addresses are generated, Exim checks to see whether they are
1177 duplicates of any existing recipient addresses. During this check, local parts
1178 are treated as case-sensitive. Duplicate addresses are discarded. Each of the
1179 remaining child addresses is then processed independently, starting with the
1180 first router by default. It is possible to change this by setting the
1181 %redirect_router% option to specify which router to start at for child
1182 addresses. Unlike %pass_router% (see below) the router specified by
1183 %redirect_router% may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1185 - 'pass': The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1186 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1187 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1188 %pass_router% option. However, (unlike %redirect_router%) the named router
1189 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1191 - 'decline': The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1192 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1193 this can be prevented by setting the %no_more% option. When %no_more% is set,
1194 all the remaining routers are skipped.
1196 - 'fail': The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1197 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1198 original address unless %unseen% is set on the router.
1200 - 'defer': The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A database
1201 may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further processing of
1202 the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again next time the
1203 message is considered for delivery.
1205 - 'error': There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1206 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1208 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1209 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable.
1210 The default error message in this situation is ``unrouteable address'', but you
1211 can set your own message by making use of the %cannot_route_message% option.
1212 This can be set for any router; the value from the last router that ``saw''
1213 the address is used.
1215 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1216 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1217 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1218 when the relevant conditions are met. The ^redirect^ router has a ``fail''
1219 facility for this purpose.
1225 Router preconditions
1226 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1227 cindex:[router preconditions, order of processing]
1228 cindex:[preconditions,order of processing]
1229 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1230 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1231 described in more detail in chapter <<CHAProutergeneric>>.
1233 - The %local_part_prefix% and %local_part_suffix% options can specify that
1234 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1235 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1236 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1237 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1238 of any other conditions.
1240 - Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1241 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1242 %verify% option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1244 Setting the %verify% option actually sets two options, %verify_sender% and
1245 %verify_recipient%, which independently control the use of the router for
1246 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1247 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1249 - If the %address_test% option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1250 run with the %-bt% option to test an address routing. This can be helpful when
1251 the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it makes it
1252 possible to use %-bt% to test subsequent delivery routing without having to
1253 simulate the effect of the scanner.
1255 - Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1256 opposed to routing it for delivery. The %verify_only% option controls this.
1258 - Certain routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to check an
1259 address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the %expn% option).
1261 - If the %domains% option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set of
1262 domains that it defines.
1264 - If the %local_parts% option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1265 the set of local parts that it defines. If %local_part_prefix% or
1266 %local_part_suffix% is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1267 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1268 that include affixes, you can do so by using a %condition% option (see below)
1269 that uses the variables $local_part$, $local_part_prefix$, and
1270 $local_part_suffix$ as necessary.
1272 - If the %check_local_user% option is set, the local part must be the name of
1273 an account on the local host.
1274 If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the local user are placed in
1275 $local_user_uid$ and $local_user_gid$; these values can be used in the
1276 remaining preconditions.
1278 - If the %router_home_directory% option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1279 because it overrides the value of $home$. If this expansion were left till
1280 later, the value of $home$ as set by %check_local_user% would be used in
1281 subsequent tests. Having two different values of $home$ in the same router
1282 could lead to confusion.
1284 - If the %senders% option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the set
1285 of addresses that it defines.
1287 - If the %require_files% option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1288 specified files is tested.
1290 - cindex:[customizing,precondition]
1291 If the %condition% option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option uses
1292 an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1293 Expanded strings are described in chapter <<CHAPexpand>>.
1296 Note that %require_files% comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use it
1297 to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1298 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1299 %exists% expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1300 %require_files% option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1301 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1302 example, _.procmailrc_).
1308 cindex:[delivery,in detail]
1309 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1311 - If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1312 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1313 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1314 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1315 files, described in the separate document entitled
1316 'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'.
1317 cindex:[Sieve filter,not available for system filter]
1318 (*Note*: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1320 Some additional features are available in system filters -- see chapter
1321 <<CHAPsystemfilter>> for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1322 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1323 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1324 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1325 condition %first_delivery% can be used to detect the first run of the system
1328 - Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject
1329 to its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle
1330 the address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because
1331 routers can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains
1332 can be processed entirely independently of each other.
1334 - cindex:[routing,loops in]
1335 cindex:[loop,while routing]
1336 A router that accepts an address may set up a local or a remote transport for
1337 it. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address is
1338 placed on a list for the particular transport, to be run later. Alternatively,
1339 the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically from alias,
1340 forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this process from
1341 the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address which has an
1342 identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1344 - When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1345 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1346 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1347 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1348 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1349 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1350 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1351 addresses to the same domain.
1353 - Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1354 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1355 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1356 to Exim (``the Exim user''), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1357 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1358 one message is set by the %remote_max_parallel% option.
1359 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1360 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1362 - cindex:[queue runner]
1363 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1364 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1365 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1366 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1367 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1368 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1369 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1370 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1371 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1373 - cindex:[delivery,retry in remote transports]
1374 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1375 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1376 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1377 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1378 not. See chapter <<CHAPretry>> for details of retry strategies.
1380 - If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1381 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1382 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1383 messages to other addresses.
1385 - cindex:[delivery,deferral]
1386 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1387 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1390 - When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1391 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1392 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1399 cindex:[delivery,retry mechanism]
1400 cindex:[retry,description of mechanism]
1401 cindex:[queue runner]
1402 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1403 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1404 uses the %-q% option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1405 intervals, or use some other means (such as 'cron') to start them. If you do
1406 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1407 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1408 it way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1409 passed its retry time.
1410 You can run several queue runners at once.
1412 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1413 address (see chapter <<CHAPretry>>). These rules also specify when Exim should
1414 give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a bounce
1415 message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and error
1416 combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated as
1421 Temporary delivery failure
1422 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1423 cindex:[delivery,temporary failure]
1424 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1425 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1426 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1427 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1428 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1429 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1430 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1433 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1434 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1435 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1438 cindex:[hints database]
1439 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1440 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1441 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1442 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1448 Permanent delivery failure
1449 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1450 cindex:[delivery,permanent failure]
1451 cindex:[bounce message,when generated]
1452 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1453 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1454 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1455 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1456 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1457 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1458 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1459 See chapter <<CHAPemsgcust>> for details.
1461 cindex:['X-Failed-Recipients:' header line]
1462 Bounce messages contain an 'X-Failed-Recipients:' header line that lists the
1463 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1466 cindex:[bounce message,recipient of]
1467 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1468 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1469 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is
1470 expanded via a forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified
1471 for delivery failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion
1472 (see section <<SECTmailinglists>>) it is common to direct bounce messages to the
1473 manager of the list.
1478 Failures to deliver bounce messages
1479 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1480 cindex:[bounce message,failure to deliver]
1481 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1482 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1483 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1484 which can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1485 for only a short time (see %timeout_frozen_after% and
1486 %ignore_bounce_errors_after%).
1492 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1493 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1495 Building and installing Exim
1496 ----------------------------
1498 cindex:[building Exim]
1502 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when upacked,
1503 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1504 _exim-{version}_) into which the following files are placed:
1507 `--------------------`--------------------------------------------------------
1508 _ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_ contains some acknowledgments
1509 _CHANGES_ contains a reference to where changes are documented
1510 _LICENCE_ the GNU General Public Licence
1511 _Makefile_ top-level make file
1512 _NOTICE_ conditions for the use of Exim
1513 _README_ list of files, directories and simple build instructions
1514 ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1516 Other files whose names begin with _README_ may also be present. The
1517 following subdirectories are created:
1520 `--------------------`------------------------------------------------
1521 _Local_ an empty directory for local configuration files
1522 _OS_ OS-specific files
1523 _doc_ documentation files
1524 _exim_monitor_ source files for the Exim monitor
1525 _scripts_ scripts used in the build process
1526 _src_ remaining source files
1527 _util_ independent utilities
1528 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
1530 The main utility programs are contained in the _src_ directory, and are built
1531 with the Exim binary. The _util_ directory contains a few optional scripts
1532 that may be useful to some sites.
1535 Multiple machine architectures and operating systems
1536 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1537 cindex:[building Exim,multiple OS/architectures]
1538 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1539 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1540 source files. Compilation does not take place in the _src_ directory. Instead,
1541 a 'build directory' is created for each architecture and operating system.
1543 cindex:[symbolic link,to build directory]
1544 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1545 the actual building takes place.
1547 In most cases, Exim can discover the machine architecture and operating system
1548 for itself, but the defaults can be overridden if necessary.
1554 cindex:[DBM libraries, discussion of]
1555 cindex:[hints database,DBM files used for]
1556 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1557 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1558 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1559 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1561 cindex:[Solaris,DBM library for]
1562 cindex:[IRIX, DBM library for]
1563 cindex:[BSD, DBM library for]
1564 cindex:[Linux, DBM library for]
1565 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1566 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1567 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1568 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1570 cindex:['ndbm' DBM library]
1571 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1572 via the 'ndbm' interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1573 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1574 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1575 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1576 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardised on the
1577 Berkeley DB library.
1579 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1580 use. When a program opens a file called _dbmfile_, there are four
1583 . A traditional 'ndbm' implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1584 Solaris, operates on two files called _dbmfile.dir_ and _dbmfile.pag_.
1586 . cindex:['gdbm' DBM library]
1587 The GNU library, 'gdbm', operates on a single file. If used via its 'ndbm'
1588 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1589 _dbmfile.dir_ and _dbmfile.pag_, but if used via its native interface, the
1590 file name is used unmodified.
1592 . cindex:[Berkeley DB library]
1593 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its 'ndbm' compatibility interface,
1594 operates on a single file called _dbmfile.db_, but otherwise looks to the
1595 programmer exactly the same as the traditional 'ndbm' implementation.
1597 . If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1598 file called _dbmfile_; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1599 the traditional 'ndbm' interface.
1601 . To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1602 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1603 2.'x' and 3.'x' were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1604 numbered 4.'x'. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1605 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1608 *http://www.sleepycat.com/[]*
1611 . cindex:['tdb' DBM library]
1612 Yet another DBM library, called 'tdb', has become available from
1615 *http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb[]*
1618 It has its own interface, and also operates on a single file.
1621 cindex:[DBM libraries, configuration for building]
1622 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1623 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1624 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1625 _Local/Makefile_). For example:
1629 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1630 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1632 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1633 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1634 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1635 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1636 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1637 _Local/Makefile_, however, overrides these system defaults.
1639 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1640 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1641 in one of these lines:
1646 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1647 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1648 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1649 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1652 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1653 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1656 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1657 file _doc/dbm.discuss.txt_ in the Exim distribution.
1661 Pre-building configuration
1662 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1663 cindex:[building Exim,pre-building configuration]
1664 cindex:[configuration for building Exim]
1665 cindex:[_Local/Makefile_]
1666 cindex:[_src/EDITME_]
1667 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1668 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1669 _Local/Makefile_. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1670 _src/EDITME_, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1671 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1672 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1673 _src/EDITME_ to _Local/Makefile_, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1675 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1676 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1677 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1678 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1679 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1680 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1682 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1683 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1684 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1685 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1686 you specify them in _Local/Makefile_ instead of at run time, so that errors
1687 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1690 cindex:[content scanning,specifying at build time]
1691 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning sofware directly from
1692 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1693 facilities, you need to set
1695 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1697 in your _Local/Makefile_. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1698 chapter <<CHAPexiscan>>.
1701 cindex:[_Local/eximon.conf_]
1702 cindex:[_exim_monitor/EDITME_]
1703 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1704 required. The file _exim_monitor/EDITME_ must be edited appropriately for
1705 your installation and saved under the name _Local/eximon.conf_. If you are
1706 happy with the default settings described in _exim_monitor/EDITME_,
1707 _Local/eximon.conf_ can be empty, but it must exist.
1709 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1710 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1711 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1712 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1713 defaults to %gcc%. See section <<SECToverride>> below for details of how to do
1720 cindex:['iconv()' support]
1721 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1722 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1723 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1724 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the %\$h_%
1725 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1726 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1727 supports the 'iconv()' function.
1729 However, some of the operating systems that supply 'iconv()' do not support
1730 very many conversions. The GNU %libiconv% library (available from
1731 *http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/[]*) can be installed on such systems to
1732 remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply 'iconv()' at
1733 all. After installing %libiconv%, you should add
1737 to your _Local/Makefile_ and rebuild Exim.
1742 Including TLS/SSL encryption support
1743 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1744 cindex:[TLS,including support for TLS]
1745 cindex:[encryption,including support for]
1746 cindex:[SUPPORT_TLS]
1747 cindex:[OpenSSL,building Exim with]
1748 cindex:[GnuTLS,building Exim with]
1749 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1750 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1751 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1752 %tls_on_connect_ports% runtime option and the %-tls-on-connect% command
1755 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1756 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1759 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1762 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1764 in _Local/Makefile_. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1765 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1768 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1769 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1772 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1776 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1778 in _Local/Makefile_, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1779 library and include files. For example:
1783 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1784 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1786 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1787 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS
1788 are given in chapter <<CHAPTLS>>.
1795 cindex:[tcpwrappers, building Exim to support]
1796 cindex:[USE_TCP_WRAPPERS]
1797 Exim can be linked with the 'tcpwrappers' library in order to check incoming
1798 SMTP calls using the 'tcpwrappers' control files. This may be a convenient
1799 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1800 already making use of 'tcpwrappers' for other purposes. To do this, you should
1801 set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in _Local/Makefile_, arrange for the file
1802 _tcpd.h_ to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1803 _libwrap.a_ is available at link time, typically by including %-lwrap% in
1804 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if 'tcpwrappers' is installed in
1805 _/usr/local_, you might have
1807 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1808 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1809 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1811 in _Local/Makefile_. The name to use in the 'tcpwrappers' control files is
1812 ``exim''. For example, the line
1814 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1816 in your _/etc/hosts.allow_ file allows connections from the local host, from
1817 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in 'friendly.domain.example'.
1818 All other connections are denied. Consult the 'tcpwrappers' documentation for
1823 Including support for IPv6
1824 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1825 cindex:[IPv6,including support for]
1826 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1827 `HAVE_IPV6=YES` in _Local/Makefile_ causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1828 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1829 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1832 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1833 defined. AAAA records (analagous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1834 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1835 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1836 over-complex, and its status was reduced to ``experimental''. It is not known
1837 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1838 this is included only if you set `SUPPORT_A6=YES` in _Local/Makefile_. The
1839 support has not been tested for some time.
1843 The building process
1844 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1845 cindex:[build directory]
1846 Once _Local/Makefile_ (and _Local/eximon.conf_, if required) have been
1847 created, run 'make' at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1848 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1849 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1850 _build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_ is created.
1851 cindex:[symbolic link,to source files]
1852 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1854 *Warning*: The %-j% (parallel) flag must not be used with 'make'; the
1855 building process fails if it is set.
1857 If this is the first time 'make' has been run, it calls a script that builds
1858 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1859 _Local_ directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1860 'make'. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1861 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1862 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command 'make
1863 makefile' can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1864 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1866 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1867 _README_ file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1868 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1874 Overriding build-time options for Exim
1875 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1876 cindex:[build-time options, overriding]
1877 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1878 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1879 values, followed by a fixed set of 'make' instructions. If a value is set
1880 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1881 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
1885 _OS/Makefile-Default_
1886 _OS/Makefile-_<'ostype'>
1888 _Local/Makefile-_<'ostype'>
1889 _Local/Makefile-_<'archtype'>
1890 _Local/Makefile-_<'ostype'>-<'archtype'>
1894 cindex:[_Local/Makefile_]
1895 cindex:[building Exim,operating system type]
1896 cindex:[building Exim,architecture type]
1897 where <'ostype'> is the operating system type and <'archtype'> is the
1898 architecture type. _Local/Makefile_ is required to exist, and the building
1899 process fails if it is absent. The other three _Local_ files are optional,
1900 and are often not needed.
1902 The values used for <'ostype'> and <'archtype'> are obtained from scripts
1903 called _scripts/os-type_ and _scripts/arch-type_ respectively. If either of
1904 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
1905 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
1906 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the %uname% command. If this
1907 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
1908 of 'ad hoc' transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
1909 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
1910 to find out what values are being used on your system.
1913 _OS/Makefile-Default_ contains comments about the variables that are set
1914 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
1915 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
1916 file for your operating system (_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_) to see what the
1920 cindex:[building Exim,overriding default settings]
1921 If you need to change any of the values that are set in _OS/Makefile-Default_
1922 or in _OS/Makefile-<ostype>_, or to add any new definitions, you do not
1923 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
1924 putting the new values in an appropriate _Local_ file. For example,
1925 cindex:[Tru64-Unix build-time settings]
1926 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
1927 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
1928 compiler is called 'cc' rather than 'gcc'. Also, the compiler must be
1929 called with the option %-std1%, to make it recognize some of the features of
1930 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
1931 default.) To do this, you should create a file called _Local/Makefile-OSF1_
1932 containing the lines
1937 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
1938 these lines directly into _Local/Makefile_.
1940 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
1941 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
1942 the contents of the _Local_ directory.
1945 cindex:[NIS lookup type,including support for]
1946 cindex:[NIS+ lookup type,including support for]
1947 cindex:[LDAP,including support for]
1948 cindex:[lookup,inclusion in binary]
1949 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
1950 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
1951 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
1952 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
1953 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
1954 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for _Local/Makefile_ are:
1960 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
1961 _src/EDITME_. In most cases the relevant include files and interface
1962 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
1963 cindex:[cdb,including support for]
1964 However, in the case of cdb, which is included in the binary only if
1968 is set, the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
1969 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
1970 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
1973 cindex:[Perl,including support for]
1974 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
1975 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
1979 must be defined in _Local/Makefile_. Details of this facility are given in
1980 chapter <<CHAPperl>>.
1982 cindex:[X11 libraries, location of]
1983 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
1984 operating systems, and of course there are different versions of X11 to cope
1985 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
1986 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
1987 The following three variables are set in _OS/Makefile-Default_:
1990 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
1991 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
1993 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
1994 example, in _OS/Makefile-SunOS5_ there is
1997 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
1998 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2000 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2001 definition of all three of these variables into your
2002 _Local/Makefile-<ostype>_ file.
2005 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2006 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2007 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2008 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2010 cindex:[DBM libraries, configuration for building]
2011 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2012 use DBM functions (see also section <<SECTdb>>). Finally, there is
2013 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2014 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2017 cindex:[configuration file,editing]
2018 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2019 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2020 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is, _Local/Makefile_
2021 or _Local/eximon.conf_) before rebuilding.
2024 OS-specific header files
2025 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2027 cindex:[building Exim,OS-specific C header files]
2028 The _OS_ directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2029 _os.h-<ostype>_. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2030 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2031 recognized in the file _OS/os.configuring_, which should be consulted if you
2032 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2036 Overriding build-time options for the monitor
2037 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2038 cindex:[building Eximon,overriding default options]
2039 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2040 where the files that are involved are
2043 _OS/eximon.conf-Default_
2044 _OS/eximon.conf-_<'ostype'>
2046 _Local/eximon.conf-_<'ostype'>
2047 _Local/eximon.conf-_<'archtype'>
2048 _Local/eximon.conf-_<'ostype'>-<'archtype'>
2051 cindex:[_Local/eximon.conf_]
2052 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2053 _OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_ file is also optional. The default values in
2054 _OS/eximon.conf-Default_ can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2055 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2056 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2057 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2062 Installing Exim binaries and scripts
2063 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2064 cindex:[installing Exim]
2065 cindex:[BIN_DIRECTORY]
2066 The command 'make install' runs the 'exim_install' script with no
2067 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2068 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in
2071 cindex:[CONFIGURE_FILE]
2072 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2073 in _Local/Makefile_. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2074 exist, the default configuration file _src/configure.default_ is copied there
2075 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2076 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2077 alternative files, no default is installed.
2079 cindex:[system aliases file]
2080 cindex:[_/etc/aliases_]
2081 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2082 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2083 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2084 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in _Local/Makefile_ (_/etc/aliases_ by default).
2085 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2086 and outputs a comment to the user.
2088 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2089 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2090 kept in _/etc/aliases_. However, some operating systems are now using
2091 _/etc/mail/aliases_. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2092 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2094 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2095 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory _/var/mail_,
2096 running as the local user. System aliases and _.forward_ files in users' home
2097 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2098 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2101 cindex:[setuid,installing Exim with]
2102 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2103 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2104 'setuid' bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run 'make
2105 install' as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2106 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2107 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2108 chapter <<CHAPsecurity>> for details).
2110 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2111 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2114 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2116 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2117 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2118 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name 'is' modified.)
2119 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2120 but this usage is deprecated.
2122 cindex:[installing Exim,what is not installed]
2123 Running 'make install' does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2124 'convert4r4', or the 'pcretest' test program. You will probably run the
2125 first of these only once (if you are upgrading from Exim 3), and the second
2126 isn't really part of Exim. None of the documentation files in the _doc_
2127 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2128 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section <<SECTinsinfdoc>> below.
2130 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix _.O_
2131 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2132 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2133 for example _exim-{version}-1_. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2134 called _exim_ to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2135 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name _exim_ is never absent
2136 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2138 cindex:[installing Exim,testing the script]
2139 If you want to see what the 'make install' will do before running it for
2140 real, you can pass the %-n% option to the installation script by this command:
2142 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2144 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2145 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2146 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2147 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2150 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2152 cindex:[installing Exim,install script options]
2153 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2155 - %-no_chown% bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2156 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2158 - %-no_symlink% bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link _exim_ to the
2161 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2163 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2166 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2167 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2168 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2170 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2176 Installing info documentation
2177 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2178 cindex:[installing Exim,'info' documentation]
2179 Not all systems use the GNU 'info' system for documentation, and for this
2180 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2181 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2184 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in _Local/Makefile_ and the Texinfo
2185 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running 'make
2186 install' automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2190 Setting up the spool directory
2191 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2192 cindex:[spool directory,creating]
2193 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2194 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2195 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2203 cindex:[testing,installation]
2204 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2205 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2206 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2210 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2211 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2212 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2213 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2214 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2217 exim -bt <local username>
2219 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2221 exim -bt <remote address>
2223 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2224 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2225 user agent. For example:
2227 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2228 From: user@your.domain.example
2229 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2230 Subject: Testing Exim
2232 This is a test message.
2235 The %-v% option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2236 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2237 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing ``Completed''.
2239 cindex:[delivery,problems with]
2240 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files ('mainlog' and
2241 'paniclog') to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2242 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2243 %-d% option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2244 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2246 exim -d -M <message-id>
2248 You must be root or an ``admin user'' in order to do this. The %-d% option
2249 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2250 For example, if you use %-d-all+route% only the debugging information relevant
2251 to routing is included. (See the %-d% option in chapter <<CHAPcommandline>> for
2254 cindex:[``sticky'' bit]
2256 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2257 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2258 ``sticky bit'' set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2259 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2260 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the ``sticky bit'' on the
2261 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2262 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2263 ^local_delivery^ transport in the default configuration file). Another
2264 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2265 'fcntl()' locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2266 agents also use 'fcntl()' locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2267 see chapter <<CHAPappendfile>>.
2269 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2270 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2271 %-oX% option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2272 port, or 'inetd' can be used to do this. The %-bh% option and the
2273 'exim_checkaccess' utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2276 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2277 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2278 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2279 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2283 Replacing another MTA with Exim
2284 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2285 cindex:[replacing another MTA]
2286 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2287 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2288 is either _/usr/sbin/sendmail_, or _/usr/lib/sendmail_ (depending on the
2289 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the 'exim'
2290 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2291 normally done by renaming any existing file and making _/usr/sbin/sendmail_
2292 or _/usr/lib/sendmail_
2294 cindex:[symbolic link,to 'exim' binary]
2295 a symbolic link to the 'exim' binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2296 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2297 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2299 cindex:[FreeBSD, MTA indirection]
2300 cindex:[_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_]
2301 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2302 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2303 _/etc/mail/mailer.conf_ instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2304 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2307 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2308 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2309 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2310 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2313 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited _/etc/mail/mailer.conf_,
2314 your Exim installation is ``live''. Check it by sending a message from your
2315 favourite user agent.
2317 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2318 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2319 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2320 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2321 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2322 'Exim's interface to mail filtering'
2329 cindex:[upgrading Exim]
2330 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2331 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2332 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2333 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-exec itself, and thereby pick up the new
2334 binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2339 Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris
2340 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2341 cindex:[Solaris,stopping Exim on]
2342 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2344 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2346 If _/usr/lib/sendmail_ has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2347 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command 'ps -e' and greps the output
2348 for the text ``sendmail''; this is not present because the actual program name
2349 (that is, ``exim'') is given by the 'ps' command with these options. A solution
2350 is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2352 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2354 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2356 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not ``stop Exim''. Messages can
2357 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2358 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2363 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2364 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2367 The Exim command line
2368 ---------------------
2369 cindex:[command line,options]
2370 cindex:[options,command line]
2371 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2372 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2373 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2374 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2375 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2376 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2379 Setting options by program name
2380 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2382 If Exim is called under the name 'mailq', it behaves as if the option %-bp%
2383 were present before any other options.
2384 The %-bp% option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2386 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2387 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2388 _/usr/sbin/sendmail_ or _/usr/lib/sendmail_.
2391 If Exim is called under the name 'rsmtp' it behaves as if the option %-bS%
2392 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The %-bS%
2393 option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP format.
2396 If Exim is called under the name 'rmail' it behaves as if the %-i% and
2397 %-oee% options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2398 Smail. The name 'rmail' is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2401 cindex:[queue runner]
2402 If Exim is called under the name 'runq' it behaves as if the option %-q% were
2403 present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The %-q%
2404 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2406 cindex:['newaliases']
2407 cindex:[alias file,building]
2408 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,calling Exim as 'newaliases']
2409 If Exim is called under the name 'newaliases' it behaves as if the option
2410 %-bi% were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2411 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2412 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2413 command if called with the %-bi% option.
2416 [[SECTtrustedadmin]]
2417 Trusted and admin users
2418 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2419 Some Exim options are available only to 'trusted users' and others are
2420 available only to 'admin users'. In the description below, the phrases ``Exim
2421 user'' and ``Exim group'' mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2422 EXIM_GROUP in _Local/Makefile_ or set by the %exim_user% and
2423 %exim_group% options. These do not necessarily have to use the name ``exim''.
2425 - cindex:[trusted user,definition of]
2426 cindex:[user, trusted definition of]
2427 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2428 %trusted_users% configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2429 supplementary group is one of those listed in the %trusted_groups%
2430 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2432 cindex:[``From'' line]
2433 cindex:[envelope sender]
2434 Trusted users are always permitted to use the %-f% option or a leading ``From ''
2435 line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to Exim through
2436 the local interface (see the %-bm% and %-f% options below). See the
2437 %untrusted_set_sender% option for a way of permitting non-trusted users to
2438 set envelope senders.
2440 cindex:['From:' header line]
2441 cindex:['Sender:' header line]
2442 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the 'From:'
2443 header line, and a 'Sender:' line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2444 'Sender:' line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2446 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2447 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2448 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2449 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2450 users may in some circumstances use %-f%, but can never set the other values
2451 that are available to trusted users.
2453 - cindex:[user, admin definition of]
2454 cindex:[admin user,definition of]
2455 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2456 Exim group or of any group listed in the %admin_groups% configuration option.
2457 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2459 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2460 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2461 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2462 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2464 By default, the use of the %-M%, %-q%, %-R%, and %-S% options to cause Exim
2465 to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2466 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the %prod_requires_admin%
2467 option false (that is, specifying %no_prod_requires_admin%).
2469 Similarly, the use of the %-bp% option to list all the messages in the queue
2470 is restricted to admin users unless %queue_list_requires_admin% is set
2474 *Warning*: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2475 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2476 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2482 Command line options
2483 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2484 The command options are described in alphabetical order below.
2487 We insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the start of the command
2488 line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2489 creates a man page for the options.
2493 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2499 cindex:[options, command line; terminating]
2500 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2501 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2502 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2506 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2507 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2512 cindex:[8-bit characters]
2513 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,8-bit characters]
2514 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2515 clean; it ignores this option.
2520 cindex:[SMTP listener]
2521 cindex:[queue runner]
2522 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2523 the %-bd% option is combined with the %-q%<'time'> option, to specify that
2524 the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2526 The %-bd% option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the %-d%
2527 (debugging) or %-v% (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2528 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2529 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2531 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2532 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2533 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2534 <<CHAPinterfaces>> contains a description of the options that control this.
2536 When a listening daemon
2537 cindex:[daemon,process id (pid)]
2538 cindex:[pid (process id),of daemon]
2539 is started without the use of %-oX% (that is, without overriding the normal
2540 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called _exim-daemon.pid_ in
2541 Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2542 PID_FILE_PATH in _Local/Makefile_. The file is written while Exim is still
2545 When %-oX% is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2546 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, %-oP% can be
2547 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2551 can be used to cause the daemon to re-exec itself. This should be done whenever
2552 Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by means of
2553 the %.include% facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version of Exim is
2554 installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are referenced
2555 from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed, because these
2556 are reread each time they are used.
2560 This option has the same effect as %-bd% except that it never disconnects from
2561 the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2565 cindex:[testing,string expansion]
2566 cindex:[expansion,testing]
2567 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2568 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2569 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2572 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in _Local/Makefile_, it tries
2573 to load the %libreadline% library dynamically whenever the %-be% option is
2574 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the 'readline()'
2575 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2576 test data. A line history is supported.
2578 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2579 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, whitespace at the start of
2580 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2581 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2582 configuration file (for example, $qualify_domain$) are available, but no
2583 message-specific values (such as $domain$) are set, because no message is
2586 *-bF*~<'filename'>::
2588 cindex:[system filter,testing]
2589 cindex:[testing,system filter]
2590 This option is the same as %-bf% except that it assumes that the filter being
2591 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2592 system filters are recognized.
2594 *-bf*~<'filename'>::
2596 cindex:[filter,testing]
2597 cindex:[testing,filter file]
2598 cindex:[forward file,testing]
2599 cindex:[testing,forward file]
2600 cindex:[Sieve filter,testing]
2601 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2602 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2603 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2606 If you want to test a system filter file, use %-bF% instead of %-bf%. You can
2607 use both %-bF% and %-bf% on the same command, in order to
2608 test a system filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2610 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2612 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2613 variables that are used by the user filter.
2615 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2620 it is taken to be a normal _.forward_ file, and is tested for validity under
2621 that interpretation. See sections <<SECTitenonfilred>> to <<SECTspecitredli>> for a
2622 description of the possible contents of non-filter redirection lists.
2624 The result of an Exim command that uses %-bf%, provided no errors are
2625 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2626 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2627 separate document entitled 'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'.
2629 When testing a filter file,
2630 cindex:[``From'' line]
2631 cindex:[envelope sender]
2632 cindex:[%-f% option,for filter testing]
2633 the envelope sender can be set by the %-f% option,
2634 or by a ``From '' line at the start of the test message. Various parameters that
2635 would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message can
2636 be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four options).
2640 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2641 tested by means of the %-bf% option. The default is the value of
2644 *-bfl*~<'local~part'>::
2646 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2647 tested by means of the %-bf% option. The default is the username of the
2648 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2649 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2650 actually being delivered.
2654 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2655 file is being tested by means of the %-bf% option. The default is an empty
2660 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2661 file is being tested by means of the %-bf% option. The default is an empty
2664 *-bh*~<'IP~address'>::
2666 cindex:[testing,incoming SMTP]
2667 cindex:[SMTP,testing incoming]
2668 cindex:[testing,relay control]
2669 cindex:[relaying,testing configuration]
2670 cindex:[policy control,testing]
2671 cindex:[debugging,%-bh% option]
2672 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2673 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2674 after a full stop. For example:
2676 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2677 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2679 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2680 of the second example above, the value of $sender_host_address$ after
2681 conversion to the canonical form is `fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`.
2683 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2684 include lines beginning with ``LOG'' for anything that would have been logged.
2685 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2686 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2687 test your relay controls using %-bh%.
2691 You cannot test features of the configuration that rely on
2692 ident (RFC 1413) callouts. These cannot be done when testing using
2693 %-bh% because there is no incoming SMTP connection.
2695 *Warning 2*: Address verification callouts (see section <<SECTcallver>>) are
2696 also skipped when testing using %-bh%. If you want these callouts to occur,
2699 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2700 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2701 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The %-oMi% option
2702 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important.
2704 The 'exim_checkaccess' utility is a ``packaged'' version of %-bh% whose
2705 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2706 acceptable or not. See section <<SECTcheckaccess>>.
2708 *-bhc*~<'IP~address'>::
2710 This option operates in the same way as %-bh%, except that address
2711 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2712 updating the callout cache database.
2716 cindex:[alias file,building]
2717 cindex:[building alias file]
2718 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-bi% option]
2719 Sendmail interprets the %-bi% option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2720 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2721 this behaviour. However, calls to _/usr/lib/sendmail_ with the %-bi% option
2722 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2725 If %-bi% is encountered, the command specified by the %bi_command%
2726 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2727 the %-oA% option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2728 The command set by %bi_command% may not contain arguments. The command can use
2729 the 'exim_dbmbuild' utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files if
2730 this is required. If the %bi_command% option is not set, calling Exim with
2735 cindex:[local message reception]
2736 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2737 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2738 command arguments (except when %-t% is also present -- see below). Each
2739 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2740 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2741 if no other conflicting option is present.
2743 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2744 qualified by the values of the %qualify_domain% or %qualify_recipient%
2745 options, as appropriate. The %-bnq% option (see below) provides a way of
2746 suppressing this for special cases.
2748 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2749 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for details.
2752 cindex:[return code,for %-bm%]
2753 is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2754 action is controlled by the %-oe'x'% option setting -- see below.
2757 cindex:[message,format]
2758 cindex:[format,message]
2759 cindex:[``From'' line]
2760 cindex:[UUCP,``From'' line]
2761 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,``From'' line]
2762 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2763 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2765 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2766 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2768 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2769 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2770 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2771 matching against the regular expression defined by the %uucp_from_pattern%
2772 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2775 cindex:[%-f% option,overriding ``From'' line]
2776 specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2777 %-f% option, but if a %-f% option is also present, its argument is used in
2778 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2779 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2783 cindex:[address qualification, suppressing]
2784 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2785 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2786 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2787 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2788 %qualify_domain%, and recipient addresses using %qualify_recipient% (which
2789 defaults to the value of %qualify_domain%).
2791 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if %-bS% (batch SMTP) is
2792 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2793 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2794 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2795 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2797 The %-bnq% option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2798 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2799 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2800 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2805 cindex:[configuration options, extracting]
2806 cindex:[options,configuration -- extracting]
2807 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2808 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2809 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2810 arguments, for example:
2812 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2814 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word ``hide'' in the
2815 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2816 users, the output is as in this example:
2818 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2820 If %configure_file% is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2821 configuration file is output.
2822 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2823 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2825 cindex:[daemon,process id (pid)]
2826 cindex:[pid (process id),of daemon]
2827 If %log_file_path% or %pid_file_path% are given, the names of the directories
2828 where log files and daemon pid files are written are output, respectively. If
2829 these values are unset, log files are written in a sub-directory of the spool
2830 directory called %log%, and the pid file is written directly into the spool
2833 If %-bP% is followed by a name preceded by `+`, for example,
2835 exim -bP +local_domains
2837 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2838 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2841 cindex:[options,router -- extracting]
2842 cindex:[options,transport -- extracting]
2843 one of the words %router%, %transport%, or %authenticator% is given,
2844 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2845 that driver are output. For example:
2847 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2849 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2850 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2851 using one of the words %router_list%, %transport_list%, or
2852 %authenticator_list%, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2853 settings can be obtained by using %routers%, %transports%, or %authenticators%.
2858 cindex:[queue,listing messages on]
2859 cindex:[listing,messages on the queue]
2860 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2861 standard output. If the %-bp% option is followed by a list of message ids,
2862 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
2863 admin user. However, the %queue_list_requires_admin% option can be set false
2864 to allow any user to see the queue.
2866 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
2868 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
2869 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
2873 cindex:[message,size in queue listing]
2874 cindex:[size,of message]
2875 first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
2876 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
2877 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
2878 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
2879 ``<>''. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
2880 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
2881 before the sender address.
2884 cindex:[frozen messages,in queue listing]
2885 the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
2886 ``\*\*\* frozen \*\*\*'' is displayed at the end of this line.
2888 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
2889 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
2890 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
2891 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
2892 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
2898 This option operates like %-bp%, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
2899 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
2900 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with ``+D'' instead
2906 cindex:[queue,count of messages on]
2907 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
2908 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
2909 %queue_list_requires_admin% is set false.
2914 This option operates like %-bp%, but the output is not sorted into
2915 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
2916 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
2917 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
2921 This option is a combination of %-bpr% and %-bpa%.
2925 This option is a combination of %-bpr% and %-bpu%.
2930 This option operates like %-bp% but shows only undelivered top-level addresses
2931 for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or forwarding are
2932 not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a router with
2933 the %one_time% option set.
2938 cindex:[testing,retry configuration]
2939 cindex:[retry,configuration testing]
2940 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
2941 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
2942 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
2944 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
2945 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
2947 See chapter <<CHAPretry>> for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
2948 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
2949 'local_part@domain', or it can be just a domain name. The second argument is
2950 an optional second domain name; if no retry rule is found for the first
2951 argument, the second is tried. This ties in with Exim's behaviour when looking
2952 for retry rules for remote hosts -- if no rule is found that matches the host,
2953 one that matches the mail domain is sought. The final argument is the name of a
2954 specific delivery error, as used in setting up retry rules, for example
2959 cindex:[testing,rewriting]
2960 cindex:[rewriting,testing]
2961 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
2962 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
2963 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
2964 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
2965 <<CHAPrewrite>> for further details.
2969 cindex:[SMTP,batched incoming]
2970 cindex:[batched SMTP input]
2971 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
2972 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
2973 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
2974 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
2975 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
2976 %untrusted_set_sender% is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
2977 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
2979 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
2980 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
2981 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
2983 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
2984 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter <<CHAPACL>>).
2985 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using %qualify_domain% and
2986 %qualify_recipient%, as appropriate, unless the %-bnq% option is used.
2988 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
2989 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
2990 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
2992 cindex:[return code,for %-bS%]
2993 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
2994 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
2995 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
2996 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
2998 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
2999 <<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>.
3003 cindex:[SMTP,local input]
3004 cindex:[local SMTP input]
3005 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3006 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3007 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter <<CHAPACL>>) are applied.
3008 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3009 messages to the MTA.
3012 cindex:[sender,source of]
3013 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or %untrusted_set_sender% is
3014 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3015 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3016 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3017 %qualify_domain% and %qualify_recipient%, as appropriate, unless the %-bnq%
3022 %-bs% option is also used to run Exim from 'inetd', as an alternative to using
3023 a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking whether the
3024 standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from 'inetd', the source
3025 of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments above concerning senders
3026 and qualification do not apply. In this situation, Exim behaves in exactly the
3027 same way as it does when receiving a message via the listening daemon.
3031 cindex:[testing,addresses]
3032 cindex:[address,testing]
3033 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3034 as an address to be tested for deliverability. The results are written to the
3035 standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no
3036 details of the failure are output, because these might contain sensitive
3037 information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3039 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3040 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3042 Unlike the %-be% test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3043 'readline()' function, because it is running as 'root' and there are
3046 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3047 (compare the %-bv% option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3048 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3049 %no_address_test% set is bypassed. This can make %-bt% easier to use for
3050 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3054 cindex:[return code,for %-bt%]
3055 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3056 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3057 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3059 *Warning*: %-bt% can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3060 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3062 cindex:[%-f% option,for address testing]
3063 you can use the %-f% option to set an appropriate sender when running
3064 %-bt% tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3065 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3066 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3067 those conditions using %-bt%. The %-N% option provides a possible way of
3072 cindex:[version number of Exim, verifying]
3073 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3074 number, and compilation date of the 'exim' binary to the standard output.
3075 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3076 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3077 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3079 As part of its operation, %-bV% causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3080 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3081 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3082 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on %-bV%
3083 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3084 realistic testing is needed. The %-bh% and %-N% options provide more dynamic
3089 cindex:[verifying address, using %-bv%]
3090 cindex:[address,verification]
3091 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3092 taken as an address to be verified. During normal operation, verification
3093 happens mostly as a consequence processing a %verify% condition in an ACL (see
3094 chapter <<CHAPACL>>). If you want to test an entire ACL, see the %-bh% option.
3096 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3097 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3098 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3100 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3101 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3103 Unlike the %-be% test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3104 'readline()' function, because it is running as 'exim' and there are
3107 Verification differs from address testing (the %-bt% option) in that routers
3108 that have %no_verify% set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3109 router that has %fail_verify% set, verification fails. The address is verified
3110 as a recipient if %-bv% is used; to test verification for a sender address,
3111 %-bvs% should be used.
3113 If the %-v% option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3114 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3115 latter case. Otherwise, more details are given of how the address has been
3116 handled, and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses
3117 are also considered. Without %-v%, generating more than one address by
3118 redirection causes verification to end sucessfully.
3121 cindex:[return code,for %-bv%]
3122 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3123 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3124 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3126 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3127 address of a message, you should use the %-f% option to set an appropriate
3128 sender when running %-bv% tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3129 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3133 This option acts like %-bv%, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3134 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3139 cindex:[configuration file,alternate]
3140 cindex:[CONFIGURE_FILE]
3141 cindex:[alternate configuration file]
3142 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3143 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3144 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3145 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3146 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3147 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3149 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3150 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3151 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3152 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3153 _Local/Makefile_, root privilege is retained for %-C% only if the caller of
3156 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3157 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3158 However, if you are using a ``packaged'' version of Exim (source or binary), the
3159 packagers might have enabled it.
3161 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3162 configuration using %-C% right through message reception and delivery, even if
3163 the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as
3164 the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
3165 use of %-C% causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
3166 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
3167 %-odq%, and another to do the delivery, using %-M%).
3169 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined _in Local/Makefile_, it specifies a
3170 prefix string with which any file named in a %-C% command line option
3171 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence `/../`.
3172 However, if the value of the %-C% option is identical to the value of
3173 CONFIGURE_FILE in _Local/Makefile_, Exim ignores %-C% and proceeds as
3174 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3175 unset, any file name can be used with %-C%.
3177 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3178 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3179 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3182 The %-C% facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3183 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3184 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3185 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3186 specified by this option.
3188 *-D*<'macro'>=<'value'>::
3190 cindex:[macro,setting on command line]
3191 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3192 (see section <<SECTmacrodefs>>). However, like %-C%, if it is used by an
3193 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3194 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in _Local/Makefile_, the use of %-D% is
3195 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3197 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3198 command line item. %-D% can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3199 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3205 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3206 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3209 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3211 %-D% may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3213 *-d*<'debug~options'>::
3215 cindex:[debugging,list of selectors]
3216 cindex:[debugging,%-d% option]
3217 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3218 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3219 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3220 filter files should be protected. When %-d% is used, %-v% is assumed. If
3221 %-d% is given on its own, a lot of standard debugging data is output. This can
3222 be reduced, or increased to include some more rarely needed information, by
3223 following %-d% with a string made up of names preceded by plus or minus
3224 characters. These add or remove sets of debugging data, respectively. For
3225 example, %-d+filter% adds filter debugging, whereas %-d-all+filter% selects
3226 only filter debugging. The available debugging categories are:
3229 `acl ` ACL interpretation
3230 `auth ` authenticators
3231 `deliver ` general delivery logic
3232 `dns ` DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3233 `dnsbl ` DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3234 `exec ` arguments for ^^execv()^^ calls
3235 `expand ` detailed debugging for string expansions
3236 `filter ` filter handling
3237 `hints_lookup ` hints data lookups
3238 `host_lookup ` all types of name-to-IP address handling
3239 `ident ` ident lookup
3240 `interface ` lists of local interfaces
3241 `lists ` matching things in lists
3242 `load ` system load checks
3243 `local_scan ` can be used by ^^local_scan()^^ (see chapter <<CHAPlocalscan>>)
3244 `lookup ` general lookup code and all lookups
3245 `memory ` memory handling
3246 `pid ` add pid to debug output lines
3247 `process_info ` setting info for the process log
3248 `queue_run ` queue runs
3249 `receive ` general message reception logic
3250 `resolver ` turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3251 `retry ` retry handling
3252 `rewrite ` address rewriting
3253 `route ` address routing
3254 `timestamp ` add timestamp to debug output lines
3256 `transport ` transports
3257 `uid ` changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3258 `verify ` address verification logic
3259 `all ` all of the above, and also %-v%
3263 cindex:[resolver, debugging output]
3264 cindex:[DNS resolver, debugging output]
3265 `resolver` option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3266 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3267 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3270 The default (%-d% with no argument) omits `expand`, `filter`,
3271 `interface`, `load`, `memory`, `pid`, `resolver`, and `timestamp`.
3272 However, the `pid` selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3273 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3274 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3277 The `timestamp` selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3278 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3281 If the %debug_print% option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3282 any debugging is selected, or if %-v% is used.
3284 *-dd*<'debug~options'>::
3286 This option behaves exactly like %-d% except when used on a command that
3287 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3288 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3289 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3293 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3294 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3295 described in section <<SECTlineendings>>.
3299 cindex:[bounce message,generating]
3300 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3301 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3302 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3303 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3304 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3305 follow the characters %-E%. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3306 new message contains the id, following ``R='', as a cross-reference.
3310 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with %-oe% which seem to be
3311 called by various programs without the leading %o% in the option. For example,
3312 the %vacation% program uses %-eq%. Exim treats all options of the form
3313 %-e'x'% as synonymous with the corresponding %-oe'x'% options.
3317 cindex:[sender,name]
3318 cindex:[name,of sender]
3319 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3320 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's 'gecos'
3321 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3322 their 'gecos' entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3323 between %-F% and the <'string'> is optional.
3327 cindex:[sender,address]
3328 cindex:[address,sender]
3329 cindex:[trusted user]
3330 cindex:[envelope sender]
3331 cindex:[user,trusted]
3332 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3333 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3334 by a trusted user, but %untrusted_set_sender% can be set to allow untrusted
3337 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3338 trusted users are defined by the %trusted_users% or %trusted_groups% options.
3339 In the absence of %-f%, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender of a local
3340 message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify domain.
3342 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of %-f%: an empty sender
3343 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3344 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3345 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3346 examples of shell commands:
3348 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3349 exim -f "" user@domain
3351 In addition, the use of %-f% is not restricted when testing a filter file with
3352 %-bf% or when testing or verifying addresses using the %-bt% or %-bv%
3355 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3356 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the 'From:' header
3357 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a 'Sender:' header,
3358 though this can be overridden by setting %no_local_from_check%.
3361 cindex:[``From'' line]
3362 space between %-f% and the <'address'> is optional (that is, they can be given
3363 as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a locally-generated
3364 message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial ``From '' line in the
3365 message -- see the description of %-bm% above -- but if %-f% is also present,
3366 it overrides ``From''.
3370 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-G% option ignored]
3371 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3375 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-h% option ignored]
3376 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3377 Sendmail it overrides the ``hop count'' obtained by counting 'Received:'
3382 cindex:[Solaris,'mail' command]
3383 cindex:[dot in incoming, non-SMTP message]
3384 This option, which has the same effect as %-oi%, specifies that a dot on a line
3385 by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find no
3386 documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the 'mailx' command
3387 in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also %-ti%.
3389 *-M*~<'message~id'>~<'message~id'>~...::
3391 cindex:[forcing delivery]
3392 cindex:[delivery,forcing attempt]
3393 cindex:[frozen messages,forcing delivery]
3394 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3395 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3396 delivery attempt. The settings of %queue_domains%, %queue_smtp_domains%, and
3397 %hold_domains% are ignored.
3400 cindex:[hints database,overriding retry hints]
3401 hints for any of the addresses are overridden -- Exim tries to deliver even if
3402 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3403 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called %prod_requires_admin%
3404 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3405 for the %-q%, %-R%, and %-S% options).
3407 *-Mar*~<'message~id'>~<'address'>~<'address'>~...::
3409 cindex:[message,adding recipients]
3410 cindex:[recipient,adding]
3411 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3412 message (``ar'' for ``add recipients''). The first argument must be a message id,
3413 and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3414 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3415 can be used only by an admin user.
3417 *-MC*~<'transport'>~<'hostname'>~<'sequence~number'>~<'message~id'>::
3419 cindex:[SMTP,passed connection]
3420 cindex:[SMTP,multiple deliveries]
3421 cindex:[multiple SMTP deliveries]
3422 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3423 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3424 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3425 given in chapter <<CHAPSMTP>>. This must be the final option, and the caller must
3426 be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3430 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3431 by Exim in conjunction with the %-MC% option. It signifies that the connection
3432 to the remote host has been authenticated.
3436 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3437 by Exim in conjunction with the %-MC% option. It signifies that the server to
3438 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3440 *-MCQ*~<'process~id'>~<'pipe~fd'>::
3442 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3443 by Exim in conjunction with the %-MC% option when the original delivery was
3444 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3445 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3446 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3447 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3451 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3452 by Exim in conjunction with the %-MC% option, and passes on the fact that the
3453 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3458 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3459 by Exim in conjunction with the %-MC% option, and passes on the fact that the
3460 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3462 *-Mc*~<'message~id'>~<'message~id'>~...::
3464 cindex:[hints database,not overridden by %-Mc%]
3465 cindex:[delivery,manually started -- not forced]
3466 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3467 but unlike the %-M% option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3468 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3469 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3470 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter <<CHAPsecurity>>).
3471 However, %-Mc% can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3472 respects retry times and other options such as %hold_domains% that are
3473 overridden when %-M% is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3474 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3475 %-q% with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3476 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3478 *-Mes*~<'message~id'>~<'address'>::
3480 cindex:[message,changing sender]
3481 cindex:[sender,changing]
3482 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3483 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or ``<>'' (``es'' for ``edit
3484 sender''). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must be a
3485 message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message is
3486 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This
3487 option can be used only by an admin user.
3489 *-Mf*~<'message~id'>~<'message~id'>~...::
3491 cindex:[freezing messages]
3492 cindex:[message,manually freezing]
3493 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as ``frozen''. This
3494 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is ``thawed'',
3495 either manually or as a result of the %auto_thaw% configuration option.
3496 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3497 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3500 *-Mg*~<'message~id'>~<'message~id'>~...::
3502 cindex:[giving up on messages]
3503 cindex:[message,abandoning delivery attempts]
3504 cindex:[delivery,abandoning further attempts]
3505 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3506 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3507 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3508 is sent to the sender, containing the text ``cancelled by administrator''.
3509 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3512 *-Mmad*~<'message~id'>~<'message~id'>~...::
3514 cindex:[delivery,cancelling all]
3515 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3516 as already delivered (``mad'' for ``mark all delivered''). However, if any
3517 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3518 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3520 *-Mmd*~<'message~id'>~<'address'>~<'address'>~...::
3522 cindex:[delivery,cancelling by address]
3523 cindex:[recipient,removing]
3524 cindex:[removing recipients]
3525 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3526 (``md'' for ``mark delivered''). The first argument must be a message id, and
3527 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3528 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3529 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3530 can be used only by an admin user.
3532 *-Mrm*~<'message~id'>~<'message~id'>~...::
3534 cindex:[removing messages]
3535 cindex:[abandoning mail]
3536 cindex:[message,manually discarding]
3537 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3538 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3539 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3540 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3541 placed on the queue.
3543 *-Mt*~<'message~id'>~<'message~id'>~...::
3545 cindex:[thawing messages]
3546 cindex:[unfreezing messages]
3547 cindex:[frozen messages,thawing]
3548 cindex:[message,thawing frozen]
3549 This option requests Exim to ``thaw'' any of the listed messages that are
3550 ``frozen'', so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the messages
3551 are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an
3554 *-Mvb*~<'message~id'>::
3556 cindex:[listing,message body]
3557 cindex:[message,listing body of]
3558 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3559 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3561 *-Mvh*~<'message~id'>::
3563 cindex:[listing,message headers]
3564 cindex:[header lines,listing]
3565 cindex:[message,listing header lines]
3566 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3567 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3569 *-Mvl*~<'message~id'>::
3571 cindex:[listing,message log]
3572 cindex:[message,listing message log]
3573 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3574 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3578 This is apparently a synonym for %-om% that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3579 treats it that way too.
3583 cindex:[debugging,%-N% option]
3584 cindex:[debugging,suppressing delivery]
3585 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3586 level. It implies %-v%. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery --
3587 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3588 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3589 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with ``\*>'' rather
3592 Because %-N% discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3593 user are allowed to use it with %-bd%, %-q%, %-R% or %-M%. In other words,
3594 an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to which it
3595 will apply. Although transportation never fails when %-N% is set, an address
3596 may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a routing
3597 problem. Once %-N% has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to the
3598 message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen for
3603 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-n% option ignored]
3604 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean ``no aliasing''. It is ignored by
3609 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean `set option`. It is ignored by
3612 *-oA*~<'file~name'>::
3614 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-oA% option]
3615 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with %-bi% to specify an
3616 alternative alias file name. Exim handles %-bi% differently; see the
3621 cindex:[SMTP,passed connection]
3622 cindex:[SMTP,multiple deliveries]
3623 cindex:[multiple SMTP deliveries]
3624 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3625 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any ^smtp^
3626 transport. If <'n'> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3630 cindex:[background delivery]
3631 cindex:[delivery,in the background]
3632 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3633 including the listening daemon. It requests ``background'' delivery of such
3634 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3635 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3636 processes to finish.
3638 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3639 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3640 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3641 This is the default action if none of the %-od% options are present.
3643 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3644 (%queue_only% or %queue_only_file%, for example) is in effect, %-odb%
3645 overrides it if %queue_only_override% is set true, which is the default
3646 setting. If %queue_only_override% is set false, %-odb% has no effect.
3650 cindex:[foreground delivery]
3651 cindex:[delivery,in the foreground]
3652 This option requests ``foreground'' (synchronous) delivery when Exim has accepted
3653 a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3654 %-odb%.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the
3655 message, and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3657 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3658 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3661 However, like %-odb%, this option has no effect if %queue_only_override% is
3662 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3664 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3665 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3666 process exists. See chapter <<CHAPnonqueueing>> for a way of setting up a
3667 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3672 This option is synonymous with %-odf%. It is provided for compatibility with
3677 cindex:[non-immediate delivery]
3678 cindex:[delivery,suppressing immediate]
3679 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
3680 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3681 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3682 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3683 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3684 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3685 %queue_only%) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3686 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also %-odqs%. It always
3691 cindex:[SMTP,delaying delivery]
3692 This option is a hybrid between %-odb%/%-odi% and %-odq%.
3693 However, like %-odb% and %-odi%, this option has no effect if
3694 %queue_only_override% is false and one of the queueing options in the
3695 configuration file is in effect.
3697 When %-odqs% does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3698 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if %-odi% is also
3699 present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done in
3700 the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not done
3701 at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3702 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3703 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3704 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The %queue_smtp_domains%
3705 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3710 cindex:[error,reporting]
3711 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3712 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3716 cindex:[return code,for %-oee%]
3717 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3718 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3719 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3720 the default %-oe'x'% option if Exim is called as 'rmail'.
3724 cindex:[error,reporting]
3725 cindex:[return code,for %-oem%]
3726 This is the same as %-oee%, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3727 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3728 This is the default %-oe'x'% option, unless Exim is called as 'rmail'.
3732 cindex:[error,reporting]
3733 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3734 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3735 cindex:[return code,for %-oep%]
3736 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3740 cindex:[error,reporting]
3741 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3746 cindex:[error,reporting]
3747 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3752 cindex:[dot in incoming, non-SMTP message]
3753 This option, which has the same effect as %-i%, specifies that a dot on a line
3754 by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3755 Otherwise, a single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing
3756 for other lines that start with a dot.
3757 This option is set by default if Exim is called as 'rmail'. See also %-ti%.
3761 This option is treated as synonymous with %-oi%.
3763 *-oMa*~<'host~address'>::
3765 cindex:[sender host address, specifying for local message]
3766 A number of options starting with %-oM% can be used to set values associated
3767 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3768 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3769 %-bh%, %-be%, %-bf%, %-bF%, %-bt%, or %-bv% testing options. In other
3770 circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3772 The %-oMa% option sets the sender host address. This may include a port number
3773 at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3775 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3777 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3778 followed by a colon and the port number:
3780 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3782 The IP address is placed in the $sender_host_address$ variable, and the
3783 port, if present, in $sender_host_port$.
3787 cindex:[authentication name, specifying for local message]
3788 See %-oMa% above for general remarks about the %-oM% options. The %-oMaa%
3789 option sets the value of $sender_host_authenticated$ (the authenticator
3790 name). See chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>> for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3792 *-oMai*~<'string'>::
3794 cindex:[authentication id, specifying for local message]
3795 See %-oMa% above for general remarks about the %-oM% options. The %-oMai%
3796 option sets the value of $authenticated_id$ (the id that was authenticated).
3797 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id) for messages from
3798 local sources. See chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>> for a discussion of authenticated
3801 *-oMas*~<'address'>::
3803 cindex:[authentication sender, specifying for local message]
3804 See %-oMa% above for general remarks about the %-oM% options. The %-oMas%
3805 option sets the authenticated sender value in $authenticated_sender$. It
3806 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
3807 messages from local sources. See chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>> for a discussion of
3808 authenticated senders.
3810 *-oMi*~<'interface~address'>::
3812 cindex:[interface address, specifying for local message]
3813 See %-oMa% above for general remarks about the %-oM% options. The %-oMi% option
3814 sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included, using the
3815 same syntax as for %-oMa%. The interface address is placed in
3816 $interface_address$ and the port number, if present, in $interface_port$.
3818 *-oMr*~<'protocol~name'>::
3820 cindex:[protocol,incoming -- specifying for local message]
3821 See %-oMa% above for general remarks about the %-oM% options. The %-oMr% option
3822 sets the received protocol value that is stored in $received_protocol$.
3823 However, this applies only when %-bs% is not used. For interactive SMTP input
3824 (%-bs%), the protocol is always ``local-'' followed by one of the standard SMTP
3825 protocol names (see the description of $received_protocol$ in section
3826 <<SECTexpvar>>). For %-bS% (batch SMTP) however, the protocol can be set by
3829 *-oMs*~<'host~name'>::
3831 cindex:[sender host name, specifying for local message]
3832 See %-oMa% above for general remarks about the %-oM% options. The %-oMs% option
3833 sets the sender host name in $sender_host_name$. When this option is present,
3834 Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it uses the
3837 *-oMt*~<'ident~string'>::
3839 cindex:[sender ident string, specifying for local message]
3840 See %-oMa% above for general remarks about the %-oM% options. The %-oMt% option
3841 sets the sender ident value in $sender_ident$. The default setting for local
3842 callers is the login id of the calling process.
3846 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-om% option ignored]
3847 In Sendmail, this option means ``me too'', indicating that the sender of a
3848 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
3849 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
3853 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-oo% option ignored]
3854 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies ``old style headers'', whatever
3859 cindex:[pid (process id),of daemon]
3860 cindex:[daemon,process id (pid)]
3861 This option is useful only in conjunction with %-bd% or %-q% with a time
3862 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
3863 written. When %-oX% is used with %-bd%, or when %-q% with a time is used
3864 without %-bd%, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
3865 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
3869 cindex:[timeout,for non-SMTP input]
3870 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
3871 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
3872 by the %receive_timeout% option. The format used for specifying times is
3873 described in section <<SECTtimeformat>>.
3877 cindex:[timeout,for SMTP input]
3878 cindex:[SMTP timeout, input]
3879 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
3880 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
3881 the %smtp_receive_timeout% option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
3882 for specifying times is described in section <<SECTtimeformat>>.
3886 This option has exactly the same effect as %-v%.
3888 *-oX*~<'number~or~string'>::
3890 cindex:[TCP/IP,setting listening ports]
3891 cindex:[TCP/IP,setting listening interfaces]
3892 cindex:[port,receiving TCP/IP]
3893 This option is relevant only when the %-bd% (start listening daemon) option is
3894 also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details of
3895 the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given in
3896 chapter <<CHAPinterfaces>>. When %-oX% is used to start a daemon, no pid file is
3897 written unless %-oP% is also present to specify a pid file name.
3901 cindex:[Perl,starting the interpreter]
3902 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
3903 chapter <<CHAPperl>>). It overrides the setting of the %perl_at_start% option,
3904 forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is needed.
3908 cindex:[Perl,starting the interpreter]
3909 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
3910 chapter <<CHAPperl>>). It overrides the setting of the %perl_at_start% option,
3911 forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is started.
3913 *-p*<'rval'>:<'sval'>::
3915 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
3917 -oMr <rval> -oMs <sval>
3919 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
3920 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
3921 Note the Exim already has two private options, %-pd% and %-ps%, that refer to
3922 embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of `p` or
3923 `s` using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
3927 cindex:[queue runner,starting manually]
3928 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
3929 configuration option called %prod_requires_admin% which can be set false to
3930 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the %-M%, %-R%, and
3934 cindex:[queue runner,description of operation]
3935 %-q% option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
3936 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
3937 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
3938 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
3939 have not been reached. Use %-qf% (see below) if you want to override this.
3942 cindex:[SMTP,passed connection]
3943 cindex:[SMTP,multiple deliveries]
3944 cindex:[multiple SMTP deliveries]
3945 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
3946 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
3949 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
3950 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
3951 mail, one message at a time. Use %-q% with a time (see below) if you want this
3952 to be repeated periodically.
3954 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
3955 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
3956 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
3957 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
3959 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
3960 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
3961 %queue_run_in_order% option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
3964 The %-q% option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
3965 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
3966 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
3970 cindex:[queue,double scanning]
3971 cindex:[queue,routing]
3972 cindex:[routing,whole queue before delivery]
3973 An option starting with %-qq% requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
3974 stage, the queue is scanned as if the %queue_smtp_domains% option matched
3975 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
3979 cindex:[hints database,remembering routing]
3980 hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts is
3981 updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
3982 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
3983 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
3984 delivered down a single SMTP
3985 cindex:[SMTP,passed connection]
3986 cindex:[SMTP,multiple deliveries]
3987 cindex:[multiple SMTP deliveries]
3988 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
3989 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
3994 cindex:[queue,initial delivery]
3995 If the 'i' flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
3996 those messages that haven't previously been tried. ('i' stands for ``initial
3997 delivery''.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
3998 %-odq% and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4002 cindex:[queue,forcing delivery]
4003 cindex:[delivery,forcing in queue run]
4004 If one 'f' flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4005 message, whereas without %f% only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4006 their retry times are tried.
4010 cindex:[frozen messages,forcing delivery]
4011 If 'ff' is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4016 cindex:[queue,local deliveries only]
4017 The 'l' (the letter ``ell'') flag specifies that only local deliveries are to be
4018 done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue for
4021 *-q*<'qflags'>~<'start~id'>~<'end~id'>::
4022 cindex:[queue,delivering specific messages]
4023 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4024 lexically less than a given value by following the %-q% option with a starting
4025 message id. For example:
4027 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4029 Messages that arrived earlier than `0t5C6f-0000c8-00` are not inspected. If a
4030 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4031 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4033 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4035 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from %-M%
4036 in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from %-Mc% in that it
4037 counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection mechanism does
4038 not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There are also other
4039 ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a queue run -- see
4042 *-q*<'qflags'><'time'>::
4043 cindex:[queue runner,starting periodically]
4044 cindex:[periodic queue running]
4045 When a time value is present, the %-q% option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4046 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4047 (whose format is described in section <<SECTtimeformat>>). This form of the %-q%
4048 option is commonly combined with the %-bd% option, in which case a single
4049 daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a combined
4050 daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4052 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4054 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4055 process every 30 minutes.
4057 When a daemon is started by %-q% with a time value, but without %-bd%, no pid
4058 file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the %-oP% option.
4060 *-qR*<'rsflags'>~<'string'>::
4062 This option is synonymous with %-R%. It is provided for Sendmail compatibility.
4064 *-qS*<'rsflags'>~<'string'>::
4066 This option is synonymous with %-S%.
4068 *-R*<'rsflags'>~<'string'>::
4070 cindex:[queue runner,for specific recipients]
4071 cindex:[delivery,to given domain]
4072 cindex:[domain,delivery to]
4073 The <'rsflags'> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4074 is optional, unless the string is 'f', 'ff', 'r', 'rf', or 'rff', which are the
4075 possible values for <'rsflags'>. White space is required if <'rsflags'> is not
4078 This option is similar to %-q% with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4079 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4080 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4081 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4082 way. If the <'rsflags'> start with 'r', <'string'> is interpreted as a regular
4083 expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4085 Once a message is selected, all its addresses are processed. For the first
4086 selected message, Exim overrides any retry information and forces a delivery
4087 attempt for each undelivered address. This means that if delivery of any
4088 address in the first message is successful, any existing retry information is
4089 deleted, and so delivery attempts for that address in subsequently selected
4090 messages (which are processed without forcing) will run. However, if delivery
4091 of any address does not succeed, the retry information is updated, and in
4092 subsequently selected messages, the failing address will be skipped.
4094 If the <'rsflags'> contain 'f' or 'ff', the delivery forcing applies to all
4095 selected messages, not just the first;
4096 cindex:[frozen messages,forcing delivery]
4097 frozen messages are included when 'ff' is present.
4099 The %-R% option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4100 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4101 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter <<CHAPACL>>), its default
4102 effect is to run Exim with the %-R% option, but it can be configured to run an
4103 arbitrary command instead.
4107 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for %-f%.
4109 *-S*<'rsflags'>~<'string'>::
4111 cindex:[delivery,from given sender]
4112 cindex:[queue runner,for specific senders]
4113 This option acts like %-R% except that it checks the string against each
4114 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If %-R% is also set, both
4115 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4116 has 'f' or 'ff' in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4120 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4121 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4122 ``queue times'' so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4126 cindex:[recipient,extracting from header lines]
4127 cindex:['Bcc:' header line]
4128 cindex:['Cc:' header line]
4129 cindex:['To:' header line]
4130 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4131 input, the %-t% option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4132 from the 'To:', 'Cc:', and 'Bcc:' header lines in the message instead of from
4133 the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting takes
4137 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-t% option]
4138 the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4139 is 'not' to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4140 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4141 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4142 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4143 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail 'add'
4144 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4145 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4146 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4147 %extract_addresses_remove_arguments% false.
4149 If a 'Bcc:' header line is present, it is removed from the message unless
4150 there is no 'To:' or 'Cc:', in which case a 'Bcc:' line with no data is
4151 created. This is necessary for conformity with the original RFC 822 standard;
4152 the requirement has been removed in RFC 2822, but that is still very new.
4155 cindex:[%Resent-% header lines,with %-t%]
4156 there are any %Resent-% header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4157 recipients from all 'Resent-To:', 'Resent-Cc:', and 'Resent-Bcc:' header
4158 lines instead of from 'To:', 'Cc:', and 'Bcc:'. This is for compatibility
4159 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4160 %-t% was used in conjunction with %Resent-% header lines.)
4162 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of %Resent-% header lines (for when a
4163 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4164 added at the front of the message, and separated by 'Received:' lines. It is
4165 not at all clear how %-t% should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4166 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a ``set''.
4167 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The %Resent-% lines are
4168 often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4169 once, it is common for the original set of %Resent-% headers to be renamed as
4170 %X-Resent-% when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4174 This option is exactly equivalent to %-t% %-i%. It is provided for
4175 compatibility with Sendmail.
4178 oindex:[%-tls-on-connect%]
4179 cindex:[TLS,use without STARTTLS]
4180 cindex:[TLS,automatic start]
4181 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4182 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4183 %tls_on_connect_ports% option. See section <<SECTsupobssmt>> and chapter
4184 <<CHAPTLS>> for further details.
4189 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-U% option ignored]
4190 Sendmail uses this option for ``initial message submission'', and its
4191 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4192 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4193 set. Exim ignores this option.
4197 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4198 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4199 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4200 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4201 the log if the setting of %log_selector% discards them. Any relevant selectors
4202 are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is unconditional.
4206 AIX uses %-x% for a private purpose (``mail from a local mail program has
4207 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item'').
4208 It sets %-x% when calling the MTA from its %mail% command. Exim ignores this
4212 We insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4213 line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4214 creates a man page for the options.
4218 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4225 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4226 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4230 [titleabbrev="The runtime configuration file"]
4231 The Exim run time configuration file
4232 ------------------------------------
4234 cindex:[run time configuration]
4235 cindex:[configuration file,general description]
4236 cindex:[CONFIGURE_FILE]
4237 cindex:[configuration file,errors in]
4238 cindex:[error,in configuration file]
4239 cindex:[return code,for bad configuration]
4240 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4241 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4242 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4245 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4246 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4247 The message is also written to the panic log. *Note*: only simple syntax
4248 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4249 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4250 actually alter the string.
4254 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4255 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4256 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4257 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4258 existing file in the list.
4262 cindex:[CONFIGURE_OWNER]
4263 cindex:[CONFIGURE_GROUP]
4264 cindex:[configuration file,ownership]
4265 cindex:[ownership,configuration file]
4266 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4267 specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
4268 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4269 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4270 group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option
4272 or by the CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4275 *Warning*: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4276 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4277 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4278 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4279 configuration is not group writeable.
4281 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4282 is provided in the file _src/configure.default_. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4283 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4284 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4285 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4286 <<CHAPdefconfil>> is a ``walk-through'' discussion of the default configuration.
4290 Using a different configuration file
4291 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4292 cindex:[configuration file,alternate]
4293 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the %-C% command line
4294 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when %-C%
4295 is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the Exim
4296 user (or unless the argument for %-C% is identical to the built-in value from
4297 CONFIGURE_FILE). %-C% is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4298 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4299 on a configuration file specified by %-C%.
4301 The privileged use of %-C% by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4302 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in _Local/Makefile_ when building Exim. However,
4303 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4304 configuration using %-C% right through message reception and delivery, even if
4305 the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as
4306 the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4307 use of %-C% causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4308 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4309 %-odq%, and another to do the delivery, using %-M%).
4311 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined _in Local/Makefile_, it specifies a
4312 prefix string with which any file named in a %-C% command line option must
4313 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence `/../`. There
4314 is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4315 name can be used with %-C%.
4317 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the %-D% command line
4318 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4319 configuration file. However, like %-C%, the use of this option by a
4320 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4321 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in _Local/Makefile_, the use of %-D% is
4322 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4324 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4325 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4326 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in _Local/Makefile_, Exim first
4327 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4328 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the 'uname()' function. If this
4329 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4330 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or %-C%.
4332 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4333 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4334 help with this. See the comments in _src/EDITME_ for details.
4339 Configuration file format
4340 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4341 cindex:[configuration file,format of]
4342 cindex:[format,configuration file]
4343 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4344 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4345 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4346 is introduced by the word ``begin'' followed by the name of the part. The
4349 - 'ACL': Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail.
4351 - cindex:[AUTH,configuration]
4352 'authenticators': Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4353 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>).
4355 - 'routers': Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4356 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered.
4358 - 'transports': Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4359 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations.
4361 - 'retry': Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be immediately delivered.
4363 - 'rewrite': Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4364 when new addresses are generated during delivery.
4366 - 'local_scan': Private options for the 'local_scan()' function. If you
4367 want to use this feature, you must set
4369 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4371 in _Local/Makefile_ before building Exim. Full details of the
4372 'local_scan()' facility are given in chapter <<CHAPlocalscan>>.
4374 cindex:[configuration file,leading whitespace in]
4375 cindex:[configuration file,trailing whitespace in]
4376 cindex:[whitespace,in configuration file]
4377 Leading and trailing whitespace in configuration lines is always ignored.
4379 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4380 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. *Note*: a
4381 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4382 and does not introduce a comment.
4384 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4385 the general rule for whitespace means that trailing white space after the
4386 backslash is ignored, and leading white space at the start of continuation
4387 lines is also ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4388 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4390 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4391 default, which is supplied in _src/configure.default_, and add, delete, or
4392 change settings as required.
4394 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4395 described in chapters <<CHAPACL>>, <<CHAPretry>>, and <<CHAPrewrite>>,
4396 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4397 items in common, and these are described below, from section <<SECTcos>>
4398 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4403 File inclusions in the configuration file
4404 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4405 cindex:[inclusions in configuration file]
4406 cindex:[configuration file,including other files]
4407 cindex:[.include in configuration file]
4408 cindex:[.include_if_exists in configuration file]
4409 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4412 .include <file name>
4416 .include_if_exists <file name>
4418 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4419 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4420 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4422 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4423 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4424 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4425 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4427 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4428 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4432 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4436 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4437 process the lines of the file as if they occurred inline where the inclusion
4443 Macros in the configuration file
4444 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4445 cindex:[macro,description of]
4446 cindex:[configuration file,macros]
4447 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4448 ``begin'' line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4449 definition, and must be of the form
4452 <'name'> = <'rest of line'>
4455 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4456 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4457 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4458 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4459 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4461 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4462 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4463 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which they are defined. The
4464 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4465 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4466 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4470 `ABCD_XYZ = `<'something'>
4471 `ABCD = `<'something else'>
4474 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4477 Macro expansion is applied to individual lines from the file, before checking
4478 for line continuation or file inclusion (see below). If a line consists solely
4479 of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the line is ignored.
4480 A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a comment line or a
4483 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4484 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4485 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4488 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4489 login=${quote_mysql:$local_part};
4492 This can then be used in a ^redirect^ router setting like this:
4494 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4496 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4497 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists -- see section
4500 Macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the %-D% command line
4501 option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when %-D% is used, unless called
4502 by root or the Exim user.
4506 Conditional skips in the configuration file
4507 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4508 cindex:[configuration file,conditional skips]
4510 You can use the directives `.ifdef`, `.ifndef`, `.elifdef`,
4511 `.elifndef`, `.else`, and `.endif` to dynamically include or exclude
4512 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4513 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4515 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4516 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4517 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4521 message_size_limit = 50M
4523 message_size_limit = 100M
4526 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro `AAA` is defined, and 100M
4527 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4528 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an ``or'' condition. To
4529 obtain an ``and'' condition, you need to use nested `.ifdef`##s.
4531 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4532 it is not very useful, because the condition ``there was a macro substitution
4533 in this line'' will always be true.
4535 Text following `.else` and `.endif` is ignored, and can be used as comment
4536 to clarify complicated nestings.
4541 Common option syntax
4542 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4543 cindex:[common option syntax]
4544 cindex:[syntax of common options]
4545 cindex:[configuration file,common option syntax]
4546 For the main set of options, driver options, and 'local_scan()' options,
4547 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4548 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4549 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4550 space) and then the value. For example:
4552 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4554 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4555 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the %-bP% command line
4556 option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the word
4557 ``hide''. For example:
4559 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4561 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4563 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4565 If ``hide'' is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on all
4566 instances of the same driver.
4568 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4569 that are found in option settings.
4574 cindex:[format,boolean]
4575 cindex:[boolean configuration values]
4576 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4577 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4578 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4579 if it is preceded by ``no_'' or ``not_'' the switch is turned off. However,
4580 boolean options may optionally be followed by an equals sign and one of the
4581 words ``true'', ``false'', ``yes'', or ``no'', as an alternative syntax. For example,
4582 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4587 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4592 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4599 cindex:[integer configuration values]
4600 cindex:[format,integer]
4601 If an integer data item starts with the characters ``0x'', the remainder of it
4602 is interpreted as a hexadecimal number. Otherwise, it is treated as octal if it
4603 starts with the digit 0, and decimal if not. If an integer value is followed by
4604 the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if it is followed by the letter M, it
4605 is multiplied by 1024x1024.
4607 When the values of integer option settings are output, values which are an
4608 exact multiple of 1024 or 1024x1024 are
4609 sometimes, but not always,
4610 printed using the letters K and M. The printing style is independent of the
4611 actual input format that was used.
4614 Octal integer values
4615 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4616 cindex:[integer format]
4617 cindex:[format,octal integer]
4618 The value of an option specified as an octal integer is always interpreted in
4619 octal, whether or not it starts with the digit zero. Such options are always
4624 Fixed point number values
4625 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4626 cindex:[fixed point configuration values]
4627 cindex:[format,fixed point]
4628 A fixed point number consists of a decimal integer, optionally followed by a
4629 decimal point and up to three further digits.
4634 Time interval values
4635 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4636 cindex:[time interval,specifying in configuration]
4637 cindex:[format,time interval]
4638 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4639 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4650 For example, ``3h50m'' specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4651 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4652 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify ``90m'' instead of ``1h30m''.
4659 cindex:[string,format of configuration values]
4660 cindex:[format,string]
4661 If a string data item does not start with a double-quote character, it is taken
4662 as consisting of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines,
4663 starting at the first character after any leading white space, with trailing
4664 white space characters removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in
4665 the string. Because Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an
4666 early stage, they can appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The
4667 following settings are therefore equivalent:
4670 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4672 trusted_users = uucp:\
4673 # This comment line is ignored
4677 cindex:[string,quoted]
4678 cindex:[escape characters in quoted strings]
4679 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4680 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4681 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4684 `-`----------------------`--------------------------------------------------
4685 `\\` single backslash
4687 `\r` carriage return
4689 `\`<'octal digits'> up to 3 octal digits specify one character
4690 `\x`<'hex digits'> up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one character
4691 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
4693 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4694 character, that character replaces the pair.
4696 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4697 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4698 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4699 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4700 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4701 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4706 cindex:[string expansion, definition of]
4707 cindex:[expansion,definition of]
4708 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to 'string expansion',
4709 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4710 circumstances (see chapter <<CHAPexpand>>). The input syntax for such strings is
4711 as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted strings
4712 is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place. However,
4713 backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any backslashes that
4714 are required for that reason must be doubled if they are within a quoted
4715 configuration string.
4718 User and group names
4719 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4720 cindex:[user name,format of]
4721 cindex:[format,user name]
4722 cindex:[group,name format]
4723 cindex:[format,group name]
4724 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4725 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4726 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4727 'getpwnam()' or 'getgrnam()' function, as appropriate.
4730 [[SECTlistconstruct]]
4733 cindex:[list,syntax of in configuration]
4734 cindex:[format,list item in configuration]
4735 cindex:[string list, definition]
4736 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4737 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type ``string list'' in
4738 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as ``domain list'',
4739 ``host list'', ``address list'', or ``local part list''. Syntactically, they are all
4740 the same; however, those other than ``string list'' are subject to particular
4741 kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter <<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>.
4743 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4744 input syntax is concerned. The %trusted_users% setting in section
4745 <<SECTstrings>> above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item in
4746 a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space on
4747 each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4748 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4751 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4753 +contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address
4756 cindex:[list separator, changing]
4757 cindex:[IPv6,addresses in lists]
4758 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4759 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4760 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4761 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4762 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4764 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4766 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4767 %log_file_path%. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4768 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4773 Empty items in lists
4774 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4775 cindex:[list,empty item in]
4776 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
4777 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
4779 senders = user@domain :
4781 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
4782 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
4783 items, the second of which is empty:
4785 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
4787 *Note*: there must be whitespace between the two colons, as otherwise they
4788 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
4789 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
4790 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
4794 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
4795 is at the end of the list.
4801 Format of driver configurations
4802 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4803 cindex:[drivers,configuration format]
4804 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
4805 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
4806 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
4807 a sequence of lines like this:
4816 In the following example, the instance name is ^localuser^, and it is
4817 followed by three options settings:
4822 transport = local_delivery
4824 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses -- by the
4825 setting of the %driver% option -- and (optionally) some configuration settings.
4826 For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to deliver with
4827 SMTP you would use the ^smtp^ driver; if you want to deliver to a local file
4828 you would use the ^appendfile^ driver. Each of the drivers is described in
4829 detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
4831 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
4832 the same underlying driver (each must have a different name).
4834 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
4835 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
4836 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
4837 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
4838 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
4841 cindex:[generic options]
4842 cindex:[options, generic -- definition of]
4843 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option:
4844 'generic' and 'private'. The generic options are those that apply to all
4845 drivers of the same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all
4847 The %driver% option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
4849 cindex:[private options]
4850 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
4851 they all have default values.
4853 The options may appear in any order, except that the %driver% option must
4854 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
4855 this reason, it is recommended that %driver% always be the first option.
4857 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
4858 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
4859 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
4860 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
4861 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
4862 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
4863 configuration lines:
4868 create an instance of the ^smtp^ transport driver whose name is
4869 ^remote_smtp^. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
4870 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
4871 instance of the ^smtp^ transport, with different options, might be defined
4877 command_timeout = 10s
4879 The names ^remote_smtp^ and ^special_smtp^ would be used to reference
4880 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
4883 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
4884 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
4885 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the %-bP% command line
4893 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4894 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4897 The default configuration file
4898 ------------------------------
4899 cindex:[configuration file,default ``walk through'']
4900 cindex:[default,configuration file ``walk through'']
4901 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as _src/configure.default_
4902 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
4903 the way Exim is configured, this chapter ``walks through'' the default
4904 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
4905 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
4906 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
4907 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
4908 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
4912 Main configuration settings
4913 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4914 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
4915 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
4918 # primary_hostname =
4920 This is a commented-out setting of the %primary_hostname% option. Exim needs
4921 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
4922 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
4923 it is unset, Exim uses the 'uname()' system function to obtain the host name.
4925 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
4927 domainlist local_domains = @
4928 domainlist relay_to_domains =
4929 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
4931 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
4932 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
4933 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
4934 configuration file (see section <<SECTnamedlists>>).
4936 The first line defines a domain list called 'local_domains'; this is used
4937 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
4940 cindex:[@ in a domain list]
4941 There is just one item in this list, the string ``@''. This is a special form of
4942 entry which means ``the name of the local host''. Thus, if the local host is
4943 called 'a.host.example', mail to 'any.user@a.host.example' is expected to
4944 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
4945 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
4947 The second line defines a domain list called 'relay_to_domains', but the
4948 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
4949 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
4950 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
4951 domain is permitted.
4953 The third line defines a host list called 'relay_from_hosts'. This list is
4954 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
4955 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
4956 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
4957 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
4958 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
4960 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
4961 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
4962 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
4964 The next configuration line is a genuine option setting:
4966 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
4968 This option specifies an 'Access Control List' (ACL) which is to be used
4969 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every
4970 RCPT command). The name of the list is 'acl_check_rcpt', and we will
4971 come to its definition below, in the ACL section of the configuration. ACLs
4972 control which recipients are accepted for an incoming message -- if a
4973 configuration does not provide an ACL to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be
4976 Two commented-out options settings are next:
4979 # qualify_recipient =
4981 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
4982 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
4983 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set %qualify_domain%,
4984 the value of %primary_hostname% is used. If you set both of these options, you
4985 can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient addresses. If
4986 you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
4988 cindex:[domain literal,recognizing format]
4989 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
4990 addresses of the form 'user@[10.11.12.13]' that is, with a ``domain literal''
4991 (an IP address) instead of a named domain.
4993 # allow_domain_literals
4995 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
4996 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
4997 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
4998 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
4999 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5000 'postmaster') where domain literals are still useful.
5002 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5006 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5007 convention is to set up 'root' as an alias for the system administrator. This
5008 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5009 The list of users specified by %never_users% is not, however, the complete
5010 list; the build-time configuration in _Local/Makefile_ has an option called
5011 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5012 contents of %never_users% are added to this list. By default
5013 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5015 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5016 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5021 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5022 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5023 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5024 or restrict the lookup to hosts on ``nearby'' networks.
5025 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5026 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5029 The next two lines are concerned with 'ident' callbacks, as defined by RFC
5030 1413 (hence their names):
5033 rfc1413_query_timeout = 30s
5035 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5036 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5037 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5038 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5039 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5040 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5041 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5043 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5044 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5045 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5046 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5048 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5049 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5051 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5052 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5054 The %percent_hack_domains% option is also commented out:
5056 # percent_hack_domains =
5058 It provides a list of domains for which the ``percent hack'' is to operate. This
5059 is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5060 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5062 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5063 concerned with messages that have been ``frozen'' on Exim's queue. When a message
5064 is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing occurs when
5065 a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender address of
5066 the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the bounce cannot be
5067 delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there are also other
5068 conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not always bounce
5071 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5072 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5074 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5075 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5076 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5077 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5078 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5084 cindex:[default,ACLs]
5085 cindex:[{ACL},default configuration]
5086 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5087 It starts with the line
5091 and it contains the definition of one ACL called 'acl_check_rcpt' that was
5092 referenced in the setting of %acl_smtp_rcpt% above.
5094 cindex:[RCPT,ACL for]
5095 This ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5096 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5097 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5098 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5099 result of the ACL processing.
5103 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5108 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5109 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5110 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5111 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message didn't come from a remote
5112 host. The colon is important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can
5113 never match anything.
5115 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5116 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5117 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5120 deny domains = +local_domains
5121 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5123 deny domains = !+local_domains
5124 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5126 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5127 characters ``@'', ``%'', ``!'', ``/'', ``|'', or dots in unusual places. Although these
5128 characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of ``@'' and leading
5129 dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur in Internet mail
5132 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5133 addresses (percent is still sometimes used -- see the %percent_hack_domains%
5134 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5135 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5136 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5137 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5138 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5139 policy of being as safe as possible.
5141 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5142 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5143 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5144 'local_domains' domain list. The ``+'' character is used to indicate a
5145 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5146 'local_domains', but in general there may be many.
5148 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5149 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain ``@'', ``%'', ``!'', ``/'', or ``|''.
5150 If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will have to
5153 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5154 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider local
5155 parts constructed as ``first-initial.second-initial.family-name'' when applied to
5156 someone like the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local
5157 part starting with a dot or containing ``/../'' can cause trouble if it is used
5158 as part of a file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for
5159 local parts that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the
5160 local part is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5162 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5163 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5164 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5165 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5166 local part. However, the sequence ``/../'' is barred. The use of ``@'', ``%'', and
5167 ``!'' is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users (or
5168 your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5170 accept local_parts = postmaster
5171 domains = +local_domains
5173 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5174 local part is 'postmaster' and the domain is one of those listed in the
5175 'local_domains' domain list. The ``+'' character is used to indicate a
5176 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5177 'local_domains', but in general there may be many.
5179 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5180 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5181 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5183 require verify = sender
5185 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5186 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5187 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5190 message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote addresses, basic
5191 verification checks only the domain, but 'callouts' can be used for more
5192 verification if required. Section <<SECTaddressverification>> discusses the
5193 details of address verification.
5196 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address is \
5197 # in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5199 # dnslists = black.list.example
5201 # warn message = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is \
5202 # in a black list at $dnslist_domain
5203 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5204 # dnslists = black.list.example
5207 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5208 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5209 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second merely inserts a warning header
5212 accept domains = +local_domains
5214 message = unknown user
5217 This statement accepts the incoming recipient address if its domain is one of
5218 the local domains, but only if the address can be verified. Verification of
5219 local addresses normally checks both the local part and the domain. The
5220 %endpass% line needs some explanation: if the condition above %endpass% fails,
5221 that is, if the address is not in a local domain, control is passed to the next
5222 ACL statement. However, if the condition below %endpass% fails, that is, if a
5223 recipient in a local domain cannot be verified, access is denied and the
5224 recipient is rejected.
5226 cindex:[customizing,ACL failure message]
5227 The %message% modifier provides a customized error message for the failure.
5229 accept domains = +relay_to_domains
5231 message = unrouteable address
5234 This statement accepts the incoming recipient address if its domain is one of
5235 the domains for which this host is a relay, but again, only if the address can
5238 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5240 Control reaches this statement only if the recipient's domain is neither a
5241 local domain, nor a relay domain. The statement accepts the address if the
5242 message is coming from one of the hosts that are defined as being allowed to
5243 relay through this host. Recipient verification is omitted here, because in
5244 many cases the clients are dumb MUAs that do not cope well with SMTP error
5245 responses. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should probably add
5246 recipient verification here.
5248 accept authenticated = *
5250 Control reaches here for attempts to relay to arbitrary domains from arbitrary
5251 hosts. The statement accepts the address only if the client host has
5252 authenticated itself. The default configuration does not define any
5253 authenticators, which means that no client can in fact authenticate. You will
5254 need to add authenticator definitions if you want to make use of this ACL
5257 deny message = relay not permitted
5259 The final statement denies access, giving a specific error message. Reaching
5260 the end of the ACL also causes access to be denied, but with the generic
5261 message ``administrative prohibition''.
5265 Router configuration
5266 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5267 cindex:[default,routers]
5268 cindex:[routers,default]
5269 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5274 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5275 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5276 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5277 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5278 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5281 # driver = ipliteral
5282 # domains = !+local_domains
5283 # transport = remote_smtp
5285 cindex:[domain literal,default router]
5286 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5287 support domain literal addresses (those of the form 'user@[10.9.8.7]'). If
5288 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5289 %allow_domain_literals% in the main part of the configuration.
5293 domains = ! +local_domains
5294 transport = remote_smtp
5295 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5298 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5299 domains. This is specified by the line
5301 domains = ! +local_domains
5303 The %domains% option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5304 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5305 that are not in the domain list called 'local_domains' (which was defined at
5306 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before 'local_domains'
5307 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5308 passed on to the following routers.
5310 The name of the router driver is ^dnslookup^,
5311 and is specified by the %driver% option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5312 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5313 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the %driver% option must be one
5314 of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5316 The ^dnslookup^ router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5317 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5318 router succeeds, the address is queued for the ^remote_smtp^ transport, as
5319 specified by the %transport% option. If the router does not find the domain in
5320 the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the %no_more% setting, so the
5321 address fails and is bounced.
5323 The %ignore_target_hosts% option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5324 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5325 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5326 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5327 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5328 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5329 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5336 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5338 file_transport = address_file
5339 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5341 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5342 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5343 alias in the _/etc/aliases_ file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5344 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5345 the value of the %data% option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5348 _/etc/aliases_ is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5349 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5350 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5351 _Local/Makefile_ before building Exim.
5356 file = $home/.forward
5361 file_transport = address_file
5362 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5363 reply_transport = address_reply
5365 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5366 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5367 individual users. The %check_local_user% setting means that the first thing it
5368 does is to check that the local part of the address is the login name of a
5369 local user. If it is not, the router is skipped. When a local user is found,
5370 the file called _.forward_ in the user's home directory is consulted. If it
5371 does not exist, or is empty, the router declines. Otherwise, the contents of
5372 _.forward_ are interpreted as redirection data (see chapter <<CHAPredirect>>
5375 cindex:[Sieve filter,enabling in default router]
5376 Traditional _.forward_ files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5377 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if %allow_filter% is set (it is
5378 commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set of
5379 Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with ``#Exim
5380 filter'' or ``#Sieve filter'', respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5381 separate document entitled 'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'.
5383 The %no_verify% and %no_expn% options mean that this router is skipped when
5384 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN
5386 There are two reasons for doing this:
5388 . Whether or not a local user has a _.forward_ file is not really relevant when
5389 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5392 . More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5393 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5394 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5395 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' _.forward_ files at
5399 The setting of %check_ancestor% prevents the router from generating a new
5400 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5401 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5402 forwarding -- see section <<SECTredlocmai>>).
5404 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5405 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5406 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a _.forward_ file contains
5408 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5410 the delivery to _/home/spqr/archive_ is done by running the %address_file%
5416 transport = local_delivery
5418 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5419 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and queuing it for
5420 the ^local_delivery^ transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5421 routers, so the address is bounced.
5425 Transport configuration
5426 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5427 cindex:[default,transports]
5428 cindex:[transports,default]
5429 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5430 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5431 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5435 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5440 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5441 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5445 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5452 This ^appendfile^ transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5453 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5454 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the _/var/mail_
5455 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5456 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5457 show how this can be done.
5459 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: 'Delivery-date:',
5460 'Envelope-to:' and 'Return-path:'. This action is requested by the three
5461 similarly-named options above.
5467 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5468 redirection (aliasing or users' _.forward_ files). The %return_output%
5469 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5478 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5479 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5480 ^appendfile^, because it comes from the ^redirect^ router.
5485 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5492 cindex:[retry,default rule]
5493 cindex:[default,retry rule]
5494 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5495 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5496 introduced by the line
5500 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5504 `\* \* F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h`
5507 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5508 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5509 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5510 is not delivered after 4 days of failure, it is bounced.
5514 Rewriting configuration
5515 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5516 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5520 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5521 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5525 Authenticators configuration
5526 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5527 cindex:[AUTH,configuration]
5528 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5530 begin authenticators
5532 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. No authenticators
5533 are specified in the default configuration file.
5537 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5538 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5544 cindex:[regular expressions,library]
5546 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5547 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5548 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5549 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5550 Jeffrey Friedl's 'Mastering Regular Expressions', which is published by
5551 O'Reilly (*http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex/[]*).
5553 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5554 are supported by PCRE is included in plain text in the file
5555 _doc/pcrepattern.txt_ in the Exim distribution, and also in the HTML
5556 tarbundle of Exim documentation, and as an appendix to the Exim book
5557 (*http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/[]*).
5559 It describes in detail the features of the regular expressions that PCRE
5560 supports, so no further description is included here. The PCRE functions are
5561 called from Exim using the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE
5562 options set), except that the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the
5563 matching is required to be case-insensitive.
5565 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5566 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5567 or an ``ends with'' wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5568 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5570 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5572 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5573 precedes interpretation -- see section <<SECTlittext>> for more discussion of
5574 this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5575 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5576 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5577 normal effect of ``anchoring'' it to the start of the string that is being
5580 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5581 recognition of a regular expression: these are the %match% condition in a
5582 string expansion, and the %matches% condition in an Exim filter file. In these
5583 cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if it
5584 does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can match
5585 anywhere in the subject string.
5587 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5588 you must code the \$ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5590 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5592 matches the domain '123.example', but it also matches '123.example.com'.
5595 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5597 if you want 'example' to be the top-level domain. (The backslash before the
5598 \$ is another artefact of string expansion.)
5602 Testing regular expressions
5603 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5604 cindex:[testing,regular expressions]
5605 cindex:[regular expressions,testing]
5607 A program called 'pcretest' forms part of the PCRE distribution and is built
5608 with PCRE during the process of building Exim. It is primarily intended for
5609 testing PCRE itself, but it can also be used for experimenting with regular
5610 expressions. After building Exim, the binary can be found in the build
5611 directory (it is not installed anywhere automatically). There is documentation
5612 of various options in _doc/pcretest.txt_, but for simple testing, none are
5613 needed. This is the output of a sample run of 'pcretest':
5616 ` re> `*`/^([^@]+)@.+\.(ac|edu)\.(?!kr)[a-z]{2}$/`*
5617 `data> `*`x@y.ac.uk`*
5621 `data> `*`x@y.ac.kr`*
5623 `data> `*`x@y.edu.com`*
5625 `data> `*`x@y.edu.co`*
5631 Input typed by the user is shown in bold face. After the ``re>'' prompt, a
5632 regular expression enclosed in delimiters is expected. If this compiles without
5633 error, ``data>'' prompts are given for strings against which the expression is
5634 matched. An empty data line causes a new regular expression to be read. If the
5635 match is successful, the captured substring values (that is, what would be in
5636 the variables $0$, $1$, $2$, etc.) are shown. The above example tests for an
5637 email address whose domain ends with either ``ac'' or ``edu'' followed by a
5638 two-character top-level domain that is not ``kr''. The local part is captured
5639 in $1$ and the ``ac'' or ``edu'' in $2$.
5646 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5647 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5650 File and database lookups
5651 -------------------------
5652 cindex:[file,lookup]
5653 cindex:[database lookups]
5654 cindex:[lookup,description of]
5655 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
5656 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
5658 . A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
5659 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
5662 . Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
5663 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
5664 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
5665 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
5666 chapter <<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>.
5668 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
5669 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
5670 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
5671 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
5673 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
5674 domains = lsearch;/some/file
5676 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
5677 String expansions are described in detail in chapter <<CHAPexpand>>. The
5678 expansion takes place first, and the file that is searched could contain lines
5681 192.168.3.4: domain1 : domain2 : ...
5682 192.168.1.9: domain3 : domain4 : ...
5684 Thus, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and possibly other
5685 types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
5687 In the second case, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
5688 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
5689 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
5694 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
5695 matches the list item.
5697 It is possible to use both kinds of lookup at once. Consider a file containing
5700 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
5702 If the value of $sender_host_address$ is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
5703 first %domains% setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
5704 causes a second lookup to occur.
5706 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
5707 available. Any of them can be used in either of the circumstances described
5708 above. The syntax requirements for the two cases are described in chapters
5709 <<CHAPexpand>> and <<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>, respectively.
5714 cindex:[lookup,types of]
5715 cindex:[single-key lookup,definition of]
5716 Two different styles of data lookup are implemented:
5718 - The 'single-key' style requires the specification of a file in which to look,
5719 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
5720 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
5722 - cindex:[query-style lookup,definition of]
5723 The 'query' style accepts a generalized database query.
5724 No particular key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can
5725 use whichever Exim variable(s) you need to construct the database query.
5727 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
5728 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
5729 default settings in _src/EDITME_ are:
5734 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
5735 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
5736 libraries and header files before building Exim.
5741 [[SECTsinglekeylookups]]
5742 Single-key lookup types
5743 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5744 cindex:[lookup,single-key types]
5745 cindex:[single-key lookup,list of types]
5746 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
5748 - cindex:[cdb,description of]
5750 cindex:[binary zero,in lookup key]
5751 ^cdb^: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
5752 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
5753 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
5754 re-creation. As such, it is particulary suitable for large files containing
5755 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
5756 be found in several places:
5759 *http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html[]*
5760 *ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/[]*
5761 *http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html[]*
5764 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
5765 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
5766 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
5767 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
5769 - cindex:[DBM,lookup type]
5771 cindex:[binary zero,in lookup key]
5772 ^dbm^: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
5773 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
5774 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
5775 <<SECTdb>> for a discussion of DBM libraries.
5777 cindex:[Berkeley DB library,file format]
5778 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
5779 when building DBM files using the %exim_dbmbuild% utility. However, when using
5780 Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with the
5781 DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
5782 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
5783 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
5785 - cindex:[lookup,dbmnz]
5786 cindex:[lookup,dbm -- terminating zero]
5787 cindex:[binary zero,in lookup key]
5789 cindex:[_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_]
5790 cindex:[dmbnz lookup type]
5791 ^dbmnz^: This is the same as ^dbm^, except that a terminating binary zero
5792 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
5793 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
5794 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
5795 use ^dbmnz^ rather than ^dbm^ if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
5796 calls using the passwords from Courier's _/etc/userdbshadow.dat_ file. Exim's
5797 utility program for creating DBM files ('exim_dbmbuild') includes the zeros
5798 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section <<SECTdbmbuild>>).
5800 - cindex:[lookup,dsearch]
5801 cindex:[dsearch lookup type]
5802 ^dsearch^: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for a file
5803 whose name is the key. The key may not contain any forward slash characters.
5804 The result of a successful lookup is the name of the file. An example of how
5805 this lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
5806 <<SECTvirtualdomains>>.
5808 - cindex:[lookup,iplsearch]
5809 cindex:[iplsearch lookup type]
5810 ^iplsearch^: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
5811 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
5812 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
5813 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
5814 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
5816 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
5817 192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
5818 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
5819 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
5821 The key for an ^iplsearch^ lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
5822 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
5823 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
5824 ``best'' match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
5825 ^iplsearch^ is the same as for ^lsearch^.
5827 *Warning 1*: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
5828 ^iplsearch^ can 'not' be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
5829 lookup types support only literal keys.
5831 *Warning 2*: In a host list, you must always use ^net-iplsearch^ so that
5832 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
5833 <<SECThoslispatsikey>>).
5835 - cindex:[linear search]
5836 cindex:[lookup,lsearch]
5837 cindex:[lsearch lookup type]
5838 ^lsearch^: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
5839 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
5840 end of the line. The first occurrence that is found in the file is used. White
5841 space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the line,
5842 with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
5843 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
5844 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
5845 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
5850 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
5851 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
5852 that the keys in an ^lsearch^ file are literal strings. There is no
5853 wildcarding of any kind.
5855 cindex:[lookup,lsearch -- colons in keys]
5856 cindex:[whitespace,in lsearch key]
5857 In most ^lsearch^ files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
5858 characters, or whitespace. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
5859 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
5860 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
5861 contents (see section <<SECTstrings>>). An optional colon is permitted after
5862 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
5863 quotes for the data part of an ^lsearch^ line.
5865 - cindex:[NIS lookup type]
5867 cindex:[binary zero,in lookup key]
5868 ^nis^: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
5869 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
5870 ^nis0^ which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
5871 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
5872 aliases; the full map names must be used.
5874 - cindex:[wildlsearch lookup type]
5875 cindex:[lookup,wildlsearch]
5876 cindex:[nwildlsearch lookup type]
5877 cindex:[lookup,nwildlsearch]
5878 ^wildlsearch^ or ^nwildlsearch^: These search a file linearly, like
5879 ^lsearch^, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key may
5880 be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is that for
5881 ^wildlsearch^, each key in the file is string-expanded before being used,
5882 whereas for ^nwildlsearch^, no expansion takes place.
5884 Like ^lsearch^, the testing is done case-insensitively. The following forms
5885 of wildcard are recognized:
5888 .. The string may begin with an asterisk to mean ``ends with''. For example:
5890 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
5891 *fish data for anythingfish
5893 .. The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
5894 example, for ^wildlsearch^:
5896 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
5898 Note the use of `\N` to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
5899 expression. If you are using ^nwildlsearch^, where the keys are not
5900 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
5902 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
5904 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
5905 either quote it (see ^lsearch^ above), or represent these characters in other
5906 ways. For example, `\s` can be used for white space and `\x3A` for a
5907 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
5908 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
5910 .. Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function
5911 that is used to implement ^(n)wildlsearch^ means that the string may begin with
5912 a lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
5915 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
5917 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
5920 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
5921 continuation rules for the data are the same as for ^lsearch^, and keys may
5922 be followed by optional colons.
5924 *Warning*: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
5925 ^(n)wildlsearch^ can 'not' be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
5926 lookup types support only literal keys.
5930 Query-style lookup types
5931 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5932 cindex:[lookup,query-style types]
5933 cindex:[query-style lookup,list of types]
5934 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
5935 many of them are given in later sections.
5937 - cindex:[DNS,as a lookup type]
5939 ^dnsdb^: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names are
5940 given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the records.
5941 See section <<SECTdnsdb>>.
5943 - cindex:[Interbase lookup type]
5944 cindex:[lookup,Interbase]
5945 ^ibase^: This does a lookup in an Interbase database.
5947 - cindex:[LDAP,lookup type]
5948 cindex:[lookup,LDAP]
5949 ^ldap^: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
5950 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called ^ldapm^
5951 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
5952 called ^ldapdn^ returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
5953 any attribute values. See section <<SECTldap>>.
5955 - cindex:[MySQL,lookup type]
5956 cindex:[lookup,MySQL]
5957 ^mysql^: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a MySQL
5958 database. See section <<SECTsql>>.
5960 - cindex:[NIS+ lookup type]
5961 cindex:[lookup,NIS+]
5962 ^nisplus^: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
5963 the field to be returned. See section <<SECTnisplus>>.
5965 - cindex:[Oracle,lookup type]
5966 cindex:[lookup,Oracle]
5967 ^oracle^: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
5968 Oracle database. See section <<SECTsql>>.
5970 - cindex:[lookup,passwd]
5971 cindex:[passwd lookup type]
5972 cindex:[_/etc/passwd_]
5973 ^passwd^ is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
5974 lookup calls 'getpwnam()' to interrogate the system password data, and on
5975 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an ^lsearch^
5976 lookup on a traditional _/etc/passwd file_, though with `*` for the
5977 password value. For example:
5979 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
5981 - cindex:[PostgreSQL lookup type]
5982 cindex:[lookup,PostgreSQL]
5983 ^pgsql^: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
5984 PostgreSQL database. See section <<SECTsql>>.
5986 - ^testdb^: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
5987 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
5989 - cindex:[whoson lookup type]
5990 cindex:[lookup,whoson]
5991 ^whoson^: 'Whoson' (*http://whoson.sourceforge.net[]*) is a proposed
5992 Internet protocol that allows Internet server programs to check whether a
5993 particular (dynamically allocated) IP address is currently allocated to a known
5994 (trusted) user and, optionally, to obtain the identity of the said user. In
5995 Exim, this can be used to implement ``POP before SMTP'' checking using ACL
5999 require condition = \
6000 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6003 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6004 the authenticated user.
6008 Temporary errors in lookups
6009 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6010 cindex:[lookup,temporary error in]
6011 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6012 completed. For example, a NIS or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6013 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6014 options such as a list of local domains.
6016 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6017 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6018 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6019 or may give up altogether.
6023 [[SECTdefaultvaluelookups]]
6024 Default values in single-key lookups
6025 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6026 cindex:[wildcard lookups]
6027 cindex:[lookup,default values]
6028 cindex:[lookup,wildcard]
6029 cindex:[lookup,\* added to type]
6030 cindex:[default,in single-key lookups]
6031 In this context, a ``default value'' is a value specified by the administrator
6032 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6034 If ``\*'' is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, %lsearch\*%) and
6035 the initial lookup fails, the key ``\*'' is looked up in the file to provide
6036 a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6038 cindex:[\*@ with single-key lookup]
6039 cindex:[lookup,\*@ added to type]
6040 cindex:[alias file,per-domain default]
6041 Alternatively, if ``\*@'' is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6042 \dbm\*\) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6043 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6044 by \*. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6045 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6046 take place because there is no @ in the key), ``\*'' is looked up.
6047 For example, a ^redirect^ router might contain:
6049 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mixed-aliases}}
6051 Suppose the address that is being processed is 'jane@eyre.example'. Exim
6052 looks up these keys, in this order:
6058 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. *Note*: in an
6059 ^lsearch^ file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6060 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6061 Exim move on to try the next key.
6065 [[SECTpartiallookup]]
6066 Partial matching in single-key lookups
6067 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6068 cindex:[partial matching]
6069 cindex:[wildcard lookups]
6070 cindex:[lookup,partial matching]
6071 cindex:[lookup,wildcard]
6072 cindex:[asterisk,in search type]
6073 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6074 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6075 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6076 information in the file that has a key starting with ``\*.'' is matched by any
6077 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6078 a key in a DBM file is
6080 *.dates.fict.example
6082 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6083 '2001.dates.fict.example' and '1984.dates.fict.example'. It is also matched
6084 by 'dates.fict.example', if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6087 *Note*: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6088 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6089 <<SECTaddresslist>>).
6091 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6092 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6093 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6094 partial matching keys
6095 beginning with a special prefix (default ``\*.'') are included in the data file.
6096 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6097 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6099 Partial matching is requested by adding the string ``partial-'' to the front of
6100 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, %partial-dbm%. When this is
6101 done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, ``\*.''
6102 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6103 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed
6104 from the start of the subject key, one-by-one, and ``\*.'' added on the front of
6107 A minimum number of two non-\* components are required. This can be adjusted
6108 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6109 %partial3-lsearch% specifies a minimum of three non-\* components in the
6110 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to ``partial2-''. If the subject
6111 key is '2250.dates.fict.example' then the following keys are looked up when
6112 the minimum number of non-\* components is two:
6114 2250.dates.fict.example
6115 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6116 *.dates.fict.example
6119 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6122 cindex:[lookup,partial matching -- changing prefix]
6123 cindex:[prefix,for partial matching]
6124 The use of ``\*.'' as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6125 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6126 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6127 parentheses instead of the hyphen after ``partial''. For example:
6129 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6131 In this example, if the domain is 'a.b.c', the sequence of lookups is
6132 `a.b.c`, `.a.b.c`, and `.b.c` (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6133 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6134 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6136 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6138 For this example, if the domain is 'a.b.c', the sequence of lookups is
6139 `a.b.c`, `b.c`, and `c`.
6141 If ``partial0'' is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with just
6142 one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right down
6143 to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6145 - If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6147 - If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6148 example, the final lookup for ``partial0(.)'' is for `.` alone.
6150 - Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6151 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6152 for ``\*'' on its own.
6154 - Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6157 If the search type ends in ``\*'' or ``\*@'' (see section
6158 <<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>> above), the search for an ultimate default that this
6159 implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If ``partial0'' is
6160 specified, adding ``\*'' to the search type has no effect with the default
6161 prefix, because the ``\*'' key is already included in the sequence of partial
6162 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6163 ``partial0(.)lsearch\*''.
6165 The use of ``\*'' in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6166 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6167 dot-separated components; a key such as `*fict.example`
6168 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6169 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6176 cindex:[lookup,caching]
6177 cindex:[caching,lookup data]
6178 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6179 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6180 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6181 single Exim process. There is no inter-process caching facility.
6183 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6184 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6185 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6186 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6187 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6188 own internal limit, which can be changed via the %lookup_open_max% option.
6190 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6191 strategic points during delivery -- for example, after all routing is complete.
6198 cindex:[lookup,quoting]
6199 cindex:[quoting,in lookups]
6200 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6201 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6202 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6206 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6207 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6209 [name="$local_part"]
6211 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6212 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6213 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6214 of the following form is provided:
6216 \$\{quote_<lookup-type>:<string>\}
6218 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6220 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6222 See chapter <<CHAPexpand>> for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6223 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6224 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6232 cindex:[dnsdb lookup]
6233 cindex:[lookup,dnsdb]
6234 cindex:[DNS,as a lookup type]
6235 The ^dnsdb^ lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6236 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6237 an expansion string could contain:
6239 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6241 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6242 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6243 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6244 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6245 %in-addr.arpa% or %ip6.arpa% happens automatically. For example:
6247 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6249 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6250 altered and nothing is added.
6252 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6253 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6254 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6255 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6256 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6257 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6259 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6261 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6262 whitespace is ignored.
6264 cindex:[SRV record,in ^dnsdb^ lookup]
6265 For SRV records, the priority, weight, port, and host name are returned for
6266 each record, separated by spaces.
6268 cindex:[MX record,in ^dnsdb^ lookup]
6269 For MX records, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6270 each record, separated by a space. However, if you want only host names, you
6271 can use the pseudo-type MXH:
6273 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6275 In this case, the preference values are omitted.
6277 cindex:[name server,for enclosing domain]
6278 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for ``zone NS''). It performs a lookup for NS
6279 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6280 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6281 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6282 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6283 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6284 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6286 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6287 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6289 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6290 the first returns the name servers for %quercite.com%, and the second returns
6291 the name servers for %edu%.
6293 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6294 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6295 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6296 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6297 for the high-level domains such as %com% or %co.uk% are not going to be on such
6302 Multiple dnsdb lookups
6303 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6304 In the previous section, ^dnsdb^ lookups for a single domain are described.
6305 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6306 ^dnsdb^ lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6307 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6309 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6310 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6311 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6313 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6314 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6315 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6316 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6318 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6319 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6320 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6322 The ^dnsdb^ lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6323 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6324 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6325 type. The possible keywords are ``defer_strict'', ``defer_never'', and
6326 ``defer_lax''. With ``strict'' behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6327 whole lookup to defer. With ``never'' behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6328 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6329 With ``lax'' behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6330 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6331 succeed. The default is ``lax'', so the following lookups are equivalent:
6333 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6334 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6336 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6337 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6345 cindex:[LDAP lookup]
6346 cindex:[lookup,LDAP]
6347 cindex:[Solaris,LDAP]
6348 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6349 become ``Open LDAP'', and there are now two different releases. Another
6350 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6351 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6352 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6353 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6354 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6355 your _Local/Makefile_:
6357 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6358 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6359 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6360 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6361 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6363 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes `OPENLDAP1`, which has the
6364 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6366 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6367 the way they handle the results of a query:
6369 - ^ldap^ requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6372 - ^ldapdn^ also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6373 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6375 - ^ldapm^ permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes from
6376 all of them are returned.
6379 For ^ldap^ and ^ldapm^, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6380 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6381 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6382 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6386 Format of LDAP queries
6387 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6388 cindex:[LDAP,query format]
6389 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6390 the configuration of a ^redirect^ router one might have this setting:
6393 data = ${lookup ldap \
6394 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6395 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6398 cindex:[LDAP,with TLS]
6399 The URL may begin with `ldap` or `ldaps` if your LDAP library supports
6400 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6401 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6406 cindex:[LDAP,quoting]
6407 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6408 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6409 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6410 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6412 The %quote_ldap% operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6413 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6423 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6424 to the rules for URLs, that is, all characters except
6428 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6430 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6434 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6436 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6438 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6441 The %quote_ldap_dn% operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6442 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6443 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6447 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6448 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6449 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6451 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6455 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6457 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6460 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6463 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6464 authentication below.
6469 cindex:[LDAP,connections]
6470 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6471 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6472 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6475 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6477 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6478 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6479 taken from the %ldap_default_servers% configuration option. This supplies a
6480 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6481 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6482 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6483 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6484 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6485 failures, and timeouts.
6487 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6488 of specifing a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6489 %ldap_default_servers% is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6490 doubled. For example
6492 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6494 If %ldap_default_servers% is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6495 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6496 the local host) is used.
6498 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6499 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6500 `ldapi` instead of `ldap` in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6501 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6504 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6505 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6506 can be specified either as an item in %ldap_default_servers%, or inline in
6507 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6509 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6511 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6512 `%2F` to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6514 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6516 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the ``hostname'' is really
6517 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6518 specifies `ldap` or `ldaps`. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6519 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6520 %ldap_default_servers% such as in the example above with traditional `ldap`
6521 or `ldaps` queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6522 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6525 If an explicit `ldapi` type is given in a query when a host name is
6526 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6527 %ldap_default_servers%, they are tried. In other words:
6529 - Using a pathname with `ldap` or `ldaps` forces the use of the Unix domain
6532 - Using `ldapi` with a host name causes an error.
6535 Using `ldapi` with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6536 %ldap_default_servers%, does whatever the library does by default.
6540 LDAP authentication and control information
6541 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6542 cindex:[LDAP,authentication]
6543 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6544 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6545 be preceded by any number of ``<''name'>=<'value'>' settings, separated by
6546 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6547 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6548 them. The following names are recognized:
6551 `DEREFERENCE` set the dereferencing parameter
6552 `NETTIME ` set a timeout for a network operation
6553 `USER ` set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6554 `PASS ` set the password, likewise
6555 `SIZE ` set the limit for the number of entries returned
6556 `TIME ` set the maximum waiting time for a query
6559 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words ``never'',
6560 ``searching'', ``finding'', or ``always''.
6562 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6563 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6564 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6565 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6566 'ldap_result()' function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6567 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6568 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6569 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of ``no timeout'' for
6570 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6572 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6573 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6576 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6577 values. This is a single line, folded for ease of reading:
6580 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6581 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6584 The encoding of spaces as {pc}20 is a URL thing which should not be done for any
6585 of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups which
6586 contain password information should be preceded by ``hide'' to prevent non-admin
6587 users from using the %-bP% option to see their values.
6589 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6590 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6591 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6593 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6594 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
6595 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
6596 quoting has two advantages:
6598 - It makes it possible to use the same %quote_ldap_dn% expansion for USER=
6599 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
6601 - It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
6603 For example, a setting such as
6605 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
6607 should work even if $1$ contains spaces.
6609 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the %quote%
6610 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
6611 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
6612 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
6617 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
6618 SMTP authentication. See the %ldapauth% expansion string condition in chapter
6623 Format of data returned by LDAP
6624 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6625 cindex:[LDAP,returned data formats]
6626 The ^ldapdn^ lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry as
6627 a sequence of values, for example
6629 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
6632 The ^ldap^ lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
6633 search filter, whereas ^ldapm^ permits this case, and inserts a newline in
6634 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
6635 values to be returned for both ^ldap^ and ^ldapm^, but in the former case
6636 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
6639 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
6640 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
6641 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
6643 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
6644 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
6645 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
6646 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
6647 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
6648 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
6649 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
6651 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
6652 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
6653 %attr1% has two values, whereas %attr2% has only one value:
6655 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
6658 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
6661 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
6662 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
6664 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
6665 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
6667 The %extract% operator in string expansions can be used to pick out individual
6668 fields from data that consists of 'key'='value' pairs. You can make use
6669 of Exim's %-be% option to run expansion tests and thereby check the results of
6678 cindex:[NIS+ lookup type]
6679 cindex:[lookup,NIS+]
6680 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ 'indexed name' followed by an optional colon
6681 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
6682 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
6683 of 'field-name=field-value' pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
6684 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
6686 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
6688 might return the string
6690 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
6691 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
6693 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
6695 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
6701 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
6702 for the given indexed key. The effect of the %quote_nisplus% expansion
6703 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
6708 More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and Interbase
6709 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6710 cindex:[MySQL,lookup type]
6711 cindex:[PostgreSQL lookup type]
6712 cindex:[lookup,MySQL]
6713 cindex:[lookup,PostgreSQL]
6714 cindex:[Oracle,lookup type]
6715 cindex:[lookup,Oracle]
6716 cindex:[Interbase lookup type]
6717 cindex:[lookup,Interbase]
6718 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or Interbase lookups are used, the
6719 %mysql_servers%, %pgsql_servers%, %oracle_servers%, or %ibase_servers%
6720 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
6721 information. Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four items:
6722 host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of Oracle, the
6723 host name field is used for the ``service name'', and the database name field is
6724 not used and should be empty. For example:
6726 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//ph10/abcdwxyz
6728 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
6729 ``hide'', to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the %-bP%
6730 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
6733 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
6734 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
6737 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <'name'>:<'port'> but
6738 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled.
6740 For each query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection
6741 and a query succeeds. Queries for these databases are SQL statements, so an
6745 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='ph10'}\
6749 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for
6750 each field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result
6754 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='ph10'}\
6760 home=/home/ph10 name="Philip Hazel"
6762 Values containing spaces and empty values are double quoted, with embedded
6763 quotes escaped by a backslash.
6765 If the result of the query contains just one field, the value is passed back
6766 verbatim, without a field name, for example:
6770 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
6771 with a newline between the data for each row.
6773 The %quote_mysql%, %quote_pgsql%, and %quote_oracle% expansion operators
6774 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
6775 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
6776 itself are escaped with backslashes. The %quote_pgsql% expansion operator, in
6777 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
6778 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
6779 characters are not special.
6783 Special MySQL features
6784 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6785 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of ``localhost'' in %mysql_servers%
6786 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
6787 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
6788 each item in %mysql_servers% is:
6791 <'hostname'>::<'port'>(<'socket name'>)/<'database'>/<'user'>/<'password'>
6794 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
6795 the local host it can be left blank or set to just ``localhost''.
6797 No database need be supplied -- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
6800 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
6801 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
6803 *Warning*: this can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
6804 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
6805 is zero because no rows are affected.
6810 Special PostgreSQL features
6811 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6812 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
6813 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
6814 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
6815 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
6818 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
6820 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
6821 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
6822 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
6824 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
6825 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
6831 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6832 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6834 [[CHAPdomhosaddlists]]
6835 [titleabbrev="Domain, host, and address lists"]
6836 Domain, host, address, and local part lists
6837 -------------------------------------------
6838 cindex:[list of domains; hosts; etc.]
6839 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
6840 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the %hold_domains% option
6841 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
6842 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter <<CHAPACL>>).
6844 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
6845 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
6846 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
6847 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
6853 cindex:[expansion,of lists]
6854 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
6855 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
6856 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
6857 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections <<SECTlistconstruct>> and
6858 <<SECTempitelis>> for details of the list syntax; the second of these discusses
6859 the way you specify empty list items.
6862 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
6863 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
6864 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
6866 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
6867 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
6868 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
6869 the `\N` expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
6870 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
6873 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
6874 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
6877 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
6878 `\N`, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
6879 senders based on the receiving domain.
6884 Negated items in lists
6885 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6886 cindex:[list,negation]
6887 cindex:[negation in lists]
6888 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
6889 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
6890 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
6891 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
6892 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
6894 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
6895 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
6896 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
6897 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
6898 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
6900 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
6902 matches any domain ending in '.b.c' except for 'a.b.c'. Domains that match
6903 neither 'a.b.c' nor '*.b.c' do not match, because the last item in the
6904 list is positive. However, if the setting were
6906 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
6908 then all domains other than 'a.b.c' would match because the last item in the
6909 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
6910 as if it had an extra item `:*` on the end.
6912 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
6913 the connector as ``or'' after a positive item and as ``and'' after a negative
6921 cindex:[list,file name in]
6922 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
6923 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
6924 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
6925 file names are not allowed,
6926 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
6927 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
6930 - For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
6931 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
6933 - Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
6934 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
6935 white space or the start of the line. For example:
6937 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
6939 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
6940 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
6941 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
6942 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
6944 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
6945 within the file is inverted. For example, if
6947 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
6949 and the file contains the lines
6954 then 'a.b.c' is in the set of domains defined by %hold_domains%, whereas any
6955 domain matching `*.b.c` is not.
6959 An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list
6960 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6961 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
6962 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
6963 confusion about the way ^lsearch^ lookups work in lists. Because
6964 an ^lsearch^ file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
6965 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
6966 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an ^lsearch^ file are
6967 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
6969 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
6970 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
6971 in the previous section.
6979 cindex:[named lists]
6981 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
6982 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
6983 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
6984 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
6985 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
6986 a domain list called 'local_domains' for all the domains that are handled
6987 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
6989 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
6991 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
6992 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
6993 configured with the line
6995 domains = +local_domains
6997 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
6998 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7002 domains = ! +local_domains
7003 transport = remote_smtp
7006 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7007 the words %domainlist%, %hostlist%, %addresslist%, or %localpartlist%,
7008 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7009 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7011 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7012 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7014 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7016 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7017 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7018 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7021 *Warning*: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7022 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7023 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7025 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7026 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7028 The second list specifies ``either in the %dom1% list or '*.b'##''. The first
7029 list specifies just ``not 'a.b'##'', so the domain 'x.y' matches it. That means
7030 it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7032 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7034 where 'x.y' does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7035 referenced lists if you can.
7037 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7038 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7039 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7041 domains = +local_domains
7043 on several of your routers
7044 or in several ACL statements,
7045 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7046 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7047 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7048 the same each time they are referenced.
7050 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7051 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7052 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7053 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7057 Named lists compared with macros
7058 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7059 cindex:[list,named compared with macro]
7060 cindex:[macro,compared with named list]
7061 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7062 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7065 ALIST = host1 : host2
7066 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7068 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7070 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7072 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7075 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7076 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7078 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7080 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7087 cindex:[list,caching of named]
7088 cindex:[caching,named lists]
7089 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7090 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7091 the cache operates only if the list contains no \$ characters, which guarantees
7092 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7093 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7094 message. For example:
7097 domainlist special_domains = \
7098 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7101 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7102 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7103 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7104 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7105 same list each time.
7107 By appending `_cache` to `domainlist` you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7108 cache the result anyway. For example:
7110 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7112 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7113 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7120 cindex:[domain list,patterns for]
7121 cindex:[list,domain list]
7122 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7123 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7125 - cindex:[primary host name]
7126 cindex:[host name, matched in domain list]
7127 cindex:[%primary_hostname%]
7128 cindex:[domain list,matching primary host name]
7129 cindex:[@ in a domain list]
7130 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7131 as set by the %primary_hostname% option (or defaulted). This makes it possible
7132 to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that differ only
7135 - cindex:[@{bk} in a domain list]
7136 cindex:[domain list,matching local IP interfaces]
7137 cindex:[domain literal]
7138 If a pattern consists of the string `@[]` it matches any local IP interface
7139 address, enclosed in square brackets, as in an email address that contains a
7141 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7144 cindex:[@mx_primary]
7145 cindex:[@mx_secondary]
7146 cindex:[domain list,matching MX pointers to local host]
7147 If a pattern consists of the string `@mx_any` it matches any domain that
7148 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7149 cindex:[%hosts_treat_as_local%]
7150 %hosts_treat_as_local%. The items `@mx_primary` and `@mx_secondary`
7151 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7152 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7153 but a secondary MX target is. ``Primary'' means an MX record with the lowest
7154 preference value -- there may of course be more than one of them.
7156 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7157 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7158 example, a single-component domain will 'not' be expanded by adding the
7159 resolver's default domain. See the %qualify_single% and %search_parents%
7160 options of the ^dnslookup^ router for a discussion of domain widening.
7162 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7163 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with `/ignore=`<'ip
7164 list'>, where <'ip list'> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7165 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the %ignore_target_hosts% option
7166 on a router). For example:
7168 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7170 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7171 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7173 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7174 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7175 contain negative items.
7177 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7178 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7179 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7182 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7183 an.other.domain : ...
7186 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7187 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7190 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7191 an.other.domain ? ...
7194 - cindex:[asterisk,in domain list]
7195 cindex:[domain list,asterisk in]
7196 cindex:[domain list,matching ``ends with'']
7197 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7198 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of ``\*'' in
7199 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7200 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7201 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7202 list item such as `*key.ex` matches 'donkey.ex' as well as
7205 - cindex:[regular expressions,in domain list]
7206 cindex:[domain list,matching regular expression]
7207 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7208 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7209 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7210 References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions are given in
7211 chapter <<CHAPregexp>>.
7213 *Warning*: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7214 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7215 use the special `\N` sequence (see chapter <<CHAPexpand>>) to specify that it
7216 is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular expression
7217 by expansion, of course).
7219 - cindex:[lookup,in domain list]
7220 cindex:[domain list,matching by lookup]
7221 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7222 semicolon (for example, ``dbm;'' or ``lsearch;''), the remainder of the pattern
7223 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7224 ``cdb;'' it must be an absolute path:
7226 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7228 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7229 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7230 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7231 is used for the %domains% option on a router
7232 or a %domains% condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7233 $domain_data$ variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7234 other statements in the same ACL.
7236 - Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by ``partial<''n'>-',
7237 where the <'n'> is optional, for example,
7239 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7241 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7242 works is given in section <<SECTpartiallookup>>.
7244 - cindex:[asterisk,in lookup type]
7245 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7246 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7247 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7248 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7249 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the $domain_data$
7252 - If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7253 semicolon (for example, ``nisplus;'' or ``ldap;''), the remainder of the pattern
7254 must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in chapter
7255 <<CHAPfdlookup>>. For example:
7258 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7259 where domain = '$domain';
7262 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7263 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7264 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7265 %domains% option on a router, the data is preserved in the $domain_data$
7266 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7268 - cindex:[domain list,matching literal domain name]
7269 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7270 between the pattern and the domain.
7273 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7276 domainlist funny_domains = \
7279 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7280 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7281 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7282 nis;domains.byname : \
7283 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7286 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7287 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7288 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7289 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7290 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7298 cindex:[host list,patterns in]
7299 cindex:[list,host list]
7300 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7301 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7302 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7303 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7304 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7305 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7306 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7309 Special host list patterns
7310 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7311 cindex:[empty item in hosts list]
7312 cindex:[host list,empty string in]
7313 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7314 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7315 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7318 cindex:[asterisk,in host list]
7319 The special pattern ``\*'' in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7320 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7325 Host list patterns that match by IP address
7326 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7327 cindex:[host list,matching IP addresses]
7328 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7329 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7330 ``::`ffff`:<''v4address'>'. When such an address is tested against a host
7331 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7332 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7335 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7336 inspecting its IP address:
7338 - If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7339 with \*, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7340 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7341 'getipnodebyname()' function when available, otherwise 'gethostbyname()'.
7342 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7343 with the IP address of the subject host.
7345 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7346 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7347 ACL condition, the ACL gives a ``defer'' response, usually leading to a temporary
7348 SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name, what happens
7349 is described in section <<SECTbehipnot>> below.
7351 - cindex:[@ in a host list]
7352 If the pattern is ``@'', the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7353 domain name, as just described.
7355 - If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7356 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal ``dotted-quad'' notation.
7357 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7358 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7359 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7360 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7361 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7362 that can never match a client host.
7364 - cindex:[@{bk} in a host list]
7365 If the pattern is ``@[]'', it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7366 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7367 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7369 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7372 - cindex:[CIDR notation]
7373 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7374 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7375 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7376 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7377 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7378 significant end of the address.
7380 *Note*: the mask is 'not' a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7381 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7382 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7383 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7387 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7388 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7391 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7394 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7395 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7398 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7399 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7402 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7404 could make use of a file containing
7409 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7410 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7411 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7414 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7418 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading ``<;'' at the start of the
7424 [[SECThoslispatsikey]]
7425 Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address
7426 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7427 cindex:[host list,lookup of IP address]
7428 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7429 address, the pattern takes this form:
7431 net-<single-key-search-type>;<search-data>
7435 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7437 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7438 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7439 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7440 ^lsearch^ files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in ^lsearch^ files by
7441 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7442 returned by the lookup is not used.
7444 cindex:[IP address,masking]
7445 cindex:[host list,masked IP address]
7446 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7447 patterns of this form:
7449 net<number>-<single-key-search-type>;<search-data>
7453 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7455 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <'number'> as the mask
7456 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7457 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7458 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7459 ``192.168.34.0/24''. IPv6 addresses are converted to a text value using lower
7460 case letters and dots as separators instead of the more usual colon, because
7461 colon is the key terminator in ^lsearch^ files. Full, unabbreviated IPv6
7462 addresses are always used.
7464 *Warning*: Specifing %net32-% (for an IPv4 address) or %net128-% (for an
7465 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifing just %net-% without a number. In
7466 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7467 case the IP address is used on its own.
7471 [[SECThoslispatnam]]
7472 Host list patterns that match by host name
7473 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7474 cindex:[host,lookup failures]
7475 cindex:[unknown host name]
7476 cindex:[host list,matching host name]
7477 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7478 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7479 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7480 address to match against, as described in the section <<SECThoslispatip>> above.)
7482 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7483 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7484 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7485 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7486 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7487 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7488 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7490 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7491 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7493 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7494 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function ('gethostbyaddr()' or
7495 'getipnodebyaddr()' if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7496 are done can be changed by setting the %host_lookup_order% option.
7498 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7499 found. These are described in section <<SECTbehipnot>> below.
7501 cindex:[host,alias for]
7502 cindex:[alias for host]
7503 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7504 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7506 - cindex:[asterisk,in host list]
7507 If a pattern starts with ``\*'' the remainder of the item must match the end of
7508 the host name. For example, `*.b.c` matches all hosts whose names end in
7509 '.b.c'. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7510 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7513 - cindex:[regular expressions,in host list]
7514 cindex:[host list,regular expression in]
7515 If the item starts with ``^'' it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7516 matched against the host name. For example,
7520 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts 'a.c.d' or
7521 'b.c.d'. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7522 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
7523 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use `\N` to mark that
7524 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7526 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
7528 *Warning*: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
7529 `\$` terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
7530 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
7537 Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found
7538 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7539 cindex:[host,lookup failures]
7540 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
7541 name (see section <<SECThoslispatip>>), or it may need to look up a host name
7542 from an IP address (see section <<SECThoslispatnam>>). In either case, the
7543 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
7545 cindex:[`+include_unknown`]
7546 cindex:[`+ignore_unknown`]
7547 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
7548 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
7549 items `+include_unknown` or `+ignore_unknown` may appear in the list (at
7550 top level -- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
7552 - If any item that follows `+include_unknown` requires information that
7553 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
7555 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
7557 rejects connections from any host whose name matches `*.enemy.ex`, and also
7558 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
7560 - If any item that follows `+ignore_unknown` requires information that cannot
7561 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
7565 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
7569 accepts from any host whose name is 'friend.example' and from 192.168.4.5,
7570 whether or not its host name can be found. Without `+ignore_unknown`, if no
7571 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
7573 Both `+include_unknown` and `+ignore_unknown` may appear in the same
7574 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
7577 *Note*: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does 'not'
7578 apply to temporary DNS errors. They always cause a defer action.
7582 [[SECThoslispatnamsk]]
7583 Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name
7584 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7585 cindex:[host,lookup failures]
7586 cindex:[unknown host name]
7587 cindex:[host list,matching host name]
7588 If a pattern is of the form
7590 <single-key-search-type>;<search-data>
7594 dbm;/host/accept/list
7596 a single-key lookup is performend, using the host name as its key. If the
7597 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
7600 *Reminder*: With this kind of pattern, you must have host 'names' as
7601 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
7602 addresses, you must precede the search type with ``net-'' (see section
7603 <<SECThoslispatsikey>>). There is, however, no reason why you could not use two
7604 items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
7605 lookup, both using the same file.
7609 Host list patterns for query-style lookups
7610 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7611 If a pattern is of the form
7613 <query-style-search-type>;<query>
7615 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
7616 data that is looked up is not used. The variables $sender_host_address$ and
7617 $sender_host_name$ can be used in the query. For example:
7620 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
7621 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
7624 The value of $sender_host_address$ for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
7625 can use the %sg% expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
7626 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the %mask% expansion
7629 If the query contains a reference to $sender_host_name$, Exim automatically
7630 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
7631 <<SECThoslispatnam>> for comments on finding host names.)
7633 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
7634 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
7635 `net-`. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, `net-` is
7636 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
7637 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, `net-` 'is' important.
7638 See section <<SECThoslispatsikey>>.)
7643 Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists
7644 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7645 cindex:[host list,mixing names and addresses in]
7646 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
7647 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
7650 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
7652 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
7653 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
7654 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
7655 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
7656 %accept% statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
7657 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
7659 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
7660 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
7662 accept hosts = *.friend.example
7663 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
7665 If the first %accept% fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
7666 <<CHAPACL>> for details of ACLs.
7675 cindex:[list,address list]
7676 cindex:[address list,empty item]
7677 cindex:[address list,patterns]
7678 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
7679 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
7680 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
7681 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
7682 using this option setting:
7686 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
7687 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
7688 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
7690 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when $sender_address$ is empty.
7692 The following kinds of address list pattern can match any address, including
7693 the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message senders:
7695 - As explained above, if a pattern item is empty, it matches the empty address
7698 - cindex:[regular expressions,in address list]
7699 cindex:[address list,regular expression in]
7700 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with ``^'', a regular expression match is
7701 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
7702 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
7703 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use `\N`
7704 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7706 deny senders = \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
7708 The `\N` sequences are removed by the expansion, so the item does start
7709 with ``^'' by the time it is being interpreted as an address pattern.
7711 - cindex:[address list,lookup for complete address]
7712 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
7713 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
7717 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
7718 mysql;select address from blocked where \
7719 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
7722 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
7723 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
7724 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
7725 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
7727 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section <<SECTpartiallookup>>) cannot
7728 be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the panic
7731 cindex:[\*@ with single-key lookup]
7732 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
7733 <<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>, but this is useful only for the ``\*@'' type of
7734 default. For example, with this lookup:
7736 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
7738 the file could contains lines like this:
7740 user1@domain1.example
7743 and for the sender address 'nimrod@jaeger.example', the sequence of keys
7746 nimrod@jaeger.example
7750 *Warning 1*: Do not include a line keyed by ``\*'' in the file, because that
7751 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
7753 *Warning 2*: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
7755 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
7756 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
7758 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
7759 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
7760 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
7764 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
7765 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
7769 - cindex:[@@ with single-key lookup]
7770 cindex:[address list,@@ lookup type]
7771 cindex:[address list,split local part and domain]
7772 If a pattern starts with ``@@'' followed by a single-key lookup item
7773 (for example, `@@lsearch;/some/file`), the address that is being checked is
7774 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
7775 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
7776 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
7777 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
7779 cindex:[asterisk,in address list]
7780 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
7781 keyed by ``\*'' (see section <<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>). The local part patterns
7782 that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with ``\*'', or even be
7783 further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example, with
7785 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
7787 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
7789 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
7791 to reject all senders except %postmaster% from that domain.
7793 cindex:[local part,starting with !]
7794 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
7795 has to be specified using a regular expression. In ^lsearch^ files, an entry
7796 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
7797 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
7798 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
7800 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
7803 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
7806 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
7807 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
7808 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
7809 might have entries like
7811 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
7812 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
7815 in a file that was searched with %@@dbm\*%, to specify a match for 8-digit
7816 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
7817 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
7818 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
7820 cindex:[loop,in lookups]
7821 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
7822 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
7824 - The @@<'lookup'> style of item can also be used with a query-style
7825 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
7826 can only return a single list of local parts.
7828 - If a pattern contains an @ character, but is not a regular expression and does
7829 not begin with a lookup type as described above, the local part of the subject
7830 address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start with an
7831 asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly the same
7832 way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
7833 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
7836 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
7837 *@+hostile_domains:\
7838 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
7839 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
7842 cindex:[local part,starting with !]
7843 cindex:[address list,local part starting with !]
7844 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
7845 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
7846 treated as a sign of negation.
7848 - If a pattern is not one of the above syntax forms, that is, if a
7849 non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not contain
7850 an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject address.
7851 The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal domain, or a
7852 domain pattern that starts with \*. In both these cases, the effect is the same
7853 as if `*@` preceded the pattern.
7855 *Warning*: there is an important difference between the address list items
7856 in these two examples:
7859 senders = *@+my_list
7861 In the first one, `my_list` is a named address list, whereas in the second
7862 example it is a named domain list.
7868 Case of letters in address lists
7869 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7870 cindex:[case of local parts]
7871 cindex:[address list,case forcing]
7872 cindex:[case forcing in address lists]
7873 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
7874 case may be significant on some systems (see %caseful_local_part% for how
7875 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 ('Anti-Spam
7876 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs') suggests that matching of addresses to blocking
7877 lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address lists in
7878 Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by default.
7880 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
7881 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
7882 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
7883 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
7884 that is looked up using the ``@@'' mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
7885 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than ^lsearch^ (which
7886 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
7890 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
7891 an address list is the string ``+caseful'', the original case of the local
7892 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
7893 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
7894 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
7895 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
7896 become case-sensitive after ``+caseful'' has been seen.
7903 cindex:[list,local part list]
7904 cindex:[local part,list]
7905 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
7906 lists, as just described. The ``+caseful'' item can be used if required. In a
7907 setting of the %local_parts% option in a router with %caseful_local_part%
7908 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
7909 case-insensitive. In this case, ``+caseful'' will restore case-sensitive matching
7910 in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
7911 %caseful_local_part% is set true in a router, matching in the %local_parts%
7912 option is case-sensitive from the start.
7914 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section <<SECTfilnamlis>>),
7915 comments are handled in the same way as address lists -- they are recognized
7916 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
7917 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
7918 that the special items that refer to the local host (`@`, `@[]`,
7919 `@mx_any`, `@mx_primary`, and `@mx_secondary`) are not recognized.
7920 Refer to section <<SECTdomainlist>> for details of the other available item
7926 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7927 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7932 cindex:[expansion,of strings]
7933 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
7934 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
7936 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
7937 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
7938 start of a portion of the string which is interpreted and replaced as described
7939 below in section <<SECTexpansionitems>> onwards. Backslash is used as an escape
7940 character, as described in the following section.
7945 Literal text in expanded strings
7946 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7947 cindex:[expansion,including literal text]
7948 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
7949 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
7950 character being treated specially in an expansion, including itself. If the
7951 string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
7952 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
7953 the string is read in (see section <<SECTstrings>>).
7955 cindex:[expansion,non-expandable substrings]
7956 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
7957 two occurrences of `\N`. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
7958 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
7960 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
7962 On encountering the first `\N`, the expander copies subsequent characters
7963 without interpretation until it reaches the next `\N` or the end of the
7968 Character escape sequences in expanded strings
7969 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7970 cindex:[expansion,escape sequences]
7971 A backslash followed by one of the letters ``n'', ``r'', or ``t'' in an expanded
7972 string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline, carriage
7973 return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three octal digits
7974 is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a backslash
7975 followed by ``x'' and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal encoding.
7977 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
7978 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
7979 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
7982 Testing string expansions
7983 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7984 cindex:[expansion,testing]
7985 cindex:[testing,string expansion]
7986 cindex:[%-be% option]
7987 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the %-be% option. This takes
7988 the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
7989 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
7990 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
7991 since no message is being processed, variables such as $local_part$ have no
7992 value. Nevertheless the %-be% option can be useful for checking out file and
7993 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as %sg%, %substr% and
7996 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the %-be% option, and
7997 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
7998 using %-be% for reading files to which they do not have access.
8003 Forced expansion failure
8004 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8005 cindex:[expansion,forced failure]
8006 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8007 alternative ``true'' and ``false'' substrings, enclosed in curly brackets. Which
8008 one is used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the
8009 expansion. If, instead of a ``false'' substring, the word ``fail'' is used (not in
8010 curly brackets), the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be
8011 detected by the code that requested the expansion. This is called ``forced
8012 expansion failure'', and its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some
8013 cases it is no different from any other expansion failure, but in others a
8014 different action may be taken. Such variations are mentioned in the
8015 documentation of the option that is being expanded.
8020 [[SECTexpansionitems]]
8023 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8024 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8025 outer set of braces, to improve readability. *Warning*: Within braces,
8026 white space is significant.
8028 *\$*<'variable~name'>~or~*\$\{*<'variable~name'>*\}*::
8029 cindex:[expansion,variables]
8030 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example
8035 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8036 characters. This form (using curly brackets) is available only for variables;
8037 it does 'not' apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given
8038 in section <<SECTexpvar>> below. If the name of a non-existent variable is given,
8039 the expansion fails.
8041 *\$\{*<'op'>*:*<'string'>*\}*::
8042 cindex:[expansion,operators]
8043 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by <'op'>
8044 is applied to it. For example,
8048 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8049 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section <<SECTexpop>>
8050 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8051 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8052 string easier to understand.
8054 *\$\{extract\{*<'key'>*\}\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}\{*<'string3'>*\}\}*::
8055 cindex:[expansion,extracting substrings by key]
8056 The key and <'string1'> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8057 whitespace is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8058 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <'string1'> must be of the
8061 <key1> = <value1> <key2> = <value2> ...
8063 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8064 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8065 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8066 described in section <<SECTstrings>>. The expanded <'string1'> is searched for
8067 the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If the
8068 key is found, <'string2'> is expanded, and replaces the whole item; otherwise
8069 <'string3'> is used. During the expansion of <'string2'> the variable $value$
8070 contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it is restored to any
8071 previous value it might have had.
8073 If \{<'string3'>\} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8074 key is not found. If \{<'string2'>\} is also omitted, the value that was
8075 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8078 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8079 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8081 Instead of \{<'string3'>\} the word ``fail'' (not in curly brackets) can
8082 appear, for example:
8084 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8086 This forces an expansion failure (see section <<SECTforexpfai>>);
8087 {<'string2'>\} must be present for ``fail'' to be recognized.
8090 *\$\{extract\{*<'number'>*\}\{*<'separators'>*\}\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}\{*<'string3'>*\}\}*::
8091 cindex:[expansion,extracting substrings by number]
8092 The <'number'> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8093 apart from leading and trailing whitespace, which is ignored.
8094 This is what distinguishes this form of %extract% from the previous kind. It
8095 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8096 extracts from <'string1'> the field whose number is given as the first
8097 argument. You can use $value$ in <'string2'> or `fail` instead of
8098 <'string3'> as before.
8100 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8101 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8102 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8103 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8104 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8105 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8106 expansion of <'string3'>, or the empty string if <'string3'> is not provided.
8109 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8113 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8115 yields ``99''. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8116 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8119 *\$\{hash\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}\{*<'string3'>*\}\}*::
8120 cindex:[hash function,textual]
8121 cindex:[expansion,textual hash]
8122 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8123 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8124 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8126 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <'m'> and
8127 <'n'>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if <'string1'>
8128 and <'string2'> do not change when they are expanded, you can use the
8129 simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8131 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8133 The second number is optional (in both notations).
8135 If <'n'> is greater than or equal to the length of the string, the expansion
8136 item returns the string. Otherwise it computes a new string of length <'n'> by
8137 applying a hashing function to the string. The new string consists of
8138 characters taken from the first <'m'> characters of the string
8140 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8142 If <'m'> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8143 letters appear. For example:
8146 `\${hash{3}{monty}} ` yields `jmg`
8147 `\${hash{5}{monty}} ` yields `monty`
8148 `\${hash{4}{62}{monty python}}` yields `fbWx`
8152 *\$header_*<'header~name'>*:*~or~*\$h_*<'header~name'>*:*::
8153 See *\$rheader* below.
8155 *\$bheader_*<'header~name'>*:*~or~*\$bh_*<'header~name'>*:*::
8156 See *\$rheader* below.
8158 *\$rheader_*<'header~name'>*:*~or~*\$rh_*<'header~name'>*:*::
8159 cindex:[expansion,header insertion]
8163 cindex:[header lines,in expansion strings]
8164 cindex:[header lines,character sets]
8165 cindex:[header lines,decoding]
8166 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8170 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8171 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8172 lines) may be present.
8174 The difference between %rheader%, %bheader%, and %header% is in the way the
8175 data in the header line is interpreted.
8178 - cindex:[whitespace,in header lines]
8179 %rheader% gives the original ``raw'' content of the header line, with no
8180 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing whitespace.
8182 - cindex:[base64 encoding,in header lines]
8183 %bheader% removes leading and trailing whitespace, and then decodes base64 or
8184 quoted-printable MIME ``words'' within the header text, but does no character
8185 set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME ``word''
8186 fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8187 cindex:[binary zero,in header line]
8188 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark -- this is
8189 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8191 - %header% tries to translate the string as decoded by %bheader% to a standard
8192 character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would be
8193 displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the %bheader% string is
8194 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8195 'iconv()' function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro
8196 HAVE_ICONV in a system Makefile or in _Local/Makefile_.
8199 In a filter file, the target character set for %header% can be specified by a
8200 command of the following form:
8202 headers charset "UTF-8"
8204 This command affects all references to $h_$ (or $header_$) expansions in
8205 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8206 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the %headers_charset%
8207 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8208 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in _Local/Makefile_. The ultimate default is
8211 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8212 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8213 'do not' terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8214 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8216 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8217 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8218 message, and any that are added by an ACL %warn% statement or by a system
8219 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8220 router or transport are not accessible.
8222 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8223 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8224 message is received. Header lines that are added by %warn% statements in a
8225 RCPT ACL (for example) are saved until the message's incoming header lines
8226 are available, at which point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running,
8227 however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
8229 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8230 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8231 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8232 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8233 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8234 replaced by an empty string. (See the %def% condition in section <<SECTexpcond>>
8235 for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8237 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all
8238 concatenated to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. A
8239 newline character is inserted between each line. For the %header% expansion,
8240 for those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at
8241 the junctions between lines. This does not happen for the %rheader% expansion.
8245 *\$\{hmac\{*<'hashname'>*\}\{*<'secret'>*\}\{*<'string'>*\}\}*::
8246 cindex:[expansion,hmac hashing]
8247 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8248 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8249 RFC 2104. This differs from `\$\{md5:secret_text...\}` or
8250 `\$\{sha1:secret_text...\}` in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8251 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8252 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either `md5` or `sha1` at present.
8255 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8257 For the hostname 'mail.example.com' and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8260 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8262 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8263 an Exim configuration:
8265 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8267 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8271 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_id} \
8272 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8273 {${primary_hostname},${message_id},$h_message-id:}}
8276 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8277 'X-Spam-Scanned:' header line. If you know the secret, you can check that this
8278 header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the host
8279 name, message ID and the 'Message-id:' header line. This can be done using
8280 Exim's %-be% option, or by other means, for example by using the
8281 'hmac_md5_hex()' function in Perl.
8284 *\$\{if~*<'condition'>*~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}\}*::
8285 cindex:[expansion,conditional]
8286 If <'condition'> is true, <'string1'> is expanded and replaces the whole item;
8287 otherwise <'string2'> is used. The available conditions are described in
8288 section <<SECTexpcond>> below. For example:
8290 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8292 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8293 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word ``fail'' may be
8294 present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8295 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8298 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string `true` if the condition
8299 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8300 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8302 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8306 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8310 *\$\{length\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}\}*::
8311 cindex:[expansion,string truncation]
8312 The %length% item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8313 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <'n'>, say. If you
8314 are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <'string1'> does not change
8315 when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of
8318 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8320 The result of this item is either the first <'n'> characters or the whole
8321 of <'string2'>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse %length% with
8322 %strlen%, which gives the length of a string.
8325 *\$\{lookup\{*<'key'>*\}~*<'search~type'>*~\{*<'file'>*\}~\{*<'string1'>*\}~\{*<'string2'>*\}\}*::
8326 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8327 described in the next item.
8329 *\$\{lookup~*<'search~type'>*~\{*<'query'>*\}~\{*<'string1'>*\}~\{*<'string2'>*\}\}*::
8330 cindex:[expansion,lookup in]
8331 cindex:[file,lookup]
8332 cindex:[lookup,in expanded string]
8333 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8334 discussed in chapter <<CHAPfdlookup>>. The first form is used for single-key
8335 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <'key'>, <'file'>,
8336 and <'query'> strings are expanded before use.
8338 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8339 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the ^manualroute^ router, or any
8340 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8341 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8342 out by the system administrator.
8345 If the lookup succeeds, <'string1'> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8346 During its expansion, the variable $value$ contains the data returned by the
8347 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8348 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <'string2'> is expanded and replaces
8349 the entire item. If \{<'string2'>\} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8350 string on failure. If <'string2'> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8351 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8352 original lookup fails.
8354 If a nested lookup is used as part of <'string1'>, $value$ contains the data
8355 for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are expanded,
8356 and also while <'string2'> of the second lookup is expanded, should the second
8357 lookup fail. + Instead of \{<'string2'>\} the word ``fail'' can appear, and in
8358 this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced to fail (see
8359 section <<SECTforexpfai>>). If both \{<'string1'>\} and \{<'string2'>\} are
8360 omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a successful lookup,
8361 and nothing in the case of failure.
8363 For single-key lookups, the string ``partial'' is permitted to precede the
8364 search type in order to do partial matching, and \* or \*@ may follow a search
8365 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8366 <<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>> and <<SECTpartiallookup>> for details).
8368 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in lookup expansion]
8369 If a partial search is used, the variables $1$ and $2$ contain the wild
8370 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8371 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8373 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8375 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8377 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8378 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8381 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8386 *\$\{nhash\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}\{*<'string3'>*\}\}*::
8387 cindex:[expansion,numeric hash]
8388 cindex:[hash function,numeric]
8389 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8390 <'n'> and <'m'>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8391 <'string1'> and <'string2'> do not change when they are expanded, you can use
8392 the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8394 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8396 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8397 the result is a number in the range 0--<'n'>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8398 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8399 slash, in the ranges 0 to <'n'>-1 and 0 to <'m'>-1, respectively. For example,
8401 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8403 returns the string ``6/33''.
8407 *\$\{perl\{*<'subroutine'>*\}\{*<'arg'>*\}\{*<'arg'>*\}...\}*::
8408 cindex:[Perl,use in expanded string]
8409 cindex:[expansion,calling Perl from]
8410 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8411 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8412 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8413 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8414 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8416 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8417 the return value is %undef%. In that case, the expansion fails in the same way
8418 as an explicit ``fail'' on a lookup item.
8419 The return value is a scalar. Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar
8420 context. For example, if you return the name of a Perl vector, the
8421 return value is the size of the vector, not its contents.
8423 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's %die% function, the expansion fails
8424 with the error message that was passed to %die%. More details of the embedded
8425 Perl facility are given in chapter <<CHAPperl>>.
8427 The ^redirect^ router has an option called %forbid_filter_perl% which locks
8428 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8431 *\$\{readfile\{*<'file~name'>*\}\{*<'eol~string'>*\}\}*::
8432 cindex:[expansion,inserting an entire file]
8433 cindex:[file,inserting into expansion]
8434 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
8435 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
8436 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
8437 newlines are left in the string.
8438 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
8439 you must wrap the item in an %expand% operator. If the file cannot be read, the
8440 string expansion fails.
8442 The ^redirect^ router has an option called %forbid_filter_readfile% which
8443 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8447 *\$\{readsocket\{*<'name'>*\}\{*<'request'>*\}\{*<'timeout'>*\}\{*<'eol~string'>*\}\{*<'fail~string'>*\}\}*::
8448 cindex:[expansion,inserting from a socket]
8449 cindex:[socket, use of in expansion]
8450 This item inserts data that is read from a Unix domain socket into the expanded
8451 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments:
8453 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
8455 Exim connects to the socket, writes the request string (unless it is an
8456 empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file is read. A timeout
8457 of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments extend what can be
8458 done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
8460 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}}
8462 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
8463 that is read, in the same way as for %readfile% (see above). This example turns
8466 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}{ }}
8468 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
8469 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
8470 addition, the following errors can occur:
8473 - Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
8475 - Failure to connect the socket;
8477 - Failure to write the request-string;
8479 - Timeout on reading from the socket.
8482 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
8483 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
8484 errors occurs. For example:
8487 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}{\n}\
8491 You can test for the existence of the socket by wrapping this expansion in
8492 `\$\{if exists`, but there is a race condition between that test and the
8493 actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument if you
8494 want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a non-existent
8497 The ^redirect^ router has an option called %forbid_filter_readsocket% which
8498 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8500 *\$rheader_*<'header~name'>*:~or~\$rh_*<'header~name'>*:*::
8501 This item inserts ``raw'' header lines. It is described with the %header%
8502 expansion item above.
8506 *\$\{run\{*<'command'>*~*<'args'>*\}\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}\}*::
8507 cindex:[expansion,running a command]
8508 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
8509 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
8510 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
8511 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
8513 cindex:[return code,from %run% expansion]
8514 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <'string1'> is expanded and
8515 replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output from the
8516 command is in the variable $value$. If the command fails, <'string2'>, if
8517 present, is expanded. If it is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively,
8518 <'string2'> can be the word ``fail'' (not in braces) to force expansion failure
8519 if the command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is the
8520 standard output on success, and nothing on failure.
8522 The return code from the command is put in the variable $runrc$, and this
8523 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
8525 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
8526 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
8530 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
8531 the return code is 127 -- the same code that shells use for non-existent
8534 *Warning*: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
8535 option values are expanded, except for those pre-conditions whose order of
8536 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set $runrc$
8537 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
8539 The ^redirect^ router has an option called %forbid_filter_run% which locks
8540 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8543 *\$\{sg\{*<'subject'>*\}\{*<'regex'>*\}\{*<'replacement'>*\}\}*::
8544 cindex:[expansion,string substitution]
8545 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
8546 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
8547 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
8548 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
8549 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example
8551 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
8553 yields ``xyzdefxyzdef''. Because all three arguments are expanded before use, if
8554 any \$ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
8555 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example
8557 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
8559 yields ``defabc'', and
8561 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
8563 yields ``K1=A K4=D K3=C''. Note the use of `\N` to protect the contents of
8564 the regular expression from string expansion.
8568 *\$\{substr\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}\{*<'string3'>*\}\}*::
8570 cindex:[substring extraction]
8571 cindex:[expansion,substring extraction]
8572 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8573 <'n'> and <'m'>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8574 <'string1'> and <'string2'> do not change when they are expanded, you can use
8575 the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8577 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8579 The second number is optional (in both notations).
8580 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
8583 The %substr% item can be used to extract more general substrings than
8584 %length%. The first number, <'n'>, is a starting offset, and <'m'> is the
8585 length required. For example
8587 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
8589 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
8590 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
8591 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
8592 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
8594 The %substr% expansion item can take negative offset values to count
8595 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
8596 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
8598 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
8600 yields ``34''. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
8601 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
8602 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
8604 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
8606 yields an empty string, but
8608 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
8612 When the second number is omitted from %substr%, the remainder of the string
8613 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
8614 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
8615 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
8618 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
8620 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, ``abcd''.
8624 *\$\{tr\{*<'subject'>*\}\{*<'characters'>*\}\{*<'replacements'>*\}\}*::
8625 cindex:[expansion,character translation]
8626 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
8627 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
8628 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
8629 replacement list. For example
8631 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
8633 yields `1b3de1`. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
8634 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
8635 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
8643 cindex:[expansion,operators]
8644 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
8645 the ``operator'' notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
8646 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
8647 following operations can be performed:
8649 *\$\{address:*<'string'>*\}*::
8650 cindex:[expansion,RFC 2822 address handling]
8651 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
8652 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
8653 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
8656 *\$\{base62:*<'digits'>*\}*::
8658 cindex:[expansion,conversion to base 62]
8659 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
8660 base 62 (sic) and output as a string of six characters, including leading
8661 zeros. *Note*: Just to be absolutely clear: this is 'not' base64
8664 *\$\{base62d:*<'base-62~digits'>*\}*::
8666 cindex:[expansion,conversion to base 62]
8667 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits. The number is converted to
8668 decimal and output as a string.
8671 *\$\{domain:*<'string'>*\}*::
8672 cindex:[domain,extraction]
8673 cindex:[expansion,domain extraction]
8674 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
8675 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
8678 *\$\{escape:*<'string'>*\}*::
8679 cindex:[expansion,escaping non-printing characters]
8680 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
8681 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
8682 significant bit set (so-called ``8-bit characters'') count as printing or not is
8683 controlled by the %print_topbitchars% option.
8686 *\$\{eval:*<'string'>*\}*::
8687 *\$\{eval10:*<'string'>*\}*::
8688 cindex:[expansion,expression evaluation]
8689 cindex:[expansion,arithmetic expression]
8690 These items supports simple arithmetic in expansion strings. The string (after
8691 expansion) must be a conventional arithmetic expression, but it is limited to
8692 the four basic operators (plus, minus, times, divide) and parentheses. All
8693 operations are carried out using integer arithmetic. Plus and minus have a
8694 lower priority than times and divide; operators with the same priority are
8695 evaluated from left to right.
8697 For %eval%, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with ``0'') or hexadecimal
8698 (starting with ``0x''). For %eval10%, all numbers are taken as decimal, even if
8699 they start with a leading zero. This can be useful when processing numbers
8700 extracted from dates or times, which often do have leading zeros.
8702 A number may be followed by ``K'' or ``M'' to multiply it by 1024 or 1024\*1024,
8703 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
8704 a decimal representation of the answer (without ``K'' or ``M''). For example:
8707 `\${eval:1+1} ` yields 2
8708 `\${eval:1+2*3} ` yields 7
8709 `\${eval:(1+2)*3} ` yields 9
8712 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
8715 deny message = Too many bad recipients
8718 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
8721 {$recipients_count} \
8722 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
8727 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
8728 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
8731 *\$\{expand:*<'string'>*\}*::
8732 cindex:[expansion,re-expansion of substring]
8733 The %expand% operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
8736 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
8738 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for %expand%, and
8739 then re-expands what it has found.
8742 *\$\{from_utf8:*<'string'>*\}*::
8744 cindex:[UTF-8,conversion from]
8745 cindex:[expansion,UTF-8 conversion]
8746 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
8747 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
8748 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
8749 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
8750 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
8751 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
8753 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
8754 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
8755 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
8756 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
8757 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
8758 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
8759 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
8762 *\$\{hash_*<'n'>*_*<'m'>*:*<'string'>*\}*::
8763 cindex:[hash function,textual]
8764 cindex:[expansion,textual hash]
8765 The %hash% operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can be
8766 used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
8767 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8769 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
8771 See the description of the general %hash% item above for details. The
8772 abbreviation %h% can be used when %hash% is used as an operator.
8776 *\$\{hex2b64:*<'hexstring'>*\}*::
8777 cindex:[base64 encoding,conversion from hex]
8778 cindex:[expansion,hex to base64]
8779 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
8780 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
8783 *\$\{lc:*<'string'>*\}*::
8784 cindex:[case forcing in strings]
8785 cindex:[string,case forcing]
8786 cindex:[lower casing]
8787 cindex:[expansion,case forcing]
8788 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
8794 *\$\{length_*<'number'>*:*<'string'>*\}*::
8795 cindex:[expansion,string truncation]
8796 The %length% operator is a simpler interface to the %length% function that can
8797 be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
8798 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
8800 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
8802 See the description of the general %length% item above for details. Note that
8803 %length% is not the same as %strlen%. The abbreviation %l% can be used when
8804 %length% is used as an operator.
8807 *\$\{local_part:*<'string'>*\}*::
8808 cindex:[expansion,local part extraction]
8809 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
8810 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
8814 *\$\{mask:*<'IP~address'>*/*<'bit~count'>*\}*::
8815 cindex:[masked IP address]
8816 cindex:[IP address,masking]
8817 cindex:[CIDR notation]
8818 cindex:[expansion,IP address masking]
8819 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
8820 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
8821 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
8822 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
8823 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
8825 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
8827 returns the string ``10.111.131.192/28''. Since this operation is expected to be
8828 mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
8829 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
8830 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
8832 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
8836 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
8838 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
8841 *\$\{md5:*<'string'>*\}*::
8843 cindex:[expansion,MD5 hash]
8844 The %md5% operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it as
8845 a 32-digit hexadecimal number,
8846 in which any letters are in lower case.
8849 *\$\{nhash_*<'n'>*_*<'m'>*:*<'string'>*\}*::
8850 cindex:[expansion,numeric hash]
8851 cindex:[hash function,numeric]
8852 The %nhash% operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
8853 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
8854 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8856 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
8858 See the description of the general %nhash% item above for details.
8861 *\$\{quote:*<'string'>*\}*::
8862 cindex:[quoting,in string expansions]
8863 cindex:[expansion,quoting]
8864 The %quote% operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
8865 is an empty string or
8866 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
8867 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
8868 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to `\n` and `\r`,
8869 respectively For example,
8877 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
8878 variable or a message header.
8880 *\$\{quote_local_part:*<'string'>*\}*::
8881 This operator is like %quote%, except that it quotes the string only if
8882 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
8883 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for %quote%).
8884 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of $local_part$
8885 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
8888 *\$\{quote_*<'lookup-type'>*:*<'string'>*\}*::
8889 cindex:[quoting,lookup-specific]
8890 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
8891 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
8892 the lookups in chapter <<CHAPfdlookup>>. For example,
8894 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
8900 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
8901 yields an unchanged string.
8904 *\$\{rxquote:*<'string'>*\}*::
8905 cindex:[quoting,in regular expressions]
8906 cindex:[regular expressions,quoting]
8907 The %rxquote% operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
8908 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
8909 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
8912 *\$\{rfc2047:*<'string'>*\}*::
8913 cindex:[expansion,RFC 2047]
8914 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
8915 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
8916 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
8917 %headers_charset% option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string contains
8918 only characters in the range 33--126, and no instances of the characters
8920 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
8922 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
8923 string, using as many ``coded words'' as necessary to encode all the
8928 *\$\{sha1:*<'string'>*\}*::
8930 cindex:[expansion,SHA-1 hashing]
8931 The %sha1% operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns it
8932 as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
8935 *\$\{stat:*<'string'>*\}*::
8936 cindex:[expansion,statting a file]
8937 cindex:[file,extracting characteristics]
8938 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the 'stat()'
8939 function is made for this path. If 'stat()' fails, an error occurs and the
8940 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
8941 series of <'name'>=<'value'> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
8942 except for the value of ``smode''. The names are: ``mode'' (giving the mode as a
8943 4-digit octal number), ``smode'' (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
8944 10-character string, as for the 'ls' command), ``inode'', ``device'', ``links'',
8945 ``uid'', ``gid'', ``size'', ``atime'', ``mtime'', and ``ctime''. You can extract individual
8946 fields using the %extract% expansion item. *Warning*: The file size may be
8947 incorrect on 32-bit systems for files larger than 2GB.
8950 *\$\{str2b64:*<'string'>*\}*::
8951 cindex:[expansion,base64 encoding]
8952 cindex:[base64 encoding,in string expansion]
8953 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
8957 *\$\{strlen:*<'string'>*\}*::
8958 cindex:[expansion,string length]
8959 cindex:[string,length in expansion]
8960 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
8961 decimal number. *Note*: Do not confuse %strlen% with %length%.
8964 *\$\{substr_*<'start'>*_*<'length'>*:*<'string'>*\}*::
8966 cindex:[substring extraction]
8967 cindex:[expansion,substring expansion]
8968 The %substr% operator is a simpler interface to the %substr% function that can
8969 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
8970 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8972 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
8974 See the description of the general %substr% item above for details. The
8975 abbreviation %s% can be used when %substr% is used as an operator.
8977 *\$\{time_interval:*<'string'>*\}*::
8978 cindex:[%time_interval%]
8979 cindex:[time interval,formatting]
8980 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
8981 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
8982 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
8985 *\$\{uc:*<'string'>*\}*::
8986 cindex:[case forcing in strings]
8987 cindex:[string,case forcing]
8988 cindex:[upper casing]
8989 cindex:[expansion,case forcing]
8990 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
8998 Expansion conditions
8999 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9000 cindex:[expansion,conditions]
9001 The following conditions are available for testing by the %\$\{if% construct
9002 while expanding strings:
9005 cindex:[expansion,negating a condition]
9006 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9009 <'symbolic~operator'>~*\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9010 cindex:[numeric comparison]
9011 cindex:[expansion,numeric comparison]
9012 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9019 `>= ` greater or equal
9026 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9028 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9029 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9030 optionally followed by one of the letters ``K'' or ``M'' (in either upper or
9031 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024\*1024, respectively.
9033 *crypteq~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9034 cindex:[expansion,encrypted comparison]
9035 cindex:[encrypted strings, comparing]
9036 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9037 authentication mechanisms (see chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>). Otherwise, it is
9038 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in _Local/Makefile_ to get %crypteq%
9039 included in the binary.
9041 The %crypteq% condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and compared
9042 against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may be in the
9043 LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the encryption type
9044 in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string does not begin
9045 with ``\{'' it is assumed to be encrypted with 'crypt()' or 'crypt16()' (see
9046 below), since such strings cannot begin with ``\{''. Typically this will be a
9047 field from a password file.
9049 An example of an encrypted string in LDAP form is:
9051 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9053 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9054 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9056 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9058 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9063 cindex:[base64 encoding,in encrypted password]
9064 %\{md5\}% computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9065 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9066 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9067 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9068 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9071 - cindex:[SHA-1 hash]
9072 %\{sha1\}% computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9073 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9074 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9075 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9076 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9078 - cindex:['crypt()']
9079 %\{crypt\}% calls the 'crypt()' function, which traditionally used to use only
9080 the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9081 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9082 whatever its length.
9084 - cindex:['crypt16()']
9085 %\{crypt16\}% calls the 'crypt16()' function (also known as 'bigcrypt()'),
9086 which was orginally created to use up to 16 characters of the password. Again,
9087 in modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9090 Exim has its own version of 'crypt16()' (which is just a double call to
9091 'crypt()'). For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9092 HAVE_CRYPT16 in _Local/Makefile_ when building Exim causes it to use the
9093 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9094 the OS-dependent _Makefile_ for those operating systems that are known to
9095 support 'crypt16()'.
9097 If you do not put any curly bracket encryption type in a %crypteq% comparison,
9098 the default is either `\{crypt\}` or `\{crypt16\}`, as determined by the
9099 setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in _Local/Makefile_. The default default is
9100 `\{crypt\}`. Whatever the default, you can always use either function by
9101 specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9103 Note that if a password is no longer than 8 characters, the results of
9104 encrypting it with 'crypt()' and 'crypt16()' are identical. That means that
9105 'crypt16()' is backwards compatible, as long as nobody feeds it a password
9106 longer than 8 characters.
9109 *def:*<'variable~name'>*::
9110 cindex:[expansion,checking for empty variable]
9111 The %def% condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9112 variables defined in section <<SECTexpvar>>. The condition is true if the named
9113 expansion variable does not contain the empty string, for example
9115 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9117 Note that the variable name is given without a leading %\$% character. If the
9118 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9120 *def:header_*<'header~name'>*:*~~or~~*def:h_*<'header~name'>*:*::
9121 cindex:[expansion,checking header line existence]
9122 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9123 exists in the message. For example,
9125 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9127 Note that no %\$% appears before %header_% or %h_% in the condition,
9128 and that header names must be terminated by colons if white space does not
9131 *eq~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9132 cindex:[string,comparison]
9133 cindex:[expansion,string comparison]
9134 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9135 resulting strings are identical, including the case of letters.
9137 *eqi~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9138 cindex:[string,comparison]
9139 cindex:[expansion,string comparison]
9140 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9141 resulting strings are identical when compared in a case-independent way.
9143 *exists~\{*<'file~name'>*\}*::
9144 cindex:[expansion,file existence test]
9145 cindex:[file,existence test]
9146 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9147 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9148 is done by calling the 'stat()' function. The use of the %exists% test in
9149 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9152 cindex:[delivery,first]
9153 cindex:[first delivery]
9154 cindex:[expansion,first delivery test]
9155 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9156 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9158 *ge~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9161 *gei~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9162 cindex:[string,comparison]
9163 cindex:[expansion,string comparison]
9164 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9165 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string: for %ge% the
9166 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for %gei% the comparison is
9169 *gt~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9172 *gti~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9173 cindex:[string,comparison]
9174 cindex:[expansion,string comparison]
9175 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9176 string is lexically greater than the second string: for %gt% the comparison
9177 includes the case of letters, whereas for %gti% the comparison is
9180 *isip~\{*<'string'>*\}*::
9183 *isip4~\{*<'string'>*\}*::
9186 *isip6~\{*<'string'>*\}*::
9187 cindex:[IP address,testing string format]
9188 cindex:[string,testing for IP address]
9189 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9190 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for %isip%, whereas
9191 %isip4% and %isip6% test just for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses, respectively. For
9192 example, you could use
9194 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
9196 to test which version of IP an incoming SMTP connection is using.
9199 *ldapauth~\{*<'ldap~query'>*\}*::
9200 cindex:[LDAP,use for authentication]
9201 cindex:[expansion,LDAP authentication test]
9202 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
9203 <<SECTldap>> for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
9204 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
9205 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
9206 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
9207 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
9208 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
9209 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>> for details
9210 of SMTP authentication, and chapter <<CHAPplaintext>> for an example of how
9214 *le~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9217 *lei~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9218 cindex:[string,comparison]
9219 cindex:[expansion,string comparison]
9220 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9221 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string: for %le% the
9222 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for %lei% the comparison is
9225 *lt~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9228 *lti~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9229 cindex:[string,comparison]
9230 cindex:[expansion,string comparison]
9231 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9232 string is lexically less than the second string: for %lt% the comparison
9233 includes the case of letters, whereas for %lti% the comparison is
9237 *match~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9238 cindex:[expansion,regular expression comparison]
9239 cindex:[regular expressions,match in expanded string]
9240 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
9241 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
9242 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
9243 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
9244 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
9245 premature termination of <'string2'>. The easiest approach is to use the
9246 `\N` feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
9249 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
9251 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
9252 backslashes is also required.
9254 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
9255 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
9256 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
9257 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
9258 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the `\$`
9259 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
9261 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in %if% expansion]
9262 At the start of an %if% expansion the values of the numeric variable
9263 substitutions $1$ etc. are remembered. Obeying a %match% condition that
9264 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
9265 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
9266 of the %if% expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
9267 combination of conditions using %or%, the subsequent values of the numeric
9268 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
9270 *match_domain~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9271 See *match_local_part*.
9273 *match_address~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9274 See *match_local_part*.
9276 *match_local_part~\{*<'string1'>*\}\{*<'string2'>*\}*::
9277 cindex:[domain list,in expansion condition]
9278 cindex:[address list,in expansion condition]
9279 cindex:[local part list,in expansion condition]
9280 These conditions make it possible to test domain, address, and local
9281 part lists within expansions. Each condition requires two arguments: an item
9282 and a list to match. A trivial example is:
9284 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
9286 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
9287 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
9288 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
9289 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
9291 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
9294 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the `+caseful`
9295 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
9296 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
9299 *Note*: Host lists are 'not' supported in this way. This is because
9300 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
9301 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. At least, I haven't come
9302 up with anything yet.
9304 *pam~\{*<'string1'>*:*<'string2'>*:...\}*::
9305 cindex:[PAM authentication]
9306 cindex:[AUTH,with PAM]
9307 cindex:[Solaris,PAM support]
9308 cindex:[expansion,PAM authentication test]
9309 'Pluggable Authentication Modules'
9310 (*http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/[]*)
9311 are a facility that is available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some
9312 GNU/Linux distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in
9313 conjunction with the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is
9318 in _Local/Makefile_. You probably need to add %-lpam% to EXTRALIBS, and
9319 in some releases of GNU/Linux %-ldl% is also needed.
9321 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
9322 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9323 The PAM module is initialized with the service name ``exim'' and the user name
9324 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<'string1'>). The
9325 remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests from
9326 the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one request,
9327 for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
9329 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
9330 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
9331 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the %sg% expansion
9332 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
9333 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
9335 server_condition = ${if pam{$1:${sg{$2}{:}{::}}}{yes}{no}}
9337 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
9339 server_condition = ${if pam{$2:${sg{$3}{:}{::}}}{yes}{no}}
9341 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
9342 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
9343 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
9344 A patched version of the 'pam_unix' module that comes with the
9345 Linux PAM package is available from *http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/[]*.
9346 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
9347 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
9348 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
9351 *pwcheck~\{*<'string1'>*:*<'string2'>*\}*::
9352 cindex:['pwcheck' daemon]
9354 cindex:[expansion,'pwcheck' authentication test]
9355 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus 'pwcheck' daemon.
9356 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
9357 that is not running as root. *Note:* The use of 'pwcheck' is now deprecated.
9358 Its replacement is 'saslauthd' (see below).
9360 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
9361 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in _Local/Makefile_ before
9362 building Exim. For example:
9364 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
9366 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
9367 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
9368 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that 'exim' is the only user that has
9369 access to the _/var/pwcheck_ directory.
9371 The %pwcheck% condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
9372 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
9373 configuration, you might have this:
9375 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$1:$2}{1}{0}}
9379 cindex:[queue runner,detecting when delivering from]
9380 cindex:[expansion,queue runner test]
9381 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
9382 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
9385 *radius~\{*<'authentication~string'>*\}*::
9387 cindex:[expansion,Radius authentication]
9388 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
9389 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in _Local/Makefile_ to specify the location of
9390 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
9393 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the %radiusclient%
9394 library. You can also link Exim with the %libradius% library that comes with
9395 FreeBSD. To do this, set
9397 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
9399 in _Local/Makefile_, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
9400 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
9401 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
9403 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
9404 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
9405 the authentication is successful. For example
9407 server_condition = \$\{if radius\{<arguments>\}\{yes\}\{no\}\}
9412 *saslauthd~\{\{*<'user'>*\}\{*<'password'>*\}\{*<'service'>*\}\{*<'realm'>*\}\}*::
9413 cindex:['saslauthd' daemon]
9415 cindex:[expansion,'saslauthd' authentication test]
9416 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus 'saslauthd'
9417 daemon. This replaces the older 'pwcheck' daemon, which is now deprecated.
9418 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
9419 by a process that is not running as root.
9421 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
9422 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in _Local/Makefile_ before
9423 building Exim. For example:
9425 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
9427 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
9428 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
9429 from the Cyrus SASL library.
9431 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the %saslauthd% condition, but only two
9432 are mandatory. For example:
9434 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$1}{$2}}{1}{0}}
9436 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
9437 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
9438 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
9442 Combining expansion conditions
9443 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9444 cindex:[expansion,combining conditions]
9445 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the %and% and
9446 %or% combination conditions. Note that %and% and %or% are complete conditions
9447 on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each sub-condition
9448 must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain the list. No
9449 repetition of %if% is used.
9452 *or~\{\{*<'cond1'>*\}\{*<'cond2'>*\}...\}*::
9453 cindex:[``or'' expansion condition]
9454 cindex:[expansion,``or'' of conditions]
9455 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
9456 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
9459 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
9461 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
9462 evaluated. If there are several ``match'' sub-conditions the values of the
9463 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
9465 *and~\{\{*<'cond1'>*\}\{*<'cond2'>*\}...\}*::
9466 cindex:[``and'' expansion condition]
9467 cindex:[expansion,``and'' of conditions]
9468 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
9469 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several ``match''
9470 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
9471 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
9472 parsed but not evaluated.
9480 cindex:[expansion variables, list of]
9481 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
9482 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
9483 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
9486 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc)]
9487 When a %match% expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
9488 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
9489 processing of the success string of the containing %if% expansion item. They
9490 may also be set externally by some other matching process which precedes the
9491 expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in Exim filter
9492 files include an %if% command with its own regular expression matching
9495 $acl_c0$ -- $acl_c9$::
9496 Values can be placed in these variables by the %set% modifier in an ACL. The
9497 values persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be used
9498 to pass information between ACLs and different invocations of the same ACL.
9499 When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the
9500 message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during
9501 subsequent delivery.
9503 $acl_m0$ -- $acl_m9$::
9504 Values can be placed in these variables by the %set% modifier in an ACL. They
9505 retain their values while a message is being received, but are reset
9506 afterwards. They are also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a
9507 TLS session. When a message is received, the values of these variables are
9508 saved with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
9509 during subsequent delivery.
9511 $acl_verify_message$::
9512 During the expansion of the %message% and %log_message% modifiers in an ACL
9513 statement after an address verification has failed, this variable contains the
9514 original failure message that will be overridden by the expanded string.
9517 This variable is set by means of the %address_data% option in routers. The
9518 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
9519 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
9520 the value from the first address is used. See chapter <<CHAProutergeneric>> for
9521 more details. *Note*: the contents of $address_data$ are visible in user filter
9524 If $address_data$ is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
9525 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
9526 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
9527 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
9528 of the verification, and in this case the final value of $address_data$ is
9529 from the child's routing.
9531 If $address_data$ is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
9532 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
9533 $sender_address_data$, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
9536 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
9537 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
9538 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
9541 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
9542 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
9543 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
9544 default configuration, if user %r2d2% has a _.forward_ file containing
9548 then when the ^address_file^ transport is running, $address_file$
9549 contains ``/home/r2d2/savemail''.
9551 cindex:[Sieve filter,value of $address_file$]
9552 For Sieve filters, the value may be ``inbox'' or a relative folder name. It is
9553 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
9554 to the relevant file.
9557 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
9558 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
9560 $authenticated_id$::
9561 cindex:[authentication,id]
9562 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
9563 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
9564 $authenticated_id$ (see chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>). For example, a user/password
9565 authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use in the
9566 routers. When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP
9567 connection), the value of $authenticated_id$ is the login name of the calling
9570 $authenticated_sender$::
9571 cindex:[sender,authenticated]
9572 cindex:[authentication,sender]
9573 cindex:[AUTH,on MAIL command]
9574 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
9575 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
9576 described in section <<SECTauthparamail>>. Unless the data is the string
9577 ``<>'', it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
9578 available during delivery in the $authenticated_sender$ variable. If the sender
9579 is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
9581 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
9582 value of $authenticated_sender$ is an address constructed from the login
9583 name of the calling process and $qualify_domain$.
9586 $authentication_failed$::
9587 cindex:[authentication,failure]
9588 This variable is set to ``1'' in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
9589 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to ``0''. This makes it
9590 possible to distinguish between ``did not try to authenticate''
9591 ($sender_host_authenticated$ is empty and $authentication_failed$ is set to
9592 ``0'') and ``tried to authenticate but failed'' ($sender_host_authenticated$ is
9593 empty and $authentication_failed$ is set to ``1''). Failure includes any
9594 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
9595 an undefined mechanism.
9598 cindex:[message body, line count]
9599 cindex:[body of message,line count]
9600 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
9601 number of lines in the message's body.
9604 cindex:[message body, binary zero count]
9605 cindex:[body of message,binary zero count]
9606 cindex:[binary zero,in message body]
9607 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
9608 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
9610 $bounce_recipient$::
9611 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
9612 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
9613 chapter <<CHAPemsgcust>>).
9615 $bounce_return_size_limit$::
9616 This contains the value set in the %bounce_return_size_limit% option, rounded
9617 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
9618 file is in use (see chapter <<CHAPemsgcust>>).
9621 cindex:[gid (group id),caller]
9622 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
9623 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
9624 $originator_gid$). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
9625 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
9628 cindex:[uid (user id),caller]
9629 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
9630 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
9631 $originator_uid$). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
9632 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
9635 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
9638 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
9639 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
9640 compilations of the same version of the program.
9642 $demime_errorlevel$::
9643 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
9644 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete %demime% condition. For
9645 details, see section <<SECTdemimecond>>.
9648 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
9649 content-scanning extension and the obsolete %demime% condition. For details,
9650 see section <<SECTdemimecond>>.
9654 cindex:[black list (DNS)]
9655 When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list,
9656 the list's domain name is put into this variable so that it can be included in
9657 the rejection message.
9660 When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list, the
9661 contents of any associated TXT record are placed in this variable.
9664 When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list,
9665 the IP address from the resource record is placed in this variable.
9666 If there are multiple records, all the addresses are included, comma-space
9670 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
9671 variable contains the domain. Global address rewriting happens when a message
9672 is received, so the value of $domain$ during routing and delivery is the
9673 value after rewriting. $domain$ is set during user filtering, but not during
9674 system filtering, because a message may have many recipients and the system
9675 filter is called just once.
9677 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
9678 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), $domain$ is set only if they all
9679 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
9680 at a time if the value of $domain$ is required at transport time -- this is
9681 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
9682 which local transports are run, see chapter <<CHAPenvironment>>.
9684 cindex:[%delay_warning_condition%]
9685 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
9686 set in $domain$ during the expansion of %delay_warning_condition%.
9688 The $domain$ variable is also used in some other circumstances:
9690 - When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, $domain$ contains the domain
9691 of the recipient address.
9692 *Note:* the domain of the sender address is in $sender_address_domain$
9693 at MAIL time and at RCPT time. $domain$ is not set for the MAIL
9696 - When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter <<CHAPrewrite>>), $domain$
9697 contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten; it can be
9698 used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to rewrite
9699 domains by file lookup.
9701 - With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
9702 $domain$ contains the subject domain. *Exception*: When a domain list in
9703 a %sender_domains% condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
9704 is in $sender_address_domain$ and not in $domain$. It works this way so
9705 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
9706 recipient domain (which is what is in $domain$ at this time).
9708 - cindex:[ETRN,value of $domain$]
9709 cindex:[%smtp_etrn_command%]
9710 When the %smtp_etrn_command% option is being expanded, $domain$ contains
9711 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section <<SECTETRN>>).
9715 When the %domains% option on a router matches a domain by
9716 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
9717 of the router as $domain_data$. In addition, if the driver routes the
9718 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
9719 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
9722 $domain_data$ is also set when the %domains% condition in an ACL matches a
9723 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
9724 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
9728 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
9731 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
9734 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
9737 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
9738 content-scanning extension and the obsolete %demime% condition. For details,
9739 see section <<SECTdemimecond>>.
9742 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is
9743 expansion syntax for inserting the message header line with the given name.
9744 Note that the name must be terminated by colon or white space, because it may
9745 contain a wide variety of characters.
9746 Note also that braces must 'not' be used.
9749 When the %check_local_user% option is set for a router, the user's home
9750 directory is placed in $home$ when the check succeeds. In particular, this
9751 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
9752 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
9753 by a setting on the transport itself.
9755 When running a filter test via the %-bf% option, $home$ is set to the value
9756 of the environment variable HOME.
9759 When the ^smtp^ transport is expanding its options for encryption using TLS,
9760 $host$ contains the name of the host to which it is connected. Likewise, when
9761 used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
9762 <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>), $host$ contains the name of the server to which the client
9765 cindex:[transport,filter]
9766 cindex:[filter,transport filter]
9767 When used in a transport filter (see chapter <<CHAPtransportgeneric>>) $host$
9768 refers to the host involved in the current connection. When a local transport
9769 is run as a result of a router that sets up a host list, $host$ contains the
9770 name of the first host.
9773 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever $host$ is set for
9774 a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
9775 when the %ignore_target_hosts% option is being processed.
9778 If a %hosts% condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
9779 of the lookup is made available in the $host_data$ variable. This
9780 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
9782 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
9783 message = $host_data
9786 $host_lookup_deferred$::
9787 cindex:[host name lookup, failure of]
9788 This variable normally contains ``0'', as does $host_lookup_failed$. When a
9789 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
9790 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
9791 variables is set to ``1''.
9794 - If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
9795 succeeded, but no records were found), $host_lookup_failed$ is set to ``1''.
9797 - If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
9798 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
9799 lookup), $host_lookup_deferred$ is set to ``1''.
9802 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
9803 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
9804 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
9805 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
9806 $host_lookup_failed$ is set to ``1''. Thus, being able to find a name from an
9807 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
9808 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
9809 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
9810 the result, the name is not accepted, and $host_lookup_deferred$ is set to
9811 ``1''. See also $sender_host_name$.
9813 $host_lookup_failed$::
9814 See $host_lookup_deferred$.
9818 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the %directory_file%
9819 option in the ^appendfile^ transport. The variable contains the inode number
9820 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
9821 a unique name for the file.
9823 $interface_address$::
9824 When a message is received over a TCP/IP connection, this variable contains the
9825 address of the local IP interface. See also the %-oMi% command line option.
9826 This variable can be used in ACLs and also, for example, to make the file name
9827 for a TLS certificate depend on which interface is being used.
9830 When a message is received over a TCP/IP connection, this variable contains the
9831 local port number. See also the %-oMi% command line option.
9832 This variable can be used in ACLs and also, for example, to make the file name
9833 for a TLS certificate depend on which port is being used.
9836 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
9837 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
9841 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 to that it
9842 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
9843 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
9846 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
9847 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
9848 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
9849 session), $local_part$ is not set.
9851 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
9852 $local_part$ during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
9853 $local_part$ is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
9854 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
9857 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
9858 value of $local_part$ during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
9859 any prefix or suffix are in $local_part_prefix$ and
9860 $local_part_suffix$, respectively.
9862 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
9863 result of aliasing or forwarding, $local_part$ is set to the local part of
9864 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see $address_file$ and
9867 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, $local_part$ contains the
9868 local part of the recipient address.
9870 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter <<CHAPrewrite>>),
9871 $local_part$ contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
9872 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
9874 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
9877 "abc:xyz"@test.example
9878 abc\:xyz@test.example
9880 the value of $local_part$ is
9884 If you use $local_part$ to create another address, you should always wrap it
9885 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a ^redirect^ router you could have:
9887 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
9889 *Note*: The value of $local_part$ is normally lower cased. If you want
9890 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
9891 %caseful_local_part% option (see chapter <<CHAProutergeneric>>).
9894 When the %local_parts% option on a router matches a local part by means of a
9895 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
9896 router as $local_part_data$. In addition, if the driver routes the address
9897 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
9898 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
9900 $local_part_data$ is also set when the %local_parts% condition in an ACL
9901 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
9902 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
9903 variable expands to nothing.
9905 $local_part_prefix$::
9906 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
9907 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
9908 variable, having been removed from $local_part$.
9910 $local_part_suffix$::
9911 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
9912 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
9913 variable, having been removed from $local_part$.
9916 This variable contains the text returned by the 'local_scan()' function when a
9917 message is received. See chapter <<CHAPlocalscan>> for more details.
9920 See $local_user_uid$.
9923 This variable and $local_user_gid$ are set to
9924 the uid and gid after the %check_local_user% router precondition succeeds.
9925 This means that their values are available for the remaining preconditions
9926 (%senders%, %require_files%, and %condition%), for the %address_data%
9927 expansion, and for any router-specific expansions. At all other times, the
9928 values in these variables are `(uid_t)(-1)` and `(gid_t)(-1)`,
9931 $localhost_number$::
9932 This contains the expanded value of the
9933 %localhost_number% option. The expansion happens after the main options have
9937 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
9938 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
9939 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
9940 the value of is -1. See also the %check_log_inodes% option.
9943 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
9944 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
9945 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
9946 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
9947 the space value is -1. See also the %check_log_space% option.
9950 $mailstore_basename$::
9951 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in
9952 ``mailstore'' format in the ^appendfile^ transport. During the expansion of the
9953 %mailstore_prefix%, %mailstore_suffix%, %message_prefix%, and
9954 %message_suffix% options, it contains the basename of the files that are being
9955 written, that is, the name without the ``.tmp'', ``.env'', or ``.msg'' suffix. At all
9956 other times, this variable is empty.
9959 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
9960 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
9961 when the ACL %malware% condition is true (see section <<SECTscanvirus>>).
9965 cindex:[message,age of]
9966 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to
9967 contain the number of seconds since the message was received. It does not
9968 change during a single delivery attempt.
9971 cindex:[body of message,expansion variable]
9972 cindex:[message body, in expansion]
9973 cindex:[binary zero,in message body]
9974 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's
9975 body while it is being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter
9976 files. The maximum number of characters of the body that are put into the
9977 variable is set by the %message_body_visible% configuration option; the
9978 default is 500. Newlines are converted into spaces to make it easier to search
9979 for phrases that might be split over a line break.
9980 Binary zeros are also converted into spaces.
9982 $message_body_end$::
9983 cindex:[body of message,expansion variable]
9984 cindex:[message body, in expansion]
9985 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
9986 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
9989 $message_body_size$::
9990 cindex:[body of message,size]
9991 cindex:[message body, size]
9992 When a message is being delivered, this variable
9993 contains the size of the body in bytes. The count starts from the character
9994 after the blank line that separates the body from the header. Newlines are
9995 included in the count. See also $message_size$, $body_linecount$, and
9999 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10000 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10001 lines are separated by newline characters.
10004 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10005 unique message id that is used by Exim to identify the message.
10006 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been
10007 successfully received.
10008 *Note*: This is 'not' the contents of the 'Message-ID:' header line; it
10009 is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
10010 `1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`.
10013 cindex:[size,of message]
10014 cindex:[message,size]
10015 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
10016 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
10017 message, but not those (such as 'Envelope-to:') that are added to individual
10018 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
10019 expansion of the %maildir_tag% option in the ^appendfile^ transport while
10020 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of $message_size$ is the
10021 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
10022 $message_body_size$, $body_linecount$, and $body_zerocount$.
10024 cindex:[RCPT,value of $message_size$]
10025 While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP RCPT command, $message_size$
10026 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
10027 value may not, of course, be truthful.
10030 A number of variables whose names start with $mime$ are
10031 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
10032 details, see section <<SECTscanmimepart>>.
10036 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
10037 of the %add% command in filter files.
10039 $original_domain$::
10040 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery,
10041 this contains the same value as $domain$. However, if a ``child'' address (for
10042 example, generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed,
10043 this variable contains the domain of the original address. This differs from
10044 $parent_domain$ only when there is more than one level of aliasing or
10045 forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a single transport
10046 run, $original_domain$ is not set.
10048 If new an address is created by means of a %deliver% command in a system
10049 filter, it is set up with an artificial ``parent'' address. This has the local
10050 part 'system-filter' and the default qualify domain.
10052 $original_local_part$::
10053 When a top-level address is being processed for
10054 delivery, this contains the same value as $local_part$, unless a prefix or
10055 suffix was removed from the local part, because $original_local_part$
10056 always contains the full local part. When a ``child'' address (for example,
10057 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
10058 variable contains the full local part of the original address.
10060 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
10061 case-insensitively, the value in $original_local_part$ is in lower case.
10062 This variable differs from $parent_local_part$ only when there is more than
10063 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
10064 delivered in a single transport run, $original_local_part$ is not set.
10066 If new an address is created by means of a %deliver% command in a system
10067 filter, it is set up with an artificial ``parent'' address. This has the local
10068 part 'system-filter' and the default qualify domain.
10072 cindex:[gid (group id),of originating user]
10073 cindex:[sender,gid]
10074 The value of $caller_gid$ that was set when the message
10075 was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the gid of
10076 the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally
10077 the gid of the Exim user.
10080 cindex:[uid (user id),of originating user]
10081 cindex:[sender,uid]
10082 The value of $caller_uid$ that was set when the message
10083 was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the uid of
10084 the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally
10085 the uid of the Exim user.
10088 This variable is similar to $original_domain$ (see
10089 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
10091 $parent_local_part$::
10092 This variable is similar to $original_local_part$
10093 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
10096 cindex:[pid (process id),of current process]
10097 This variable contains the current process id.
10100 cindex:[filter,transport filter]
10101 cindex:[transport,filter]
10102 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here
10103 because the string ``\$pipe_addresses'' is handled specially in the command
10104 specification for the ^pipe^ transport (chapter <<CHAPpipetransport>>) and in
10105 transport filters (described under %transport_filter% in chapter
10106 <<CHAPtransportgeneric>>). It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and
10107 provokes an ``unknown variable'' error if encountered.
10109 $primary_hostname$::
10110 The value set in the configuration file, or read by the
10111 'uname()' function. If 'uname()' returns a single-component name, Exim
10112 calls 'gethostbyname()' (or 'getipnodebyname()' where available) in an
10113 attempt to acquire a fully qualified host name.
10114 See also $smtp_active_hostname$.
10117 The value set for this option in the configuration file.
10119 $qualify_recipient$::
10120 The value set for this option in the configuration file,
10121 or if not set, the value of $qualify_domain$.
10124 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
10125 contains the number of RCPT commands received for the current message. If
10126 this variable is used in a RCPT ACL, its value includes the current
10129 $rcpt_defer_count$::
10130 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
10131 contains the number of RCPT commands in the current message that have
10132 previously been rejected with a temporary (4##'xx') response.
10134 $rcpt_fail_count$::
10135 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
10136 contains the number of RCPT commands in the current message that have
10137 previously been rejected with a permanent (5##'xx') response.
10140 This variable contains the number of 'Received:' header
10141 lines in the message, including the one added by Exim (so its value is always
10142 greater than zero). It is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and
10143 while routing and delivering.
10146 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming
10147 message, this variable contains that address when the 'Received:' header line
10149 The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before the
10150 'local_scan()' function is run.
10152 $received_protocol$::
10153 When a message is being processed, this variable
10154 contains the name of the protocol by which it was received.
10155 Most of the names used by Exim are defined by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They
10156 start with ``smtp'' (the client used HELO) or ``esmtp'' (the client used
10157 EHLO). This can be followed by ``s'' for secure (encrypted) and/or ``a'' for
10158 authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol is set to ``esmtpsa'', the
10159 message was received over an encrypted SMTP connection and the client was
10160 successfully authenticated.
10162 Exim uses the protocol name ``smtps'' for the case when encryption is
10163 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
10164 %tls_on_connect_ports%), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
10165 encrypted SMTP session. The name ``smtps'' is also used for the rare situation
10166 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
10167 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
10169 The %-oMr% option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
10170 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
10171 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
10175 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in
10176 an ACL %recipients% condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
10177 value remains set until the next %recipients% test. Thus, you can do things
10181 `require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`
10182 `deny `'some further test involving' `\$recipient_data`
10185 *Warning*: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
10186 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
10187 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
10188 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
10190 $recipient_verify_failure$::
10191 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails,
10192 this variable contains information about the failure. It is set to one of the
10196 - ``qualify'': The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
10197 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
10199 - ``route'': Routing failed.
10201 - ``mail'': Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
10202 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
10205 - ``recipient'': The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
10207 - ``postmaster'': The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
10210 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
10211 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
10215 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a
10216 message. A comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
10217 However, the variable is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc
10218 recipients in unprivileged users' filter files. You can use $recipients$ only
10219 in these two cases:
10221 . In a system filter file.
10223 . In the ACLs associated with the DATA command, that is, the ACLs defined by
10224 %acl_smtp_predata% and %acl_smtp_data%.
10227 $recipients_count$::
10228 When a message is being processed, this variable
10229 contains the number of envelope recipients that came with the message.
10230 Duplicates are not excluded from the count. While a message is being received
10231 over SMTP, the number increases for each accepted recipient. It can be
10232 referenced in an ACL.
10235 When a message is being processed, this variable contains
10236 the contents of the 'Reply-To:' header line if one exists
10237 and it is not empty,
10238 or otherwise the contents of the 'From:' header line.
10241 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path --
10242 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
10243 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, $return_path$ has the
10244 same value as $sender_address$, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
10245 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
10246 for bounce messages, $return_path$ subsequently contains the new bounce
10247 address, whereas $sender_address$ always contains the original sender address
10248 that was received with the message. In other words, $sender_address$ contains
10249 the incoming envelope sender, and $return_path$ contains the outgoing envelope
10252 $return_size_limit$::
10253 This is an obsolete name for $bounce_return_size_limit$.
10256 cindex:[return code,from %run% expansion]
10257 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
10258 %\$\{run...\}% expansion item. *Warning*: In a router or transport, you cannot
10259 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
10260 pre-conditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
10261 reliably expect to set $runrc$ by the expansion of one option, and use it in
10265 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
10266 local host, what happens is controlled by the
10267 cindex:[%self% option,value of host name]
10268 %self% generic router option. One of its values causes the address to be passed
10269 to another router. When this happens, $self_hostname$ is set to the name of
10270 the local host that the original router encountered. In other circumstances its
10274 When a message is being processed, this variable contains
10275 the sender's address that was received in the message's envelope. For bounce
10276 messages, the value of this variable is the empty string.
10277 See also $return_path$.
10279 $sender_address_data$::
10280 If $address_data$ is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10281 sender address, the final value is preserved in $sender_address_data$, to
10282 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
10283 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
10284 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
10287 $sender_address_domain$::
10288 The domain portion of $sender_address$.
10290 $sender_address_local_part$::
10291 The local part portion of $sender_address$.
10294 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL %senders% condition or in
10295 a router %senders% option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value
10296 remains set until the next %senders% test. Thus, you can do things like this:
10299 `require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`
10300 `deny `'some further test involving' `\$sender_data`
10303 *Warning*: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
10304 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
10305 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
10306 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
10308 $sender_fullhost$::
10309 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
10310 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
10311 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
10312 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
10313 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
10314 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
10315 %host_lookup% option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
10316 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
10317 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
10318 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
10319 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
10321 $sender_helo_name$::
10322 When a message is received from a remote host that has
10323 issued a HELO or EHLO command, the argument of that command is placed
10324 in this variable. It is also set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message
10325 is received using SMTP locally via the %-bs% or %-bS% options.
10327 $sender_host_address$::
10328 When a message is received from a remote host, this
10329 variable contains that host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is
10332 $sender_host_authenticated$::
10333 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
10334 driver which successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
10335 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication.
10337 $sender_host_name$::
10338 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
10339 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
10340 other means, this variable is empty.
10342 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
10343 $sender_host_name$ triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
10344 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
10345 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
10346 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
10347 $sender_host_name$ remains empty, and $host_lookup_failed$ is set to ``1''.
10349 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
10350 DNS timeout), $host_lookup_deferred$ is set to ``1'', and
10351 $host_lookup_failed$ remains set to ``0''.
10353 Once $host_lookup_failed$ is set to ``1'', Exim does not try to look up the
10354 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to $sender_host_name$
10355 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if $sender_host_deferred$
10358 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
10359 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
10360 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
10361 following are true:
10363 - A string containing $sender_host_name$ is expanded.
10365 - The calling host matches the list in %host_lookup%. In the default
10366 configuration, this option is set to \*, so it must be changed if lookups are
10367 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for %host_lookup% is unset.)
10369 - Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
10370 that require this are described in sections <<SECThoslispatnam>> and
10371 <<SECThoslispatnamsk>>.
10373 - The calling host matches %helo_try_verify_hosts% or %helo_verify_hosts%.
10374 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
10375 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
10377 - The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
10378 domains in %helo_lookup_domains%. The default value of this option is
10381 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
10384 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
10385 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
10388 $sender_host_port$::
10389 When a message is received from a remote host, this
10390 variable contains the port number that was used on the remote host.
10393 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
10394 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
10395 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
10399 This is provided specifically for use in 'Received:' headers. It starts with
10400 either the verified host name (as obtained from a
10401 cindex:[DNS,reverse lookup]
10402 cindex:[reverse DNS lookup]
10403 reverse DNS lookup) or, if there is no verified host name, the IP address in
10404 square brackets. After that there may be text in parentheses. When the first
10405 item is a verified host name, the first thing in the parentheses is the IP
10406 address in square brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if port
10407 logging is enabled. When the first item is an IP address, the port is recorded
10408 as ``port='xxxx'##'' inside the parentheses.
10410 There may also be items of the form ``helo='xxxx'##'' if HELO or EHLO
10411 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
10412 address, and ``ident='xxxx'##'' if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If all
10413 three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted into
10414 the string, to improve the formatting of the 'Received:' header.
10416 $sender_verify_failure$::
10417 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
10418 about the failure. The details are the same as for $recipient_verify_failure$.
10420 $smtp_active_hostname$::
10421 During an SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active host
10422 name, as specified by the %smtp_active_hostname% option. The value of
10423 $smtp_active_hostname$ is saved with any message that is received, so its value
10424 can be consulted during routing and delivery.
10427 $smtp_command_argument$::
10428 cindex:[AUTH,argument]
10429 cindex:[EXPN,argument]
10430 cindex:[ETRN,argument]
10431 cindex:[VRFY,argument]
10432 While an ACL is running to check an AUTH, EHLO, EXPN, ETRN, HELO, or VRFY
10433 command, this variable contains the argument for the SMTP command.
10436 These variables are copies of the values of the $n0$ -- $n9$ accumulators that
10437 were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system filter
10438 file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For example, a
10439 system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a message is
10443 A number of variables whose names start with $spam$ are available when Exim is
10444 compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
10445 <<SECTscanspamass>>.
10448 $spool_directory$::
10449 The name of Exim's spool directory.
10452 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
10453 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
10454 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
10455 is -1. See also the %check_spool_inodes% option.
10458 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
10459 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
10460 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
10461 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
10462 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
10463 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
10465 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
10467 See also the %check_spool_space% option.
10471 This variable is set only during the processing of the %foranyaddress% command
10472 in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that command.
10474 $tls_certificate_verified$::
10475 This variable is set to ``1'' if a TLS certificate was verified when the message
10476 was received, and ``0'' otherwise.
10479 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
10480 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
10481 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
10482 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. See chapter
10483 <<CHAPTLS>> for details of TLS support.
10486 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
10487 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
10488 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
10489 $tls_peerdn$ during subsequent processing.
10492 The time of day and date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox files,
10493 for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
10496 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
10499 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
10500 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
10501 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
10502 values for those that are behind (west).
10505 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
10506 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
10509 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
10510 is used for datestamping log files when %log_file_path% contains the `%D`
10514 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
10518 This variable contains the UTC date and time in ``Zulu'' format, as specified by
10519 ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
10523 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
10524 or external command, as described above.
10527 The version number of Exim.
10529 $warn_message_delay$::
10530 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
10531 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section <<SECTcustwarn>>.
10533 $warn_message_recipients$::
10534 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
10535 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section <<SECTcustwarn>>.
10539 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
10540 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
10545 cindex:[Perl,calling from Exim]
10546 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
10547 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
10548 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
10549 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
10554 in your _Local/Makefile_ and then build Exim in the normal way.
10557 Setting up so Perl can be used
10558 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10559 cindex:[%perl_startup%]
10560 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
10561 %perl_startup% and an expansion string operator %\$\{perl ...\}%. If there is
10562 no %perl_startup% option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
10563 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
10564 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a %perl_startup%
10565 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
10566 a newly created Perl interpreter.
10568 The value of %perl_startup% is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
10569 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
10570 should usually be something like
10572 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
10574 where _/etc/exim.pl_ is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
10575 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
10576 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
10577 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
10578 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
10579 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
10580 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
10581 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
10584 - cindex:[%perl_at_start%]
10585 Setting %perl_at_start% (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
10586 a startup when Exim is entered.
10588 - The command line option %-ps% also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
10589 overriding the setting of %perl_at_start%.
10591 There is also a command line option %-pd% (for delay) which suppresses the
10592 initial startup, even if %perl_at_start% is set.
10595 Calling Perl subroutines
10596 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10597 When the configuration file includes a %perl_startup% option you can make use
10598 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
10599 by the %perl_startup% code. The operator is used in any of the following
10603 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
10604 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
10606 which calls the subroutine %foo% with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
10607 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
10608 with an error message of the form
10610 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
10612 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
10613 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
10614 return value is 'undef', the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
10615 an explicit ``fail'' on an %\$\{if ...\}% or %\$\{lookup...\}% item. If the
10616 subroutine aborts by obeying Perl's %die% function, the expansion fails with
10617 the error message that was passed to %die%.
10620 Calling Exim functions from Perl
10621 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10622 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function 'Exim::expand_string'
10623 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
10626 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
10628 makes the current Exim $local_part$ available in the Perl variable $lp$.
10629 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
10630 $local_part$ being interpolated as a Perl variable.
10632 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a ``fail'' item, the result of
10633 'Exim::expand_string' is %undef%. If there is a syntax error in the
10634 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
10635 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if %die% were used.
10637 cindex:[debugging,from embedded Perl]
10638 cindex:[log,writing from embedded Perl]
10639 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
10640 'Exim::debug_write(<'string'>)' writes the string to the standard error
10641 stream if Exim's debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you
10642 must supply it. 'Exim::log_write(<'string'>)' writes the string to Exim's
10643 main log, adding a leading timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a
10644 terminating newline.
10647 Use of standard output and error by Perl
10648 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10649 cindex:[Perl,standard output and error]
10650 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
10651 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
10652 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
10653 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
10654 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
10655 error streams are connected to _/dev/null_ in the daemon. The chaos is
10656 avoided, but the output is lost.
10658 cindex:[Perl,use of %warn%]
10659 The Perl %warn% statement writes to the standard error stream by default. Calls
10660 to %warn% may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which you have
10661 no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for output
10662 from the %warn% statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can change
10663 this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code. For
10664 example, to discard %warn% output completely, you need this:
10666 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
10668 Whenever a %warn% is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
10669 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
10670 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the %warn% message is passed
10671 as the first subroutine argument.
10675 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
10676 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
10679 [titleabbrev="Starting the daemon"]
10680 Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces
10681 -----------------------------------------------------
10682 cindex:[daemon,starting]
10683 cindex:[interface,listening]
10684 cindex:[network interface]
10685 cindex:[interface,network]
10686 cindex:[IP address,for listening]
10687 cindex:[daemon,listening IP addresses]
10688 cindex:[TCP/IP,setting listening interfaces]
10689 cindex:[TCP/IP,setting listening ports]
10690 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
10691 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
10692 or more ``logical'' interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
10693 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
10694 In addition, TCP/IP software supports ``loopback'' interfaces (127.0.0.1 in IPv4
10695 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
10696 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
10698 . When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
10699 and ports to listen on.
10701 . When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
10702 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
10703 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
10704 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
10705 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
10706 local host. Unless the %self% router option or the %allow_localhost%
10707 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
10708 as an error situation.
10710 . When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
10711 for the outgoing connection.
10714 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
10715 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
10716 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
10717 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
10718 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
10720 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
10721 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
10722 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
10723 chapter describes how they operate.
10725 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
10726 actually used are set in $interface_address$ and $interface_port$.
10730 Starting a listening daemon
10731 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10732 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the %-bd% command line
10733 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
10736 - %daemon_smtp_ports% contains a list of default ports. (For backward
10737 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
10739 - %local_interfaces% contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
10740 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
10742 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
10743 described in section <<SECTlistconstruct>>. When IPv6 addresses are involved, it
10744 is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
10745 colons. For example:
10748 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
10751 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
10754 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
10755 in %local_interfaces%:
10757 . The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
10758 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
10761 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
10762 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
10765 . The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
10766 with a colon separator, for example:
10769 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
10770 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
10773 When a port is not specified, the value of %daemon_smtp_ports% is used. The
10774 default setting contains just one port:
10776 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
10778 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
10779 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
10780 %daemon_smtp_ports% can be identified either by name (defined in
10781 _/etc/services_) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
10782 IP addresses in %local_interfaces%, only numbers (not names) can be used.
10786 Special IP listening addresses
10787 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10788 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
10789 as ``all IPv4 interfaces'' and ``all IPv6 interfaces'', respectively. In each
10790 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to ``listen on all IPv##'x' interfaces''
10791 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
10792 default value of %local_interfaces% is
10794 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
10796 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
10798 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10800 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
10804 Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports
10805 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10806 The %-oX% command line option can be used to override the values of
10807 %daemon_smtp_ports% and/or %local_interfaces% for a particular daemon
10808 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the %-D%
10809 option. However, %-oX% can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
10810 the runtime configuration by %-D% is allowed only when the caller is root or
10813 The value of %-oX% is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
10814 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
10815 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
10816 %daemon_smtp_ports% is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
10817 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of %local_interfaces% is
10818 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
10822 overrides %daemon_smtp_ports%, but leaves %local_interfaces% unchanged,
10825 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
10827 overrides %local_interfaces%, leaving %daemon_smtp_ports% unchanged.
10828 (However, since %local_interfaces% now contains no items without ports, the
10829 value of %daemon_smtp_ports% is no longer relevant in this example.)
10834 Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol
10835 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10836 cindex:[ssmtp protocol]
10837 cindex:[smtps protocol]
10838 cindex:[SMTP,ssmtp protocol]
10839 cindex:[SMTP,smtps protocol]
10840 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
10841 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
10842 still use this protocol. If the %tls_on_connect_ports% option is set to a
10843 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
10844 common use of this option is expected to be
10846 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
10848 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
10849 a command line option %-tls-on-connect%, which forces all ports to behave in
10850 this way when a daemon is started.
10852 *Warning*: Setting %tls_on_connect_ports% does not of itself cause the
10853 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
10854 %daemon_smtp_ports%, %local_interfaces%, or the %-oX% option. (This is
10855 because %tls_on_connect_ports% applies to %inetd% connections as well as to
10856 connections via the daemon.)
10861 IPv6 address scopes
10862 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10863 IPv6 addresses have ``scopes'', and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
10864 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
10865 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
10866 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
10867 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
10868 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
10870 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
10872 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
10873 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls 'getaddrinfo()'
10874 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
10875 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
10876 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
10877 'getaddrinfo()'. If
10879 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
10881 is set in _Local/Makefile_ (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
10882 Exim uses 'inet_pton()' to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
10883 instead of 'getaddrinfo()'. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
10884 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
10885 'getaddrinfo()' -- recognizing scoped addresses -- is lost.
10889 Examples of starting a listening daemon
10890 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10891 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
10893 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
10894 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10896 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
10897 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
10898 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
10899 read the comments in the _daemon.c_ source file.)
10901 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
10903 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
10905 (leaving %local_interfaces% at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
10908 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
10909 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
10912 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
10913 IPv4 loopback address only:
10915 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
10917 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
10919 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
10921 *Warning*: such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
10925 [[SECTreclocipadd]]
10926 Recognising the local host
10927 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10928 The %local_interfaces% option is also used when Exim needs to determine
10929 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
10930 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
10933 For this usage, port numbers in %local_interfaces% are ignored. If either of
10934 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
10935 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
10936 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
10938 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
10939 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
10940 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
10941 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
10942 %extra_local_interfaces% to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
10943 ``all'' wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
10944 used for listening. Consider this example:
10947 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
10949 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
10951 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10954 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
10955 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
10958 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
10959 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
10960 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
10961 these cases can be handled by setting the %hosts_treat_as_local% option.
10962 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
10963 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
10964 host if its name matches %hosts_treat_as_local%, or if any of its IP
10965 addresses match %local_interfaces% or %extra_local_interfaces%.
10969 Delivering to a remote host
10970 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10971 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
10972 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
10973 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
10974 %interface% option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
10975 description of the smtp transport in chapter <<CHAPsmtptrans>> for more details.
10980 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
10981 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
10986 cindex:[configuration file,main section]
10987 cindex:[main configuration]
10988 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
10990 - Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
10991 <<SECTmacrodefs>> for details of macro processing.
10993 - Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words ``domainlist'',
10994 ``hostlist'', ``addresslist'', or ``localpartlist''. Their use is described in
10995 section <<SECTnamedlists>>.
10997 - Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
10998 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
10999 ``hide'', the %-bP% command line option displays its value to admin users only.
11000 See section <<SECTcos>> for a description of the syntax of these option settings.
11002 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
11003 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
11004 in alphabetical order in section <<SECTalomo>> below. However, because there are
11005 now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as an
11006 aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
11007 listed in more than one group.
11012 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11013 %bi_command% to run for %-bi% command line option
11014 %keep_malformed% for broken files -- should not happen
11015 %localhost_number% for unique message ids in clusters
11016 %message_body_visible% how much to show in $message_body$
11017 %mua_wrapper% run in ``MUA wrapper'' mode
11018 %print_topbitchars% top-bit characters are printing
11019 %timezone% force time zone
11020 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11026 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11027 %exim_group% override compiled-in value
11028 %exim_path% override compiled-in value
11029 %exim_user% override compiled-in value
11030 %primary_hostname% default from 'uname()'
11031 %split_spool_directory% use multiple directories
11032 %spool_directory% override compiled-in value
11033 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11040 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11041 %admin_groups% groups that are Exim admin users
11042 %deliver_drop_privilege% drop root for delivery processes
11043 %local_from_check% insert 'Sender:' if necessary
11044 %local_from_prefix% for testing 'From:' for local sender
11045 %local_from_suffix% for testing 'From:' for local sender
11046 %local_sender_retain% keep 'Sender:' from untrusted user
11047 %never_users% do not run deliveries as these
11048 %prod_requires_admin% forced delivery requires admin user
11049 %queue_list_requires_admin% queue listing requires admin user
11050 %trusted_groups% groups that are trusted
11051 %trusted_users% users that are trusted
11052 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11059 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11060 %hosts_connection_nolog% exemption from connect logging
11061 %log_file_path% override compiled-in value
11062 %log_selector% set/unset optional logging
11063 %log_timezone% add timezone to log lines
11064 %message_logs% create per-message logs
11065 %preserve_message_logs% after message completion
11066 %process_log_path% for SIGUSR1 and 'exiwhat'
11067 %syslog_duplication% controls duplicate log lines on syslog
11068 %syslog_facility% set syslog ``facility'' field
11069 %syslog_processname% set syslog ``ident'' field
11070 %syslog_timestamp% timestamp syslog lines
11071 %write_rejectlog% control use of message log
11072 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11079 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11080 %auto_thaw% sets time for retrying frozen messages
11081 %freeze_tell% send message when freezing
11082 %move_frozen_messages% to another directory
11083 %timeout_frozen_after% keep frozen messages only so long
11084 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11091 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11092 %ldap_default_servers% used if no server in query
11093 %ldap_version% set protocol version
11094 %lookup_open_max% lookup files held open
11095 %mysql_servers% as it says
11096 %oracle_servers% as it says
11097 %pgsql_servers% as it says
11098 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11105 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11106 %message_id_header_domain% used to build 'Message-ID:' header
11107 %message_id_header_text% ditto
11108 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11112 Embedded Perl Startup
11113 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11115 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11116 %perl_at_start% always start the interpreter
11117 %perl_startup% code to obey when starting Perl
11118 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11125 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11126 %daemon_smtp_ports% default ports
11127 %extra_local_interfaces% not necessarily listened on
11128 %local_interfaces% on which to listen, with optional ports
11129 %pid_file_path% override compiled-in value
11130 %queue_run_max% maximum simultaneous queue runners
11131 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11138 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11139 %check_log_inodes% before accepting a message
11140 %check_log_space% before accepting a message
11141 %check_spool_inodes% before accepting a message
11142 %check_spool_space% before accepting a message
11143 %deliver_queue_load_max% no queue deliveries if load high
11144 %queue_only_load% queue incoming if load high
11145 %queue_run_max% maximum simultaneous queue runners
11146 %remote_max_parallel% parallel SMTP delivery per message
11147 %smtp_accept_max% simultaneous incoming connections
11148 %smtp_accept_max_nommail% non-mail commands
11149 %smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts% hosts to which the limit applies
11150 %smtp_accept_max_per_connection% messages per connection
11151 %smtp_accept_max_per_host% connections from one host
11152 %smtp_accept_queue% queue mail if more connections
11153 %smtp_accept_queue_per_connection% queue if more messages per connection
11154 %smtp_accept_reserve% only reserve hosts if more connections
11155 %smtp_check_spool_space% from SIZE on MAIL command
11156 %smtp_connect_backlog% passed to TCP/IP stack
11157 %smtp_load_reserve% SMTP from reserved hosts if load high
11158 %smtp_reserve_hosts% these are the reserve hosts
11159 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11166 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11167 %acl_not_smtp% set ACL for non-SMTP messages
11168 %acl_smtp_auth% set ACL for AUTH
11169 %acl_smtp_connect% set ACL for connection
11170 %acl_smtp_data% set ACL for DATA
11171 %acl_smtp_etrn% set ACL for ETRN
11172 %acl_smtp_expn% set ACL for EXPN
11173 %acl_smtp_helo% set ACL for EHLO or HELO
11174 %acl_smtp_mail% set ACL for MAIL
11175 %acl_smtp_mailauth% set ACL for AUTH on MAIL command
11176 %acl_smtp_mime% set ACL for MIME parts
11177 %acl_smtp_predata% set ACL for start of data
11178 %acl_smtp_quit% set ACL for QUIT
11179 %acl_smtp_rcpt% set ACL for RCPT
11180 %acl_smtp_starttls% set ACL for STARTTLS
11181 %acl_smtp_vrfy% set ACL for VRFY
11182 %av_scanner% specify virus scanner
11183 %header_maxsize% total size of message header
11184 %header_line_maxsize% individual header line limit
11185 %helo_accept_junk_hosts% allow syntactic junk from these hosts
11186 %helo_allow_chars% allow illegal chars in HELO names
11187 %helo_lookup_domains% lookup hostname for these HELO names
11188 %helo_try_verify_hosts% HELO soft-checked for these hosts
11189 %helo_verify_hosts% HELO hard-checked for these hosts
11190 %host_lookup% host name looked up for these hosts
11191 %host_lookup_order% order of DNS and local name lookups
11192 %host_reject_connection% reject connection from these hosts
11193 %hosts_treat_as_local% useful in some cluster configurations
11194 %local_scan_timeout% timeout for 'local_scan()'
11195 %message_size_limit% for all messages
11196 %percent_hack_domains% recognize %-hack for these domains
11197 %spamd_address% set interface to SpamAssassin
11198 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11205 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11206 %callout_domain_negative_expire% timeout for negative domain cache item
11207 %callout_domain_positive_expire% timeout for positive domain cache item
11208 %callout_negative_expire% timeout for negative address cache item
11209 %callout_positive_expire% timeout for positive address cache item
11210 %callout_random_local_part% string to use for ``random'' testing
11211 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11218 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11219 %tls_advertise_hosts% advertise TLS to these hosts
11220 %tls_certificate% location of server certificate
11221 %tls_crl% certificate revocation list
11222 %tls_dhparam% DH parameters for server
11223 %tls_on_connect_ports% specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports
11224 %tls_privatekey% location of server private key
11225 %tls_remember_esmtp% don't reset after starting TLS
11226 %tls_require_ciphers% specify acceptable cipers
11227 %tls_try_verify_hosts% try to verify client certificate
11228 %tls_verify_certificates% expected client certificates
11229 %tls_verify_hosts% insist on client certificate verify
11230 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11234 Local user handling
11235 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11237 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11238 %finduser_retries% useful in NIS environments
11239 %gecos_name% used when creating 'Sender:'
11240 %gecos_pattern% ditto
11241 %max_username_length% for systems that truncate
11242 %unknown_login% used when no login name found
11243 %unknown_username% ditto
11244 %uucp_from_pattern% for recognizing ``From '' lines
11245 %uucp_from_sender% ditto
11246 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11250 All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)
11251 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11253 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11254 %header_maxsize% total size of message header
11255 %header_line_maxsize% individual header line limit
11256 %message_size_limit% applies to all messages
11257 %percent_hack_domains% recognize %-hack for these domains
11258 %received_header_text% expanded to make 'Received:'
11259 %received_headers_max% for mail loop detection
11260 %recipients_max% limit per message
11261 %recipients_max_reject% permanently reject excess
11262 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11267 Non-SMTP incoming messages
11268 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11270 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11271 %receive_timeout% for non-SMTP messages
11272 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11278 Incoming SMTP messages
11279 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11280 See also the 'Policy controls' section above.
11283 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11284 %host_lookup% host name looked up for these hosts
11285 %host_lookup_order% order of DNS and local name lookups
11286 %recipient_unqualified_hosts% may send unqualified recipients
11287 %rfc1413_hosts% make ident calls to these hosts
11288 %rfc1413_query_timeout% zero disables ident calls
11289 %sender_unqualified_hosts% may send unqualified senders
11290 %smtp_accept_keepalive% some TCP/IP magic
11291 %smtp_accept_max% simultaneous incoming connections
11292 %smtp_accept_max_nommail% non-mail commands
11293 %smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts% hosts to which the limit applies
11294 %smtp_accept_max_per_connection% messages per connection
11295 %smtp_accept_max_per_host% connections from one host
11296 %smtp_accept_queue% queue mail if more connections
11297 %smtp_accept_queue_per_connection% queue if more messages per connection
11298 %smtp_accept_reserve% only reserve hosts if more connections
11299 %smtp_active_hostname% host name to use in messages
11300 %smtp_banner% text for welcome banner
11301 %smtp_check_spool_space% from SIZE on MAIL command
11302 %smtp_connect_backlog% passed to TCP/IP stack
11303 %smtp_enforce_sync% of SMTP command/responses
11304 %smtp_etrn_command% what to run for ETRN
11305 %smtp_etrn_serialize% only one at once
11306 %smtp_load_reserve% only reserve hosts if this load
11307 %smtp_max_unknown_commands% before dropping connection
11308 %smtp_ratelimit_hosts% apply ratelimiting to these hosts
11309 %smtp_ratelimit_mail% ratelimit for MAIL commands
11310 %smtp_ratelimit_rcpt% ratelimit for RCPT commands
11311 %smtp_receive_timeout% per command or data line
11312 %smtp_reserve_hosts% these are the reserve hosts
11313 %smtp_return_error_details% give detail on rejections
11314 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11321 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11322 %accept_8bitmime% advertise 8BITMIME
11323 %auth_advertise_hosts% advertise AUTH to these hosts
11324 %ignore_fromline_hosts% allow ``From '' from these hosts
11325 %ignore_fromline_local% allow ``From '' from local SMTP
11326 %pipelining_advertise_hosts% advertise pipelining to these hosts
11327 %tls_advertise_hosts% advertise TLS to these hosts
11328 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11332 Processing messages
11333 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11335 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11336 %allow_domain_literals% recognize domain literal syntax
11337 %allow_mx_to_ip% allow MX to point to IP address
11338 %allow_utf8_domains% in addresses
11339 %delivery_date_remove% from incoming messages
11340 %envelope_to_remote% from incoming messages
11341 %extract_addresses_remove_arguments%affects %-t% processing
11342 %headers_charset% default for translations
11343 %qualify_domain% default for senders
11344 %qualify_recipient% default for recipients
11345 %return_path_remove% from incoming messages
11346 %strip_excess_angle_brackets% in addresses
11347 %strip_trailing_dot% at end of addresses
11348 %untrusted_set_sender% untrusted can set envelope sender
11349 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11356 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11357 %system_filter% locate system filter
11358 %system_filter_directory_transport% transport for delivery to a directory
11359 %system_filter_file_transport% transport for delivery to a file
11360 %system_filter_group% group for filter running
11361 %system_filter_pipe_transport% transport for delivery to a pipe
11362 %system_filter_reply_transport% transport for autoreply delivery
11363 %system_filter_user% user for filter running
11364 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11368 Routing and delivery
11369 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11371 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11372 %dns_again_means_nonexist% for broken domains
11373 %dns_check_names_pattern% pre-DNS syntax check
11374 %dns_ipv4_lookup% only v4 lookup for these domains
11375 %dns_retrans% parameter for resolver
11376 %dns_retry% parameter for resolver
11377 %hold_domains% hold delivery for these domains
11378 %local_interfaces% for routing checks
11379 %queue_domains% no immediate delivery for these
11380 %queue_only% no immediate delivery at all
11381 %queue_only_file% no immediate deliveryif file exists
11382 %queue_only_load% no immediate delivery if load is high
11383 %queue_only_override% allow command line to override
11384 %queue_run_in_order% order of arrival
11385 %queue_run_max% of simultaneous queue runners
11386 %queue_smtp_domains% no immediate SMTP delivery for these
11387 %remote_max_parallel% parallel SMTP delivery per message
11388 %remote_sort_domains% order of remote deliveries
11389 %retry_data_expire% timeout for retry data
11390 %retry_interval_max% safety net for retry rules
11391 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11395 Bounce and warning messages
11396 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11398 `-----------------------------------`-------------------------------------
11399 %bounce_message_file% content of bounce
11400 %bounce_message_text% content of bounce
11401 %bounce_return_body% include body if returning message
11402 %bounce_return_message% include original message in bounce
11403 %bounce_return_size_limit% limit on returned message
11404 %bounce_sender_authentication% send authenticated sender with bounce
11405 %errors_copy% copy bounce messages
11406 %errors_reply_to% 'Reply-to:' in bounces
11407 %delay_warning% time schedule
11408 %delay_warning_condition% condition for warning messages
11409 %ignore_bounce_errors_after% discard undeliverable bounces
11410 %warn_message_file% content of warning message
11411 --------------------------------------------------------------------------
11416 Alphabetical list of main options
11417 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11418 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with !!.
11420 oindex:[%accept_8bitmime%]
11422 %accept_8bitmime%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
11426 cindex:[8-bit characters]
11427 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
11428 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
11429 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
11430 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
11431 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
11433 oindex:[%acl_not_smtp%]
11435 %acl_not_smtp%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11438 cindex:[{ACL},for non-SMTP messages]
11439 cindex:[non-SMTP messages, ACL for]
11440 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message is on the point
11441 of being accepted. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11443 oindex:[%acl_smtp_auth%]
11445 %acl_smtp_auth%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11448 cindex:[{ACL},setting up for SMTP commands]
11449 cindex:[AUTH,ACL for]
11450 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
11451 received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11453 oindex:[%acl_smtp_connect%]
11455 %acl_smtp_connect%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11458 cindex:[{ACL},on SMTP connection]
11459 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
11460 See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11462 oindex:[%acl_smtp_data%]
11464 %acl_smtp_data%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11467 cindex:[DATA, ACL for]
11468 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
11469 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
11470 acknowledgement is sent. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11472 oindex:[%acl_smtp_etrn%]
11474 %acl_smtp_etrn%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11477 cindex:[ETRN,ACL for]
11478 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
11479 received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11481 oindex:[%acl_smtp_expn%]
11483 %acl_smtp_expn%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11486 cindex:[EXPN,ACL for]
11487 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
11488 received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11490 oindex:[%acl_smtp_helo%]
11492 %acl_smtp_helo%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11495 cindex:[EHLO,ACL for]
11496 cindex:[HELO,ACL for]
11497 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
11498 command is received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11501 oindex:[%acl_smtp_mail%]
11503 %acl_smtp_mail%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11506 cindex:[MAIL,ACL for]
11507 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
11508 received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11510 oindex:[%acl_smtp_mailauth%]
11512 %acl_smtp_mailauth%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11515 cindex:[AUTH,on MAIL command]
11516 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
11517 a MAIL command. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for details of ACLs, and chapter
11518 <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>> for details of authentication.
11520 oindex:[%acl_smtp_mime%]
11522 %acl_smtp_mime%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11525 cindex:[MIME content scanning,ACL for]
11526 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
11527 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
11528 section <<SECTscanmimepart>> for details.
11530 oindex:[%acl_smtp_predata%]
11532 %acl_smtp_predata%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11535 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
11536 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for
11539 oindex:[%acl_smtp_quit%]
11541 %acl_smtp_quit%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11544 cindex:[QUIT,ACL for]
11545 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
11546 received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11548 oindex:[%acl_smtp_rcpt%]
11550 %acl_smtp_rcpt%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11553 cindex:[RCPT,ACL for]
11554 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
11555 received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11557 oindex:[%acl_smtp_starttls%]
11559 %acl_smtp_starttls%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11562 cindex:[STARTTLS, ACL for]
11563 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
11564 received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11566 oindex:[%acl_smtp_vrfy%]
11568 %acl_smtp_vrfy%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
11571 cindex:[VRFY,ACL for]
11572 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
11573 received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for further details.
11575 oindex:[%admin_groups%]
11577 %admin_groups%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
11580 cindex:[admin user]
11581 If the current group or any of the supplementary groups of the caller is in
11582 this colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
11583 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
11584 admin privileges by putting that group in %admin_groups%. However, this does
11585 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
11586 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
11589 oindex:[%allow_domain_literals%]
11591 %allow_domain_literals%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
11594 cindex:[domain literal]
11595 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
11596 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
11597 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
11598 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
11600 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
11601 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
11602 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
11603 %allow_domain_literals% true, and also to add `@[]` to the list of local
11604 domains (defined in the named domain list %local_domains% in the default
11605 configuration). This ``magic string'' matches the domain literal form of all the
11606 local host's IP addresses.
11609 oindex:[%allow_mx_to_ip%]
11611 %allow_mx_to_ip%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
11614 cindex:[MX record,pointing to IP address]
11615 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
11616 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
11617 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
11618 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
11619 practice, so to avoid ``Why can''t Exim do this?' complaints, %allow_mx_to_ip%
11620 exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not recommended, except
11621 when you have no other choice.
11623 oindex:[%allow_utf8_domains%]
11625 %allow_utf8_domains%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
11628 cindex:[domain,UTF-8 characters in]
11629 cindex:[UTF-8,in domain name]
11630 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
11631 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
11632 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
11633 experiment if they wish.
11635 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
11636 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
11637 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
11638 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
11639 adjust the value of %dns_check_names_pattern% to match the extended form. A
11640 suitable setting is:
11643 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
11644 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
11647 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
11649 dns_check_names_pattern =
11651 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
11654 oindex:[%auth_advertise_hosts%]
11656 %auth_advertise_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: '\*'
11659 cindex:[authentication,advertising]
11660 cindex:[AUTH,advertising]
11661 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
11662 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
11663 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
11664 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
11665 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
11666 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
11667 %server_advertise_condition% generic authenticator option on the individual
11668 authenticators. See chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>> for further details.
11670 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
11671 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
11672 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
11673 authentication, for example). The %auth_advertise_hosts% option can be used
11674 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
11675 which Exim advertises AUTH.
11677 cindex:[AUTH,advertising when encrypted]
11678 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
11679 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
11680 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
11682 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
11684 If $tls_cipher$ is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
11685 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
11686 expansion is \*, which matches all hosts.
11689 oindex:[%auto_thaw%]
11691 %auto_thaw%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '0s'
11694 cindex:[thawing messages]
11695 cindex:[unfreezing messages]
11696 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
11697 new delivery attempt on any frozen message if this much time has passed since
11698 it was frozen. This may result in the message being re-frozen if nothing has
11699 changed since the last attempt. It is a way of saying ``keep on trying, even
11700 though there are big problems''. See also %timeout_frozen_after% and
11701 %ignore_bounce_errors_after%.
11704 oindex:[%av_scanner%]
11706 %av_scanner%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
11709 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
11710 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
11712 sophie:/var/run/sophie
11714 If the value of %av_scanner% starts with dollar character, it is expanded
11715 before use. See section <<SECTscanvirus>> for further details.
11719 oindex:[%bi_command%]
11721 %bi_command%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
11724 cindex:[%-bi% option]
11725 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
11726 the %-bi% option (see chapter <<CHAPcommandline>>). The string value is just the
11727 command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is required, it
11728 must come from the %-oA% command line option.
11731 oindex:[%bounce_message_file%]
11733 %bounce_message_file%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
11736 cindex:[bounce message,customizing]
11737 cindex:[customizing,bounce message]
11738 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
11739 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
11740 chapter <<CHAPemsgcust>>. See also %warn_message_file%.
11743 oindex:[%bounce_message_text%]
11745 %bounce_message_text%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
11748 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
11749 message immediately after ``This message was created automatically by mail
11750 delivery software.'' It is not used if %bounce_message_file% is set.
11752 oindex:[%bounce_return_body%]
11754 %bounce_return_body%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
11757 cindex:[bounce message,including body]
11758 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
11759 bounce message when %bounce_return_message% is true. If it is not set, only
11760 the message header is included.
11761 cindex:[bounce message,including original]
11763 oindex:[%bounce_return_message%]
11765 %bounce_return_message%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
11768 If this option is set false, the original message is not included in bounce
11769 messages generated by Exim. See also %bounce_return_size_limit%.
11772 oindex:[%bounce_return_size_limit%]
11774 %bounce_return_size_limit%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '100K'
11777 cindex:[size limit, of bounce]
11778 cindex:[bounce message,size limit]
11779 cindex:[limit,bounce message size]
11780 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
11781 senders as part of bounce messages when %bounce_return_message% is true. The
11782 limit should be less than the value of the global %message_size_limit% and of
11783 any %message_size_limit% settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
11784 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
11786 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
11787 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
11788 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
11789 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
11790 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
11793 oindex:[%bounce_sender_authentication%]
11795 %bounce_sender_authentication%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
11798 cindex:[bounce message,sender authentication]
11799 cindex:[authentication,bounce message]
11800 cindex:[AUTH,on bounce message]
11801 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
11802 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
11803 connection. A typical setting might be:
11805 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
11807 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
11809 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
11811 The value of %bounce_sender_authentication% must always be a complete email
11814 oindex:[%callout_domain_negative_expire%]
11816 %callout_domain_negative_expire%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '3h'
11819 cindex:[caching,callout timeouts]
11820 cindex:[callout,caching timeouts]
11821 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
11822 domain. See section <<SECTcallver>> for details of callout verification, and
11823 section <<SECTcallvercache>> for details of the caching.
11826 oindex:[%callout_domain_positive_expire%]
11828 %callout_domain_positive_expire%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '7d'
11831 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
11832 domain. See section <<SECTcallver>> for details of callout verification, and
11833 section <<SECTcallvercache>> for details of the caching.
11836 oindex:[%callout_negative_expire%]
11838 %callout_negative_expire%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '2h'
11841 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
11842 address. See section <<SECTcallver>> for details of callout verification, and
11843 section <<SECTcallvercache>> for details of the caching.
11846 oindex:[%callout_positive_expire%]
11848 %callout_positive_expire%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '24h'
11851 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
11852 address. See section <<SECTcallver>> for details of callout verification, and
11853 section <<SECTcallvercache>> for details of the caching.
11856 oindex:[%callout_random_local_part%]
11858 %callout_random_local_part%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
11861 This option defines the ``random'' local part that can be used as part of callout
11862 verification. The default value is
11864 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
11866 See section <<CALLaddparcall>> for details of how this value is used.
11869 oindex:[%check_log_inodes%]
11871 %check_log_inodes%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
11874 See %check_spool_space% below.
11877 oindex:[%check_log_space%]
11879 %check_log_space%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
11882 See %check_spool_space% below.
11885 oindex:[%check_spool_inodes%]
11887 %check_spool_inodes%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
11890 See %check_spool_space% below.
11893 oindex:[%check_spool_space%]
11895 %check_spool_space%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
11898 cindex:[checking disk space]
11899 cindex:[disk space, checking]
11900 cindex:[spool directory,checking space]
11901 The four %check_...% options allow for checking of disk resources before a
11902 message is accepted.
11904 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
11905 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so
11906 by testing the the variables $log_inodes$, $log_space$,
11907 $spool_inodes$, and $spool_space$ in an ACL with appropriate additional
11911 %check_spool_space% and %check_spool_inodes% check the spool partition if
11912 either value is greater than zero, for example:
11914 check_spool_space = 10M
11915 check_spool_inodes = 100
11917 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
11918 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in _Local/Makefile_. It is used for holding messages in
11921 %check_log_space% and %check_log_inodes% check the partition in which log
11922 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
11923 %log_file_path% and %spool_directory% refer to different partitions.
11925 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
11926 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
11927 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
11928 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
11929 %check_spool_space% value, and the check is performed even if
11930 %check_spool_space% is zero, unless %no_smtp_check_spool_space% is set.
11932 The values for %check_spool_space% and %check_log_space% are held as a
11933 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
11935 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
11936 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
11937 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
11939 oindex:[%daemon_smtp_ports%]
11941 %daemon_smtp_ports%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: `smtp`
11944 cindex:[port,for daemon]
11945 cindex:[TCP/IP,setting listening ports]
11946 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
11947 listens. See chapter <<CHAPinterfaces>> for details of how it is used. For
11948 backward compatibility, %daemon_smtp_port% (singular) is a synonym.
11951 oindex:[%delay_warning%]
11953 %delay_warning%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time list', Default: '24h'
11956 cindex:[warning of delay]
11957 cindex:[delay warning, specifying]
11958 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
11959 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
11960 after which to send warning messages.
11962 If the value of the option is an empty string or a zero time, no warnings are
11965 Up to 10 times may be given. If a message has been on the queue for longer than
11966 the last time, the last interval between the times is used to compute
11967 subsequent warning times. For example, with
11969 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
11971 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
11972 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
11973 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
11974 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
11978 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
11979 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
11981 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
11985 oindex:[%delay_warning_condition%]
11987 %delay_warning_condition%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
11990 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
11991 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in $domain$ during the
11992 expansion. Otherwise $domain$ is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
11993 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of ``0'', ``no'' or
11994 ``false'' (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is not
11995 sent. The default is
11998 delay_warning_condition = \
11999 ${if match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk}{no}{yes}}
12002 which suppresses the sending of warnings about messages that have ``bulk'',
12003 ``list'' or ``junk'' in a 'Precedence:' header.
12005 oindex:[%deliver_drop_privilege%]
12007 %deliver_drop_privilege%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
12010 cindex:[unprivileged delivery]
12011 cindex:[delivery,unprivileged]
12012 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
12013 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
12014 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
12015 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
12016 chapter <<CHAPsecurity>>.
12018 oindex:[%deliver_queue_load_max%]
12020 %deliver_queue_load_max%, Use: 'main', Type: 'fixed-point', Default: 'unset'
12023 cindex:[load average]
12024 cindex:[queue runner,abandoning]
12025 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
12026 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
12027 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
12028 See also %queue_only_load% and %smtp_load_reserve%.
12031 oindex:[%delivery_date_remove%]
12033 %delivery_date_remove%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
12036 cindex:['Delivery-date:' header line]
12037 Exim's transports have an option for adding a 'Delivery-date:' header to a
12038 message when it is delivered -- in exactly the same way as 'Return-path:' is
12039 handled. 'Delivery-date:' records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
12040 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
12041 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
12042 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
12044 oindex:[%dns_again_means_nonexist%]
12046 %dns_again_means_nonexist%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12049 cindex:[DNS,``try again'' response; overriding]
12050 DNS lookups give a ``try again'' response for the DNS errors ``non-authoritative
12051 host not found'' and ``SERVERFAIL''. This can cause Exim to keep trying to
12052 deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to incoming mail.
12053 Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and may persist
12054 for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches anything in
12055 %dns_again_means_nonexist%, it is treated as if it did not exist. This
12056 option should be used with care.
12057 You can make it apply to reverse lookups by a setting such as this:
12059 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
12061 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. The ^dnslookup^ router
12062 has some options of its own for controlling what happens when lookups for MX or
12063 SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific options are applied
12064 after the global option.
12066 oindex:[%dns_check_names_pattern%]
12068 %dns_check_names_pattern%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
12071 cindex:[DNS,pre-check of name syntax]
12072 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
12073 names for illegal characters before handing them to the DNS resolver, because
12074 some resolvers give temporary errors for malformed names. If a domain name
12075 contains any illegal characters, a ``not found'' result is forced, and the
12076 resolver is not called. The check is done by matching the domain name against a
12077 regular expression, which is the value of this option. The default pattern is
12080 dns_check_names_pattern = \
12081 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9-]*[^\W_])?)+$
12084 which permits only letters, digits, and hyphens in components, but they may not
12085 start or end with a hyphen.
12086 If you set %allow_utf8_domains%, you must modify this pattern, or set the
12087 option to an empty string.
12090 oindex:[%dns_ipv4_lookup%]
12092 %dns_ipv4_lookup%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12095 cindex:[IPv6,DNS lookup for AAAA records]
12096 cindex:[DNS,IPv6 lookup for AAAA records]
12097 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, it looks for IPv6 address records
12098 (AAAA and, if configured, A6) as well as IPv4 address records when trying to
12099 find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's domain matches this list.
12101 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
12102 not work for the new IPv6 record types. If Exim is handed an IPv6 address
12103 record as a result of an MX lookup, it always recognizes it, and may as a
12104 result make an outgoing IPv6 connection. All this option does is to make Exim
12105 look only for IPv4-style A records when it needs to find an IP address for a
12106 host name. In due course, when the world's name servers have all been upgraded,
12107 there should be no need for this option.
12110 oindex:[%dns_retrans%]
12112 %dns_retrans%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '0s'
12115 cindex:[DNS,resolver options]
12116 The options %dns_retrans% and %dns_retry% can be used to set the
12117 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
12118 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
12119 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
12120 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
12121 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
12122 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
12123 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
12127 oindex:[%dns_retry%]
12129 %dns_retry%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
12132 See %dns_retrans% above.
12137 %drop_cr%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
12140 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
12141 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
12142 described in section <<SECTlineendings>>.
12145 oindex:[%envelope_to_remove%]
12147 %envelope_to_remove%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
12150 cindex:['Envelope-to:' header line]
12151 Exim's transports have an option for adding an 'Envelope-to:' header to a
12152 message when it is delivered -- in exactly the same way as 'Return-path:' is
12153 handled. 'Envelope-to:' records the original recipient address from the
12154 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
12155 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
12156 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
12157 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
12160 oindex:[%errors_copy%]
12162 %errors_copy%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12165 cindex:[bounce message,copy to other address]
12166 cindex:[copy of bounce message]
12167 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
12168 generates to other addresses. *Note*: this does not apply to bounce messages
12169 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
12170 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
12171 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
12172 must be enclosed in double quotes.
12174 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
12175 (see section <<SECTaddresslist>>). When a pattern matches the recipient of the
12176 bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The items
12177 are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items are
12178 examined. For example:
12181 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
12182 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
12183 postmaster@mydomain.example
12186 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables
12187 $local_part$ and $domain$ are set from the original recipient of the error
12188 message, and if there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
12190 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in %errors_copy%]
12191 variables $0$, $1$, etc. are set in the normal way.
12194 oindex:[%errors_reply_to%]
12196 %errors_reply_to%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
12199 cindex:[bounce message,'Reply-to:' in]
12200 Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
12202 From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@<qualify-domain>>
12204 where <'qualify-domain'> is the value of the %qualify_domain% option.
12205 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
12206 %errors_reply_to% option is set, a 'Reply-To:' header is added to bounce and
12207 warning messages. For example:
12209 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
12211 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
12215 oindex:[%exim_group%]
12217 %exim_group%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'compile-time configured'
12220 cindex:[gid (group id),Exim's own]
12221 cindex:[Exim group]
12222 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
12223 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
12224 option is used only when %exim_user% is also set. Unless it consists entirely
12225 of digits, the string is looked up using 'getgrnam()', and failure causes a
12226 configuration error. See chapter <<CHAPsecurity>> for a discussion of security
12230 oindex:[%exim_path%]
12232 %exim_path%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
12235 cindex:[Exim binary, path name]
12236 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
12237 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file 'exim' in
12238 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
12239 is necessary to change %exim_path% if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
12241 *Warning*: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
12242 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
12243 where the binary is. (They then use the %-bP% option to extract option
12244 settings such as the value of %spool_directory%.)
12247 oindex:[%exim_user%]
12249 %exim_user%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'compile-time configured'
12252 cindex:[uid (user id),Exim's own]
12254 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
12255 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
12256 time configuration file and the use of the %-C% and %-D% command line options
12257 is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
12259 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
12260 'getpwnam()', and failure causes a configuration error. If %exim_group% is
12261 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of 'getpwnam()' if it is
12262 used. See chapter <<CHAPsecurity>> for a discussion of security issues.
12265 oindex:[%extra_local_interfaces%]
12267 %extra_local_interfaces%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
12270 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
12271 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
12272 <<SECTreclocipadd>> for details.
12275 oindex:[%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%]
12277 %extract_addresses_remove_ ~arguments%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
12280 cindex:[%-t% option]
12281 cindex:[command line,addresses with %-t%]
12282 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,%-t% option]
12283 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
12284 are present on the command line when the %-t% option is used to build an
12285 envelope from a message's 'To:', 'Cc:' and 'Bcc:' headers, the command line
12286 addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail behaves.
12287 However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that command
12288 line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
12289 %extract_addresses_remove_arguments% is true (the default), Exim subtracts
12290 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
12294 oindex:[%finduser_retries%]
12296 %finduser_retries%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
12299 cindex:[NIS, looking up users; retrying]
12300 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
12301 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when 'getpwnam()' and
12302 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
12303 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine ``not found''
12304 errors. If %finduser_retries% is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
12305 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
12308 cindex:[_/etc/passwd_, multiple reading of]
12309 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
12310 a traditional _/etc/passwd_ file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
12311 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
12315 oindex:[%freeze_tell%]
12317 %freeze_tell%, Use: 'main', "Type: 'string list, comma separated'", Default: 'unset'
12320 cindex:[freezing messages,sending a message when freezing]
12321 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
12323 Exim freezes a message. This means that no further delivery attempts take place
12324 until an administrator (or the %auto_thaw% feature) thaws the message. If
12325 %freeze_tell% is set, Exim generates a warning message whenever it freezes
12326 something, unless the message it is freezing is a
12328 bounce message. (Without this exception there is the possibility of looping.)
12329 The warning message is sent to the addresses supplied as the comma-separated
12330 value of this option. If several of the message's addresses cause freezing,
12331 only a single message is sent.
12332 If the freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the
12333 message log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for
12334 any logging that you require.
12337 oindex:[%gecos_name%]
12339 %gecos_name%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
12343 cindex:[``gecos'' field, parsing]
12344 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the ``gecos'' field in the system
12345 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
12346 looks up this field for use when it is creating 'Sender:' or 'From:' headers.
12347 If either %gecos_pattern% or %gecos_name% are unset, the contents of the
12348 field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered, it is
12349 replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
12350 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
12352 When these options are set, %gecos_pattern% is treated as a regular expression
12353 that is to be applied to the field (again with & replaced by the login name),
12354 and if it matches, %gecos_name% is expanded and used as the user's name.
12356 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in %gecos_name%]
12357 Numeric variables such as $1$, $2$, etc. can be used in the expansion to
12358 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
12359 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
12361 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
12366 oindex:[%gecos_pattern%]
12368 %gecos_pattern%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
12371 See %gecos_name% above.
12374 oindex:[%headers_charset%]
12376 %headers_charset%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
12379 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
12380 ``words'' in header lines, when referenced by an $h_xxx$ expansion item. The
12381 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in _Local/Makefile_. The
12382 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
12383 insertions in section <<SECTexpansionitems>>.
12387 oindex:[%header_maxsize%]
12389 %header_maxsize%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: 'see below'
12392 cindex:[header section,maximum size of]
12393 cindex:[limit,size of message header section]
12394 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
12395 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
12396 _Local/Makefile_; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
12397 sections are rejected.
12400 oindex:[%header_line_maxsize%]
12402 %header_line_maxsize%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
12405 cindex:[header lines,maximum size of]
12406 cindex:[limit,size of one header line]
12407 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
12408 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
12409 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
12410 zero means ``no limit''.
12415 oindex:[%helo_accept_junk_hosts%]
12417 %helo_accept_junk_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12420 cindex:[HELO,accepting junk data]
12421 cindex:[EHLO,accepting junk data]
12422 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
12423 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
12424 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
12425 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See %helo_verify_hosts%
12426 if you want to do semantic checking.
12427 See also %helo_allow_chars% for a way of extending the permitted character
12431 oindex:[%helo_allow_chars%]
12433 %helo_allow_chars%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
12436 cindex:[HELO,underscores in]
12437 cindex:[EHLO,underscores in]
12438 cindex:[underscore in EHLO/HELO]
12439 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
12440 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
12441 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
12443 helo_allow_chars = _
12445 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
12448 oindex:[%helo_lookup_domains%]
12450 %helo_lookup_domains%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: `@:@[]`
12453 cindex:[HELO,forcing reverse lookup]
12454 cindex:[EHLO,forcing reverse lookup]
12455 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
12456 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
12457 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
12458 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
12462 oindex:[%helo_try_verify_hosts%]
12464 %helo_try_verify_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12467 cindex:[HELO verifying, optional]
12468 cindex:[EHLO verifying, optional]
12469 The RFCs mandate that a server must not reject a message because it doesn't
12470 like the HELO or EHLO command. By default, Exim just checks the syntax
12471 of these commands (see %helo_accept_junk_hosts% and %helo_allow_chars%
12472 above). However, some sites like to be stricter. If the calling host matches
12473 %helo_try_verify_hosts%, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO
12474 or EHLO command either:
12476 - is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host (the RFCs
12477 specifically allow this), or
12479 - cindex:[DNS,reverse lookup]
12480 cindex:[reverse DNS lookup]
12481 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
12482 calling host address, or
12484 - when looked up using 'gethostbyname()' (or 'getipnodebyname()' when
12485 available) yields the calling host address.
12487 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
12488 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
12489 be detected later in an ACL by the `verify = helo` condition. If you want
12490 verification failure to cause rejection of EHLO or HELO, use
12491 %helo_verify_hosts% instead.
12495 oindex:[%helo_verify_hosts%]
12497 %helo_verify_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12500 cindex:[HELO verifying, mandatory]
12501 cindex:[EHLO verifying, mandatory]
12502 For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host name given in the
12503 HELO or EHLO in the same way as for %helo_try_verify_hosts%. If the
12504 check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is rejected with a 550 error, and
12505 entries are written to the main and reject logs. If a MAIL command is
12506 received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a
12511 oindex:[%hold_domains%]
12513 %hold_domains%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12516 cindex:[domain,delaying delivery]
12517 cindex:[delivery,delaying certain domains]
12518 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
12519 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
12520 %-M%, %-qf%, %-Rf% or %-Sf% options, and also while testing or verifying
12521 addresses using %-bt% or %-bv%. Otherwise, if a domain matches an item in
12522 %hold_domains%, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and it is
12523 deferred every time the message is looked at.
12525 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
12526 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
12527 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
12528 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use %queue_domains% or
12529 %queue_smtp_domains%, not %hold_domains%.
12531 A setting of %hold_domains% does not override Exim's code for removing
12532 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
12533 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
12534 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
12537 oindex:[%host_lookup%]
12539 %host_lookup%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12542 cindex:[host name lookup, forcing]
12543 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
12544 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
12545 %helo_try_verify_hosts% or %helo_verify_hosts%, or the host matches this
12546 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
12547 default configuration file contains
12551 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
12552 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
12554 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
12555 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
12556 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
12558 After any kind of failure, the host name (in $sender_host_name$) remains
12559 unset, and $host_lookup_failed$ is set to the string ``1''. See also
12560 %dns_again_means_nonexist%, %helo_lookup_domains%, and `verify =
12561 reverse_host_lookup` in ACLs.
12564 oindex:[%host_lookup_order%]
12566 %host_lookup_order%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: `bydns:byaddr`
12569 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
12570 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
12571 first, and then to try a local lookup (using 'gethostbyaddr()' or equivalent)
12572 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
12575 *Warning*: the ``byaddr'' method does not always yield aliases when there are
12576 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
12577 _/etc/hosts_. Different operating systems give different results in this
12578 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
12582 oindex:[%host_reject_connection%]
12584 %host_reject_connection%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12587 cindex:[host,rejecting connections from]
12588 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
12589 as soon as the connection is made.
12590 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
12591 nowadays the ACL specified by %acl_smtp_connect% can also reject incoming
12592 connections immediately.
12594 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
12595 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
12596 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
12597 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
12598 chapter <<CHAPACL>>.
12601 oindex:[%hosts_connection_nolog%]
12603 %hosts_connection_nolog%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12606 cindex:[host,not logging connections from]
12607 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
12608 happen, even though the %smtp_connection% log selector is set. For example,
12609 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
12610 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
12611 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
12612 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
12613 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
12615 hosts_connection_nolog = :
12617 If the %smtp_connection% log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
12621 oindex:[%hosts_treat_as_local%]
12623 %hosts_treat_as_local%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12626 cindex:[local host,domains treated as]
12627 cindex:[host,treated as local]
12628 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
12629 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
12631 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
12632 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
12634 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
12635 `@mx_any`, `@mx_primary`, and `@mx_secondary` in a domain list (see
12636 section <<SECTdomainlist>>), and when checking the %hosts% option in the ^smtp^
12637 transport for the local host (see the %allow_localhost% option in that
12639 See also %local_interfaces%, %extra_local_interfaces%, and chapter
12640 <<CHAPinterfaces>>, which contains a discussion about local network interfaces
12641 and recognising the local host.
12644 oindex:[%ignore_bounce_errors_after%]
12646 %ignore_bounce_errors_after%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '10w'
12649 cindex:[bounce message,discarding]
12650 cindex:[discarding bounce message]
12651 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
12652 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
12653 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
12655 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
12656 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
12657 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
12658 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
12659 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
12660 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
12661 for frozen messages. For example,
12663 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
12665 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
12666 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
12667 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
12668 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
12669 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see %auto_thaw% and
12670 %timeout_frozen_after%.
12673 oindex:[%ignore_fromline_hosts%]
12675 %ignore_fromline_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
12678 cindex:[``From'' line]
12679 cindex:[UUCP,``From'' line]
12680 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like ``From'' line before the
12681 headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the message's
12682 body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as such. Exim
12683 can be made to ignore it by setting %ignore_fromline_hosts% to match those
12684 hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local process
12685 rather than a remote host, and is using %-bs% to inject the messages,
12686 %ignore_fromline_local% must be set to achieve this effect.
12689 oindex:[%ignore_fromline_local%]
12691 %ignore_fromline_local%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
12694 See %ignore_fromline_hosts% above.
12697 oindex:[%keep_malformed%]
12699 %keep_malformed%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '4d'
12702 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
12703 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
12704 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
12708 oindex:[%ldap_default_servers%]
12710 %ldap_default_servers%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
12713 cindex:[LDAP,default servers]
12714 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
12715 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section <<SECTforldaque>> for details
12716 of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built with
12720 oindex:[%ldap_version%]
12722 %ldap_version%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: 'unset'
12725 cindex:[LDAP protocol version, forcing]
12726 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
12727 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the %-bP% command line option as
12728 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
12729 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
12730 has been built with LDAP support.
12734 oindex:[%local_from_check%]
12736 %local_from_check%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
12739 cindex:['Sender:' header line,disabling addition of]
12740 cindex:['From:' header line,disabling checking of]
12741 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
12742 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing 'Sender:' header line, and checks
12743 that the 'From:' header line matches the login of the calling user and the
12744 domain specified by %qualify_domain%.
12746 *Note*: An unqualified address (no domain) in the 'From:' header in a
12747 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
12748 %-bnq% command line option is used.
12750 You can use %local_from_prefix% and %local_from_suffix% to permit affixes
12751 on the local part. If the 'From:' header line does not match, Exim adds a
12752 'Sender:' header with an address constructed from the calling user's login and
12753 the default qualify domain.
12755 If %local_from_check% is set false, the 'From:' header check is disabled,
12756 and no 'Sender:' header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
12757 'Sender:' header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
12758 %local_sender_retain% to be true.
12760 cindex:[envelope sender]
12761 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
12762 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
12763 %untrusted_set_sender% permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
12765 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify ``submission mode'' to
12766 request similar header line checking. See section <<SECTthesenhea>>, which has
12767 more details about 'Sender:' processing.
12772 oindex:[%local_from_prefix%]
12774 %local_from_prefix%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
12777 When Exim checks the 'From:' header line of locally submitted messages for
12778 matching the login id (see %local_from_check% above), it can be configured to
12779 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
12780 done by setting %local_from_prefix% and/or %local_from_suffix% to
12781 appropriate lists, in the same form as the %local_part_prefix% and
12782 %local_part_suffix% router options (see chapter <<CHAProutergeneric>>). For
12785 local_from_prefix = *-
12787 is set, a 'From:' line containing
12789 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
12791 will not cause a 'Sender:' header to be added if 'user@your.domain.example'
12792 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
12796 oindex:[%local_from_suffix%]
12798 %local_from_suffix%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
12801 See %local_from_prefix% above.
12804 oindex:[%local_interfaces%]
12806 %local_interfaces%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'see below'
12809 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
12810 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
12811 <<CHAPinterfaces>> contains a full description of this option and the related
12814 %daemon_smtp_ports%, %extra_local_interfaces%, %hosts_treat_as_local%,
12815 and %tls_on_connect_ports%.
12817 The default value for %local_interfaces% is
12819 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12821 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
12823 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12827 oindex:[%local_scan_timeout%]
12829 %local_scan_timeout%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '5m'
12832 cindex:[timeout,for 'local_scan()' function]
12833 cindex:['local_scan()' function,timeout]
12834 This timeout applies to the 'local_scan()' function (see chapter
12835 <<CHAPlocalscan>>). Zero means ``no timeout''. If the timeout is exceeded, the
12836 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
12837 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
12838 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
12842 oindex:[%local_sender_retain%]
12844 %local_sender_retain%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
12847 cindex:['Sender:' header line,retaining from local submission]
12848 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
12849 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing 'Sender:' header line. If you
12850 do not want this to happen, you must set %local_sender_retain%, and you must
12851 also set %local_from_check% to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
12852 Section <<SECTthesenhea>> has more details about 'Sender:' processing.
12857 oindex:[%localhost_number%]
12859 %localhost_number%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
12862 cindex:[host,locally unique number for]
12863 cindex:[message ids, with multiple hosts]
12864 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
12865 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
12866 value for the %localhost_number% option. The string is expanded immediately
12867 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
12868 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
12869 range 0--16 (or 0--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file systems).
12870 This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
12871 $localhost_number$. When %localhost_number is set%, the final two
12872 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
12873 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
12874 section <<SECTmessiden>>.
12878 oindex:[%log_file_path%]
12880 %log_file_path%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list'!!, Default: 'set at compile time'
12883 cindex:[log,file path for]
12884 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
12885 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
12886 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
12887 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
12888 are written in a sub-directory called _log_ in Exim's spool directory.
12889 Chapter <<CHAPlog>> contains further details about Exim's logging, and section
12890 <<SECTwhelogwri>> describes how the contents of %log_file_path% are used. If
12891 this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion variables) it
12892 is recommended that you do not set this option in the configuration file, but
12893 instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in _Local/Makefile_ so that
12894 it is available to Exim for logging errors detected early on -- in particular,
12895 failure to read the configuration file.
12898 oindex:[%log_selector%]
12900 %log_selector%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
12903 cindex:[log,selectors]
12904 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
12905 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
12906 minus characters. For example:
12908 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
12910 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
12911 logging, in section <<SECTlogselector>>.
12914 oindex:[%log_timezone%]
12916 %log_timezone%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
12919 cindex:[log,timezone for entries]
12920 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
12921 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
12922 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
12923 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
12924 %log_timezone% true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
12925 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
12926 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
12927 $tod_log$ variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
12928 another variable called $tod_zone$ that contains just the timezone offset.
12931 oindex:[%lookup_open_max%]
12933 %lookup_open_max%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '25'
12936 cindex:[too many open files]
12937 cindex:[open files, too many]
12938 cindex:[file,too many open]
12939 cindex:[lookup,maximum open files]
12940 cindex:[limit,open files for lookups]
12941 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
12942 lookups that use regular files (that is, ^lsearch^, ^dbm^, and ^cdb^). Exim
12943 normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same file is
12944 required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least recently
12945 used file. Note that if you are using the 'ndbm' library, it actually opens
12946 two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts as one for the
12947 purposes of %lookup_open_max%. If you are getting ``too many open files''
12948 errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of %lookup_open_max%.
12951 oindex:[%max_username_length%]
12953 %max_username_length%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
12956 cindex:[length of login name]
12957 cindex:[user name,maximum length]
12958 cindex:[limit,user name length]
12959 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
12960 'getpwnam()' to eight characters, instead of returning ``no such user''. If
12961 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call 'getpwnam()' with
12962 an argument that is longer behaves as if 'getpwnam()' failed.
12966 oindex:[%message_body_visible%]
12968 %message_body_visible%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '500'
12971 cindex:[body of message,visible size]
12972 cindex:[message body, visible size]
12973 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
12974 $message_body$ and $message_body_end$ expansion variables.
12977 oindex:[%message_id_header_domain%]
12979 %message_id_header_domain%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
12982 cindex:['Message-ID:' header line]
12983 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
12984 (domain) of the 'Message-ID:' header that Exim creates if a
12985 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. ``Locally-originated''
12986 means ``not received over TCP/IP.''
12987 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
12988 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
12989 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
12990 empty string, the option is ignored.
12993 oindex:[%message_id_header_text%]
12995 %message_id_header_text%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
12998 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
12999 the 'Message-id:' header that Exim creates if a
13001 incoming message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC
13002 2822 to take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message
13003 id as the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option
13004 is set, it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and
13005 does not yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header
13006 immediately before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any
13007 characters that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into
13008 hyphens. This means that variables such as $tod_log$ can be used, because
13009 the spaces and colons will become hyphens.
13012 oindex:[%message_logs%]
13014 %message_logs%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
13017 cindex:[message log, disabling]
13018 cindex:[log,message log; disabling]
13019 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13020 _msglog_ spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13021 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13022 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13023 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13024 which is not affected by this option.
13027 oindex:[%message_size_limit%]
13029 %message_size_limit%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: '50M'
13032 cindex:[message,size limit]
13033 cindex:[limit,message size]
13034 cindex:[size of message, limit]
13035 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13036 value is expanded for each incoming
13037 connection so, for example, it can be made to depend on the IP address of the
13038 remote host for messages arriving via TCP/IP. *Note*: This limit cannot be
13039 made to depend on a message's sender or any other properties of an individual
13040 message, because it has to be advertised in the server's response to EHLO.
13041 String expansion failure causes a temporary error. A value of zero means no
13042 limit, but its use is not recommended. See also %bounce_return_size_limit%.
13044 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
13045 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
13046 failure message to the sender, depending on the %-oe% setting. Rejection of an
13047 oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also the
13048 generic transport option %message_size_limit%, which limits the size of
13049 message that an individual transport can process.
13052 oindex:[%move_frozen_messages%]
13054 %move_frozen_messages%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
13057 cindex:[frozen messages,moving]
13058 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
13060 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
13062 in _Local/Makefile_, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
13063 moved from the _input_ and _msglog_ directories on the spool to _Finput_
13064 and _Fmsglog_, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
13065 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
13066 lists generated by %-bp% or by the Exim monitor.
13069 oindex:[%mua_wrapper%]
13071 %mua_wrapper%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
13074 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
13075 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter <<CHAPnonqueueing>>
13076 contains a full description of this facility.
13080 oindex:[%mysql_servers%]
13082 %mysql_servers%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
13085 cindex:[MySQL,server list]
13086 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
13087 be used in conjunction with ^mysql^ lookups (see section <<SECTsql>>). The
13088 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
13091 oindex:[%never_users%]
13093 %never_users%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
13096 Local message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
13097 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
13098 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
13101 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
13102 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
13103 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
13104 contains just the single user name ``root''. The %never_users% runtime option
13105 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
13107 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
13108 %never_users% list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
13111 never_users = root:daemon:bin
13113 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
13114 harm. This option overrides the %pipe_as_creator% option of the ^pipe^
13118 oindex:[%oracle_servers%]
13120 %oracle_servers%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
13123 cindex:[Oracle,server list]
13124 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
13125 to be used in conjunction with ^oracle^ lookups (see section <<SECTsql>>). The
13126 option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
13129 oindex:[%percent_hack_domains%]
13131 %percent_hack_domains%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
13134 cindex:[``percent hack'']
13135 cindex:[source routing,in email address]
13136 cindex:[address,source-routed]
13137 The ``percent hack'' is the convention whereby a local part containing a percent
13138 sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent replaced by @.
13139 This is sometimes called ``source routing'', though that term is also applied to
13140 RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this option is set, Exim
13141 implements the percent facility for those domains listed, but no others. This
13142 happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against an ACL.
13144 *Warning*: The ``percent hack'' has often been abused by people who are
13145 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
13146 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
13147 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
13148 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
13149 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
13150 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
13153 oindex:[%perl_at_start%]
13155 %perl_at_start%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
13158 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
13159 interpreter. See chapter <<CHAPperl>> for details of its use.
13162 oindex:[%perl_startup%]
13164 %perl_startup%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
13167 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
13168 interpreter. See chapter <<CHAPperl>> for details of its use.
13171 oindex:[%pgsql_servers%]
13173 %pgsql_servers%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
13176 cindex:[PostgreSQL lookup type,server list]
13177 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
13178 data, to be used in conjunction with ^pgsql^ lookups (see section <<SECTsql>>).
13179 The option is available only if Exim has been built with PostgreSQL support.
13182 oindex:[%pid_file_path%]
13184 %pid_file_path%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'set at compile time'
13187 cindex:[daemon,pid file path]
13188 cindex:[pid file, path for]
13189 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
13190 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
13193 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
13195 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file _exim-daemon.pid_ in Exim's
13197 The value set by the option can be overridden by the %-oP% command line
13198 option. A pid file is not written if a ``non-standard'' daemon is run by means of
13199 the %-oX% option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by %-oP%.
13202 oindex:[%pipelining_advertise_hosts%]
13204 %pipelining_advertise_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: '\*'
13207 cindex:[PIPELINING advertising, suppressing]
13208 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
13209 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. When PIPELINING is not
13210 advertised and %smtp_enforce_sync% is true, an Exim server enforces strict
13211 synchronization for each SMTP command and response.
13212 When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes that clients will use it; ``out
13213 of order'' commands that are ``expected'' do not count as protocol errors (see
13214 %smtp_max_synprot_errors%).
13217 oindex:[%preserve_message_logs%]
13219 %preserve_message_logs%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
13222 cindex:[message logs, preserving]
13223 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
13224 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
13225 called _msglog.OLD_, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
13226 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
13227 volume of mail. Use with care!
13230 oindex:[%primary_hostname%]
13232 %primary_hostname%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
13235 cindex:[name,of local host]
13236 cindex:[host,name of local]
13237 cindex:[local host,name of]
13238 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO
13239 or HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the %helo_data%
13240 option in the ^smtp^ transport),
13241 and as the default for %qualify_domain%. If it is not set, Exim calls
13242 'uname()' to find it. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name
13243 returned by 'uname()' contains only one component, Exim passes it to
13244 'gethostbyname()' (or 'getipnodebyname()' when available) in order to
13245 obtain the fully qualified version.
13247 The value of $primary_hostname$ is also used by default in some SMTP
13248 response messages from an Exim server. This can be changed dynamically by
13249 setting %smtp_active_hostname%.
13252 oindex:[%print_topbitchars%]
13254 %print_topbitchars%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
13257 cindex:[printing characters]
13258 cindex:[8-bit characters]
13259 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
13260 32--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
13261 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
13262 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If %print_topbitchars% is
13263 set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
13267 oindex:[%process_log_path%]
13269 %process_log_path%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
13272 cindex:[process log path]
13273 cindex:[log,process log]
13275 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
13276 ``process log'' when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the 'exiwhat' utility
13277 script. If this option is unset, the file called _exim-process.info_ in
13278 Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly can
13279 be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
13280 different spool directories.
13283 oindex:[%prod_requires_admin%]
13285 %prod_requires_admin%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
13288 cindex:[%-M% option]
13289 cindex:[%-R% option]
13290 cindex:[%-q% option]
13291 The %-M%, %-R%, and %-q% command-line options require the caller to be an
13292 admin user unless %prod_requires_admin% is set false. See also
13293 %queue_list_requires_admin%.
13296 oindex:[%qualify_domain%]
13298 %qualify_domain%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
13301 cindex:[domain,for qualifying addresses]
13302 cindex:[address,qualification]
13303 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
13304 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
13305 recipient addresses if %qualify_recipient% is not set.
13307 Unqualified addresses are accepted by default only for locally-generated
13310 Qualification is also applied to addresses in header lines such as 'From:' and
13311 'To:' for locally-generated messages, unless the %-bnq% command line option
13315 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
13316 unless the sending host matches %sender_unqualified_hosts% or
13317 %recipient_unqualified_hosts% (as appropriate), in which case incoming
13318 addresses are qualified with %qualify_domain% or %qualify_recipient% as
13319 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
13320 addresses. If %qualify_domain% is not set, it defaults to the
13321 %primary_hostname% value.
13324 oindex:[%qualify_recipient%]
13326 %qualify_recipient%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
13329 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
13330 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See %qualify_domain% above.
13334 oindex:[%queue_domains%]
13336 %queue_domains%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
13339 cindex:[domain,specifying non-immediate delivery]
13340 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
13341 cindex:[message,queueing certain domains]
13342 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
13343 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
13344 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
13345 next queue run. See also %hold_domains% and %queue_smtp_domains%.
13348 oindex:[%queue_list_requires_admin%]
13350 %queue_list_requires_admin%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
13353 cindex:[%-bp% option]
13354 The %-bp% command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the queue,
13355 requires the caller to be an admin user unless %queue_list_requires_admin%
13356 is set false. See also %prod_requires_admin%.
13359 oindex:[%queue_only%]
13361 %queue_only%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
13364 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
13365 cindex:[message,queueing unconditionally]
13366 If %queue_only% is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
13367 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
13368 next queue run. Even if %queue_only% is false, incoming messages may not get
13369 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
13371 The %-odq% command line has the same effect as %queue_only%. The %-odb% and
13372 %-odi% command line options override %queue_only% unless
13373 %queue_only_override% is set false. See also %queue_only_file%,
13374 %queue_only_load%, and %smtp_accept_queue%.
13377 oindex:[%queue_only_file%]
13379 %queue_only_file%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
13382 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
13383 cindex:[message,queueing by file existence]
13384 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
13385 one optionally preceded by ``smtp''. When Exim is receiving a message,
13386 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to 'stat()'. For
13387 each path that exists, the corresponding queuing option is set.
13388 For paths with no prefix, %queue_only% is set; for paths prefixed by ``smtp'',
13389 %queue_smtp_domains% is set to match all domains. So, for example,
13391 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
13393 causes Exim to behave as if %queue_smtp_domains% were set to ``\*'' whenever
13394 _/some/file_ exists.
13397 oindex:[%queue_only_load%]
13399 %queue_only_load%, Use: 'main', Type: 'fixed-point', Default: 'unset'
13402 cindex:[load average]
13403 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
13404 cindex:[message,queueing by load]
13405 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
13406 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
13407 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages on the same
13408 connection are queued. Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue
13409 runner processes. This option has no effect on ancient operating systems on
13410 which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
13411 %deliver_queue_load_max% and %smtp_load_reserve%.
13414 oindex:[%queue_only_override%]
13416 %queue_only_override%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
13419 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
13420 When this option is true, the %-od'x'% command line options override the
13421 setting of %queue_only% or %queue_only_file% in the configuration file. If
13422 %queue_only_override% is set false, the %-od'x'% options cannot be used to
13423 override; they are accepted, but ignored.
13426 oindex:[%queue_run_in_order%]
13428 %queue_run_in_order%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
13431 cindex:[queue runner,processing messages in order]
13432 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
13433 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
13434 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
13435 single directory (the default),
13437 a single list is created for both the ordered and the non-ordered cases.
13438 However, if %split_spool_directory% is set, a single list is not created when
13439 %queue_run_in_order% is false. In this case, the sub-directories are
13440 processed one at a time (in a random order), and this avoids setting up one
13441 huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting %queue_run_in_order% with
13442 %split_spool_directory% may degrade performance when the queue is large,
13443 because of the extra work in setting up the single, large list. In most
13444 situations, %queue_run_in_order% should not be set.
13448 oindex:[%queue_run_max%]
13450 %queue_run_max%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '5'
13453 cindex:[queue runner,maximum number of]
13454 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
13455 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
13456 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
13457 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
13458 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
13459 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
13460 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
13463 oindex:[%queue_smtp_domains%]
13465 %queue_smtp_domains%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
13468 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
13469 cindex:[message,queueing remote deliveries]
13470 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
13471 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
13472 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
13473 %queue_smtp_domains%, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
13474 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
13475 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
13476 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
13477 over a single SMTP connection. The %-odqs% command line option causes all SMTP
13478 deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
13479 %queue_smtp_domains% to ``\*''. See also %hold_domains% and %queue_domains%.
13482 oindex:[%receive_timeout%]
13484 %receive_timeout%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '0s'
13487 cindex:[timeout,for non-SMTP input]
13488 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
13489 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
13490 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
13491 %-or% command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
13492 controlled by %smtp_receive_timeout%.
13494 oindex:[%received_header_text%]
13496 %received_header_text%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
13499 cindex:[customizing, 'Received:' header]
13500 cindex:['Received:' header line,customizing]
13501 This string defines the contents of the 'Received:' message header that is
13502 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
13503 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
13504 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no 'Received:' header line is
13505 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
13506 ``Received:'' and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for 'Received:' header
13507 lines. The default setting is:
13510 received_header_text = Received: \
13511 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
13512 {${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident }}\
13513 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
13514 by $primary_hostname \
13515 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
13516 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
13517 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
13519 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
13522 Note the use of quotes, to allow the sequences `\n` and `\t` to be used
13523 for newlines and tabs, respectively. The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted
13524 when Exim is built without TLS support. The use of conditional expansions
13525 ensures that this works for both locally generated messages and messages
13526 received from remote hosts, giving header lines such as the following:
13528 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
13529 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
13530 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
13531 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
13532 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
13533 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
13535 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
13536 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
13537 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
13538 message was accepted.
13541 oindex:[%received_headers_max%]
13543 %received_headers_max%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '30'
13546 cindex:[loop,prevention]
13547 cindex:[mail loop prevention]
13548 cindex:['Received:' header line,counting]
13549 When a message is to be delivered, the number of 'Received:' headers is
13550 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
13551 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
13552 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
13555 oindex:[%recipient_unqualified_hosts%]
13557 %recipient_unqualified_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
13560 cindex:[unqualified addresses]
13561 cindex:[host,unqualified addresses from]
13562 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
13563 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
13564 qualified by the addition of the %qualify_recipient% value. This option also
13565 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
13566 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
13567 host that matches %recipient_unqualified_hosts%,
13568 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the %-bnq%
13569 option was not set.
13572 oindex:[%recipients_max%]
13574 %recipients_max%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
13577 cindex:[limit,number of recipients]
13578 cindex:[recipient,maximum number]
13579 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
13580 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
13581 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
13582 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
13583 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
13586 cindex:[RCPT,maximum number of incoming]
13587 Note that the RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
13588 RCPT commands in a single message.
13591 oindex:[%recipients_max_reject%]
13593 %recipients_max_reject%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
13596 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
13597 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
13598 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
13599 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
13600 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
13601 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
13604 oindex:[%remote_max_parallel%]
13606 %remote_max_parallel%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '2'
13609 cindex:[delivery,parallelism for remote]
13610 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
13611 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
13612 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
13613 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
13614 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to %remote_max_parallel%
13615 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than %remote_max_parallel%
13616 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
13617 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
13618 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
13619 %remote_sort_domains% option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
13620 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
13621 tagged with its process id.
13623 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
13624 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
13625 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
13626 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
13629 cindex:[number of deliveries]
13630 cindex:[delivery,maximum number of]
13631 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
13632 need to set the %queue_only% option. This ensures that all incoming messages
13633 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
13634 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
13635 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
13636 runners by setting the %queue_run_max% parameter. Because each queue runner
13637 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
13638 then take place at once is %queue_run_max% multiplied by
13639 %remote_max_parallel%.
13641 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
13642 %queue_smtp_domains% instead of %queue_only%. This has the added benefit of
13643 doing the SMTP routing before queuing, so that several messages for the same
13644 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
13647 oindex:[%remote_sort_domains%]
13649 %remote_sort_domains%, Use: 'main', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
13652 cindex:[sorting remote deliveries]
13653 cindex:[delivery,sorting remote]
13654 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
13655 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
13657 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
13659 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the 'cam.ac.uk' domain first, then
13660 to those in the %uk% domain, then to any others.
13663 oindex:[%retry_data_expire%]
13665 %retry_data_expire%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '7d'
13668 cindex:[hints database,data expiry]
13669 This option sets a ``use before'' time on retry information in Exim's hints
13670 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
13671 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
13675 oindex:[%retry_interval_max%]
13677 %retry_interval_max%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '24h'
13680 cindex:[retry,limit on interval]
13681 cindex:[limit,on retry interval]
13682 Chapter <<CHAPretry>> describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the intervals
13683 between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered straight away.
13684 This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between retries.
13687 oindex:[%return_path_remove%]
13689 %return_path_remove%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
13692 cindex:['Return-path:' header line,removing]
13693 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a 'Return-path:'
13694 header line into a message when it makes a ``final delivery''. The 'Return-path:'
13695 header preserves the sender address as received in the MAIL command. This
13696 description implies that this header should not be present in an incoming
13697 message. If %return_path_remove% is true, any existing 'Return-path:'
13698 headers are removed from messages at the time they are received. Exim's
13699 transports have options for adding 'Return-path:' headers at the time of
13700 delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
13703 oindex:[%return_size_limit%]
13705 %return_size_limit%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '100K'
13708 This option is an obsolete synonym for %bounce_return_size_limit%.
13711 oindex:[%rfc1413_hosts%]
13713 %rfc1413_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: '\*'
13717 cindex:[host,for RFC 1413 calls]
13718 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
13722 oindex:[%rfc1413_query_timeout%]
13724 %rfc1413_query_timeout%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '30s'
13727 cindex:[RFC 1413,query timeout]
13728 cindex:[timeout,for RFC 1413 call]
13729 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
13730 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
13733 oindex:[%sender_unqualified_hosts%]
13735 %sender_unqualified_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
13738 cindex:[unqualified addresses]
13739 cindex:[host,unqualified addresses from]
13740 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
13741 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
13742 %qualify_domain%. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does not
13743 reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but it
13744 qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
13745 %sender_unqualified_hosts%,
13746 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the %-bnq%
13747 option was not set.
13750 oindex:[%smtp_accept_keepalive%]
13752 %smtp_accept_keepalive%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
13755 cindex:[keepalive,on incoming connection]
13756 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
13757 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
13758 connections periodically, by sending packets with ``old'' sequence numbers. The
13759 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgement if the connection is
13760 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
13761 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
13762 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
13763 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
13764 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
13768 oindex:[%smtp_accept_max%]
13770 %smtp_accept_max%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '20'
13773 cindex:[limit,incoming SMTP connections]
13774 cindex:[SMTP,incoming connection count]
13776 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
13777 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
13778 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by 'inetd'. If the value
13779 is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be non-zero if
13780 either %smtp_accept_max_per_host% or %smtp_accept_queue% is set. See also
13781 %smtp_accept_reserve%.
13785 oindex:[%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%]
13787 %smtp_accept_max_nonmail%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '10'
13790 cindex:[limit,non-mail SMTP commands]
13791 cindex:[SMTP,limiting non-mail commands]
13792 Exim counts the number of ``non-mail'' commands in an SMTP session, and drops the
13793 connection if there are too many. This option defines ``too many''. The check
13794 catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
13795 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
13796 client host matches %smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%.
13798 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
13799 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
13800 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurence of HELO
13801 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
13802 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
13803 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
13804 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
13805 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
13808 oindex:[%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%]
13810 %smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: '\*'
13813 You can control which hosts are subject to the %smtp_accept_max_nonmail%
13814 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
13815 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
13820 oindex:[%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%]
13822 %smtp_accept_max_per_connection%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '1000'
13825 cindex:[SMTP incoming message count, limiting]
13826 cindex:[limit,messages per SMTP connection]
13827 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
13828 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
13829 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
13830 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
13831 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
13835 oindex:[%smtp_accept_max_per_host%]
13837 %smtp_accept_max_per_host%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
13840 cindex:[limit,SMTP connections from one host]
13841 cindex:[host,limiting SMTP connections from]
13842 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
13843 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
13844 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
13845 reference to $sender_host_address$. Once the limit is reached, additional
13846 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. The
13847 default value of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set, it is required
13848 that %smtp_accept_max% be non-zero.
13850 *Warning*: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
13851 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
13852 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
13853 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
13854 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
13855 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
13859 oindex:[%smtp_accept_queue%]
13861 %smtp_accept_queue%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
13864 cindex:[SMTP,incoming connection count]
13865 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
13866 cindex:[message,queueing by SMTP connection count]
13867 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls handled via the listening
13868 daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed on the
13869 queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. A value of zero implies
13870 no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only if it is less than the
13871 %smtp_accept_max% value (unless that is zero). See also %queue_only%,
13872 %queue_only_load%, %queue_smtp_domains%, and the various %-od% command
13876 oindex:[%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%]
13878 %smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '10'
13881 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
13882 cindex:[message,queueing by message count]
13883 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
13884 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
13885 the use of %-bs% or %-bS%. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
13886 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
13887 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
13888 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
13889 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
13890 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
13891 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
13894 oindex:[%smtp_accept_reserve%]
13896 %smtp_accept_reserve%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
13899 cindex:[SMTP,incoming call count]
13900 cindex:[host,reserved]
13901 When %smtp_accept_max% is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
13902 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
13903 that are specified in %smtp_reserve_hosts%. The value set in
13904 %smtp_accept_max% includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
13905 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
13906 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that that group
13907 of hosts can always get at least %smtp_accept_reserve% connections.
13909 For example, if %smtp_accept_max% is set to 50 and %smtp_accept_reserve% is
13910 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
13911 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in %smtp_reserve_hosts%.
13912 See also %smtp_accept_max_per_host%.
13915 oindex:[%smtp_active_hostname%]
13917 %smtp_active_hostname%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
13920 cindex:[host,name in SMTP responses]
13921 cindex:[SMTP,host name in responses]
13922 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
13923 several different hosts. At the start of an SMTP connection, its value is
13924 expanded and used instead of the value of $primary_hostname$ in SMTP
13925 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
13926 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
13928 It is also used in HELO commands for callout verification.
13929 The active hostname is placed in the $smtp_active_hostname$ variable, which
13930 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
13931 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
13934 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
13935 expansion results in an empty string, the value of $primary_hostname$ is
13936 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
13937 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
13938 value of %smtp_active_hostname% depends on the incoming interface address.
13942 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$interface_address}{10.0.0.1}\
13943 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
13947 oindex:[%smtp_banner%]
13949 %smtp_banner%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
13952 cindex:[SMTP,welcome banner]
13953 cindex:[banner for SMTP]
13954 cindex:[welcome banner for SMTP]
13955 cindex:[customizing,SMTP banner]
13956 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
13957 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
13960 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
13961 $version_number $tod_full
13964 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
13965 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use ``\n'' in the string at
13966 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
13967 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
13968 multiline response).
13971 oindex:[%smtp_check_spool_space%]
13973 %smtp_check_spool_space%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
13976 cindex:[checking disk space]
13977 cindex:[disk space, checking]
13978 cindex:[spool directory,checking space]
13979 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
13980 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
13981 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
13982 leaving free the amount specified by %check_spool_space% (even if that value
13983 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
13986 oindex:[%smtp_connect_backlog%]
13988 %smtp_connect_backlog%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '20'
13991 cindex:[connection backlog]
13992 cindex:[SMTP,connection backlog]
13993 cindex:[backlog of connections]
13994 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
13995 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
13996 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
13997 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
13998 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
13999 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14000 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14001 attacks by SYN flooding.
14004 oindex:[%smtp_enforce_sync%]
14006 %smtp_enforce_sync%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
14009 cindex:[SMTP,synchronization checking]
14010 cindex:[synchronization checking in SMTP]
14011 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14012 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14013 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14014 fewer, but they still exist.
14016 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14017 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14018 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response ``554
14019 SMTP synchronization error'' is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing for
14020 this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected input
14021 may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it does
14022 detect many instances.
14024 The check can be globally disabled by setting %smtp_enforce_sync% false.
14025 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14026 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a %control% modifier in an ACL
14027 (see section <<SECTcontrols>>). See also %pipelining_advertise_hosts%.
14031 oindex:[%smtp_etrn_command%]
14033 %smtp_etrn_command%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14036 cindex:[ETRN,command to be run]
14037 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14038 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14039 chapter <<CHAPACL>>). The string is split up into separate arguments which are
14040 independently expanded. The expansion variable $domain$ is set to the
14041 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14044 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain $sender_host_address
14046 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14047 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14048 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14049 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14050 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14054 oindex:[%smtp_etrn_serialize%]
14056 %smtp_etrn_serialize%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
14059 cindex:[ETRN,serializing]
14060 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14061 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14062 section <<SECTETRN>> for details.
14065 oindex:[%smtp_load_reserve%]
14067 %smtp_load_reserve%, Use: 'main', Type: 'fixed-point', Default: 'unset'
14070 cindex:[load average]
14071 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14072 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in %smtp_reserve_hosts%.
14073 If %smtp_reserve_hosts% is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14074 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14075 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14076 %deliver_queue_load_max% and %queue_only_load%.
14080 oindex:[%smtp_max_synprot_errors%]
14082 %smtp_max_synprot_errors%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '3'
14085 cindex:[SMTP,limiting syntax and protocol errors]
14086 cindex:[limit,SMTP syntax and protocol errors]
14087 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14088 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14090 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14092 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14093 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14094 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14095 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14096 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14098 cindex:[PIPELINING,expected errors]
14099 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14100 ``expected'', for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14101 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14102 %pipelining_advertise_hosts%), and in this situation, ``expected'' errors do
14103 not count towards the limit.
14107 oindex:[%smtp_max_unknown_commands%]
14109 %smtp_max_unknown_commands%, Use: 'main', Type: 'integer', Default: '3'
14112 cindex:[SMTP,limiting unknown commands]
14113 cindex:[limit,unknown SMTP commands]
14114 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14115 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14118 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14119 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14123 oindex:[%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%]
14125 %smtp_ratelimit_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
14128 cindex:[SMTP,rate limiting]
14129 cindex:[limit,rate of message arrival]
14130 cindex:[RCPT,rate limiting]
14131 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14132 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14133 recipients. When a host matches %smtp_ratelimit_hosts%, the values of
14134 %smtp_ratelimit_mail% and %smtp_ratelimit_rcpt% are used to control the
14135 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14136 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14139 - A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14141 - An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14142 fractional parts are allowed here.
14144 - A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14146 - A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14147 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14149 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14150 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14152 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14153 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14155 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14156 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14157 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14158 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14160 It is also possible to configure delays explicitly in ACLs. See section
14161 <<SECTACLmodi>> for details.
14165 oindex:[%smtp_ratelimit_mail%]
14167 %smtp_ratelimit_mail%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
14170 See %smtp_ratelimit_hosts% above.
14173 oindex:[%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%]
14175 %smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
14178 See %smtp_ratelimit_hosts% above.
14181 oindex:[%smtp_receive_timeout%]
14183 %smtp_receive_timeout%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '5m'
14186 cindex:[timeout,for SMTP input]
14187 cindex:[SMTP timeout, input]
14188 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14189 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14190 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14191 the message is abandoned.
14192 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14194 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14195 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14197 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14198 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14201 cindex:[%-os% option]
14202 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14203 %-os% command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
14204 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
14205 of local input using %-bs% or %-bS%.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
14206 timeout is controlled by %receive_timeout% and %-or%.
14209 oindex:[%smtp_reserve_hosts%]
14211 %smtp_reserve_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
14214 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
14215 %smtp_accept_reserve% and %smtp_load_reserve% above.
14218 oindex:[%smtp_return_error_details%]
14220 %smtp_return_error_details%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
14223 cindex:[SMTP,details policy failures]
14224 cindex:[policy control rejection, returning details]
14225 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
14226 ``Administrative prohibition'' when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
14227 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
14228 to spammers. However, some other syadmins who are applying strict checking
14229 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
14230 %smtp_return_error_details% true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
14231 example, instead of ``Administrative prohibition'', it might give:
14233 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
14234 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
14238 oindex:[%spamd_address%]
14240 %spamd_address%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: `127.0.0.1 783`
14243 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
14244 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's %spamd% daemon. See
14245 section <<SECTscanspamass>> for more details.
14249 oindex:[%split_spool_directory%]
14251 %split_spool_directory%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
14254 cindex:[multiple spool directories]
14255 cindex:[spool directory,split]
14256 cindex:[directories, multiple]
14257 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
14258 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
14259 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
14260 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
14261 arrival of the message.
14263 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
14264 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
14265 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
14266 directory; however, if %preserve_message_logs% is set, all old msglog files
14267 are still placed in the single directory _msglog.OLD_.
14269 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
14270 changing %split_spool_directory%. Exim notices messages that are in the
14271 ``wrong'' place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off after
14272 a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
14273 automatically deleted.
14275 When %split_spool_directory% is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
14276 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
14277 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
14278 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
14279 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
14280 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
14281 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
14282 if %queue_run_in_order% is set, none of this new processing happens. The
14283 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
14286 oindex:[%spool_directory%]
14288 %spool_directory%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'set at compile time'
14291 cindex:[spool directory,path to]
14292 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
14293 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
14294 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
14295 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
14296 $primary_hostname$.
14298 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
14299 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
14300 log files are being written to the spool directory (see %log_file_path%).
14301 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
14302 as failures in the configuration file.
14304 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
14305 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
14308 oindex:[%strip_excess_angle_brackets%]
14310 %strip_excess_angle_brackets%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
14313 cindex:[angle brackets, excess]
14314 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round ``route-addr''
14315 items in addresses are stripped. For example, `\<\<xxx@a.b.c.d\>\>` is treated
14316 as `<xxx@a.b.c.d>`. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on
14317 to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this option is
14318 not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
14321 oindex:[%strip_trailing_dot%]
14323 %strip_trailing_dot%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
14326 cindex:[trailing dot on domain]
14327 cindex:[dot,trailing on domain]
14328 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
14329 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
14330 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
14331 domain causes a syntax error.
14332 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
14336 oindex:[%syslog_duplication%]
14338 %syslog_duplication%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
14341 cindex:[syslog,duplicate log lines; suppressing]
14342 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
14343 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
14344 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
14345 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
14346 nuisance. If %syslog_duplication% is set false, only one copy of any
14347 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
14348 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
14349 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
14350 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
14351 the LOG_ALERT priority.
14354 oindex:[%syslog_facility%]
14356 %syslog_facility%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
14359 cindex:[syslog,facility; setting]
14360 This option sets the syslog ``facility'' name, used when Exim is logging to
14361 syslog. The value must be one of the strings ``mail'', ``user'', ``news'', ``uucp'',
14362 ``daemon'', or ``local'x'##'' where 'x' is a digit between 0 and 7. If this
14363 option is unset, ``mail'' is used. See chapter <<CHAPlog>> for details of Exim's
14368 oindex:[%syslog_processname%]
14370 %syslog_processname%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: `exim`
14373 cindex:[syslog,process name; setting]
14374 This option sets the syslog ``ident'' name, used when Exim is logging to syslog.
14375 The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter <<CHAPlog>> for
14376 details of Exim's logging.
14380 oindex:[%syslog_timestamp%]
14382 %syslog_timestamp%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
14385 cindex:[syslog,timestamps]
14386 If %syslog_timestamp% is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
14387 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter <<CHAPlog>> for
14388 details of Exim's logging.
14391 oindex:[%system_filter%]
14393 %system_filter%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14396 cindex:[filter,system filter]
14397 cindex:[system filter,specifying]
14398 cindex:[Sieve filter,not available for system filter]
14399 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
14400 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
14401 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
14402 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
14403 appropriate %system_filter_..._transport% option(s) must be set, to define
14404 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
14405 <<CHAPsystemfilter>>.
14408 oindex:[%system_filter_directory_transport%]
14410 %system_filter_directory_transport%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14413 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
14414 %save% command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in ``/'',
14415 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
14416 During the delivery, the variable $address_file$ contains the path name.
14419 oindex:[%system_filter_file_transport%]
14421 %system_filter_file_transport%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14424 cindex:[file,transport for system filter]
14425 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the %save%
14426 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in ``/''. During
14427 the delivery, the variable $address_file$ contains the path name.
14429 oindex:[%system_filter_group%]
14431 %system_filter_group%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
14434 cindex:[gid (group id),system filter]
14435 This option is used only when %system_filter_user% is also set. It sets the
14436 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
14437 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
14439 oindex:[%system_filter_pipe_transport%]
14441 %system_filter_pipe_transport%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14444 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,for system filter]
14445 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a %pipe% command is
14446 used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable $address_pipe$
14447 contains the pipe command.
14450 oindex:[%system_filter_reply_transport%]
14452 %system_filter_reply_transport%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14455 cindex:[^autoreply^ transport,for system filter]
14456 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a %mail% command is
14457 used in a system filter.
14459 oindex:[%system_filter_user%]
14461 %system_filter_user%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
14464 cindex:[uid (user id),system filter]
14465 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
14466 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
14467 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
14468 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
14469 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
14470 specified by %system_filter_group%. When the uid is specified numerically,
14471 %system_filter_group% is required to be set.
14473 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
14474 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
14475 transport option overrides. Normally you should set %system_filter_user% if
14476 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
14479 oindex:[%tcp_nodelay%]
14481 %tcp_nodelay%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
14484 cindex:[daemon,TCP_NODELAY on sockets]
14485 cindex:[Nagle algorithm]
14486 cindex:[TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets]
14487 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
14488 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
14489 turns off the ``Nagle algorithm'', which is a way of improving network
14490 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
14491 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
14492 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
14493 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
14494 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
14498 oindex:[%timeout_frozen_after%]
14500 %timeout_frozen_after%, Use: 'main', Type: 'time', Default: '0s'
14503 cindex:[frozen messages,timing out]
14504 cindex:[timeout,frozen messages]
14505 If %timeout_frozen_after% is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
14506 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given
14507 time is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If it is a bounce
14508 message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the sender, in a
14509 similar manner to cancellation by the %-Mg% command line option. If you want
14510 to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of frozen message,
14511 see %ignore_bounce_errors_after%.
14514 oindex:[%timezone%]
14516 %timezone%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
14519 cindex:[timezone, setting]
14520 The value of %timezone% is used to set the environment variable TZ while
14521 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
14522 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
14523 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
14527 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in _Local/Makefile_,
14528 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
14529 is built. If %timezone% is set to the empty string, either at build or run
14530 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
14531 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
14532 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
14535 oindex:[%tls_advertise_hosts%]
14537 %tls_advertise_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
14540 cindex:[TLS,advertising]
14541 cindex:[encryption,on SMTP connection]
14542 cindex:[SMTP,encrypted connection]
14543 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
14544 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
14545 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
14546 chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for details of Exim's support for TLS.
14549 oindex:[%tls_certificate%]
14551 %tls_certificate%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14554 cindex:[TLS,server certificate; location of]
14555 cindex:[certificate for server, location of]
14556 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
14557 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
14558 assumed to be in this file if %tls_privatekey% is unset. See chapter <<CHAPTLS>>
14559 for further details.
14561 *Note*: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
14562 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
14563 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the %tls_certificate%
14564 option in the relevant ^smtp^ transport.
14569 %tls_crl%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14572 cindex:[TLS,server certificate revocation list]
14573 cindex:[certificate,revocation list for server]
14574 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
14575 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
14578 oindex:[%tls_dhparam%]
14580 %tls_dhparam%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14583 cindex:[TLS,D-H parameters for server]
14584 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
14585 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
14586 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
14587 ignored. See section <<SECTopenvsgnu>> for further details.
14590 oindex:[%tls_on_connect_ports%]
14592 %tls_on_connect_ports%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
14595 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
14596 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
14597 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
14598 further details, see section <<SECTsupobssmt>>.
14602 oindex:[%tls_privatekey%]
14604 %tls_privatekey%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14607 cindex:[TLS,server private key; location of]
14608 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
14609 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, the
14610 private key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See
14611 chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for further details.
14614 oindex:[%tls_remember_esmtp%]
14616 %tls_remember_esmtp%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
14619 cindex:[TLS,esmtp state; remembering]
14620 cindex:[TLS,broken clients]
14621 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
14622 ``esmtp'' state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
14623 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
14627 oindex:[%tls_require_ciphers%]
14629 %tls_require_ciphers%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14632 cindex:[TLS,requiring specific ciphers]
14633 cindex:[cipher,requiring specific]
14634 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
14635 The ^smtp^ transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
14636 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
14637 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
14638 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
14639 in somewhat different ways.
14641 If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the preference order of the
14644 Details are given in sections <<SECTreqciphssl>> and <<SECTreqciphgnu>>.
14647 oindex:[%tls_try_verify_hosts%]
14649 %tls_try_verify_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
14652 cindex:[TLS,client certificate verification]
14653 cindex:[certificate,verification of client]
14654 See %tls_verify_hosts% below.
14657 oindex:[%tls_verify_certificates%]
14659 %tls_verify_certificates%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14662 cindex:[TLS,client certificate verification]
14663 cindex:[certificate,verification of client]
14664 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
14665 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
14666 match %tls_verify_hosts% or %tls_try_verify_hosts%. Alternatively, if you
14667 are using OpenSSL, you can set %tls_verify_certificates% to the name of a
14668 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
14669 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
14672 oindex:[%tls_verify_hosts%]
14674 %tls_verify_hosts%, Use: 'main', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
14677 cindex:[TLS,client certificate verification]
14678 cindex:[certificate,verification of client]
14679 This option, along with %tls_try_verify_hosts%, controls the checking of
14680 certificates from clients.
14681 The expected certificates are defined by %tls_verify_certificates%, which
14682 must be set. A configuration error occurs if either %tls_verify_hosts% or
14683 %tls_try_verify_hosts% is set and %tls_verify_certificates% is not set.
14685 Any client that matches %tls_verify_hosts% is constrained by
14686 %tls_verify_certificates%. The client must present one of the listed
14687 certificates. If it does not, the connection is aborted.
14689 A weaker form of checking is provided by %tls_try_verify_hosts%. If a client
14690 matches this option (but not %tls_verify_hosts%), Exim requests a
14691 certificate and checks it against %tls_verify_certificates%, but does not
14692 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
14693 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
14694 such as ``accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received, but
14695 accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified certificate''.
14697 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
14701 oindex:[%trusted_groups%]
14703 %trusted_groups%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
14706 cindex:[trusted group]
14707 cindex:[group,trusted]
14708 If this option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups,
14709 or which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted.
14710 The groups can be specified numerically or by name.
14711 See section <<SECTtrustedadmin>> for details of what trusted callers are
14712 permitted to do. If neither %trusted_groups% nor %trusted_users% is set, only
14713 root and the Exim user are trusted.
14716 oindex:[%trusted_users%]
14718 %trusted_users%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
14721 cindex:[trusted user]
14722 cindex:[user,trusted]
14723 If this option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users
14725 The users can be specified numerically or by name.
14726 See section <<SECTtrustedadmin>> for details of what trusted callers are
14727 permitted to do. If neither %trusted_groups% nor %trusted_users% is set, only
14728 root and the Exim user are trusted.
14730 oindex:[%unknown_login%]
14732 %unknown_login%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14735 cindex:[uid (user id),unknown caller]
14736 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
14737 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using 'getpwuid()', Exim
14738 gives up. The %unknown_login% option can be used to set a login name to be
14739 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like %user\$caller_uid%
14740 can be set. When %unknown_login% is used, the value of %unknown_username% is
14741 used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
14745 oindex:[%unknown_username%]
14747 %unknown_username%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
14750 See %unknown_login%.
14753 oindex:[%untrusted_set_sender%]
14755 %untrusted_set_sender%, Use: 'main', Type: 'address list'!!, Default: 'unset'
14758 cindex:[trusted user]
14759 cindex:[sender,setting by untrusted user]
14760 cindex:[untrusted user, setting sender]
14761 cindex:[user,untrusted setting sender]
14762 cindex:[envelope sender]
14763 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
14764 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
14765 default qualification domain. Data from the %-f% option (for setting envelope
14766 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if %-bs% or %-bS%
14767 is used) is ignored.
14769 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
14770 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
14772 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
14774 The %untrusted_set_sender% option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
14775 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
14776 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
14777 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
14778 identity of the user is in $sender_ident$, so you can, for example, restrict
14779 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
14780 followed by a hyphen
14781 by a setting like this:
14783 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
14785 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
14786 restriction, you can use
14788 untrusted_set_sender = *
14790 The %untrusted_set_sender% option applies to all forms of local input, but
14791 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
14792 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
14793 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
14794 'Sender:' header in the message, or from adding a 'Sender:' header if
14795 necessary. See %local_sender_retain% and %local_from_check% for ways of
14796 overriding these actions. The handling of the 'Sender:' header is also
14797 described in section <<SECTthesenhea>>.
14799 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following ``<=''.
14800 For local messages, the user's login always follows, after ``U=''. In %-bp%
14801 displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an envelope sender
14802 address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the sender address.
14805 oindex:[%uucp_from_pattern%]
14807 %uucp_from_pattern%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
14810 cindex:[``From'' line]
14811 cindex:[UUCP,``From'' line]
14812 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
14813 an initial line starting with ``From'' to pass the envelope sender. In
14814 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
14815 of a regular expression that is set in %uucp_from_pattern%. When the pattern
14816 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
14817 %uucp_from_sender%, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
14818 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
14820 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
14821 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
14823 The pattern can be seen by running
14825 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
14827 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
14828 year in the second case. The first word after ``From'' is matched in the regular
14829 expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
14830 %uucp_from_sender% is ``$1'', which therefore just uses this first word (``ph10''
14831 in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
14832 %ignore_fromline_hosts%.
14835 oindex:[%uucp_from_sender%]
14837 %uucp_from_sender%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string'!!, Default: `\$1`
14840 See %uucp_from_pattern% above.
14843 oindex:[%warn_message_file%]
14845 %warn_message_file%, Use: 'main', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
14848 cindex:[warning of delay,customizing the message]
14849 cindex:[customizing,warning message]
14850 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14851 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
14852 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
14853 %delay_warning%. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
14854 <<CHAPemsgcust>>. See also %bounce_message_file%.
14857 oindex:[%write_rejectlog%]
14859 %write_rejectlog%, Use: 'main', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
14862 cindex:[reject log,disabling]
14863 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
14864 See chapter <<CHAPlog>> for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
14869 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14870 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14872 [[CHAProutergeneric]]
14873 Generic options for routers
14874 ---------------------------
14875 cindex:[options,generic; for routers]
14876 cindex:[generic options,router]
14877 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
14878 Those that are preconditions are marked with !? in the ``use'' field.
14880 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
14881 <<SECTrunindrou>> and <<SECTrouprecon>>. The latter specifies the order in
14882 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
14883 provide data for a transport is: %errors_to%, %headers_add%, %headers_remove%,
14888 oindex:[%address_data%]
14890 %address_data%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14893 cindex:[router,data attached to address]
14894 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
14895 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
14896 router declines. Other expansion failures cause delivery of the address to be
14899 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
14900 accessed using the variable $address_data$ in the current router, subsequent
14901 routers, and the eventual transport.
14903 *Warning*: if the current or any subsequent router is a ^redirect^ router
14904 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of $address_data$ are
14905 accessible in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is
14906 usually either not confidential or it ``belongs'' to the current user, but if you
14907 do put confidential data into $address_data$ you need to remember this
14910 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of $address_data$ remains
14911 with the address, though it can be changed by another %address_data% setting
14912 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
14913 $address_data$ propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
14914 ``child'' that is generated by a router with the %unseen% option.
14916 The idea of %address_data% is that you can use it to look up a lot of data for
14917 the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example, you
14918 could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
14920 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
14922 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
14924 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
14926 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
14927 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
14929 The %address_data% facility is also useful as a means of passing information
14930 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
14932 $address_data$ is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
14933 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
14934 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to $sender_address_data$.
14939 oindex:[%address_test%]
14941 %address_test%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
14944 cindex:[%-bt% option]
14945 cindex:[router,skipping when address testing]
14946 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
14947 by means of the %-bt% command line option. This can be a convenience when your
14948 first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
14949 having to set the ``already scanned'' indicator when testing real address
14954 oindex:[%cannot_route_message%]
14956 %cannot_route_message%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
14959 cindex:[router,customizing ``cannot route'' message]
14960 cindex:[customizing,``cannot route'' message]
14961 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
14962 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is ``Unrouteable
14963 address''. This option is useful only on routers that have %more% set false, or
14964 on the very last router in a configuration, because the value that is used is
14965 taken from the last router that inspects an address. For example, using the
14966 default configuration, you could put:
14968 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
14970 on the first (^dnslookup^) router, and
14972 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
14974 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails, the
14975 default message is used.
14976 Unless the expansion failure was explicitly forced, a message about the failure
14977 is written to the main and panic logs, in addition to the normal message about
14978 the routing failure.
14981 oindex:[%caseful_local_part%]
14983 %caseful_local_part%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
14986 cindex:[case of local parts]
14987 cindex:[router,case of local parts]
14988 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
14989 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
14990 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
14991 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
14992 part lists (for example, %local_parts%), case-sensitive matching can be turned
14993 on by ``+caseful'' as a list item. See section <<SECTcasletadd>> for more details.
14995 The value of the $local_part$ variable is forced to lower case while a
14996 router is running unless %caseful_local_part% is set. When a router assigns
14997 an address to a transport, the value of $local_part$ when the transport runs
14998 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
14999 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of $original_local_part$
15000 and $parent_local_part$ are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15002 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15003 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate %control%
15004 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15005 (see section <<SECTcontrols>>).
15009 oindex:[%check_local_user%]
15011 %check_local_user%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15014 cindex:[local user, checking in router]
15015 cindex:[router,checking for local user]
15016 cindex:[_/etc/passwd_]
15017 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15018 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15019 local system. The check is done by calling the 'getpwnam()' function rather
15020 than trying to read _/etc/passwd_ directly. This means that other methods of
15021 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15022 user, $home$ is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15023 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15024 given in section <<SECTrouprecon>>). However, the value of $home$ can be
15025 overridden by %router_home_directory%. If the local part is not a local user,
15026 the router is skipped.
15028 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15029 or matches something else, you cannot combine %check_local_user% with a
15030 setting of %local_parts%, because that specifies the logical 'and' of the
15031 two conditions. However, you can use a ^passwd^ lookup in a %local_parts%
15032 setting to achieve this. For example:
15034 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15036 Note, however, that the side effects of %check_local_user% (such as setting
15037 up a home directory) do not occur when a ^passwd^ lookup is used in a
15038 %local_parts% (or any other) precondition.
15042 oindex:[%condition%]
15044 %condition%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15047 cindex:[router,customized precondition]
15048 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15049 router to be called. The %condition% option is the last precondition to be
15050 evaluated (see section <<SECTrouprecon>>). The string is expanded, and if the
15051 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings ``0'' or
15052 ``no'' or ``false'' (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the router
15053 is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15055 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15056 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15058 The %condition% option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15059 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15060 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15062 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15064 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15066 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15069 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15070 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15071 be specified using %condition%.
15075 oindex:[%debug_print%]
15077 %debug_print%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15080 cindex:[testing,variables in drivers]
15081 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the %-d% command line
15082 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15083 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15084 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15085 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15086 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a %condition%
15087 option appears not to be working, %debug_print% can be used to output the
15088 variables it references. The output happens after checks for %domains%,
15089 %local_parts%, and %check_local_user% but before any other preconditions are
15090 tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15094 oindex:[%disable_logging%]
15096 %disable_logging%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15099 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15100 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15101 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15102 transport option of the same name.
15107 %domains%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
15110 cindex:[router,restricting to specific domains]
15111 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15112 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15113 lookup returned for the domain is placed in $domain_data$ for use in string
15114 expansions of the driver's private options.
15115 See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a list of the order in which preconditions
15122 %driver%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
15125 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15130 oindex:[%errors_to%]
15132 %errors_to%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15135 cindex:[envelope sender]
15136 cindex:[router,changing address for errors]
15137 If a router successfully handles an address, it may queue the address for
15138 delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if there is a
15139 delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce message is sent
15140 to the address that results from expanding this string, provided that the
15141 address verifies successfully.
15142 %errors_to% is expanded before %headers_add%, %headers_remove%, and
15145 If the option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15146 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15147 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15148 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15150 If an address for which %errors_to% has been set ends up being delivered over
15151 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the %errors_to% value, so that
15152 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15153 sent there. The most common use of %errors_to% is probably to direct mailing
15154 list bounces to the manager of the list, as described in section
15155 <<SECTmailinglists>>.
15157 The %errors_to% setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15158 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own %errors_to%
15160 or if it is delivered by a transport with a %return_path% setting.
15162 You can set %errors_to% to the empty string by either of these settings:
15167 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15168 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15169 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15170 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to `<>`, unless
15171 overridden by the %return_path% option on the transport.
15173 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15174 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15175 path in $address_data$ in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15176 setting %return_path%.
15182 %expn%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
15185 cindex:[address,testing]
15186 cindex:[testing,addresses]
15187 cindex:[EXPN,router skipping]
15188 cindex:[router,skipping for EXPN]
15189 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15190 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15191 want to turn it off on a router for users' _.forward_ files, while leaving it
15192 on for the system alias file.
15193 See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a list of the order in which preconditions
15196 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15197 <<CHAPACL>>). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15198 an address with %-bt%. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is %-bv%.
15202 oindex:[%fail_verify%]
15204 %fail_verify%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15207 cindex:[router,forcing verification failure]
15208 Setting this option has the effect of setting both %fail_verify_sender% and
15209 %fail_verify_recipient% to the same value.
15213 oindex:[%fail_verify_recipient%]
15215 %fail_verify_recipient%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15218 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15219 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15223 oindex:[%fail_verify_sender%]
15225 %fail_verify_sender%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15228 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15229 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15233 oindex:[%fallback_hosts%]
15235 %fallback_hosts%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
15238 cindex:[router,fallback hosts]
15239 cindex:[fallback,hosts specified on router]
15240 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15241 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. If a router queues an
15242 address for a remote transport, this host list is associated with the address,
15243 and used instead of the transport's fallback host list. If %hosts_randomize%
15244 is set on the transport, the order of the list is randomized for each use. See
15245 the %fallback_hosts% option of the ^smtp^ transport for further details.
15250 %group%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
15253 cindex:[gid (group id),local delivery]
15254 cindex:[local transports,uid and gid]
15255 cindex:[transport,local]
15256 cindex:[router,setting group]
15257 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15258 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15260 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15261 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15262 The default is unset, unless %check_local_user% is set, when the default
15263 is taken from the password information. See also %initgroups% and %user% and
15264 the discussion in chapter <<CHAPenvironment>>.
15268 oindex:[%headers_add%]
15270 %headers_add%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15273 cindex:[header lines,adding]
15274 cindex:[router,adding header lines]
15275 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15276 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15277 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15278 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15279 <<SECTheadersaddrem>>.
15281 The %headers_add% option is expanded after %errors_to%, but before
15282 %headers_remove% and %transport%. If the expanded string is empty, or if the
15283 expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion failures
15284 are treated as configuration errors.
15286 *Warning*: The %headers_add% option cannot be used for a ^redirect^
15287 router that has the %one_time% option set.
15292 oindex:[%headers_remove%]
15294 %headers_remove%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15297 cindex:[header lines,removing]
15298 cindex:[router,removing header lines]
15299 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15300 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15301 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15302 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15303 section <<SECTheadersaddrem>>.
15305 The %headers_remove% option is expanded after %errors_to% and %headers_add%,
15306 but before %transport%. If the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no
15307 effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration errors.
15309 *Warning*: The %headers_remove% option cannot be used for a ^redirect^
15310 router that has the %one_time% option set.
15315 oindex:[%ignore_target_hosts%]
15317 %ignore_target_hosts%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
15320 cindex:[IP address,discarding]
15321 cindex:[router,discarding IP addresses]
15322 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15323 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15324 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15325 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15328 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15332 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15334 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a ^dnslookup^ router are
15335 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15336 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the ``unrouteable
15337 domain'' error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15339 Similarly, if %ignore_target_hosts% is set on an ^ipliteral^ router, the
15340 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15342 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15343 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of %ignore_target_hosts%
15344 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15345 domain that is being routed.
15347 During its expansion, $host_address$ is set to the IP address that is being
15350 oindex:[%initgroups%]
15352 %initgroups%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15355 cindex:[additional groups]
15356 cindex:[groups, additional]
15357 cindex:[local transports,uid and gid]
15358 cindex:[transport,local]
15359 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15360 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15361 'initgroups()' function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15362 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also %group% and
15363 %user% and the discussion in chapter <<CHAPenvironment>>.
15367 oindex:[%local_part_prefix%]
15369 %local_part_prefix%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
15372 cindex:[router,prefix for local part]
15373 cindex:[prefix,for local part; used in router]
15374 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part
15375 starts with one of the given strings, or %local_part_prefix_optional% is
15377 See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a list of the order in which preconditions
15380 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
15381 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
15382 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
15383 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
15384 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
15386 cindex:[multiple mailboxes]
15387 cindex:[mailbox,multiple]
15388 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
15389 section <<SECTmulbox>>.
15391 During the testing of the %local_parts% option, and while the router is
15392 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
15393 expansion variable $local_part_prefix$. If the router accepts the address,
15394 this remains true during subsequent delivery.
15395 In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT command
15396 for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default. This
15397 behaviour can be overridden by setting %rcpt_include_affixes% true on the
15398 relevant transport.
15400 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
15401 %owner-something%. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
15402 %real-username% to bypass a user's _.forward_ file -- helpful when trying to
15403 tell a user their forwarding is broken -- by placing a router like this one
15404 immediately before the router that handles _.forward_ files:
15408 local_part_prefix = real-
15410 transport = local_delivery
15412 If both %local_part_prefix% and %local_part_suffix% are set for a router,
15413 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
15414 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
15415 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
15418 oindex:[%local_part_prefix_optional%]
15420 %local_part_prefix_optional%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15423 See %local_part_prefix% above.
15427 oindex:[%local_part_suffix%]
15429 %local_part_suffix%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
15432 cindex:[router,suffix for local part]
15433 cindex:[suffix for local part, used in router]
15434 This option operates in the same way as %local_part_prefix%, except that the
15435 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
15436 %local_part_suffix_optional% option determines whether the suffix is
15437 mandatory, and the wildcard \* character, if present, must be the last
15438 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
15439 parts of the form %something-request% and multiple user mailboxes of the form
15443 oindex:[%local_part_suffix_optional%]
15445 %local_part_suffix_optional%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15448 See %local_part_suffix% above.
15452 oindex:[%local_parts%]
15454 %local_parts%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'local part list'!!, Default: 'unset'
15457 cindex:[router,restricting to specific local parts]
15458 cindex:[local part,checking in router]
15459 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
15460 See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a list of the order in which preconditions
15462 section <<SECTlocparlis>> for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
15463 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
15466 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
15468 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
15469 for the local part is placed in the variable $local_part_data$ for use in
15470 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
15471 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
15472 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
15473 each virtual domain:
15477 local_parts = postmaster
15478 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
15483 oindex:[%log_as_local%]
15485 %log_as_local%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'see below'
15488 cindex:[log,delivery line]
15489 cindex:[delivery,log line format]
15490 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
15491 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the ``local'' style, the
15492 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
15493 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the ^accept^
15494 router, and false for all the others.
15500 %more%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean'!!, Default: 'true'
15503 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
15504 that is, one of the strings ``yes'', ``no'', ``true'', or ``false''. Any other
15505 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
15506 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
15507 delivery to be deferred.
15509 If this option is set false, and the router is run, but declines to handle the
15510 address, no further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is
15512 cindex:[%self% option]
15513 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
15514 means of the setting
15518 or otherwise, the setting of %more% is ignored. Also, the setting of %more%
15519 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
15520 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
15524 oindex:[%pass_on_timeout%]
15526 %pass_on_timeout%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
15529 cindex:[timeout,of router]
15530 cindex:[router,timeout]
15531 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
15532 address. If %pass_on_timeout% is set, the address is passed on to the next
15533 router, overriding %no_more%. This may be helpful for systems that are
15534 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
15535 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
15537 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
15538 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
15539 applies to all of them.
15543 oindex:[%pass_router%]
15545 %pass_router%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
15548 cindex:[router,go to after ``pass'']
15549 When a router returns ``pass'', the address is normally handed on to the next
15550 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting %pass_router% to the name
15551 of another router. However (unlike %redirect_router%) the named router must be
15552 below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only to
15553 the special case of ``pass''. It does not apply when a router returns ``decline''.
15557 oindex:[%redirect_router%]
15559 %redirect_router%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
15562 cindex:[router,start at after redirection]
15563 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
15564 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
15565 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
15566 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
15568 The %redirect_router% option can be set to the name of any router instance. It
15569 causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
15570 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
15571 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
15575 oindex:[%require_files%]
15577 %require_files%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'string list'!!, Default: 'unset'
15580 cindex:[file,requiring for router]
15581 cindex:[router,requiring file existence]
15582 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
15583 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
15584 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
15585 through the %require_files% list, expanding each item separately.
15587 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
15588 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
15589 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
15590 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
15592 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
15593 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
15594 ``!''. The paths are passed to the 'stat()' function to test for the existence
15595 of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not preceded by
15596 ``!'' do not exist, or if any paths preceded by ``!'' do exist.
15599 If 'stat()' cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
15600 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
15603 This option is checked after the %domains%, %local_parts%, and %senders%
15604 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
15605 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a
15606 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
15607 these options are all expanded, you can use the %exists% expansion condition to
15608 make such tests. The %require_files% option is intended for checking files
15609 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
15610 transport (for example _.procmailrc_).
15612 During delivery, the 'stat()' function is run as root, but there is a
15613 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
15614 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a ``rough'' check that
15615 operates as follows:
15617 If an item in a %require_files% list does not contain any forward slash
15618 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
15619 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
15620 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
15623 require_files = mail:/some/file
15624 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
15626 If a user or group name in a %require_files% list does not exist, the
15627 %require_files% condition fails.
15629 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
15630 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for ``x'' access on
15631 directories, and ``r'' access on the final file. Note that this means that file
15632 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
15634 *Warning 1*: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
15635 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
15636 may affect the result of a %require_files% check. In particular, 'stat()'
15637 may yield the error EACCES (``Permission denied''). This means that the Exim
15638 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
15640 *Warning 2*: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
15641 'stat()' can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
15642 without root access.
15644 In this case, if a check for access by a particular user is requested, Exim
15645 creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the check again in that
15648 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
15649 be caused by a configuration error,
15651 and routing is deferred because the existence or non-existence of the file
15652 cannot be determined. However, in some circumstances it may be desirable to
15653 treat this condition as if the file did not exist. If the file name (or the
15654 exclamation mark that precedes the file name for non-existence) is preceded by
15655 a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated as if the file did not exist. For
15658 require_files = +/some/file
15660 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
15661 handles users' _.forward_ files), another solution is to set the %verify%
15662 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
15666 oindex:[%retry_use_local_part%]
15668 %retry_use_local_part%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'see below'
15671 cindex:[hints database,retry keys]
15672 cindex:[local part,in retry keys]
15673 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
15674 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
15675 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
15676 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
15677 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
15680 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
15681 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
15682 router. The default value is true for any router that has %check_local_user%
15683 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
15684 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
15687 The setting of %retry_use_local_part% applies only to the router on which it
15688 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
15689 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
15693 oindex:[%router_home_directory%]
15695 %router_home_directory%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15698 cindex:[router,home directory for]
15699 cindex:[home directory,for router]
15700 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
15701 %transport_home_directory%, which sets a home directory for later
15702 transporting.) In particular, if used on a ^redirect^ router, this option
15703 sets a value for $home$ while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
15704 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored -- other failures
15705 cause the router to defer.
15707 Expansion of %router_home_directory% happens immediately after the
15708 %check_local_user% test (if configured), before any further expansions take
15710 (See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a list of the order in which preconditions
15712 While the router is running, %router_home_directory% overrides the value of
15713 $home$ that came from %check_local_user%.
15715 When a router accepts an address and routes it to a transport (including the
15716 cases when a redirect router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply delivery),
15717 the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first of these
15718 values that is set:
15720 - The %home_directory% option on the transport;
15722 - The %transport_home_directory% option on the router;
15724 - The password data if %check_local_user% is set on the router;
15726 - The %router_home_directory% option on the router.
15728 In other words, %router_home_directory% overrides the password data for the
15729 router, but not for the transport.
15735 %self%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string', Default: 'freeze'
15738 cindex:[MX record,pointing to local host]
15739 cindex:[local host,MX pointing to]
15740 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
15741 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the ^dnslookup^, ^ipliteral^,
15742 and ^manualroute^ routers.
15743 Certain configurations of the ^queryprogram^ router can also specify a list
15745 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
15746 ^smtp^ transport. The %self% option specifies what happens when the first
15747 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
15748 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
15749 <<SECTreclocipadd>>.
15751 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
15752 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
15753 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
15754 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
15755 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
15759 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
15761 %reroute%: <'domain'>::
15762 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
15763 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
15764 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
15766 %reroute: rewrite:% <'domain'>::
15767 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
15768 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
15772 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
15773 %pass_router% option if it is set.
15774 cindex:[%more% option]
15775 This overrides %no_more%.
15777 During subsequent routing and delivery, the variable $self_hostname$ contains
15778 the name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
15779 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
15785 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
15786 Without %no_more%, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
15787 be passed to the next router.
15790 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
15793 cindex:[local host,sending to]
15794 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
15795 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an ^smtp^ transport, it makes
15796 sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port is not
15797 this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
15798 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
15804 %senders%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'address list'!!, Default: 'unset'
15807 cindex:[router,checking senders]
15808 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
15809 address matches something on the list.
15810 See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a list of the order in which preconditions
15813 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
15814 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an %errors_to%
15815 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the %-bt% option to
15816 check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the %-f% option to set
15817 an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when verifying
15818 the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the SMTP
15819 VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender
15823 oindex:[%translate_ip_address%]
15825 %translate_ip_address%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15828 cindex:[IP address,translating]
15829 cindex:[packet radio]
15830 cindex:[router,IP address translation]
15831 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
15832 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
15833 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
15834 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
15835 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
15836 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
15837 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in _Local/Makefile_.
15839 The %translate_ip_address% string is expanded for every IP address generated
15840 by the router, with the generated address set in $host_address$. If the
15841 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
15842 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
15843 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
15844 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name -- this is looked up
15845 using 'gethostbyname()' (or 'getipnodebyname()' when available) to produce
15846 one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP addresses
15847 in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
15850 translate_ip_address = \
15851 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}{$value}fail}}
15854 The file would contain lines like
15856 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
15857 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
15859 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
15864 oindex:[%transport%]
15866 %transport%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15869 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
15870 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
15871 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
15872 after the expansion of %errors_to%, %headers_add%, and %headers_remove%, and
15873 result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
15874 delivery is deferred.
15876 The %transport% option is not used by the ^redirect^ router, but it does have
15877 some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries (see
15878 chapter <<CHAPredirect>>).
15882 oindex:[%transport_current_directory%]
15884 %transport_current_directory%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
15887 cindex:[current directory for local transport]
15888 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
15889 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
15890 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
15891 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
15892 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
15893 overridden by a setting on the transport.
15894 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
15895 logged, and delivery is deferred.
15896 See chapter <<CHAPenvironment>> for details of the local delivery environment.
15901 oindex:[%transport_home_directory%]
15903 %transport_home_directory%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
15906 cindex:[home directory,for local transport]
15907 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
15908 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
15909 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
15910 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
15911 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
15912 setting of %home_directory% on the transport.
15913 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
15914 logged, and delivery is deferred.
15916 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
15917 %transport_home_directory% is not set for the router, the home directory for
15918 the tranport is taken from the password data if %check_local_user% is set for
15919 the router. Otherwise it is taken from %router_home_directory% if that option
15920 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
15922 See chapter <<CHAPenvironment>> for further details of the local delivery
15930 %unseen%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'boolean'!!, Default: 'false'
15933 cindex:[router,carrying on after success]
15934 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
15935 that is, one of the strings ``yes'', ``no'', ``true'', or ``false''. Any other result
15936 causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15937 the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause delivery
15940 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
15941 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
15942 overriding a false setting of %more%. There is little point in setting %more%
15943 false if %unseen% is always true, but it may be useful in cases when the value
15944 of %unseen% contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is sometimes
15945 true and sometimes false).
15947 cindex:[copy of message (%unseen% option)]
15948 The %unseen% option can be used to cause copies of messages to be delivered to
15949 some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery. In effect,
15950 the current address is made into a ``parent'' that has two children -- one that
15951 is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on to be routed
15954 Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by this router or
15955 by previous routers affect the ``unseen'' copy of the message only. The clone
15956 that continues to be processed by further routers starts with no added headers
15957 and none specified for removal.
15959 However, any data that was set by the %address_data% option in the current or
15960 previous routers is passed on. Setting this option has a similar effect to the
15961 %unseen% command qualifier in filter files.
15967 %user%, Use: 'routers', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
15970 cindex:[uid (user id),local delivery]
15971 cindex:[local transports,uid and gid]
15972 cindex:[transport,local]
15973 cindex:[router,user for filter processing]
15974 cindex:[filter,user for processing]
15975 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15976 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
15977 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15978 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15979 This user is also used by the ^redirect^ router when running a filter file.
15980 The default is unset, except when %check_local_user% is set. In this case,
15981 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
15982 a name, and %group% is not set, the group associated with the user is used. See
15983 also %initgroups% and %group% and the discussion in chapter <<CHAPenvironment>>.
15989 %verify%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
15992 Setting this option has the effect of setting %verify_sender% and
15993 %verify_recipient% to the same value.
15996 oindex:[%verify_only%]
15998 %verify_only%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
16001 cindex:[EXPN,with %verify_only%]
16002 cindex:[%-bv% option]
16003 cindex:[router,used only when verifying]
16004 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16005 testing with the %-bv% option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16006 with the %-bt% option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16007 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of %verify_sender%
16008 and %verify_recipient%.
16010 *Warning*: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16011 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16012 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16016 oindex:[%verify_recipient%]
16018 %verify_recipient%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
16021 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16023 or testing recipient verification using %-bv%.
16024 See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a list of the order in which preconditions
16028 oindex:[%verify_sender%]
16030 %verify_sender%, Use: 'routers'!?, Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
16033 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16034 or testing sender verification using %-bvs%.
16035 See section <<SECTrouprecon>> for a list of the order in which preconditions
16043 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16044 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16048 cindex:[^accept^ router]
16049 cindex:[routers,^accept^]
16050 The ^accept^ router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being used
16051 purely for verification (see %verify_only%) a transport is required to be
16052 defined by the generic %transport% option. If the preconditions that are
16053 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16054 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16055 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16059 domains = mydomain.example
16061 transport = local_delivery
16063 The %domains% condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16064 %check_local_user% checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16065 When both preconditions are met, the ^accept^ router runs, and queues the
16066 address for the ^local_delivery^ transport.
16073 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16074 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16077 The dnslookup router
16078 --------------------
16079 cindex:[^dnslookup^ router]
16080 cindex:[routers,^dnslookup^]
16081 The ^dnslookup^ router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16082 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16083 unless %verify_only% is set.
16085 If SRV support is configured (see %check_srv% below), Exim first searches for
16086 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16087 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16088 However, %mx_domains% can be set to disable the direct use of address records.
16090 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16091 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16092 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16093 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16094 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the %ignore_target_hosts%
16095 generic option, the router declines.
16097 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16098 to the local host, or to any host name that matches %hosts_treat_as_local%,
16099 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16101 cindex:[MX record,pointing to local host]
16102 cindex:[local host,MX pointing to]
16103 cindex:[%self% option,in ^dnslookup^ router]
16104 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16105 address record, is the local host, or matches %hosts_treat_as_local%, what
16106 happens is controlled by the generic %self% option.
16109 [[SECTprowitdnsloo]]
16110 Problems with DNS lookups
16111 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16112 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16113 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16114 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16115 MX records. The global %dns_again_means_nonexist% option can help with this
16116 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16118 For this reason, there are two options, %srv_fail_domains% and
16119 %mx_fail_domains%, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16120 ^dnslookup^ router results in a DNS failure or a ``try again'' response. If an
16121 attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16122 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded ``no
16123 such record''. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router proceeds
16124 to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to look for A
16125 or AAAA records, unless the domain matches %mx_domains%, in which case routing
16131 Private options for dnslookup
16132 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16133 cindex:[options,^dnslookup^ router]
16134 The private options for the ^dnslookup^ router are as follows:
16136 oindex:[%check_secondary_mx%]
16138 %check_secondary_mx%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
16141 cindex:[MX record,checking for secondary]
16142 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16143 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16144 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16145 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16146 the local host is described in section <<SECTreclocipadd>>.
16149 oindex:[%check_srv%]
16151 %check_srv%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
16154 cindex:[SRV record,enabling use of]
16155 The ^dnslookup^ router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16156 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16157 enable SRV support, set the %check_srv% option to the name of the service
16158 required. For example,
16162 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16163 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16164 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16165 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the %check_srv%
16166 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16169 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16170 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16171 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates ``no such service for
16172 this domain''; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16173 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16174 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16176 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16177 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16178 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16179 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16180 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16181 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16182 have an additional ``weight'' feature which some people might find useful when
16183 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16185 See section <<SECTprowitdnsloo>> above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour when
16186 there is a DNS lookup error.
16190 oindex:[%mx_domains%]
16192 %mx_domains%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
16195 cindex:[MX record,required to exist]
16196 cindex:[SRV record,required to exist]
16197 A domain that matches %mx_domains% is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16198 record in order to be recognised. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16199 For example, if all the mail hosts in 'fict.example' are known to have MX
16200 records, except for those in 'discworld.fict.example', you could use this
16203 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16205 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16206 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16207 the address record.
16210 oindex:[%mx_fail_domains%]
16212 %mx_fail_domains%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
16215 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16216 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16217 <<SECTprowitdnsloo>> for more discussion.
16222 oindex:[%qualify_single%]
16224 %qualify_single%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
16227 cindex:[DNS,resolver options]
16228 cindex:[DNS,qualifying single-component names]
16229 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16230 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16231 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16232 called 'dictionary.ref.example', the domain 'thesaurus' would be changed to
16233 'thesaurus.ref.example' inside the resolver. For details of what your resolver
16234 actually does, consult your man pages for 'resolver' and 'resolv.conf'.
16238 oindex:[%rewrite_headers%]
16240 %rewrite_headers%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
16243 cindex:[rewriting,header lines]
16244 cindex:[header lines,rewriting]
16245 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16246 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16247 an address is specified as 'dormouse@teaparty', the domain might be
16248 expanded to 'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'. Domain expansion can also
16249 occur as a result of setting the %widen_domains% option. If %rewrite_headers%
16250 is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in any 'Bcc:', 'Cc:',
16251 'From:', 'Reply-to:', 'Sender:', and 'To:' header lines of the message are
16252 rewritten with the full domain name.
16254 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16255 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16258 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16259 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16260 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16261 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16262 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16266 oindex:[%same_domain_copy_routing%]
16268 %same_domain_copy_routing%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
16271 cindex:[address,copying routing]
16272 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the ^dnslookup^ router
16273 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16274 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16275 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16276 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16277 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16279 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16280 domain, and you are using a ^dnslookup^ router which is independent of the
16281 local part, you can set %same_domain_copy_routing% to bypass repeated DNS
16282 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when ^dnslookup^
16283 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16284 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16285 without processing them independently,
16286 provided the following conditions are met:
16288 - No router that processed the address specified %headers_add% or
16291 - The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by ``widening''
16297 oindex:[%search_parents%]
16299 %search_parents%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
16302 cindex:[DNS,resolver options]
16303 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16304 lookups. This is different from the %qualify_single% option in that it applies
16305 to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes the
16306 resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent domains.
16307 For example, on a machine in the 'fict.example' domain, if looking up
16308 'teaparty.wonderland' failed, the resolver would try
16309 'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'. For details of what your resolver
16310 actually does, consult your man pages for 'resolver' and 'resolv.conf'.
16312 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16313 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16318 oindex:[%srv_fail_domains%]
16320 %srv_fail_domains%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'domain list'!!, Default: 'unset'
16323 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16324 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16325 <<SECTprowitdnsloo>> for more discussion.
16330 oindex:[%widen_domains%]
16332 %widen_domains%, Use: 'dnslookup', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
16335 cindex:[domain,partial; widening]
16336 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16337 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16340 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16342 is set and a lookup of 'klingon.dictionary' fails,
16343 'klingon.dictionary.fict.example' is looked up, and if this fails,
16344 'klingon.dictionary.ref.example' is tried. Note that the %qualify_single%
16345 and %search_parents% options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16350 Effect of qualify_single and search_parents
16351 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16352 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16353 of the %qualify_single% or %search_parents% options, Exim rewrites the
16354 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless %rewrite_headers%
16355 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16357 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16358 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16359 such as that implied by
16363 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16364 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16374 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16375 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16377 The ipliteral router
16378 --------------------
16379 cindex:[^ipliteral^ router]
16380 cindex:[domain literal,routing]
16381 cindex:[routers,^ipliteral^]
16382 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16383 verification (see %verify_only%) a transport is required to be defined by the
16384 generic %transport% option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16385 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal, that is, an IP address enclosed
16386 in square brackets. For example, this router handles the address
16390 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address.
16392 cindex:[%self% option,in ^ipliteral^ router]
16393 If the IP address matches something in %ignore_target_hosts%, the router
16394 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16395 %self% option determines what happens.
16397 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16398 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16399 also set the main configuration option %allow_domain_literals%. Otherwise,
16400 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16404 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16405 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16407 The iplookup router
16408 -------------------
16409 cindex:[^iplookup^ router]
16410 cindex:[routers,^iplookup^]
16411 The ^iplookup^ router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16412 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16413 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16416 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16418 in your _Local/Makefile_ configuration file.
16420 The ^iplookup^ router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16421 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16422 a different address -- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16423 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16424 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16427 Background, for those that are interested: We have an Oracle database of all
16428 Cambridge users, and one of the items of data it maintains for each user is
16429 where to send mail addressed to 'user@cam.ac.uk'. The MX records for
16430 'cam.ac.uk' point to a central machine that has a large alias list that is
16431 abstracted from the database. Mail from outside is switched by this system, and
16432 originally internal mail was also done this way. However, this resulted in a
16433 fair number of messages travelling from some of our larger systems to the
16434 switch and back again. The Oracle machine now runs a UDP service that can be
16435 called by the ^iplookup^ router in Exim to find out where 'user@cam.ac.uk'
16436 addresses really have to go; this saves passing through the central switch, and
16437 in many cases saves doing any remote delivery at all.
16439 Since ^iplookup^ is just a rewriting router, a transport must not be
16441 cindex:[options,^iplookup^ router]
16446 %hosts%, Use: 'iplookup', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
16449 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16450 names. The hosts are looked up using 'gethostbyname()'
16451 (or 'getipnodebyname()' when available)
16452 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16453 happens is controlled by %optional%.
16456 oindex:[%optional%]
16458 %optional%, Use: 'iplookup', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
16461 If %optional% is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address is
16462 passed to the next router, overriding %no_more%. If %optional% is false,
16463 delivery to the address is deferred.
16468 %port%, Use: 'iplookup', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
16471 cindex:[port,^iplookup^ router]
16472 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16476 oindex:[%protocol%]
16478 %protocol%, Use: 'iplookup', Type: 'string', Default: 'udp'
16481 This option can be set to ``udp'' or ``tcp'' to specify which of the two protocols
16487 %query%, Use: 'iplookup', Type: 'string'!!, Default: `\$local_part@\$domain \$local_part@\$domain`
16490 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16491 repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct query
16492 in the default case (see %response_pattern% below).
16497 %reroute%, Use: 'iplookup', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
16500 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16501 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16502 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16503 in the response by %response_pattern% by means of numeric variables such as
16504 $1$, $2$, etc. The variable $0$ refers to the entire input string,
16505 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16506 up in the form 'local_part@domain'.
16509 oindex:[%response_pattern%]
16511 %response_pattern%, Use: 'iplookup', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
16514 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16515 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16516 router declines. If %response_pattern% is not set, no checking of the response
16517 is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a check that
16518 the text returned after the first white space is the original address. This
16519 checks that the answer that has been received is in response to the correct
16520 question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the following
16523 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
16524 reroute = $local_part@$1
16530 %timeout%, Use: 'iplookup', Type: 'time', Default: '5s'
16533 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
16534 machine. The same timeout is used for the 'connect()' function for a TCP
16535 call. It does not apply to UDP.
16540 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16541 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16543 The manualroute router
16544 ----------------------
16545 cindex:[^manualroute^ router]
16546 cindex:[routers,^manualroute^]
16547 cindex:[domain,manually routing]
16548 The ^manualroute^ router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
16549 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
16550 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
16551 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, ^manualroute^ can also
16552 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
16553 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
16555 The ^manualroute^ router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain it
16556 is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern has
16557 associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
16558 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
16559 ``routing rule''. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
16560 generic %transport% option must specify a transport, unless the router is being
16561 used purely for verification (see %verify_only%).
16563 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
16564 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
16565 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
16566 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
16567 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
16568 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
16569 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in $host$ as a single
16572 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in %route_list%,
16573 or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file or database by
16574 setting %route_data%. Only one of these settings may appear in any one
16575 instance of ^manualroute^. The format of routing rules is described below,
16576 following the list of private options.
16580 Private options for manualroute
16581 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16583 cindex:[options,^manualroute^ router]
16584 The private options for the ^manualroute^ router are as follows:
16587 oindex:[%host_find_failed%]
16589 %host_find_failed%, Use: 'manualroute', Type: 'string', Default: 'freeze'
16592 This option controls what happens when ^manualroute^ tries to find an IP
16593 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
16602 The default assumes that this state is a serious configuration error. The
16603 difference between ``pass'' and ``decline'' is that the former forces the address
16604 to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by %pass_router%),
16605 cindex:[%more% option]
16606 overriding %no_more%, whereas the latter passes the address to the next router
16607 only if %more% is true.
16609 This option applies only to a definite ``does not exist'' state; if a host lookup
16610 gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the generic
16611 %pass_on_timeout% option is set.
16614 oindex:[%hosts_randomize%]
16616 %hosts_randomize%, Use: 'manualroute', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
16619 cindex:[randomized host list]
16620 cindex:[host,list of; randomized]
16621 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
16622 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
16623 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
16624 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
16625 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
16626 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
16627 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
16629 When %hosts_randomize% is true, a host list may be split
16630 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
16631 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
16632 item that is just `+` in the host list. For example:
16634 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
16636 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
16637 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
16638 If %hosts_randomize% is not set, a `+` item in the list is ignored. If a
16639 randomized host list is passed to an ^smtp^ transport that also has
16640 %hosts_randomize set%, the list is not re-randomized.
16643 oindex:[%route_data%]
16645 %route_data%, Use: 'manualroute', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
16648 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
16649 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
16652 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
16654 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
16655 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
16659 oindex:[%route_list%]
16661 %route_list%, Use: 'manualroute', "Type: 'string list, semicolon-separated'", Default: 'unset'
16664 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
16665 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
16666 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
16669 oindex:[%same_domain_copy_routing%]
16671 %same_domain_copy_routing%, Use: 'manualroute', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
16674 cindex:[address,copying routing]
16675 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the ^manualroute^ router
16676 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16677 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16678 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16679 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16680 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16682 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16683 domain, and you are using a ^manualroute^ router which is independent of the
16684 local part, you can set %same_domain_copy_routing% to bypass repeated DNS
16685 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when ^manualroute^
16686 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16687 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16688 without processing them independently. However, this is only done if
16689 %headers_add% and %headers_remove% are unset.
16694 Routing rules in route_list
16695 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16696 The value of %route_list% is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
16697 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
16698 entered as two semicolons. Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
16700 <domain pattern> <list of hosts> <options>
16702 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
16707 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
16708 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
16711 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
16712 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
16713 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a %route_list% must start with a
16714 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
16715 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
16716 <<SECTdomainlist>>),
16717 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
16718 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
16719 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
16720 in a %route_list%).
16722 The rules in %route_list% are searched in order until one of the patterns
16723 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
16724 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
16725 %route_list% is set, %route_data% must not be set.
16729 Routing rules in route_data
16730 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16731 The use of %route_list% is convenient when there are only a small number of
16732 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
16733 hold the routing information, and use the %route_data% option instead.
16734 The value of %route_data% is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
16735 Most commonly, %route_data% is set as a string that contains an
16736 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
16739 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
16740 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
16742 This data can be accessed by setting
16744 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
16746 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
16747 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in %route_data%. The only
16748 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
16749 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
16750 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
16755 Format of the list of hosts
16756 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16757 A list of hosts, whether obtained via %route_data% or %route_list%, is always
16758 separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router declines.
16759 The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names and/or
16760 IP addresses. IP addresses are not enclosed in brackets.
16762 If the list of hosts was obtained from a %route_list% item, the following
16763 variables are set during its expansion:
16765 - cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in ^manualroute^ router]
16766 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
16767 $1$, $2$, etc. may be set.
16769 - $0$ is always set to the entire domain.
16771 - $1$ is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
16774 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
16775 looked up is available in the expansion variable $value$.
16780 How the list of hosts is used
16781 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16782 When an address is routed to an ^smtp^ transport by ^manualroute^, each of
16783 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
16784 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the %hosts_randomize%
16785 option, either on the router (see section <<SECTprioptman>> above), or on the
16788 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
16789 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by `/MX` is
16790 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
16791 records in the DNS. For example:
16793 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
16795 If the %hosts_randomize% option is set, the order of the items in the list is
16796 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
16797 that is not followed by `/MX` it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
16798 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
16799 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
16800 happens is controlled by the
16801 cindex:[%self% option,in ^manualroute^ router]
16802 %self% option of the router.
16804 A name on the list that is followed by `/MX` is replaced with the list of
16805 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
16806 lookup; the %bydns% and %byname% options (see section <<SECThowoptused>> below)
16807 are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the preference
16808 values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because randomizing
16809 happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is defined by
16812 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
16813 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
16814 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
16816 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
16817 depends on where in the original list of hosts the `/MX` item appears. If it
16818 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
16819 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
16821 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
16822 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the %self% option of the
16825 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
16826 failures when looking up IP addresses: %pass_on_timeout% and
16827 %host_find_failed% are used when relevant.
16829 The generic %ignore_target_hosts% option applies to all hosts in the list,
16830 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
16835 How the options are used
16836 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16837 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
16838 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
16839 %transport% option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
16840 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
16841 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
16842 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
16844 - %randomize%: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
16845 setting of %hosts_randomize% for this routing rule only.
16847 - %no_randomize%: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
16848 overriding the setting of %hosts_randomize% for this routing rule only.
16850 - %byname%: use 'getipnodebyname()' ('gethostbyname()' on older systems) to
16851 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
16852 also look in _/etc/hosts_ or other sources of information.
16854 - %bydns%: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
16855 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
16856 timeout), delivery is deferred.
16861 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
16862 domain2 host4:host5
16865 If neither %byname% nor %bydns% is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a DNS
16866 lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
16867 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to 'getipnodebyname()'
16868 or 'gethostbyname()', and the result of the lookup is the result of that
16871 *Warning*: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
16872 called via 'getipnodebyname()' times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
16873 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
16874 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite ``no such host'' is the local
16879 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
16880 %host_find_failed% option.
16882 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
16883 The host list is passed to the transport in the $host$ variable.
16887 Manualroute examples
16888 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
16889 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the %remote_smtp%
16890 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
16892 - cindex:[smart host,example router]
16893 The ^manualroute^ router can be used to forward all external mail to a
16894 'smart host'. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
16895 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example,
16897 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
16899 you can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
16900 your first router something like this:
16903 driver = manualroute
16904 domains = !+local_domains
16905 transport = remote_smtp
16906 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
16908 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
16909 'smarthost.ref.example'. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
16910 they are tried in order
16911 (but you can use %hosts_randomize% to vary the order each time).
16912 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
16915 driver = manualroute
16916 transport = remote_smtp
16917 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
16919 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
16920 However, they behave differently if %no_more% is added to them. In the first
16921 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the %domains%
16922 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
16923 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, %no_more% would
16924 have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it always
16925 runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
16926 %no_more% would prevent subsequent routers from running.
16928 - cindex:[mail hub example]
16929 A 'mail hub' is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
16930 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
16931 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
16932 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
16933 ^manualroute^ router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
16934 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
16935 using the %route_list% option, but for a larger number a file or database
16936 lookup is easier to manage.
16938 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
16939 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
16943 driver = manualroute
16944 transport = remote_smtp
16945 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
16947 This configuration routes domains that match `*.rhodes.tvs.example` to hosts
16948 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
16949 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
16950 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
16951 domain can be used to find the host:
16954 driver = manualroute
16955 transport = remote_smtp
16956 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
16958 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
16959 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
16960 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
16963 - cindex:[batched SMTP output example]
16964 cindex:[SMTP,batched outgoing; example]
16965 You can use ^manualroute^ to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
16966 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
16967 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
16968 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
16971 driver = manualroute
16972 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
16973 route_list = saved.domain.example
16975 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
16976 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
16977 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
16981 driver = manualroute
16983 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
16984 *.saved.domain2.example \
16985 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
16989 The first of these just passes the domain in the $host$ variable, which
16990 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in $domain$), but the second does a
16991 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
16992 the address if the lookup fails.
16994 - cindex:[UUCP,example of router for]
16995 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
16996 ^manualroute^ in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
16997 one way it can be done:
17004 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17005 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17006 return_fail_output = true
17011 driver = manualroute
17013 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17016 The file _/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_ contains entries like
17018 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17020 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing ``.UUCP'' but this way
17021 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17022 'darksite.ethereal.example' and the UUCP host name 'darksite'.
17031 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17032 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17035 The queryprogram router
17036 -----------------------
17037 cindex:[^queryprogram^ router]
17038 cindex:[routers,^queryprogram^]
17039 cindex:[routing,by external program]
17040 The ^queryprogram^ router routes an address by running an external command and
17041 acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended mainly
17042 for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments. However, if
17043 it is possible to use the precondition options (%domains%, %local_parts%,
17044 etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly be used in
17045 special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private options:
17046 cindex:[options,^queryprogram^ router]
17050 %command%, Use: 'queryprogram', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
17053 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17054 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17055 expanded separately (exactly as for a ^pipe^ transport, described in chapter
17056 <<CHAPpipetransport>>).
17059 oindex:[%command_group%]
17061 %command_group%, Use: 'queryprogram', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
17064 cindex:[gid (group id),in ^queryprogram^ router]
17065 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command. It must be set
17066 if %command_user% specifies a numerical uid. If it begins with a digit, it is
17067 interpreted as the numerical value of the gid. Otherwise it is looked up using
17071 oindex:[%command_user%]
17073 %command_user%, Use: 'queryprogram', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
17076 cindex:[uid (user id),for ^queryprogram^]
17077 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17078 command. If it begins with a digit it is interpreted as the numerical value of
17079 the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up using 'getpwnam()' to obtain a value for
17080 the uid and, if %command_group% is not set, a value for the gid also.
17083 oindex:[%current_directory%]
17085 %current_directory%, Use: 'queryprogram', Type: 'string', Default: '/'
17088 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17089 before running the command.
17094 %timeout%, Use: 'queryprogram', Type: 'time', Default: '1h'
17097 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17098 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17102 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17103 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17104 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17105 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17106 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17108 - 'Accept': routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17111 - 'Decline': the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17114 - 'Fail': routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17115 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17116 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17117 included in the SMTP response.
17119 - 'Defer': routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17120 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17121 included in any SMTP response.
17123 - 'Freeze': the same as 'defer', except that the message is frozen.
17125 - 'Pass': pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17126 %pass_router%), overriding %no_more%.
17128 - 'Redirect': the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17129 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17130 or the router specified by %redirect_router%, if set.
17132 When the first word is 'accept', the remainder of the line consists of a
17133 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17136 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17137 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17139 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17140 is included, the transport specified by the generic %transport% option is used.
17141 The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is an
17142 ^smtp^ transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17144 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the ^manualroute^ router.
17145 As well as host names and IP addresses, it may contain names followed by
17146 `/MX` to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX
17149 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17150 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17151 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17152 goes on to try a call to 'getipnodebyname()' or 'gethostbyname()', and the
17153 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17155 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the $address_data$
17156 variable. For example, this return line
17158 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17160 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17161 the transport runs, the string ``rule1'' is in $address_data$.
17166 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17167 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17170 The redirect router
17171 -------------------
17172 cindex:[^redirect^ router]
17173 cindex:[routers,^redirect^]
17174 cindex:[alias file,in a ^redirect^ router]
17175 cindex:[address redirection,^redirect^ router]
17176 The ^redirect^ router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17177 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17178 (usually called _/etc/aliases_) and for handling users' personal _.forward_
17179 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17180 redirected in several different ways:
17182 - It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17185 - It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17187 - It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17189 - It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17191 - It can be forced to fail, with a custom error message.
17193 - It can be temporarily deferred.
17195 - It can be discarded.
17197 The generic %transport% option must not be set for ^redirect^ routers.
17198 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17199 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the %file_transport%,
17200 %pipe_transport% and %reply_transport% descriptions below.
17206 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17207 expanding the contents of the %data% option, or by reading the entire contents
17208 of a file whose name is given in the %file% option. These two options are
17209 mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system aliases, in
17210 a configuration like this:
17214 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17216 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17217 expansion of %data% results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17218 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17219 cause delivery to be deferred.
17221 A configuration using %file% is commonly used for handling users' _.forward_
17227 file = $home/.forward
17230 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17231 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. *Warning*: This
17232 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17233 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17238 Forward files and address verification
17239 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17240 cindex:[address redirection,while verifying]
17241 It is usual to set %no_verify% on ^redirect^ routers which handle users'
17242 _.forward_ files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17244 - When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17245 running under the Exim uid, not as root.
17246 No additional groups are set up, even if the Exim uid is a member of other
17247 groups (that is, the 'initgroups()' function is not run).
17248 Exim is unable to change uid to read the file as the user, and it may not be
17249 able to read it as the Exim user. So in practice the router may not be able to
17252 - However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a _.forward_ file
17253 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17254 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17255 saves some resources.
17262 Interpreting redirection data
17263 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17264 cindex:[Sieve filter,specifying in redirection data]
17265 cindex:[filter,specifying in redirection data]
17266 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from %data% or %file%, can be
17267 interpreted in two different ways:
17269 - If the %allow_filter% option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17270 ``#Exim filter'' or ``#Sieve filter'', it is interpreted as a list of
17271 'filtering' instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17272 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17273 in a separate document entitled 'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'; this
17274 document is intended for use by end users.
17276 - Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17277 described in the next section.
17279 When a message is redirected to a file (a ``mail folder''), the file name given
17280 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17281 generate a relative path -- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17282 configuration. See section <<SECTfildiropt>> for a discussion of this issue for
17283 the ^appendfile^ transport.
17287 [[SECTitenonfilred]]
17288 Items in a non-filter redirection list
17289 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17290 cindex:[address redirection,non-filter list items]
17291 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17292 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17293 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17294 <<SECTspecitredli>> below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17295 disabled by means of options whose names begin with %allow_% or %forbid_%,
17296 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17297 commas or newlines.
17298 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17301 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17302 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17303 next newline character is ignored.
17305 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17306 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17307 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description, ``item''
17308 refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been removed.
17310 *Warning*: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17311 and the expansion contains a reference to $local_part$, you should make use
17312 of the %quote% expansion operator, in case the local part contains special
17313 characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17314 'obsolete.example', retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17317 data = ${quote:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17323 Redirecting to a local mailbox
17324 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17325 cindex:[routing,loops in]
17326 cindex:[loop while routing, avoidance of]
17327 cindex:[address redirection,to local mailbox]
17328 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17329 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17330 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17331 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17332 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17333 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17334 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17336 cindex:[address redirection,local part without domain]
17337 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17338 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17339 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17340 'cleo' might have a _.forward_ file containing this:
17342 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17344 cindex:[backslash in alias file]
17345 cindex:[alias file,backslash in]
17346 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17347 preceeded by ``\'', but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17348 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17351 If an item begins with ``\'' and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC 2822
17352 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the domain
17353 of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading ``\'', unqualified
17354 addresses are qualified using the value in %qualify_recipient%, but you can
17355 force the incoming domain to be used by setting %qualify_preserve_domain%.
17357 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17358 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17363 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is 'spqr') wants to save copies of
17364 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17367 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17369 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to 'Sam.Reman' fails. The
17370 ^redirect^ router for system aliases does not process 'Sam.Reman' the
17371 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17372 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17373 should really contain
17375 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17377 but because this is such a common error, the %check_ancestor% option (see
17378 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17379 ^redirect^ router that is handling users' _.forward_ files.
17383 [[SECTspecitredli]]
17384 Special items in redirection lists
17385 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17386 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17387 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17389 - cindex:[pipe,in redirection list]
17390 cindex:[address redirection,to pipe]
17391 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with ``|'' and does not parse
17392 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17393 command must be specified by the %pipe_transport% option.
17394 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17395 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17397 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17398 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17399 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17400 in double quotes, for example:
17402 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17404 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17405 quote just the command. An item such as
17407 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17409 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17411 - cindex:[file,in redirection list]
17412 cindex:[address redirection,to file]
17413 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with ``/'' and does not parse
17414 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17416 /home/world/minbari
17418 is treated as a file name, but
17420 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17422 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17423 the %file_transport% option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17424 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17425 file name, and %directory_transport% is used instead.
17427 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17428 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17430 cindex:[_/dev/null_]
17431 However, if a redirection item is the path _/dev/null_, delivery to it is
17432 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows ``\*\*bypassed\*\*''
17433 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17435 - cindex:[included address list]
17436 cindex:[address redirection,included external list]
17437 If an item is of the form
17439 :include:<path name>
17441 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17442 point. *Note*: such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an out-of-line
17443 addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated by commas or
17444 newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first item in an
17445 alias list in an ^lsearch^ file, a colon must be used to terminate the alias
17446 name. This example is incorrect:
17448 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17450 It must be given as
17452 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17454 - cindex:[address redirection,to black hole]
17455 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17456 %data% option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes the
17457 router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17458 cindex:[black hole]
17459 cindex:[abandoning mail]
17463 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is done, and no error
17464 message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing _/dev/null_, but
17465 can be independently disabled.
17467 *Warning*: If `:blackhole:` appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17468 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17469 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17470 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17473 - cindex:[delivery,forcing failure]
17474 cindex:[delivery,forcing deferral]
17475 cindex:[failing delivery,forcing]
17476 cindex:[deferred delivery, forcing]
17477 cindex:[customizing,failure message]
17478 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17479 redirection items of the form
17484 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
17485 entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (':blackhole:' is
17486 different). Any text following ':fail:' or ':defer:' is placed in the error
17487 text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17489 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17491 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17493 cindex:[VRFY error text, display of]
17494 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17496 cindex:[EXPN error text, display of]
17497 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command.
17499 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
17500 default message is available in the variable $acl_verify_message$ and can
17501 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired. Exim sends a 451
17502 SMTP code for a ':defer:', and 550 for ':fail:'. In non-SMTP cases the text
17503 is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17505 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list -- a comma does not
17506 terminate it -- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
17507 normally present in alias expansions. In ^lsearch^ lookups they are removed as
17508 part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of lookup
17509 and in ':include:' files.
17511 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
17512 containing ':fail:' causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
17513 whereas ':defer:' causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
17514 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
17515 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
17518 - cindex:[alias file,exception to default]
17519 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
17520 chapter <<CHAPfdlookup>>) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need for
17521 exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
17525 This differs from ':fail:' in that it causes the ^redirect^ router to decline,
17526 whereas ':fail:' forces routing to fail. A lookup which results in an empty
17527 redirection list has the same effect.
17531 Duplicate addresses
17532 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17533 cindex:[duplicate addresses]
17534 cindex:[address duplicate, discarding]
17535 cindex:[pipe,duplicated]
17536 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
17537 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
17538 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
17539 aliasing scheme of the type
17541 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
17545 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
17546 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part ``pipe'' it gets
17547 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
17550 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
17551 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
17553 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
17554 the pipes are distinct.
17558 Repeated redirection expansion
17559 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17560 cindex:[repeated redirection expansion]
17561 cindex:[address redirection,repeated for each delivery attempt]
17562 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
17563 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
17564 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
17565 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
17566 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The %one_time% option
17567 can be used to avoid this.
17570 Errors in redirection lists
17571 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17572 cindex:[address redirection,errors]
17573 If %skip_syntax_errors% is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
17574 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
17575 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
17576 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
17577 deferred. See also %syntax_errors_to%.
17581 Private options for the redirect router
17582 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
17584 cindex:[options,^redirect^ router]
17585 The private options for the ^redirect^ router are as follows:
17588 oindex:[%allow_defer%]
17590 %allow_defer%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17593 Setting this option allows the use of ':defer:' in non-filter redirection
17595 or the %defer% command in an Exim filter file.
17598 oindex:[%allow_fail%]
17600 %allow_fail%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17603 cindex:[failing delivery,from filter]
17604 If this option is true, the ':fail:' item can be used in a redirection list,
17605 and the %fail% command may be used in a filter file.
17608 oindex:[%allow_filter%]
17610 %allow_filter%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17613 cindex:[filter,enabling use of]
17614 cindex:[Sieve filter,enabling use of]
17615 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
17616 ``#Exim filter'' or ``#Sieve filter'' as a set of filtering instructions. There
17617 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
17618 lock out; see the %forbid_filter_xxx% options below.
17620 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
17621 the other type; see %forbid_exim_filter% and %forbid_sieve_filter%.
17624 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic %user% and %group%
17625 options. These take their defaults from the password data if
17626 %check_local_user% is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
17627 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When %allow_filter% is set
17628 true, Exim insists that either %check_local_user% or %user% is set.
17632 oindex:[%allow_freeze%]
17634 %allow_freeze%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17637 cindex:[freezing messages,allowing in filter]
17638 Setting this option allows the use of the %freeze% command in an Exim filter.
17639 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
17640 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
17641 let ordinary users do.
17645 oindex:[%check_ancestor%]
17647 %check_ancestor%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17650 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
17651 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
17652 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
17653 configuration file for handling users' _.forward_ files. It is recommended
17654 for this use of the ^redirect^ router.
17656 When %check_ancestor% is set, if a generated address (including the domain) is
17657 the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
17658 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
17659 and B has a _.forward_ file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
17660 domain, the local part ``Joe.Bloggs'' is aliased to ``jb'' and _~jb/.forward_
17663 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
17665 Without the %check_ancestor% setting, either local part (``jb'' or ``joe.bloggs'')
17666 gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was originally. If ``jb''
17667 is the real mailbox name, mail to ``jb'' gets delivered (having been turned into
17668 ``joe.bloggs'' by the _.forward_ file and back to ``jb'' by the alias), but mail
17669 to ``joe.bloggs'' fails. Setting %check_ancestor% on the ^redirect^ router that
17670 handles the _.forward_ file prevents it from turning ``jb'' back into
17671 ``joe.bloggs'' when that was the original address. See also the %repeat_use%
17675 oindex:[%check_group%]
17677 %check_group%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'see below'
17680 When the %file% option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
17681 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
17682 %owngroups% option, together with the user's default group if
17683 %check_local_user% is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
17684 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if %check_local_user%
17685 is set and the %modemask% option permits the group write bit, or if the
17686 %owngroups% option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
17690 oindex:[%check_owner%]
17692 %check_owner%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'see below'
17695 When the %file% option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when this
17696 option is set. If %check_local_user% is set, the local user is permitted;
17697 otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the %owners% option. The
17698 default value for this option is true if %check_local_user% or %owners% is
17699 set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
17704 %data%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
17707 This option is mutually exclusive with %file%. One or other of them must be
17708 set, but not both. The contents of %data% are expanded, and then used as the
17709 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
17710 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
17711 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
17713 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with ``#Exim
17714 filter'', and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
17715 terminated with newline characters. For example:
17718 data = #Exim filter\n\
17719 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
17722 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
17723 you can use the $\{sg\}$ expansion item to turn the escape string of your
17724 choice into a newline.
17727 oindex:[%directory_transport%]
17729 %directory_transport%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
17732 A ^redirect^ router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
17733 ending with a slash is specified as a new ``address''. The transport used is
17734 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
17735 configured transport. This should normally be an ^appendfile^ transport.
17740 %file%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
17743 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
17744 is mutually exclusive with the %data% option. The string is expanded before
17745 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
17746 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
17747 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
17748 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
17749 entirely of comments), the router declines.
17751 cindex:[NFS,checking for file existence]
17752 If the attempt to open the file fails with a ``does not exist'' error, Exim
17753 runs a check on the containing directory,
17754 unless %ignore_enotdir% is true (see below).
17755 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
17756 happen when users' _.forward_ files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
17757 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
17758 not, the router declines.
17761 oindex:[%file_transport%]
17763 %file_transport%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
17766 A ^redirect^ router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
17767 ending in a slash is specified as a new ``address''. The transport used is
17768 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
17769 configured transport.
17770 This should normally be an ^appendfile^ transport.
17771 When it is running, the file name is in $address_file$.
17774 oindex:[%forbid_blackhole%]
17776 %forbid_blackhole%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17779 If this option is true, the ':blackhole:' item may not appear in a redirection
17783 oindex:[%forbid_exim_filter%]
17785 %forbid_exim_filter%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17788 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
17789 %allow_filter% is true.
17794 oindex:[%forbid_file%]
17796 %forbid_file%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17799 cindex:[delivery,to file; forbidding]
17800 cindex:[Sieve filter,forbidding delivery to a file]
17801 cindex:[Sieve filter,``keep'' facility; disabling]
17802 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
17803 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
17804 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if %one_time% is
17805 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
17806 locks out the Sieve's ``keep'' facility.
17809 oindex:[%forbid_filter_existstest%]
17811 %forbid_filter_existstest%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17814 cindex:[filter,locking out certain features]
17815 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
17816 make use of the %exists% condition.
17819 oindex:[%forbid_filter_logwrite%]
17821 %forbid_filter_logwrite%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17824 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
17825 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
17826 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
17830 oindex:[%forbid_filter_lookup%]
17832 %forbid_filter_lookup%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17835 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
17836 to make use of %lookup% items.
17839 oindex:[%forbid_filter_perl%]
17841 %forbid_filter_perl%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17844 This option is available only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
17845 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
17846 of the embedded Perl support.
17849 oindex:[%forbid_filter_readfile%]
17851 %forbid_filter_readfile%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17854 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
17855 to make use of %readfile% items.
17858 oindex:[%forbid_filter_readsocket%]
17860 %forbid_filter_readsocket%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17863 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
17864 to make use of %readsocket% items.
17867 oindex:[%forbid_filter_reply%]
17869 %forbid_filter_reply%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17872 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
17873 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim
17875 or Sieve filter files, not from traditional forward files.
17877 This option is forced to be true if %one_time% is set.
17880 oindex:[%forbid_filter_run%]
17882 %forbid_filter_run%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17885 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
17886 to make use of %run% items.
17889 oindex:[%forbid_include%]
17891 %forbid_include%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17894 If this option is true, items of the form
17896 :include:<path name>
17898 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
17901 oindex:[%forbid_pipe%]
17903 %forbid_pipe%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17906 cindex:[delivery,to pipe; forbidding]
17907 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
17908 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
17909 forward file. This option is forced to be true if %one_time% is set.
17912 oindex:[%forbid_sieve_filter%]
17914 %forbid_sieve_filter%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17917 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
17918 %allow_filter% is true.
17923 oindex:[%hide_child_in_errmsg%]
17925 %hide_child_in_errmsg%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17928 cindex:[bounce message,redirection details; suppressing]
17929 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
17930 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says ``an address
17931 generated from <''the top level address'>'. Of course, this applies only to
17932 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, 'its'
17933 bounce may well quote the generated address.
17936 oindex:[%ignore_eacces%]
17938 %ignore_eacces%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17942 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
17943 EACCES error (permission denied), the ^redirect^ router behaves as if the
17944 file did not exist.
17947 oindex:[%ignore_enotdir%]
17949 %ignore_enotdir%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17953 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
17954 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the ^redirect^
17955 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
17957 Setting %ignore_enotdir% has another effect as well: When a ^redirect^
17958 router that has the %file% option set discovers that the file does not exist
17959 (the ENOENT error), it tries to 'stat()' the parent directory, as a check
17960 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
17961 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when %ignore_enotdir% is
17962 set, because that option tells Exim to ignore ``something on the path is not a
17963 directory'' (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
17964 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
17968 oindex:[%include_directory%]
17970 %include_directory%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
17973 If this option is set, the path names of any ':include:' items in a redirection
17974 list must start with this directory.
17977 oindex:[%modemask%]
17979 %modemask%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'octal integer', Default: '022'
17982 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
17983 %file% option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
17986 oindex:[%one_time%]
17988 %one_time%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
17991 cindex:[one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion]
17992 cindex:[alias file,one-time expansion]
17993 cindex:[forward file,one-time expansion]
17994 cindex:[mailing lists,one-time expansion]
17995 cindex:[address redirection,one-time expansion]
17996 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
17997 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem
17998 when one or more of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first
17999 attempt. The problem is not one of duplicate delivery -- Exim is clever enough
18000 to handle that -- but of what happens when the redirection list changes during
18001 the time that the message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the
18002 case of mailing lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages
18003 that were posted before they subscribed.
18005 If %one_time% is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18006 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18007 ``top level'' addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18008 ``delivered''. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next
18011 *Warning 1*: This means that any header line addition or removal that is
18012 specified by this router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the
18013 first attempt. For this reason, the %headers_add% and %headers_remove%
18014 generic options are not permitted when %one_time% is set.
18016 *Warning 2*: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18017 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) %forbid_file%, %forbid_pipe%,
18018 and %forbid_filter_reply% are forced to be true when %one_time% is set.
18020 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18021 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18022 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18023 %all_parents% log selector is set. It is expected that %one_time% will
18024 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18030 %owners%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
18033 cindex:[ownership,alias file]
18034 cindex:[ownership,forward file]
18035 cindex:[alias file,ownership]
18036 cindex:[forward file,ownership]
18037 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by %file%.
18038 This list is in addition to the local user when %check_local_user% is set.
18039 See %check_owner% above.
18042 oindex:[%owngroups%]
18044 %owngroups%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
18047 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by %file%. The
18048 list is in addition to the local user's primary group when %check_local_user%
18049 is set. See %check_group% above.
18052 oindex:[%pipe_transport%]
18054 %pipe_transport%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18057 A ^redirect^ router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string starting
18058 with a vertical bar character is specified as a new ``address''. The transport
18059 used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18060 configured transport.
18061 This should normally be a ^pipe^ transport.
18062 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in $address_pipe$.
18065 oindex:[%qualify_domain%]
18067 %qualify_domain%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18070 If this option is set and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18071 generated, it is qualified with the domain specified by expanding this string,
18072 instead of the global setting in %qualify_recipient%. If the expansion fails,
18073 the router declines. If you want to revert to the default, you can have the
18074 expansion generate $qualify_recipient$.
18077 oindex:[%qualify_preserve_domain%]
18079 %qualify_preserve_domain%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18082 cindex:[domain,in redirection; preserving]
18083 cindex:[preserving domain in redirection]
18084 cindex:[address redirection,domain; preserving]
18085 If this is set and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is generated,
18086 it is qualified with the domain of the
18087 parent address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the local
18088 %qualify_domain% or global %qualify_recipient% value.
18091 oindex:[%repeat_use%]
18093 %repeat_use%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
18096 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18097 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18098 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18099 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18100 %check_ancestor% above and the generic %redirect_router% option.
18103 oindex:[%reply_transport%]
18105 %reply_transport%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18108 A ^redirect^ router sets up an automatic reply when a %mail% or %vacation%
18109 command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified by this
18110 option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured transport.
18111 This should normally be an ^autoreply^ transport. Other transports are
18112 unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18117 %rewrite%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
18120 cindex:[address redirection,disabling rewriting]
18121 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18122 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18123 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18127 oindex:[%sieve_vacation_directory%]
18129 %sieve_vacation_directory%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18132 cindex:[Sieve filter,vacation directory]
18133 To enable the ``vacation'' extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18134 %sieve_vacation_directory% to the directory where vacation databases are held
18135 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18136 %reply_transport% option refers to an ^autoreply^ transport.
18141 oindex:[%skip_syntax_errors%]
18143 %skip_syntax_errors%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18146 cindex:[forward file,broken]
18147 cindex:[address redirection,broken files]
18148 cindex:[alias file,broken]
18149 cindex:[broken alias or forward files]
18150 cindex:[ignoring faulty addresses]
18151 cindex:[skipping faulty addresses]
18152 cindex:[error,skipping bad syntax]
18153 If %skip_syntax_errors% is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18154 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18155 %syntax_errors_to% is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18156 giving details of the failures. If %syntax_errors_text% is set, its contents
18157 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18158 %syntax_errors_to%. Usually it is appropriate to set %syntax_errors_to% to
18159 be the same address as the generic %errors_to% option. The
18160 %skip_syntax_errors% option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18162 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18163 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18164 the following routers.
18166 If %skip_syntax_errors% is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18167 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18168 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18169 so it is passed to the following routers.
18171 cindex:[Sieve filter,syntax errors in]
18172 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the ``keep'' action to occur. This
18173 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of %skip_syntax_errors%,
18174 %syntax_errors_to%, and %syntax_errors_text% are not used.
18176 %skip_syntax_errors% can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18177 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The %syntax_errors_to%
18178 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18179 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18186 file = $home/.forward
18187 file_transport = address_file
18188 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18189 reply_transport = address_reply
18192 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part\$domain
18193 syntax_errors_text = \
18194 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18195 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18196 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18197 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18198 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18199 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18200 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18201 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18202 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18203 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18206 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18207 `real-` are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18208 put this immediately before the ^userforward^ router:
18213 local_part_prefix = real-
18214 transport = local_delivery
18218 oindex:[%syntax_errors_text%]
18220 %syntax_errors_text%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18223 See %skip_syntax_errors% above.
18226 oindex:[%syntax_errors_to%]
18228 %syntax_errors_to%, Use: 'redirect', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
18231 See %skip_syntax_errors% above.
18238 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18239 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18241 [[CHAPenvironment]]
18242 [titleabbrev="Environment for local transports"]
18243 Environment for running local transports
18244 ----------------------------------------
18245 cindex:[local transports,environment for]
18246 cindex:[environment for local transports]
18247 cindex:[transport,local; environment for]
18248 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The ^autoreply^
18249 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18250 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18251 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18253 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18254 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The ^pipe^
18255 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18256 <<SECTpipeenv>> for details.
18258 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18259 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18260 settings with that address as a result of its %check_local_user%, %group%, or
18261 %user% options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18262 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18266 Concurrent deliveries
18267 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
18268 cindex:[concurrent deliveries]
18269 cindex:[simultaneous deliveries]
18270 If two different messages for the same local recpient arrive more or less
18271 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18272 the ^appendfile^ transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18273 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18276 However, when you use a ^pipe^ transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18277 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18281 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18283 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18284 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18285 %exim_lock% utility program (see section <<SECTmailboxmaint>>) to lock a file
18286 using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18294 cindex:[local transports,uid and gid]
18295 cindex:[transport,local; uid and gid]
18296 All transports have the options %group% and %user%. If %group% is set, it
18297 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if %user% is not
18298 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18299 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18300 group (set by the transport). For example:
18303 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18307 transport = group_delivery
18310 # This transport overrides the group
18312 driver = appendfile
18313 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18316 If %user% is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18317 address. If %user% is non-numeric and %group% is not set, the gid associated
18318 with the user is used. If %user% is numeric, %group% must be set.
18320 cindex:[%initgroups% option]
18321 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the 'initgroups()'
18322 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the %initgroups%
18323 option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified by the
18324 transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option for
18325 calling 'initgroups()' is taken from the router configuration.
18327 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,uid for]
18328 The ^pipe^ transport contains the special option %pipe_as_creator%. If this
18329 is set and %user% is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18330 receive the message is used, and if %group% is not set, the corresponding
18331 original gid is also used.
18335 Current and home directories
18336 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
18337 cindex:[current directory for local transport]
18338 cindex:[home directory,for local transport]
18339 cindex:[transport,local; home directory for]
18340 cindex:[transport,local; current directory for]
18341 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18342 the %transport_current_directory% and %transport_home_directory% options.
18343 However, if the transport's %current_directory% or %home_directory% options
18344 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18345 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18347 - The %home_directory% option on the transport;
18349 - The %transport_home_directory% option on the router;
18351 - The password data if %check_local_user% is set on the router;
18353 - The %router_home_directory% option on the router.
18355 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18357 - The %current_directory% option on the transport;
18359 - The %transport_current_directory% option on the router.
18362 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18363 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18364 directory to _/_ before running a local transport.
18368 Expansion variables derived from the address
18369 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
18370 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18371 variables such as $domain$ and $local_part$ are set during local
18372 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18373 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18374 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18375 never set, $domain$ is set only if all the addresses have the same
18376 domain, and $original_domain$ is never set.
18384 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18385 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18387 [[CHAPtransportgeneric]]
18388 Generic options for transports
18389 ------------------------------
18391 cindex:[generic options,transport]
18392 cindex:[options,generic; for transports]
18393 cindex:[transport,generic options for]
18394 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18397 oindex:[%body_only%]
18399 %body_only%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18402 cindex:[transport,body only]
18403 cindex:[message,transporting body only]
18404 cindex:[body of message,transporting]
18405 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18406 mutually exclusive with %headers_only%. If it is used with the ^appendfile^ or
18407 ^pipe^ transports, the settings of %message_prefix% and %message_suffix%
18408 should be checked, because this option does not automatically suppress them.
18411 oindex:[%current_directory%]
18413 %current_directory%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18416 cindex:[transport,current directory for]
18417 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18418 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18419 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18420 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18423 oindex:[%disable_logging%]
18425 %disable_logging%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18428 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18429 deliveries by the transport or for any
18430 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18431 what you are doing.
18434 oindex:[%debug_print%]
18436 %debug_print%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18439 cindex:[testing,variables in drivers]
18440 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the %-d% command line
18441 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18443 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18444 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18445 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18446 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a %headers_add%
18447 option is not working properly, %debug_print% could be used to output the
18448 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18452 oindex:[%delivery_date_add%]
18454 %delivery_date_add%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18457 cindex:['Delivery-date:' header line]
18458 If this option is true, a 'Delivery-date:' header is added to the message. This
18459 gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard header,
18460 Exim has a configuration option (%delivery_date_remove%) which requests its
18461 removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent
18462 to other recipients.
18467 %driver%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
18470 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18471 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18474 oindex:[%envelope_to_add%]
18476 %envelope_to_add%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18479 cindex:['Envelope-to:' header line]
18480 If this option is true, an 'Envelope-to:' header is added to the message. This
18481 gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18482 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18483 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18484 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18485 header, Exim has a configuration option (%envelope_to_remove%) which requests
18486 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18487 resent to other recipients.
18492 %group%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'Exim group'
18495 cindex:[transport,group; specifying]
18496 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18497 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18498 %user% (see below).
18501 oindex:[%headers_add%]
18503 %headers_add%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18506 cindex:[header lines,adding in transport]
18507 cindex:[transport,header lines; adding]
18508 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18509 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18510 <<SECTheadersaddrem>>. Additional header lines can also be specified by routers.
18511 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion is
18512 forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18513 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18517 oindex:[%headers_only%]
18519 %headers_only%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18522 cindex:[transport,header lines only]
18523 cindex:[message,transporting headers only]
18524 cindex:[header lines,transporting]
18525 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18526 exclusive with %body_only%. If it is used with the ^appendfile^ or ^pipe^
18527 transports, the settings of %message_prefix% and %message_suffix% should be
18528 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18531 oindex:[%headers_remove%]
18533 %headers_remove%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18536 cindex:[header lines,removing]
18537 cindex:[transport,header lines; removing]
18538 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18539 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18540 in section <<SECTheadersaddrem>>. Header removal can also be specified by
18541 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18542 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18543 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18547 oindex:[%headers_rewrite%]
18549 %headers_rewrite%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
18552 cindex:[transport,header lines; rewriting]
18553 cindex:[rewriting,at transport time]
18554 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18555 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18556 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18557 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18558 message is received. These are described in chapter <<CHAPrewrite>>. For example,
18561 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18565 changes %a@b% into %c@d% in 'From:' header lines, and %x@y% into %w@z% in
18566 all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the header lines
18567 just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect only those
18568 copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only the
18569 message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system filter,
18570 are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are
18571 not affected by this option. These rewriting rules are 'not' applied to the
18572 envelope. You can change the return path using %return_path%, but you cannot
18573 change envelope recipients at this time.
18576 oindex:[%home_directory%]
18578 %home_directory%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18581 cindex:[transport,home directory for]
18582 This option specifies a home directory setting for the transport, overriding
18583 any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is placed in
18584 $home$ while expanding the transport's private options. It is also used as
18585 the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18586 %current_directory% option on the transport or the
18587 %transport_current_directory% option on the router.
18588 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18589 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18592 oindex:[%initgroups%]
18594 %initgroups%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18597 cindex:[additional groups]
18598 cindex:[groups, additional]
18599 cindex:[transport,group; additional]
18600 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18601 transport, the 'initgroups()' function is called when running the transport
18602 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18605 oindex:[%message_size_limit%]
18607 %message_size_limit%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: '0'
18610 cindex:[limit,message size per transport]
18611 cindex:[size of message, limit]
18612 cindex:[transport,message size; limiting]
18613 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18614 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of digits,
18615 optionally followed by K or M.
18616 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, or if the
18617 result is not of the required form, delivery is deferred.
18618 If the value is greater than zero and the size of a message exceeds this
18619 limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that the resulting bounce
18620 message could be routed to the same transport, you should ensure that
18621 %return_size_limit% is less than the transport's %message_size_limit%, as
18622 otherwise the bounce message will fail to get delivered.
18626 oindex:[%rcpt_include_affixes%]
18628 %rcpt_include_affixes%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18631 cindex:[prefix,for local part; including in envelope]
18632 cindex:[suffix,for local part; including in envelope]
18633 cindex:[local part,prefix]
18634 cindex:[local part,suffix]
18635 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18636 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18637 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18640 local_part_prefix = *-
18642 routes the address 'abc-xyz@some.domain' to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18645 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18647 If %rcpt_include_affixes% is set true, the whole local part is included in
18648 the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP deliveries by the
18649 ^appendfile^ and ^pipe^ transports as well as to the ^lmtp^ and ^smtp^
18653 oindex:[%retry_use_local_part%]
18655 %retry_use_local_part%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'see below'
18658 cindex:[hints database,retry keys]
18659 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
18660 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
18661 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
18662 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
18663 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
18664 temporary failure -- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
18665 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
18667 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
18668 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
18669 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
18670 this by setting %retry_use_local_part% false.
18672 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
18673 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
18674 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
18677 oindex:[%return_path%]
18679 %return_path%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18682 cindex:[envelope sender]
18683 cindex:[transport,return path; changing]
18684 cindex:[return path,changing in transport]
18685 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
18686 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
18687 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
18688 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
18689 SMTP MAIL command. If you set %return_path% for a local transport, the
18690 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the 'Return-path:'
18691 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
18693 The expansion can refer to the existing value via $return_path$. This is
18694 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
18695 %errors_to% option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
18696 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
18697 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) -- see
18698 chapter <<CHAPSMTP>>.
18700 *Note*: If a delivery error is detected locally,
18701 including the case when a remote server rejects a message at SMTP time,
18702 the bounce message is not sent to the value of this option, but to the
18703 previously set errors address (which defaults to the incoming sender address).
18707 oindex:[%return_path_add%]
18709 %return_path_add%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
18712 cindex:['Return-path:' header line]
18713 If this option is true, a 'Return-path:' header is added to the message.
18714 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
18715 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
18716 have easy access to it.
18718 RFC 2821 states that the 'Return-path:' header is added to a message ``when the
18719 delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery''. This implies that this header
18720 should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration option,
18721 %return_path_remove%, which requests removal of this header from incoming
18722 messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other recipients.
18725 oindex:[%shadow_condition%]
18727 %shadow_condition%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18730 See %shadow_transport% below.
18733 oindex:[%shadow_transport%]
18735 %shadow_transport%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
18738 cindex:[shadow transport]
18739 cindex:[transport,shadow]
18740 A local transport may set the %shadow_transport% option to the name of another
18741 local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
18743 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
18744 %shadow_condition% is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
18745 string or one of the strings ``0'' or ``no'' or ``false'', the message is also passed
18746 to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses.
18747 If expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion
18748 failures cause a log line to be written.
18750 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
18751 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
18752 provided; the %shadow_transport% option is ignored on any transport when it is
18753 running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also ignored.
18755 The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the
18758 ST=<shadow transport name>
18760 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
18761 parentheses afterwards.
18763 Shadow transports can be used for a number of different purposes, including
18764 keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally provides, and
18765 implementing automatic acknowledgement policies based on message headers that
18766 some sites insist on.
18769 oindex:[%transport_filter%]
18771 %transport_filter%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
18774 cindex:[transport,filter]
18775 cindex:[filter,transport filter]
18776 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
18777 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
18778 individual users or via a system filter.
18780 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
18781 %transport_filter% is started up in a separate process, and the entire
18782 message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard input
18783 (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
18784 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
18786 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
18787 terminated by newline (``\n'').
18789 The message is passed to the filter before any SMTP-specific processing, such
18790 as turning ``\n'' into ``\r\n'' and escaping lines beginning with a dot, and
18791 also before any processing implied by the settings of %check_string% and
18792 %escape_string% in the ^appendfile^ or ^pipe^ transports.
18794 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
18795 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
18798 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
18799 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. A demonstration Perl script is provided in
18800 _util/transport-filter.pl_; this makes a few arbitrary modifications just to
18801 show the possibilities. Exim does not check the result, except to test for a
18802 final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over SMTP must end
18803 with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
18806 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
18807 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
18808 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
18809 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
18810 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
18811 the %size_addition% option on the ^smtp^ transport, either to allow for
18812 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
18814 The value of the %transport_filter% option is the command string for starting
18815 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
18816 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the ^pipe^ transport:
18817 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately. The
18818 special argument $pipe_addresses$ is replaced by a number of arguments, one
18819 for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't an ideal name for
18820 this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the ^pipe^
18821 transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
18824 cindex:[$host_address$]
18825 The expansion variables $host$ and $host_address$ are available when the
18826 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
18827 which the message is being sent. For example:
18830 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
18831 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
18834 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
18835 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default.
18837 The command should normally yield a zero return code. A non-zero code is taken
18838 to mean that the transport filter failed in some way. Delivery of the message
18839 is deferred. It is not possible to cause a message to be bounced from a
18843 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
18844 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
18845 message, which happens if the %return_message% option is set.
18848 oindex:[%transport_filter_timeout%]
18850 %transport_filter_timeout%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'time', Default: '5m'
18853 cindex:[transport filter, timeout]
18854 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
18855 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is treated as a
18856 temporary delivery failure.
18862 %user%, Use: 'transports', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'Exim user'
18865 cindex:[uid (user id),local delivery]
18866 cindex:[transport user, specifying]
18867 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
18868 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
18869 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
18870 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the %group%
18873 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
18874 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
18875 %check_local_user%) by the router or transport.
18877 cindex:[hints database,access by remote transport]
18878 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
18879 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
18880 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
18888 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18889 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18892 [titleabbrev="Address batching"]
18893 Address batching in local transports
18894 ------------------------------------
18895 cindex:[transport,local; address batching in]
18896 The only remote transport (^smtp^) is normally configured to handle more than
18897 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
18898 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
18899 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
18900 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
18901 copy of the message is delivered each time.
18903 cindex:[batched local delivery]
18904 cindex:[%batch_max%]
18905 cindex:[%batch_id%]
18906 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
18907 local transport, for example:
18909 - In an ^appendfile^ transport, when storing messages in files for later
18910 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
18911 recipients saves space.
18913 - In an ^lmtp^ transport, when delivering over ``local SMTP'' to some process,
18914 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
18916 - In a ^pipe^ transport, when passing the message
18917 to a scanner program or
18918 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
18921 The three local transports (^appendfile^, ^lmtp^, and ^pipe^) all have
18922 the same options for controlling multiple (``batched'') deliveries, namely
18923 %batch_max% and %batch_id%. To save repeating the information for each
18924 transport, these options are described here.
18926 The %batch_max% option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
18927 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one.
18928 When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a %batch_max%
18929 value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch (that is, in a
18930 single run of the transport), subject to certain conditions:
18932 - If any of the transport's options contain a reference to $local_part$, no
18933 batching is possible.
18935 - If any of the transport's options contain a reference to $domain$, only
18936 addresses with the same domain are batched.
18938 - cindex:[customizing,batching condition]
18939 If %batch_id% is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
18940 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
18941 customized batching conditions.
18942 Failure of the expansion for any reason, including forced failure, disables
18943 batching, but it does not stop the delivery from taking place.
18945 - Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
18946 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
18947 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
18950 cindex:['Envelope-to:' header line]
18951 If the generic %envelope_to_add% option is set for the transport, the
18952 'Envelope-to:' header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
18953 that are batched together.
18955 The ^appendfile^ and ^pipe^ transports have an option called %use_bsmtp%,
18956 which causes them to deliver the message in ``batched SMTP'' format, with the
18957 envelope represented as SMTP commands. The %check_string% and %escape_string%
18958 options are forced to the values
18961 escape_string = ".."
18963 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
18964 given in section <<SECTbatchSMTP>>. The ^lmtp^ transport does not have a
18965 %use_bsmtp% option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
18967 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,with multiple addresses]
18968 If you are not using BSMTP, but are using a ^pipe^ transport, you can include
18969 $pipe_addresses$ as part of the command. This is not a true variable; it is
18970 a bit of magic that causes each of the recipient addresses to be inserted into
18971 the command as a separate argument. This provides a way of accessing all the
18972 addresses that are being delivered in the batch.
18974 If you are using a batching ^appendfile^ transport without %use_bsmtp%, the
18975 only way to preserve the recipient addresses is to set the %envelope_to_add%
18976 option. This causes an 'Envelope-to:' header line to be added to the message,
18977 containing all the recipients.
18981 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18982 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18985 The appendfile transport
18986 ------------------------
18987 cindex:[^appendfile^ transport]
18988 cindex:[transports,^appendfile^]
18989 cindex:[directory creation]
18990 cindex:[creating directories]
18991 The ^appendfile^ transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
18992 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
18993 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
18994 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
18995 University of Washington IMAP daemon, 'inter alia'. When each message is
18996 being delivered as a separate file, ``maildir'' format can optionally be used to
18997 give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
18998 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as ``mailstore'' is also
18999 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19000 directory as necessary, provided that %create_directory% is set.
19002 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19003 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19004 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in _Local/Makefile_ to have the appropriate code
19007 cindex:[quota,system]
19008 Exim recognises system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19009 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19010 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19012 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19013 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19014 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19015 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19017 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19018 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19021 ^appendfile^ is most commonly used for local deliveries to users' mailboxes.
19022 However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for putting messages
19023 into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim. ``Batch SMTP''
19024 format is often used in this case (see the %use_bsmtp% option).
19029 The file and directory options
19030 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
19031 The %file% option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19032 the %directory% option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19033 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19034 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them 'must' be set.
19036 However, ^appendfile^ is also used for delivering messages to files or
19037 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19038 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a %save% command in a user's
19039 Exim filter). When such a transport is running, $local_part$ contains the
19040 local part that was aliased or forwarded, and $address_file$ contains the
19041 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19042 operation. There are two cases:
19044 - If neither %file% nor %directory% is set, the redirection operation
19045 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with `/`). This is the most
19046 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19047 different folders. See for example, the ^address_file^ transport in the
19048 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19049 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19050 %maildir_format% or %mailstore_format%.
19052 - If %file% or %directory% is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is used
19053 to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19054 contents of $address_file$ are used in some way in the string expansion.
19057 cindex:[Sieve filter,configuring ^appendfile^]
19058 cindex:[Sieve filter,relative mailbox path handling]
19059 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19060 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19065 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19067 require "fileinto";
19068 fileinto "folder23";
19070 In this situation, the expansion of %file% or %directory% in the transport must
19071 transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the case
19072 of Sieve filters, the name 'inbox' must be handled. It is the name that is
19073 used as a result of a ``keep'' action in the filter. This example shows one way
19074 of handling this requirement:
19077 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19078 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19079 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19081 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19086 With this setting of %file%, 'inbox' refers to the standard mailbox location,
19087 absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the _mail_
19088 directory within the home directory.
19090 *Note 1*: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19091 _folder23_ is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19092 the router. In particular, this is the case if %check_local_user% is set. If
19093 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19094 %router_home_directory% empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19095 path to the transport.
19097 *Note 2*: An absolute path in $address_file$ is not treated specially;
19098 the %file% or %directory% option is still used if it is set.
19103 Private options for appendfile
19104 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
19105 cindex:[options,^appendfile^ transport]
19109 oindex:[%allow_fifo%]
19111 %allow_fifo%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19114 cindex:[fifo (named pipe)]
19115 cindex:[named pipe (fifo)]
19116 cindex:[pipe,named (fifo)]
19117 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19118 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19119 delivery is deferred.
19122 oindex:[%allow_symlink%]
19124 %allow_symlink%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19127 cindex:[symbolic link,to mailbox]
19128 cindex:[mailbox,symbolic link]
19129 By default, ^appendfile^ will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19130 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19131 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19132 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19133 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19136 oindex:[%batch_id%]
19138 %batch_id%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19141 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter <<CHAPbatching>>.
19142 However, batching is automatically disabled for ^appendfile^ deliveries that
19143 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19147 oindex:[%batch_max%]
19149 %batch_max%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'integer', Default: '1'
19152 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter <<CHAPbatching>>.
19155 oindex:[%check_group%]
19157 %check_group%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19160 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the %file%
19161 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19162 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19163 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19166 oindex:[%check_owner%]
19168 %check_owner%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
19171 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the %file% option is
19172 checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19173 process is running.
19176 oindex:[%check_string%]
19178 %check_string%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string', Default: 'see below'
19181 cindex:[``From'' line]
19182 As ^appendfile^ writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19183 matching %check_string%, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19184 replaced by the contents of %escape_string%. The value of %check_string% is a
19185 literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19186 contains is significant.
19188 If %use_bsmtp% is set the values of %check_string% and %escape_string% are
19189 forced to ``.'' and ``..'' respectively, and any settings in the configuration are
19190 ignored. Otherwise, they default to ``From '' and ``>From '' when the %file% option
19191 is set, and unset when
19192 any of the %directory%, %maildir%, or %mailstore% options are set.
19194 The default settings, along with %message_prefix% and %message_suffix%, are
19195 suitable for traditional ``BSD'' mailboxes, where a line beginning with ``From
19196 '' indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing if
19197 another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19198 cindex:[MMDF format mailbox]
19199 cindex:[mailbox,MMDF format]
19201 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19202 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19203 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19204 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19206 oindex:[%create_directory%]
19208 %create_directory%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
19211 cindex:[directory creation]
19212 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19213 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19214 is given by the %directory_mode% option.
19216 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19217 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19218 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19219 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19220 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19224 oindex:[%create_file%]
19226 %create_file%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string', Default: 'anywhere'
19229 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19230 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the %file% option and
19231 directories defined by the %directory% option. In the case of maildir delivery,
19232 it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories beneath.
19234 The option must be set to one of the words ``anywhere'', ``inhome'', or
19235 ``belowhome''. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been set
19236 for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19237 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19238 names are generated from users' _.forward_ files. These are usually handled
19239 by an ^appendfile^ transport called %address_file%. See also
19243 oindex:[%directory%]
19245 %directory%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19248 This option is mutually exclusive with the %file% option, but one of %file% or
19249 %directory% must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19250 redirection (see section <<SECTfildiropt>>).
19252 When %directory% is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19253 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19254 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19255 (see %maildir_format% and %mailstore_format%), and see section <<SECTopdir>>
19256 for further details of this form of delivery.
19259 oindex:[%directory_file%]
19261 %directory_file%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: `q\$\{base62{co}\$tod_epoch\}-\$inode`
19265 When %directory% is set, but neither %maildir_format% nor %mailstore_format%
19266 is set, ^appendfile^ delivers each message into a file whose name is obtained
19267 by expanding this string. The default value generates a unique name from the
19268 current time, in base 62 form, and the inode of the file. The variable
19269 $inode$ is available only when expanding this option.
19272 oindex:[%directory_mode%]
19274 %directory_mode%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'octal integer', Default: '0700'
19277 If ^appendfile^ creates any directories as a result of the %create_directory%
19278 option, their mode is specified by this option.
19281 oindex:[%escape_string%]
19283 %escape_string%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string', Default: 'see description'
19286 See %check_string% above.
19291 %file%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19294 This option is mutually exclusive with the %directory% option, but one of
19295 %file% or %directory% must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of
19296 a redirection (see section <<SECTfildiropt>>). The %file% option specifies a
19297 single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19298 %use_fcntl_lock%, %use_flock_lock%, or %use_lockfile% must be set with
19301 cindex:[NFS,lock file]
19302 cindex:[locking files]
19303 cindex:[lock files]
19304 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19305 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19307 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19308 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19311 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19312 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19315 cindex:[``sticky'' bit]
19316 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19317 is configured to use lock files (see %use_lockfile% below) it must be able to
19318 create a file in the directory, so the ``sticky'' bit must be turned on for
19319 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the %group% option can be used to
19320 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19324 oindex:[%file_format%]
19326 %file_format%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
19329 cindex:[file,mailbox; checking existing format]
19330 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19331 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19332 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19333 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19334 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19335 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19336 transport. For example, suppose the standard ^local_delivery^ transport has
19340 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19341 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19344 Mailboxes that begin with ``From'' are still handled by this transport, but if a
19345 mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19346 to a transport called %local_mmdf_delivery%, which presumably is configured
19347 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19348 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19349 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19350 delivery is deferred.
19353 oindex:[%file_must_exist%]
19355 %file_must_exist%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19358 If this option is true, the file specified by the %file% option must exist, and
19359 an error occurs if it does not. Otherwise, it is created if it does not exist.
19362 oindex:[%lock_fcntl_timeout%]
19364 %lock_fcntl_timeout%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'time', Default: '0s'
19367 cindex:[timeout,mailbox locking]
19368 cindex:[mailbox locking,blocking and non-blocking]
19369 cindex:[locking files]
19370 By default, the ^appendfile^ transport uses non-blocking calls to 'fcntl()'
19371 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19372 sleeps for %lock_interval% and tries again, up to %lock_retries% times.
19373 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19374 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19375 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19376 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19377 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19379 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19380 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19381 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19382 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19384 If %lock_fcntl_timeout% is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19385 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19388 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19390 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19391 which ^appendfile^ is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19392 %lock_fcntl_timeout% is set very large.
19394 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19395 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19397 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19401 oindex:[%lock_flock_timeout%]
19403 %lock_flock_timeout%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'time', Default: '0s'
19406 This timeout applies to file locking when using 'flock()' (see %use_flock%);
19407 the timeout operates in a similar manner to %lock_fcntl_timeout%.
19410 oindex:[%lock_interval%]
19412 %lock_interval%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'time', Default: '3s'
19415 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19416 for details of locking.
19419 oindex:[%lock_retries%]
19421 %lock_retries%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'integer', Default: '10'
19424 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19425 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19428 oindex:[%lockfile_mode%]
19430 %lockfile_mode%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'octal integer', Default: '0600'
19433 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19434 used (see %use_lockfile%).
19437 oindex:[%lockfile_timeout%]
19439 %lockfile_timeout%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'time', Default: '30m'
19442 cindex:[timeout,mailbox locking]
19443 When a lock file is being used (see %use_lockfile%), if a lock file already
19444 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19445 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19448 oindex:[%mailbox_filecount%]
19450 %mailbox_filecount%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19453 cindex:[mailbox,specifying size of]
19454 cindex:[size,of mailbox]
19455 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19456 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19457 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19458 external source that maintains the data.
19461 oindex:[%mailbox_size%]
19463 %mailbox_size%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19466 cindex:[mailbox,specifying size of]
19467 cindex:[size,of mailbox]
19468 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19469 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19470 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19471 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19472 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19476 oindex:[%maildir_format%]
19478 %maildir_format%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19481 cindex:[maildir format,specifying]
19482 If this option is set with the %directory% option, the delivery is into a new
19483 file, in the ``maildir'' format that is used by other mail software. When the
19484 transport is activated directly from a ^redirect^ router (for example, the
19485 ^address_file^ transport in the default configuration), setting
19486 %maildir_format% causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19487 directory, whether or not it ends with `/`. This option is available only if
19488 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in _Local/Makefile_. See section
19489 <<SECTmaildirdelivery>> below for further details.
19492 oindex:[%maildir_quota_directory_regex%]
19494 %maildir_quota_directory_regex%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string', Default: 'See below'
19497 cindex:[maildir format,quota; directories included in]
19498 cindex:[quota,maildir; directories included in]
19499 This option is relevant only when %maildir_use_size_file% is set. It defines
19500 a regular expression for specifying directories that should be included in the
19501 quota calculation. The default value is
19503 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19505 which includes the _cur_ and _new_ directories, and any maildir++ folders
19506 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19508 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19510 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19512 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19513 directory whose name is _.Trash_.
19516 oindex:[%maildir_retries%]
19518 %maildir_retries%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'integer', Default: '10'
19521 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19522 ``maildir'' format. See section <<SECTmaildirdelivery>> below.
19525 oindex:[%maildir_tag%]
19527 %maildir_tag%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19530 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19531 section <<SECTmaildirdelivery>> below.
19534 oindex:[%maildir_use_size_file%]
19536 %maildir_use_size_file%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19539 cindex:[maildir format,_maildirsize_ file]
19540 Setting this option true enables support for _maildirsize_ files. Exim
19541 creates a _maildirsize_ file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19542 quota from the %quota% option of the transport. If %quota% is unset, the value
19543 is zero. See section <<SECTmaildirdelivery>> below for further details.
19546 oindex:[%mailstore_format%]
19548 %mailstore_format%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19551 cindex:[mailstore format,specifying]
19552 If this option is set with the %directory% option, the delivery is into two new
19553 files in ``mailstore'' format. The option is available only if
19554 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in _Local/Makefile_. See section
19555 <<SECTopdir>> below for further details.
19558 oindex:[%mailstore_prefix%]
19560 %mailstore_prefix%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19563 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19564 section <<SECTopdir>> below.
19567 oindex:[%mailstore_suffix%]
19569 %mailstore_suffix%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19572 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19573 section <<SECTopdir>> below.
19576 oindex:[%mbx_format%]
19578 %mbx_format%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19581 cindex:[locking files]
19582 cindex:[file,locking]
19583 cindex:[file,MBX format]
19584 cindex:[MBX format, specifying]
19585 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19586 set in _Local/Makefile_. If %mbx_format% is set with the %file% option,
19587 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19588 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19589 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the 'c-client' library that they all use.
19591 *Note*: The %message_prefix% and %message_suffix% options are not
19592 automatically changed by the use of %mbx_format%. They should normally be set
19593 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19601 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19602 %use_mbx_lock% is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19603 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with %mbx_format%, but
19604 %use_fcntl_lock% and %use_mbx_lock% are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19605 interworks with 'c-client', providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19606 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19607 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19608 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19610 If you set %use_fcntl_lock% with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19611 the standard version of 'c-client', because as long as it has a mailbox open
19612 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19613 append messages to it.
19616 oindex:[%message_prefix%]
19618 %message_prefix%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
19621 cindex:[``From'' line]
19622 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19623 The default is unset unless %file% is specified and %use_bsmtp% is not set, in
19627 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19628 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19633 oindex:[%message_suffix%]
19635 %message_suffix%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
19638 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19639 The default is unset unless %file% is specified and %use_bsmtp% is not set, in
19640 which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19649 %mode%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'octal integer', Default: '0600'
19652 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19653 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19654 permissions, an error occurs unless %mode_fail_narrower% is false. However,
19655 if the delivery is the result of a %save% command in a filter file specifing a
19656 particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19657 value, and this option is ignored.
19660 oindex:[%mode_fail_narrower%]
19662 %mode_fail_narrower%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
19665 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19666 mode than that specified by the %mode% option. If %mode_fail_narrower% is
19667 true, the delivery is deferred (``mailbox has the wrong mode''); otherwise Exim
19668 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19671 oindex:[%notify_comsat%]
19673 %notify_comsat%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19676 If this option is true, the 'comsat' daemon is notified after every successful
19677 delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged on users
19678 about incoming mail.
19683 %quota%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19686 cindex:[quota,imposed by Exim]
19687 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19688 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the %directory% option is
19689 set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19690 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19691 individually inspected and their sizes summed.
19692 (See %quota_size_regex% and %maildir_use_size_file% for ways to avoid this
19693 in environments where users have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19695 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19696 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19697 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19699 A file's size is taken as its 'used' value. Because of blocking effects, this
19700 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19701 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19702 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19703 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the 'used' figure, because this is
19704 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19706 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19707 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K or M. The
19708 expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for the
19709 delivery. This means that files which are inaccessible to the end user can be
19710 used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19711 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19712 system quota failures.
19714 *Note*: A value of zero is interpreted as ``no quota''.
19716 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19717 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19718 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19719 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19720 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19721 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19722 changed by setting %quota_is_inclusive% false. When this is done, the check
19723 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19724 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19725 delivered. See also %quota_warn_threshold%.
19728 oindex:[%quota_directory%]
19730 %quota_directory%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
19733 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19734 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19735 called _maildirfolder_ exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19736 delivery directory.
19739 oindex:[%quota_filecount%]
19741 %quota_filecount%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: '0'
19744 This option applies when the %directory% option is set. It limits the total
19745 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19746 can only be used if %quota% is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19747 failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19750 oindex:[%quota_is_inclusive%]
19752 %quota_is_inclusive%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
19758 oindex:[%quota_size_regex%]
19760 %quota_size_regex%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
19763 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19764 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19765 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks %quota_size_regex%.
19766 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19767 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19768 file's size. The value of %quota_size_regex% is not expanded.
19770 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19771 -- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19772 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting %maildir_tag% to add
19773 the file length to the file name. For example:
19775 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19776 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19778 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
19779 file name (even though %maildir_tag% puts it there) because maildir MUAs
19780 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
19783 oindex:[%quota_warn_message%]
19785 %quota_warn_message%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
19788 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
19789 %quota_warn_threshold% is set, it defaults to
19792 quota_warn_message = "\
19793 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
19794 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
19795 This message is automatically created \
19796 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
19797 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
19798 a warning threshold that is\n\
19799 set by the system administrator.\n"
19804 oindex:[%quota_warn_threshold%]
19806 %quota_warn_threshold%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'string'!!, Default: '0'
19809 cindex:[quota,warning threshold]
19810 cindex:[mailbox,size warning]
19811 cindex:[size,of mailbox]
19812 This option is expanded in the same way as %quota% (see above). If the
19813 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
19814 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
19815 threshold, a warning message is sent. If %quota% is also set, the threshold may
19816 be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent sign.
19820 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
19822 If %quota% is not set, a setting of %quota_warn_threshold% that ends with a
19823 percent sign is ignored.
19825 The warning message itself is specified by the %quota_warn_message% option,
19826 and it must start with a 'To:' header line containing the recipient(s). A
19827 'Subject:' line should also normally be supplied. The %quota% option does not
19828 have to be set in order to use this option; they are independent of one
19829 another except when the threshold is specified as a percentage.
19832 oindex:[%use_bsmtp%]
19834 %use_bsmtp%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19837 cindex:[envelope sender]
19838 If this option is set true, ^appendfile^ writes messages in ``batch SMTP''
19839 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
19840 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
19841 so by setting the %message_prefix% option. See section <<SECTbatchSMTP>> for
19842 details of batch SMTP.
19845 oindex:[%use_crlf%]
19847 %use_crlf%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19850 cindex:[carriage return]
19852 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
19853 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
19854 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
19855 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
19857 The contents of the %message_prefix% and %message_suffix% options are written
19858 verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these are
19859 needed. In cases where these options have non-empty defaults, the values end
19860 with a single linefeed, so they
19862 be changed to end with `\r\n` if %use_crlf% is set.
19865 oindex:[%use_fcntl_lock%]
19867 %use_fcntl_lock%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'see below'
19870 This option controls the use of the 'fcntl()' function to lock a file for
19871 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
19872 %use_flock_lock% is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
19873 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both %use_fcntl_lock% and
19874 %use_flock_lock% are unset, %use_lockfile% must be set.
19877 oindex:[%use_flock_lock%]
19879 %use_flock_lock%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
19882 This option is provided to support the use of 'flock()' for file locking, for
19883 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
19884 'fcntl()' and 'lockf()' locking, and these two functions interwork with
19885 each other. Exim uses 'fcntl()' locking by default.
19887 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
19888 'flock()' is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
19889 where 'flock()' does not correctly interwork with 'fcntl()'. You can use
19890 both 'fcntl()' and 'flock()' locking simultaneously if you want.
19892 cindex:[Solaris,'flock()' support]
19893 Not all operating systems provide 'flock()'. Some versions of Solaris do not
19894 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
19895 'lockf()'). If the OS does not have 'flock()', Exim will be built without
19896 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
19899 *Warning*: 'flock()' locks do not work on NFS files (unless 'flock()'
19900 is just being mapped onto 'fcntl()' by the OS).
19903 oindex:[%use_lockfile%]
19905 %use_lockfile%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'see below'
19908 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
19909 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
19910 'fcntl()'. You should only turn %use_lockfile% off if you are absolutely
19911 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
19912 'fcntl()' rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
19913 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
19915 cindex:[NFS,lock file]
19916 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
19917 necessary to take out a lock 'before' opening the file, and the lock file
19918 achieves this. Otherwise, even with 'fcntl()' locking, there is a risk of
19921 The %use_lockfile% option is set by default unless %use_mbx_lock% is set. It
19922 is not possible to turn both %use_lockfile% and %use_fcntl_lock% off, except
19923 when %mbx_format% is set.
19926 oindex:[%use_mbx_lock%]
19928 %use_mbx_lock%, Use: 'appendfile', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'see below'
19931 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19932 set in _Local/Makefile_. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
19933 locking rules be used. It is set by default if %mbx_format% is set and none of
19934 the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules are
19935 the same as are used by the 'c-client' library that underlies Pine and the
19936 IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The rules
19937 allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking does not
19938 work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
19940 You can set %use_mbx_lock% with either (or both) of %use_fcntl_lock% and
19941 %use_flock_lock% to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
19942 MBX locking rules. The default is to use 'fcntl()' if %use_mbx_lock% is set
19943 without %use_fcntl_lock% or %use_flock_lock%.
19949 Operational details for appending
19950 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
19951 cindex:[appending to a file]
19952 cindex:[file,appending]
19953 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
19955 - If the name of the file is _/dev/null_, no action is taken, and a success
19958 - cindex:[directory creation]
19959 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
19960 %create_directory% option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
19961 %directory_mode% option.
19963 - If %file_format% is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
19964 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
19967 - cindex:[file,locking]
19968 cindex:[locking files]
19969 cindex:[NFS,lock file]
19970 If %use_lockfile% is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
19971 reliably over NFS, as follows:
19974 . Create a ``hitching post'' file whose name is that of the lock file with the
19975 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
19976 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
19978 . Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
19980 . If the call to 'link()' succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
19981 Unlink the hitching post name.
19983 . Otherwise, use 'stat()' to get information about the hitching post file, and
19984 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
19985 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
19986 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the 'link()' call.
19988 . If creation of the lock file failed, wait for %lock_interval% and try again,
19989 up to %lock_retries% times. However, since any program that writes to a
19990 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
19991 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
19992 existing lock file is older than %lockfile_timeout% Exim attempts to unlink it
19993 before trying again.
19996 - A call is made to 'lstat()' to discover whether the main file exists, and if
19997 so, what its characteristics are. If 'lstat()' fails for any reason other
19998 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20000 - cindex:[symbolic link,to mailbox]
20001 cindex:[mailbox,symbolic link]
20002 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20003 %allow_symlink% option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20004 checked, and then 'stat()' is called to find out about the real file, which
20005 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20006 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20007 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20008 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20011 - If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20012 and group (if the group is being checked -- see %check_group% above) are
20013 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20014 delivery is deferred.
20016 - If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20017 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless %mode_fail_narrower%
20018 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20021 - The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20022 If this fails because the file has vanished, ^appendfile^ behaves as if it
20023 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20025 - If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20026 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20027 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20029 - If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the %file_must_exist%
20030 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20031 directory if the %create_file% option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20032 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20033 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the %allow_symlink% option must be
20034 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20035 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20036 that prevents link following.
20038 - cindex:[loop,while file testing]
20039 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20040 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20041 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20042 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20044 - If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20046 - cindex:[file,locking]
20047 cindex:[locking files]
20048 Once the file is open, unless both %use_fcntl_lock% and %use_flock_lock%
20049 are false, it is locked using 'fcntl()' or 'flock()' or both. If
20050 %use_mbx_lock% is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20051 However, if %use_mbx_lock% is true,
20052 Exim takes out a shared lock on the open file,
20053 and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20055 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20057 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20058 the MBX locking rules.
20060 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20061 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20062 %lock_fcntl_timeout% or %lock_flock_timeout%, as appropriate.
20064 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20065 %lock_interval%, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20066 to lock it again. This happens up to %lock_retries% times, after which the
20067 delivery is deferred.
20069 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to 'fcntl()' or
20070 'flock()' are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20071 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20072 immediately. It retries up to
20074 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20076 times (rounded up).
20079 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the 'fcntl()'
20080 and/or 'flock()' locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20084 Operational details for delivery to a new file
20085 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20086 cindex:[delivery,to single file]
20087 cindex:[``From'' line]
20088 When the %directory% option is set instead of %file%, each message is delivered
20089 into a newly-created file or set of files. When ^appendfile^ is activated
20090 directly from a ^redirect^ router, neither %file% nor %directory% is normally
20091 set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the router. (See for example,
20092 the ^address_file^ transport in the default configuration.) In this case,
20093 delivery is to a new file if either the path name ends in `/`, or the
20094 %maildir_format% or %mailstore_format% option is set.
20096 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20097 locking options of the transport are ignored. The ``From'' line that by default
20098 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20099 of message lines that start with ``From'', and there is no need to ensure a
20100 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20101 %check_string%, %message_prefix%, and %message_suffix% are all unset when
20102 any of %directory%, %maildir_format%, or %mailstore_format% is set.
20104 If Exim is required to check a %quota% setting, it adds up the sizes of all the
20105 files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20106 different directory by setting %quota_directory%. Also, for maildir deliveries
20107 (see below) the _maildirfolder_ convention is honoured.
20110 cindex:[maildir format]
20111 cindex:[mailstore format]
20112 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20113 done, controlled by the settings of the %maildir_format% and
20114 %mailstore_format% options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20115 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20116 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in _Local/Makefile_.
20118 cindex:[directory creation]
20119 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20120 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the %create_directory%
20121 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20122 constrained by setting %create_file%. A created directory's mode is given by
20123 the %directory_mode% option. If creation fails, or if the %create_directory%
20124 option is not set when creation is required, delivery is deferred.
20128 [[SECTmaildirdelivery]]
20131 cindex:[maildir format,description of]
20132 If the %maildir_format% option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20133 it to a file whose name is _tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_ in the
20134 given directory. If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20135 _new_ subdirectory.
20137 In the file name, <'stime'> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20138 <'mtime'> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20139 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20140 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20141 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls 'stat()' for the file before
20142 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20143 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to %maildir_retries% times.
20145 cindex:[quota,in maildir delivery]
20147 If Exim is required to check a %quota% setting before a maildir delivery, and
20148 %quota_directory% is not set, it looks for a file called _maildirfolder_ in
20149 the maildir directory (alongside _new_, _cur_, _tmp_). If this exists,
20150 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20151 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20152 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20153 amount of space used.
20155 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20156 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20157 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20158 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20159 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20160 of the %mailbox_size% option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20165 Using tags to record message sizes
20166 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20167 If %maildir_tag% is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20168 When the maildir file is renamed into the _new_ sub-directory, the
20169 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20170 name to the point where the test 'stat()' call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20171 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20173 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20174 %quota_size_regex% above for an example. The expansion of %maildir_tag%
20175 happens after the message has been written. The value of the $message_size$
20176 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20177 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20178 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except ``/''.
20179 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20180 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20185 Using a maildirsize file
20186 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20187 cindex:[quota,in maildir delivery]
20188 cindex:[maildir format,_maildirsize_ file]
20189 If %maildir_use_size_file% is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20190 storing quota and message size information in a file called _maildirsize_
20191 within the maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim creates it,
20192 setting the quota from the %quota% option of the transport. If the maildir
20193 directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt to write a
20194 _maildirsize_ file.
20196 The _maildirsize_ file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20197 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20198 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20199 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20200 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20201 need to know the quota.
20203 If the %quota% option in the transport is unset or zero, the _maildirsize_
20204 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20206 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20207 maildir participate in quota calculations. See the description of the
20208 %maildir_quota_directory_regex% option above for details.
20214 cindex:[mailstore format,description of]
20215 If the %mailstore_format% option is true, each message is written as two files
20216 in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the message id
20217 and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use this base
20218 name plus the suffixes _.env_ and _.msg_. The _.env_ file contains the
20219 message's envelope, and the _.msg_ file contains the message itself.
20221 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20222 _.tmp_. The _.msg_ file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20223 _.tmp_ file is renamed as the _.env_ file. Programs that access messages in
20224 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a _.msg_ and a _.env_
20225 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20226 the absence of a _.tmp_ file.
20228 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the %mailstore_prefix%
20229 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20230 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20231 There can be more than one recipient only if the %batch_max% option is set
20232 greater than one. Finally, %mailstore_suffix% is expanded and the result
20233 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20235 If expansion of %mailstore_prefix% or %mailstore_suffix% ends with a forced
20236 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20237 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred.
20241 Non-special new file delivery
20242 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20243 If neither %maildir_format% nor %mailstore_format% is set, a single new file
20244 is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20245 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20246 section <<SECTbatchSMTP>>), a setting such as
20248 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20250 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20251 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20252 expanding the contents of the %directory_file% option.
20259 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20260 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20262 The autoreply transport
20263 -----------------------
20264 cindex:[transports,^autoreply^]
20265 cindex:[^autoreply^ transport]
20266 The ^autoreply^ transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20267 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message.
20269 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20270 %unseen% option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20271 delivered anywhere. However, when the %unseen% option is set on the router that
20272 passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20273 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20276 The ^autoreply^ transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20277 ``vacation'' message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20278 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20279 message cascades, messages created by the ^autoreply^ transport always have
20280 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20282 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20283 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20284 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20285 transport is run as a consequence of a
20287 or %vacation% command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20288 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20289 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20290 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20291 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the %file_optional%,
20292 %mode%, and %return_message% options apply in all cases.
20294 ^Autoreply^ is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20295 command in a user's filter file, ^autoreply^ normally runs under the uid and
20296 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20297 <<CHAPenvironment>>).
20299 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a ^pipe^ transport
20300 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20301 ^autoreply^ transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20302 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20303 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20304 the sender in a single message, whereas if ^autoreply^ is used, a separate
20305 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20307 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20308 message that ^autoreply^ creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20309 immediately followed by whitespace. If any non-printing characters are found,
20310 the transport defers.
20311 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20312 controlled by the %print_topbitchars% global option.
20314 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20315 %headers_add%) are set on an ^autoreply^ transport, they apply to the copy of
20316 the original message that is included in the generated message when
20317 %return_message% is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20319 If the ^autoreply^ transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20320 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20321 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to $sender_address$ when this
20322 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20323 problems. They are just discarded.
20327 Private options for autoreply
20328 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20329 cindex:[options,^autoreply^ transport]
20333 %bcc%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20336 This specifies the addresses that are to receive ``blind carbon copies'' of the
20337 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20342 %cc%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20345 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the 'Cc:' header
20346 when the message is specified by the transport.
20351 %file%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20354 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20355 is specified by the transport. If both %file% and %text% are set, the text
20356 string comes first.
20359 oindex:[%file_expand%]
20361 %file_expand%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
20364 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the %file% option are
20365 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20368 oindex:[%file_optional%]
20370 %file_optional%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
20373 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the %file%
20374 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20379 %from%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20382 This specifies the contents of the 'From:' header when the message is specified
20388 %headers%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20391 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message when
20392 the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using ``\n''
20393 to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20398 %log%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20401 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20402 the message is specified by the transport.
20407 %mode%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'octal integer', Default: '0600'
20410 If either the log file or the ``once'' file has to be created, this mode is used.
20413 oindex:[%never_mail%]
20415 %never_mail%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'address list'!!, Default: 'unset'
20418 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20419 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20420 discarded, no message is created.
20426 %once%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20429 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each
20430 'To:' recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport.
20431 *Note*: This does not apply to 'Cc:' or 'Bcc:' recipients.
20432 If %once_file_size% is not set, a DBM database is used, and it is allowed to
20433 grow as large as necessary. If a potential recipient is already in the
20434 database, no message is sent by default. However, if %once_repeat% specifies a
20435 time greater than zero, the message is sent if that much time has elapsed since
20436 a message was last sent to this recipient. If %once% is unset, the message is
20439 If %once_file_size% is set greater than zero, it changes the way Exim
20440 implements the %once% option. Instead of using a DBM file to record every
20441 recipient it sends to, it uses a regular file, whose size will never get larger
20442 than the given value. In the file, it keeps a linear list of recipient
20443 addresses and times at which they were sent messages. If the file is full when
20444 a new address needs to be added, the oldest address is dropped. If
20445 %once_repeat% is not set, this means that a given recipient may receive
20446 multiple messages, but at unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of
20447 turnover of addresses in the file. If %once_repeat% is set, it specifies a
20448 maximum time between repeats.
20451 oindex:[%once_file_size%]
20453 %once_file_size%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'integer', Default: '0'
20459 oindex:[%once_repeat%]
20461 %once_repeat%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'time'!!, Default: '0s'
20465 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20468 oindex:[%reply_to%]
20470 %reply_to%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20473 This specifies the contents of the 'Reply-To:' header when the message is
20474 specified by the transport.
20477 oindex:[%return_message%]
20479 %return_message%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
20482 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20483 message, subject to the maximum size set in the %return_size_limit% global
20484 configuration option.
20489 %subject%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20492 This specifies the contents of the 'Subject:' header when the message is
20493 specified by the transport.
20495 It is tempting to quote the original subject in automatic responses. For
20498 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20500 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20501 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20502 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20503 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20510 %text%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20513 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20514 message is specified by the transport. If both %text% and %file% are set, the
20520 %to%, Use: 'autoreply', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20523 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the 'To:' header
20524 when the message is specified by the transport.
20529 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20530 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20535 cindex:[transports,^lmtp^]
20536 cindex:[^lmtp^ transport]
20537 cindex:[LMTP,over a pipe]
20538 cindex:[LMTP,over a socket]
20539 The ^lmtp^ transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20541 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20542 This transport is something of a cross between the ^pipe^ and ^smtp^
20543 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20544 implemented as an option for the ^smtp^ transport. Because LMTP is expected
20545 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in _src/EDITME_
20546 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20550 is present in your _Local/Makefile_ in order to have the ^lmtp^ transport
20551 included in the Exim binary.
20553 cindex:[options,^lmtp^ transport]
20554 The private options of the ^lmtp^ transport are as follows:
20556 oindex:[%batch_id%]
20558 %batch_id%, Use: 'lmtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20561 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter <<CHAPbatching>>.
20564 oindex:[%batch_max%]
20566 %batch_max%, Use: 'lmtp', Type: 'integer', Default: '1'
20569 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20570 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20571 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20572 batching in chapter <<CHAPbatching>>.
20577 %command%, Use: 'lmtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20580 This option must be set if %socket% is not set.
20581 The string is a command which is run in a separate process. It is split up into
20582 a command name and list of arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so
20583 expansion cannot change the number of arguments). The command is run directly,
20584 not via a shell. The message is passed to the new process using the standard
20585 input and output to operate the LMTP protocol.
20590 %socket%, Use: 'lmtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20593 This option must be set if %command% is not set. The result of expansion must
20594 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20595 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20600 %timeout%, Use: 'lmtp', Type: 'time', Default: '5m'
20603 The transport is aborted if the created process
20604 or Unix domain socket
20605 does not respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout.
20608 Here is an example of a typical LMTP transport:
20612 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20616 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20617 necessary, running as the user 'exim'.
20621 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20622 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20624 [[CHAPpipetransport]]
20627 cindex:[transports,^pipe^]
20628 cindex:[^pipe^ transport]
20629 The ^pipe^ transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20630 running in another process.
20633 use of ^pipe^ as a pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other
20634 delivery mechanism (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to
20635 automatically process their incoming messages. The ^pipe^ transport can be
20636 used in one of the following ways:
20638 - A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the transport
20639 is configured as a ^pipe^ transport. In this case, $local_part$ contains
20640 the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run is
20641 specified by the %command% option on the transport.
20643 - If the %batch_max% option is set greater than 1 (the default), the transport
20644 can be called upon to handle more than one address in a single run. In this
20645 case, $local_part$ is not set (because it is not unique). However, the
20646 pseudo-variable $pipe_addresses$ (described in section <<SECThowcommandrun>>
20647 below) contains all the addresses that are being handled.
20649 - A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20650 alias or forward file). In this case, $local_part$ contains the local part
20651 that was redirected, and $address_pipe$ contains the text of the pipe
20652 command itself. The %command% option on the transport is ignored.
20655 The ^pipe^ transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20656 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20657 implemented by the ^lmtp^ transport.
20659 In the case when ^pipe^ is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20660 _.forward_ file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20661 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20662 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and ``home''
20663 directories are also controllable. See chapter <<CHAPenvironment>> for details of
20664 the local delivery environment.
20668 Concurrent delivery
20669 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20670 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20671 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20672 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20673 write to a file, the %exim_lock% utility might be of use.
20678 Returned status and data
20679 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20680 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,returned data]
20681 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20682 have failed, unless either the %ignore_status% option is set (in which case
20683 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20684 in the %temp_errors% option, which are interpreted as meaning ``try again
20685 later''. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20686 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20687 ``local delivery failed''.
20689 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20690 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20691 value is the return code minus 128.
20693 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if 'execve()' fails), the
20694 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20695 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20696 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20698 The %return_output% option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20699 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20700 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20701 return code or if %ignore_status% is set. The output from the command is
20702 included as part of the bounce message. The %return_fail_output% option is
20703 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20704 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20709 [[SECThowcommandrun]]
20710 How the command is run
20711 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20712 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,path for command]
20713 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20714 by the ^pipe^ transport itself. The %allow_commands% and %restrict_to_path%
20715 options can be used to restrict the commands that may be run.
20717 cindex:[quoting,in pipe command]
20718 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20719 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20720 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20722 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20723 traditional _.forward_ file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20724 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20725 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20726 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20728 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xxx}{yyy}}
20730 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20731 arguments. You have to write
20733 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xxx}{yyy}}"
20735 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20736 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20737 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20738 interact with external quoting.
20740 cindex:[transport,filter]
20741 cindex:[filter,transport filter]
20742 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20743 `\$pipe_addresses\}`. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20744 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20745 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20746 inserted in the argument list at that point 'as a separate argument'. This
20747 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20748 ^pipe^ transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20750 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20751 in a subprocess directly from the transport, 'not' under a shell. The
20752 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20753 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20754 read by Exim. The %max_output% option controls how much output the command may
20755 produce, and the %return_output% and %return_fail_output% options control
20756 what is done with it.
20758 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20759 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20760 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20761 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20762 where existing commands (for example, in _.forward_ files) expect to be run
20763 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20764 an option called %use_shell%, which changes the way the ^pipe^ transport
20765 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20766 as a single string and passes the result to _/bin/sh_. The
20767 %restrict_to_path% option and the $pipe_addresses$ facility cannot be used
20768 with %use_shell%, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20773 Environment variables
20774 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20775 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,environment for command]
20776 cindex:[environment for pipe transport]
20777 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20778 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20779 the %environment% option can be used to add additional variables to this
20783 `DOMAIN ` the domain of the address
20784 `HOME ` the home directory, if set
20785 `HOST ` the host name when called from a router (see below)
20786 `LOCAL_PART ` see below
20787 `LOCAL_PART_PREFIX ` see below
20788 `LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX ` see below
20789 `LOGNAME ` see below
20790 `MESSAGE_ID ` the message's id
20791 `PATH ` as specified by the %path% option below
20792 `QUALIFY_DOMAIN ` the sender qualification domain
20793 `RECIPIENT ` the complete recipient address
20794 `SENDER ` the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20796 `TZ ` the value of the %timezone% option, if set
20800 When a ^pipe^ transport is called directly from (for example) an ^accept^
20801 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20802 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20803 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20804 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20805 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20806 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20809 HOST is set only when a ^pipe^ transport is called from a router that
20810 associates hosts with an address, typically when using ^pipe^ as a
20811 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20815 If the transport's generic %home_directory% option is set, its value is used
20816 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20817 by the router's %transport_home_directory% option, which defaults to the
20818 user's home directory if %check_local_user% is set.
20821 Private options for pipe
20822 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
20823 cindex:[options,^pipe^ transport]
20827 oindex:[%allow_commands%]
20829 %allow_commands%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string list'!!, Default: 'unset'
20832 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,permitted commands]
20833 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20834 permitted commands. If %restrict_to_path% is not set, the only commands
20835 permitted are those in the %allow_commands% list. They need not be absolute
20836 paths; the %path% option is still used for relative paths. If
20837 %restrict_to_path% is set with %allow_commands%, the command must either be
20838 in the %allow_commands% list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
20839 the path. In other words, if neither %allow_commands% nor %restrict_to_path%
20840 is set, there is no restriction on the command, but otherwise only commands
20841 that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For example, if
20843 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
20845 and %restrict_to_path% is not set, the only permitted command is
20846 _/usr/bin/vacation_. The %allow_commands% option may not be set if
20847 %use_shell% is set.
20850 oindex:[%batch_id%]
20852 %batch_id%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20855 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter <<CHAPbatching>>.
20858 oindex:[%batch_max%]
20860 %batch_max%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'integer', Default: '1'
20863 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20864 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter <<CHAPbatching>>.
20867 oindex:[%check_string%]
20869 %check_string%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
20872 As ^pipe^ writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
20873 %check_string%, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
20874 by the contents of %escape_string%, provided both are set. The value of
20875 %check_string% is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
20876 any letters it contains is significant. When %use_bsmtp% is set, the contents
20877 of %check_string% and %escape_string% are forced to values that implement the
20878 SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
20884 %command%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20887 This option need not be set when ^pipe^ is being used to deliver to pipes
20888 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
20889 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
20890 the %path% option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
20891 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
20892 <<SECThowcommandrun>> above.
20895 oindex:[%environment%]
20897 %environment%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
20900 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,environment for command]
20901 cindex:[environment for ^pipe^ transport]
20902 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
20903 command runs (see section <<SECTpipeenv>> for the default list). Its value is a
20904 string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20905 environment settings of the form ``<''name'>=<'value'>'.
20908 oindex:[%escape_string%]
20910 %escape_string%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
20913 See %check_string% above.
20916 oindex:[%freeze_exec_fail%]
20918 %freeze_exec_fail%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
20921 cindex:[exec failure]
20922 cindex:[failure of exec]
20923 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,failure of exec]
20924 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
20925 any other failure while running the command. However, if %freeze_exec_fail%
20926 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
20927 frozen, whatever the setting of %ignore_status%.
20930 oindex:[%ignore_status%]
20932 %ignore_status%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
20935 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
20936 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
20937 Otherwise, a non-zero status
20938 or termination by signal
20939 causes an error return from the transport unless the status value is one of
20940 those listed in %temp_errors%; these cause the delivery to be deferred and
20944 oindex:[%log_defer_output%]
20946 %log_defer_output%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
20949 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,logging output]
20950 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
20951 one of the codes listed in %temp_errors% (that is, delivery was deferred),
20952 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
20955 oindex:[%log_fail_output%]
20957 %log_fail_output%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
20960 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
20961 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
20962 %temp_errors% (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
20963 written to the main log.
20965 This option and %log_output% are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be
20970 oindex:[%log_output%]
20972 %log_output%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
20975 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
20976 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code.
20978 This option and %log_fail_output% are mutually exclusive. Only one of them
20983 oindex:[%max_output%]
20985 %max_output%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'integer', Default: '20K'
20988 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
20989 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
20990 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
20991 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
20992 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
20993 %return_output%). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
20994 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
20997 oindex:[%message_prefix%]
20999 %message_prefix%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
21002 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21003 The default is unset if %use_bsmtp% is set. Otherwise it is
21007 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21013 cindex:[``From'' line]
21014 This is required by the commonly used _/usr/bin/vacation_ program.
21015 However, it must 'not' be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21016 or to the %tmail% local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by setting
21022 oindex:[%message_suffix%]
21024 %message_suffix%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
21027 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21028 The default is unset if %use_bsmtp% is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21029 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21037 %path%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string', Default: `/usr/bin`
21040 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21041 variable of the subprocess. If the %command% option does not yield an absolute
21042 path name, the command is sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way.
21043 *Warning*: This does not apply to a command specified as a transport
21047 oindex:[%pipe_as_creator%]
21049 %pipe_as_creator%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21052 cindex:[uid (user id),local delivery]
21053 If the generic %user% option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21054 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21055 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21056 %group% option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21057 accept the message is used.
21060 oindex:[%restrict_to_path%]
21062 %restrict_to_path%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21065 When this option is set, any command name not listed in %allow_commands% must
21066 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21067 in the %path% option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21068 command has been generated from a user's _.forward_ file. This is usually
21069 handled by a ^pipe^ transport called %address_pipe%.
21072 oindex:[%return_fail_output%]
21074 %return_fail_output%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21077 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21078 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in %temp_errors% (that
21079 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21080 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21081 message), output from the command is discarded.
21083 This option and %return_output% are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
21088 oindex:[%return_output%]
21090 %return_output%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21093 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21094 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21095 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21096 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21097 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21100 This option and %return_fail_output% are mutually exclusive. Only one of them
21105 oindex:[%temp_errors%]
21107 %temp_errors%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'string list', Default: 'see below'
21110 cindex:[^pipe^ transport,temporary failure]
21111 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21112 asterisk. If %ignore_status% is false
21113 and %return_output% is not set,
21114 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21115 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21116 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21117 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21118 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in _sysexits.h_. If Exim is
21119 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21120 and 73, respectively.
21125 %timeout%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'time', Default: '1h'
21128 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21129 causes the delivery to fail. A zero time interval specifies no timeout. In
21130 order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the command are also killed,
21131 Exim makes the initial process a process group leader, and kills the whole
21132 process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated if one of the
21133 processes starts a new process group.
21138 %umask%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'octal integer', Default: '022'
21141 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21144 oindex:[%use_bsmtp%]
21146 %use_bsmtp%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21149 cindex:[envelope sender]
21150 If this option is set true, the ^pipe^ transport writes messages in ``batch
21151 SMTP'' format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21152 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21153 you can do so by setting the %message_prefix% option. See section
21154 <<SECTbatchSMTP>> for details of batch SMTP.
21157 oindex:[%use_crlf%]
21159 %use_crlf%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21162 cindex:[carriage return]
21164 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21165 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21166 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21167 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21169 The contents of the %message_prefix% and %message_suffix% options are written
21170 verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these are
21171 needed. Since the default values for both %message_prefix% and
21172 %message_suffix% end with a single linefeed, their values
21174 be changed to end with `\r\n` if %use_crlf% is set.
21177 oindex:[%use_shell%]
21179 %use_shell%, Use: 'pipe', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21182 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to _/bin/sh_
21183 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21184 <<SECThowcommandrun>>. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21185 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21186 modified. The %allow_commands% and %restrict_to_path% options, and the
21187 `\$pipe_addresses` facility are incompatible with %use_shell%. The
21188 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to _/bin/sh_ as data for
21193 Using an external local delivery agent
21194 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
21195 cindex:[local delivery,using an external agent]
21196 cindex:['procmail']
21197 cindex:[external local delivery]
21198 cindex:[delivery,'procmail']
21199 cindex:[delivery,by external agent]
21200 The ^pipe^ transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21201 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as %procmail%. When doing
21202 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21203 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21204 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21205 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21206 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21207 configuration for %procmail%:
21212 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21216 check_string = "From "
21217 escape_string = ">From "
21225 transport = procmail_pipe
21228 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21229 'mail'. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as 'mail'
21230 or 'exim', but in this case you must arrange for %procmail% to trust that
21231 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a %group%
21232 or a %user% option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The home
21233 directory is the user's home directory by default.
21235 Note that the command that the pipe transport runs does 'not' begin with
21239 as shown in the %procmail% documentation, because Exim does not by default use
21240 a shell to run pipe commands.
21243 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21244 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21248 local_delivery_cyrus:
21250 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21251 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21263 local_part_suffix = .*
21264 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21267 Note the unsetting of %message_prefix% and %message_suffix%, and the use of
21268 %return_output% to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21272 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21273 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21278 cindex:[transports,^smtp^]
21279 cindex:[^smtp^ transport]
21280 The ^smtp^ transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21281 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21282 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21283 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21284 <<CHAPretry>>) is applied to each IP address independently.
21287 Multiple messages on a single connection
21288 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
21289 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21292 - If a message contains more than %max_rcpt% (see below) addresses that are
21293 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21294 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21295 the ^smtp^ transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually does
21296 when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the value
21297 of the global %remote_max_parallel% option. Details are given in section
21298 <<SECToutSMTPTCP>>.)
21300 - cindex:[hints database,remembering routing]
21301 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21302 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21303 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21304 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21305 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21309 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21310 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of %connection_max_messages%,
21311 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21315 Use of the \$host variable
21316 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
21318 cindex:[$host_address$]
21319 At the start of a run of the ^smtp^ transport, the values of $host$ and
21320 $host_address$ are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21321 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21322 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, $host$ and
21323 $host_address$ are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21324 that are in force when the %helo_data%, %hosts_try_auth%, %interface%,
21325 %serialize_hosts%, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21329 Private options for smtp
21330 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
21331 cindex:[options,^smtp^ transport]
21332 The private options of the ^smtp^ transport are as follows:
21335 oindex:[%allow_localhost%]
21337 %allow_localhost%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21340 cindex:[local host,sending to]
21341 cindex:[fallback,hosts specified on transport]
21342 When a host specified in %hosts% or %fallback_hosts% (see below) turns out to
21343 be the local host, or is listed in %hosts_treat_as_local%, delivery is
21344 deferred by default. However, if %allow_localhost% is set, Exim goes on to do
21345 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21346 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21347 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21350 oindex:[%authenticated_sender%]
21352 %authenticated_sender%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
21356 When Exim has authenticated as a client, this option sets a value for the
21357 AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, overriding any existing
21358 authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is forced to fail, the
21359 option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery to be deferred. If
21360 the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also ignored.
21362 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21363 %authenticated_sender% still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21364 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands.
21366 This option allows you to use the ^smtp^ transport in LMTP mode to
21367 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21368 ``authenticated sender'', via a setting such as:
21370 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21372 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21373 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21375 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21376 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21380 oindex:[%command_timeout%]
21382 %command_timeout%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'time', Default: '5m'
21385 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21386 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21387 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21390 oindex:[%connect_timeout%]
21392 %connect_timeout%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'time', Default: '5m'
21395 This sets a timeout for the 'connect()' function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21396 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21397 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21398 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21399 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21400 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21403 oindex:[%connection_max_messages%]
21405 %connection_max_messages%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'integer', Default: '500'
21408 cindex:[SMTP,passed connection]
21409 cindex:[SMTP,multiple deliveries]
21410 cindex:[multiple SMTP deliveries]
21411 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21412 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21413 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the %-oB% command line
21417 oindex:[%data_timeout%]
21419 %data_timeout%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'time', Default: '5m'
21422 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21423 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21424 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also %final_timeout%.
21427 oindex:[%delay_after_cutoff%]
21429 %delay_after_cutoff%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
21432 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21433 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21436 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21437 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21438 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21439 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21440 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21441 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21443 If %delay_after_cutoff% is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21444 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21445 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21446 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21447 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21448 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21449 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21450 %delay_after_cutoff% means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21454 oindex:[%dns_qualify_single%]
21456 %dns_qualify_single%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
21459 If the %hosts% or %fallback_hosts% option is being used,
21460 and the %gethostbyname% option is false,
21461 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the %qualify_single% option
21462 in chapter <<CHAPdnslookup>> for more details.
21465 oindex:[%dns_search_parents%]
21467 %dns_search_parents%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21470 cindex:[%search_parents%]
21471 If the %hosts% or %fallback_hosts% option is being used, and the
21472 %gethostbyname% option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21473 See the %search_parents% option in chapter <<CHAPdnslookup>> for more details.
21477 oindex:[%fallback_hosts%]
21479 %fallback_hosts%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string list', Default: 'unset'
21482 cindex:[fallback,hosts specified on transport]
21483 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21484 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. Fallback hosts can also be
21485 specified on routers, which associate them with the addresses they process. As
21486 for the %hosts% option without %hosts_override%, %fallback_hosts% specified
21487 on the transport is used only if the address does not have its own associated
21488 fallback host list. Unlike %hosts%, a setting of %fallback_hosts% on an
21489 address is not overridden by %hosts_override%. However, %hosts_randomize%
21490 does apply to fallback host lists.
21492 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21493 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21494 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21495 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21496 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21498 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21499 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21500 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and %max_rcpt% permits it), a single
21501 copy of the message is sent.
21503 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21504 %gethostbyname% option, as for the %hosts% option. Fallback hosts apply
21505 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21506 from %hosts%. This option provides a ``use a smart host only if delivery fails''
21510 oindex:[%final_timeout%]
21512 %final_timeout%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'time', Default: '10m'
21515 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21516 line containing just ``.'' that terminates a message. Its value must not be zero.
21519 oindex:[%gethostbyname%]
21521 %gethostbyname%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21524 If this option is true when the %hosts% and/or %fallback_hosts% options are
21525 being used, names are looked up using 'gethostbyname()'
21526 (or 'getipnodebyname()' when available)
21527 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21528 it may also consult other sources of information such as _/etc/hosts_.
21530 oindex:[%helo_data%]
21532 %helo_data%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: `\$primary_hostname`
21535 cindex:[HELO argument, setting]
21536 cindex:[EHLO argument, setting]
21537 The value of this option is expanded, and used as the argument for the EHLO
21538 or HELO command that starts the outgoing SMTP session.
21543 %hosts%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21546 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as ^dnslookup^, which
21547 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS. However, addresses
21548 can be passed to the ^smtp^ transport by any router, and not all of them can
21549 provide an associated host list. The %hosts% option specifies a list of hosts
21550 which are used if the address being processed does not have any hosts
21551 associated with it. The hosts specified by %hosts% are also used, whether or
21552 not the address has its own hosts, if %hosts_override% is set.
21554 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21555 list of host names or IP addresses. If the expansion fails, delivery is
21556 deferred. Unless the failure was caused by the inability to complete a lookup,
21557 the error is logged to the panic log as well as the main log. Host names are
21558 looked up either by searching directly for address records in the DNS or by
21559 calling 'gethostbyname()'
21560 (or 'getipnodebyname()' when available),
21561 depending on the setting of the %gethostbyname% option. When Exim is compiled
21562 with IPv6 support, if a host that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and
21563 IPv6 addresses, both types of address are used.
21565 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21566 unless %hosts_randomize% is set.
21569 oindex:[%hosts_avoid_esmtp%]
21571 %hosts_avoid_esmtp%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21574 cindex:[ESMTP, avoiding use of]
21575 cindex:[HELO,forcing use of]
21576 cindex:[EHLO,avoiding use of]
21577 cindex:[PIPELINING,avoiding the use of]
21578 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21579 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21580 matches %hosts_avoid_esmtp%, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21581 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21582 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21585 oindex:[%hosts_avoid_tls%]
21587 %hosts_avoid_tls%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21590 cindex:[TLS,avoiding for certain hosts]
21591 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21592 matches this list. See chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for details of TLS.
21595 oindex:[%hosts_max_try%]
21597 %hosts_max_try%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'integer', Default: '5'
21600 cindex:[host,maximum number to try]
21601 cindex:[limit,number of hosts tried]
21602 cindex:[limit,number of MX tried]
21603 cindex:[MX record,maximum tried]
21604 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21605 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21606 <<SECTvalhosmax>> describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21609 oindex:[%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%]
21611 %hosts_max_try_hardlimit%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'integer', Default: '50'
21614 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21615 tries for any one delivery. Section <<SECTvalhosmax>> describes its use and why
21620 oindex:[%hosts_nopass_tls%]
21622 %hosts_nopass_tls%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21625 cindex:[TLS,passing connection]
21626 cindex:[multiple SMTP deliveries]
21627 cindex:[TLS,multiple message deliveries]
21628 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21629 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21630 message on the same connection. See section <<SECTmulmessam>> for an explanation
21631 of when this might be needed.
21634 oindex:[%hosts_override%]
21636 %hosts_override%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21639 If this option is set and the %hosts% option is also set, any hosts that are
21640 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21641 %hosts% option are always used. This option does not apply to
21645 oindex:[%hosts_randomize%]
21647 %hosts_randomize%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'false'
21650 cindex:[randomized host list]
21651 cindex:[host,list of; randomized]
21652 cindex:[fallback,randomized hosts]
21653 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21654 %hosts% or the %fallback_hosts% option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21655 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21656 router), and were not randomizied by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21657 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21658 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21660 When %hosts_randomize% is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21661 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21662 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21663 `+` in the host list. For example:
21665 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21667 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21668 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21669 If %hosts_randomize% is not set, a `+` item in the list is ignored.
21671 oindex:[%hosts_require_auth%]
21673 %hosts_require_auth%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21676 cindex:[authentication,required by client]
21677 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21678 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21679 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21680 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21681 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21682 hard failure if required. See also %hosts_try_auth%, and chapter
21683 <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>> for details of authentication.
21686 oindex:[%hosts_require_tls%]
21688 %hosts_require_tls%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21691 cindex:[TLS,requiring for certain servers]
21692 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21693 matches this list. See chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for details of TLS.
21694 *Note*: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21695 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21697 oindex:[%hosts_try_auth%]
21699 %hosts_try_auth%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21702 cindex:[authentication,optional in client]
21703 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21704 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21705 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21706 unauthenticated. See also %hosts_require_auth%, and chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>
21707 for details of authentication.
21709 oindex:[%interface%]
21711 %interface%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21714 cindex:[bind IP address]
21715 cindex:[IP address,binding]
21716 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21717 call. The variables $host$ and $host_address$ refer to the host to which a
21718 connection is about to be made during the expansion of the string. Forced
21719 expansion failure, or an empty string result causes the option to be ignored.
21720 Otherwise, after expansion,
21721 the string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21722 separator can be changed in the usual way.
21725 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21727 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21728 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21729 %interface% is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21730 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21733 oindex:[%keepalive%]
21735 %keepalive%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
21738 cindex:[keepalive,on outgoing connection]
21739 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21740 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21741 periodically, by sending packets with ``old'' sequence numbers. The other end of
21742 the connection should send a acknowledgement if the connection is still okay or
21743 a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is that
21744 it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection that can
21745 get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the TCP/IP
21746 call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21750 oindex:[%max_rcpt%]
21752 %max_rcpt%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'integer', Default: '100'
21755 cindex:[RCPT,maximum number of outgoing]
21756 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21757 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21758 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if %remote_max_parallel%
21762 oindex:[%multi_domain%]
21764 %multi_domain%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
21767 When this option is set, the ^smtp^ transport can handle a number of addresses
21768 containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve to the same
21769 list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to handling only
21770 one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use $domain$ in an
21771 expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there is a single
21772 domain involved in a remote delivery.
21777 %port%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'see below'
21780 cindex:[port,sending TCP/IP]
21781 cindex:[TCP/IP,setting outgoing port]
21782 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects. If
21783 it begins with a digit it is taken as a port number; otherwise it is looked up
21784 using 'getservbyname()'. The default value is normally ``smtp'', but if
21785 %protocol% is set to ``lmtp'', the default is ``lmtp''.
21786 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery is
21791 oindex:[%protocol%]
21793 %protocol%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string', Default: 'smtp'
21796 cindex:[LMTP,over TCP/IP]
21797 If this option is set to ``lmtp'' instead of ``smtp'', the default value for the
21798 %port% option changes to ``lmtp'', and the transport operates the LMTP protocol
21799 (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21800 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21801 over a pipe to a local process -- see chapter <<CHAPLMTP>>.
21804 oindex:[%retry_include_ip_address%]
21806 %retry_include_ip_address%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
21809 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21810 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21811 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21812 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21813 addresses is not affected.
21815 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21816 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21817 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21818 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21819 instance of the ^smtp^ transport, set up specially to handle the dialup hosts.
21822 oindex:[%serialize_hosts%]
21824 %serialize_hosts%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'host list'!!, Default: 'unset'
21827 cindex:[serializing connections]
21828 cindex:[host,serializing connections]
21829 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21830 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21831 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21832 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21833 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21834 %serialize_hosts% to match the relevant hosts.
21836 cindex:[hints database,serializing deliveries to a host]
21837 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21838 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21839 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21840 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21841 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21843 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21844 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21845 start with _misc_ and they are kept in the _spool/db_ directory. There
21846 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21847 are used for ETRN serialization.
21850 oindex:[%size_addition%]
21852 %size_addition%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'integer', Default: '1024'
21856 cindex:[message,size issue for transport filter]
21857 cindex:[size,of message]
21858 cindex:[transport,filter]
21859 cindex:[filter,transport filter]
21860 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21861 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21862 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of %size_addition% to the value it
21863 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21864 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21865 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21867 Alternatively, if the value of %size_addition% is set negative, it disables
21868 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21871 oindex:[%tls_certificate%]
21873 %tls_certificate%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
21876 cindex:[TLS client certificate, location of]
21877 cindex:[certificate for client, location of]
21878 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21879 client's certificate, for use when sending a message over an encrypted
21880 connection. The values of $host$ and $host_address$ are set to the name
21881 and address of the server during the expansion. See chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for
21884 *Note*: This option must be set if you want Exim to use TLS when sending
21885 messages as a client. The global option of the same name specifies the
21886 certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically assumed that the same
21887 certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a client.
21892 %tls_crl%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
21895 cindex:[TLS,client certificate revocation list]
21896 cindex:[certificate,revocation list for client]
21897 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21898 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21901 oindex:[%tls_privatekey%]
21903 %tls_privatekey%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
21906 cindex:[TLS client private key, location of]
21907 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21908 client's private key, for use when sending a message over an encrypted
21909 connection. The values of $host$ and $host_address$ are set to the name
21910 and address of the server during the expansion.
21911 If this option is unset, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21913 See chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for details of TLS.
21916 oindex:[%tls_require_ciphers%]
21918 %tls_require_ciphers%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
21921 cindex:[TLS,requiring specific ciphers]
21922 cindex:[cipher,requiring specific]
21923 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21924 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21925 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of $host$ and
21926 $host_address$ are set to the name and address of the server during the
21927 expansion. See chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for details of TLS; note that this option is
21928 used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections <<SECTreqciphssl>>
21929 and <<SECTreqciphgnu>>). For GnuTLS, the order of the ciphers is a preference
21934 oindex:[%tls_tempfail_tryclear%]
21936 %tls_tempfail_tryclear%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'boolean', Default: 'true'
21939 When the server host is not in %hosts_require_tls%, and there is a problem in
21940 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21941 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21942 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21943 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4##'xx'
21944 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21945 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21946 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21950 oindex:[%tls_verify_certificates%]
21952 %tls_verify_certificates%, Use: 'smtp', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
21955 cindex:[TLS,server certificate verification]
21956 cindex:[certificate,verification of server]
21957 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
21958 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
21959 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
21960 %tls_verify_certificates% to the name of a directory containing certificate
21961 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
21962 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of $host$ and
21963 $host_address$ are set to the name and address of the server during the
21964 expansion of this option. See chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for details of TLS.
21970 How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used
21971 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
21972 cindex:[host,maximum number to try]
21973 cindex:[limit,hosts; maximum number tried]
21974 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
21975 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are %hosts_max_try% and
21976 %hosts_max_try_hardlimit%.
21979 The %hosts_max_try% option limits the number of hosts that are tried
21980 for a single delivery. However, despite the term ``host'' in its name, the option
21981 actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a multihomed
21982 host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for retrying.
21984 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
21985 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
21986 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
21988 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
21989 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
21990 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
21991 %hosts_max_try% is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
21992 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
21994 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
21995 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
21996 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
21997 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
21998 %hosts_max_retry% may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
21999 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22000 see below for an exception).
22002 Secondly, when the %hosts_max_try% limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22003 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22004 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22005 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22006 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22008 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22009 higher MX value. If %hosts_max_try% is small (the default is 5) only a few
22010 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22011 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22012 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22013 reached their retry times.
22015 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22016 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22017 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22018 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22019 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22020 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried
22022 until all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days),
22023 because there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry
22024 times. With the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each
22025 MX value at every delivery attempt, even if the %hosts_max_try% limit has
22026 already been reached.
22028 The above logic means that %hosts_max_try% is not a hard limit, and in
22029 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22030 out an email address. When %hosts_max_try% was implemented, this seemed a
22031 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22032 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22033 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22035 The %hosts_max_try_hardlimit% option was added to help with this problem.
22036 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22037 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22038 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22044 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22045 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22050 cindex:[rewriting,addresses]
22051 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22052 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22053 (referred to as an ``unqualified address'') or when an address contains an
22054 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22056 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22057 messages, or messages from hosts that match %sender_unqualified_hosts% or
22058 %recipient_unqualified_hosts%, respectively. Unqualified addresses in header
22059 lines are qualified if they are in locally submitted messages, or messages from
22060 hosts that are permitted to send unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise,
22061 unqualified addresses in header lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22063 One situation in which Exim does 'not' automatically rewrite a domain is
22064 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22065 such a domain should be rewritten using the ``canonical'' name, and some MTAs do
22066 this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22069 Explicitly configured address rewriting
22070 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22071 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22072 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22073 %headers_rewrite% option that can be set on any transport.
22075 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22076 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22077 facility; you do not have to use it.
22079 The main rewriting rules that appear in the ``rewrite'' section of the
22080 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22081 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22082 address to which it applies.
22084 Rewriting of addresses in header lines applies only to those headers that
22085 were received with the message, and, in the case of transport rewriting, those
22086 that were added by a system filter. That is, it applies only to those headers
22087 that are common to all copies of the message. Header lines that are added by
22088 individual routers or transports (and which are therefore specific to
22089 individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten.
22091 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22092 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22093 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22094 used sparingly, and mainly for ``regularizing'' addresses in your own domains.
22095 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22098 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22099 illustrated by these examples:
22101 - The company whose domain is 'hitch.fict.example' has a number of hosts that
22102 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22103 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites '*.hitch.fict.example' as
22104 'hitch.fict.example' when sending mail off-site.
22106 - A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22107 'fp42@hitch.fict.example' becomes 'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'.
22111 When does rewriting happen?
22112 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22113 cindex:[rewriting,timing of]
22114 cindex:[{ACL},rewriting addresses in]
22115 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22116 message's processing.
22118 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22119 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section <<SECTrewriteS>>), but no
22120 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22121 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22122 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of $sender_address$ is the
22123 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22124 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22125 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22127 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22128 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22129 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22130 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22131 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22132 value of $local_part$ and $domain$ after verification are always the same
22133 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten -- except for
22134 SMTP-time rewriting -- address).
22136 Once a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope recipient
22137 addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to the
22138 addresses in the header lines (if configured).
22139 cindex:['local_scan()' function,address rewriting; timing of]
22140 Thus, all the rewriting is completed before the DATA ACL and
22141 'local_scan()' functions are run.
22143 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22144 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22145 redirection, unless %no_rewrite% is set on the router.
22147 cindex:[envelope sender, rewriting]
22148 cindex:[rewriting,at transport time]
22149 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22150 specified by setting the generic %headers_rewrite% option on a transport. This
22151 option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22152 section of the configuration file. In addition, the outgoing envelope sender
22153 can be rewritten by means of the %return_path% transport option. However, it
22154 is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at transport time.
22159 Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input
22160 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22161 cindex:[rewriting,testing]
22162 cindex:[testing,rewriting]
22163 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22164 configuration file headed by ``begin rewrite''. It can be tested by the %-brw%
22165 command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC 2822
22166 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22167 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22168 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22169 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22171 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22173 might produce the output
22175 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22176 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22177 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22178 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22179 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22180 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22181 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22182 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22184 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22185 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22186 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22187 set for a particular transport.
22192 cindex:[rewriting,rules]
22193 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22196 <source pattern> <replacement> <flags>
22198 Rewriting rules that are specified for the %headers_rewrite% generic transport
22199 option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list takes the
22200 same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration
22201 (except that any colons must be doubled, of course).
22203 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22204 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22205 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22206 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22209 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22210 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22211 replaced by later rules (but see the ``q'' and ``R'' flags).
22213 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22214 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22215 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22216 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22217 address in 'To:' must not assume that the message's address in 'From:' has (or
22218 has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of 'From:' may assume that
22219 the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22221 The variables $local_part$ and $domain$ can be used in the replacement
22222 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22223 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22227 where the lookup key uses $1$ and $2$ or $local_part$ and $domain$ to
22228 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22233 cindex:[rewriting,patterns]
22234 cindex:[address list,in a rewriting pattern]
22235 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22236 address list (see section <<SECTaddresslist>>). It is in fact processed as a
22237 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22238 against the address.
22240 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22241 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22242 can use a regular expression that starts with `^(?i)`.
22244 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in rewriting rules]
22245 After matching, the numerical variables $1$, $2$, etc. may be set,
22246 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22247 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. $0$ always
22248 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22249 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22250 of pattern they are set as follows:
22252 - If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22253 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with $1$ associated with
22254 the first asterisk, and $2$ with the second, if present. For example, if the
22257 *queen@*.fict.example
22259 is matched against the address 'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example' then
22261 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22265 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22266 does, it is $1$ that contains the wild part of the domain.
22268 - If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22269 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22270 for example, that the address 'foo@bar.baz.example' is processed by a
22271 rewriting rule of the form
22273 *@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file <replacement string>
22275 and the key in the file that matches the domain is `*.baz.example`. Then
22281 If the address 'foo@baz.example' is looked up, this matches the same
22282 wildcard file entry, and in this case $2$ is set to the empty string, but
22283 $3$ is still set to 'baz.example'. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22284 partial lookup, $2$ is again set to the empty string and $3$ is set to the
22285 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22289 Rewriting replacements
22290 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22291 cindex:[rewriting,replacements]
22292 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22293 match the pattern and the flags are 'not' rewritten, and no subsequent
22294 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22296 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22298 specifies that 'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example' is never to be rewritten in
22301 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22302 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22303 $local_part$ and $domain$ refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22304 Any letters they contain retain their original case -- they are not lower
22305 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22306 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22307 the presence of ``fail'' in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22308 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22309 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22310 entry written to the panic log.
22316 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22318 - Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22321 - A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22323 - Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22325 For rules that are part of the %headers_rewrite% generic transport option,
22326 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22330 Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite
22331 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22332 cindex:[rewriting,flags]
22333 If none of the following flag letters, nor the ``S'' flag (see section
22334 <<SECTrewriteS>>) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers and
22335 to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22336 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22337 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22340 `E` rewrite all envelope fields
22341 `F` rewrite the envelope From field
22342 `T` rewrite the envelope To field
22343 `b` rewrite the 'Bcc:' header
22344 `c` rewrite the 'Cc:' header
22345 `f` rewrite the 'From:' header
22346 `h` rewrite all headers
22347 `r` rewrite the 'Reply-To:' header
22348 `s` rewrite the 'Sender:' header
22349 `t` rewrite the 'To:' header
22352 You should be particularly careful about rewriting 'Sender:' headers, and
22353 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22357 The SMTP-time rewriting flag
22358 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22359 cindex:[SMTP,rewriting malformed addresses]
22360 cindex:[RCPT,rewriting argument of]
22361 cindex:[MAIL,rewriting argument of]
22362 The rewrite flag ``S'' specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at SMTP
22363 time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22364 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22365 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22366 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22368 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22369 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, ``bang paths'' in batched SMTP
22370 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22371 the variables $local_part$ and $domain$ are not available during the
22372 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22373 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22376 Flags controlling the rewriting process
22377 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22378 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22379 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22380 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22382 - If the ``Q'' flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22383 unqualified local part. It is qualified with %qualify_recipient%. In the
22384 absence of ``Q'' the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22386 - If the ``q'' flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22387 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a ``fail'' in the expansion.
22388 The ``q'' flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type (does not
22389 match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22391 - The ``R'' flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22392 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the ``q'' flag, to stop
22393 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22395 - cindex:[rewriting,whole addresses]
22396 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22397 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 ``phrase''
22398 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22400 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22404 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22406 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22407 done by adding the flag letter ``w'' to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22408 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22409 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22410 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22411 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22412 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047.
22413 The character set is taken from %headers_charset%, which defaults to
22416 When the ``w'' flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22417 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22423 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22426 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22427 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22428 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22431 Note the use of ``fail'' in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22432 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22433 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22434 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the ``q'' flag is not
22435 present in that rule. An alternative to ``fail'' would be to supply $1$
22436 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22437 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22438 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22440 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22441 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22443 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22445 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22446 local part 'root' at any domain ending in 'hitch.fict.example'.
22448 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22449 $\{if$ in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22450 messages that originate outside the local host:
22453 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22454 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22457 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22460 cindex:[rewriting,bang paths]
22461 cindex:[bang paths,rewriting]
22462 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of ``bang paths''. If it sees such an
22463 address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with the
22464 local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22465 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22466 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22467 components. For example, the rule
22469 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22471 rewrites a two-component bang path 'host.name!user' as the domain address
22472 'user@host.name'. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22473 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22474 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22475 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22476 use the ``S'' flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22477 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22483 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22484 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22487 Retry configuration
22488 -------------------
22489 cindex:[retry configuration, description of]
22490 cindex:[configuration file,retry section]
22491 The ``retry'' section of the run time configuration file contains a list of retry
22492 rules which control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot be
22493 delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules, temporary errors
22494 are treated as permanent. The %-brt% command line option can be used to test
22495 which retry rule will be used for a given address or domain.
22497 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22498 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22499 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22500 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22501 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22502 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the %retry_defer% log
22503 selector is set, the message
22504 cindex:[retry,time not reached]
22505 ``retry time not reached'' is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22506 skipped for this reason. Section <<SECToutSMTPerr>> contains more details of the
22507 handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22509 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22510 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22511 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22512 failures to route the domain 'snark.fict.example' and failures to deliver to
22513 the host 'snark.fict.example'. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22514 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22515 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22516 domain are maintained independently.
22518 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22519 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22520 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22521 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22522 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22523 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22524 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22525 the local address is reached.
22531 cindex:[retry,rules]
22532 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22533 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22534 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22535 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched in
22536 order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22537 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22538 message's sender, respectively.
22541 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22542 <<SECTaddresslist>>). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list, which
22543 means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that has
22544 been delayed. Address list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were
22545 preceded by ``\*@'', which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with
22546 just a domain. For example,
22548 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22550 provides a rule for any address in the 'lookingglass.fict.example' domain,
22553 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22555 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part %alice%.
22556 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22559 cindex:[regular expressions,in retry rules]
22560 *Warning*: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22561 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22562 expressions work in address lists.
22565 `\^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example\\$\N \* G,1h,10m,2` %Wrong%
22566 `\^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example\\$\N \* G,1h,10m,2` %Right%
22571 Choosing which retry rule to use
22572 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22573 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22574 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22575 against the complete address only if %retry_use_local_part% is set for the
22576 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22577 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with ``\*''.
22578 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22579 ``\*@''. By default, %retry_use_local_part% is true for routers where
22580 %check_local_user% is true, and false for other routers.
22582 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22583 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22584 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22585 %retry_use_local_part% is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22588 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt has
22589 failed, what happens depends on the type of failure. After a 4##'xx' SMTP
22590 response for a recipient address, the whole address is used when searching the
22591 retry rules. The rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the
22594 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address,
22595 (for example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is
22596 checked twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name
22597 (preceded by ``\*@'' when matching a regular expression). If this does not match
22598 the line, the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For
22599 example, suppose the MX records for 'a.b.c.example' are
22601 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22605 and the retry rules are
22607 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22608 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22610 and a delivery to the host 'x.y.z.example' fails. The first rule matches
22611 neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second rule. This does
22612 not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used to calculate
22613 the retry time for the host 'x.y.z.example'. Meanwhile, Exim tries to deliver
22614 to 'p.q.r.example'. If this fails, the first retry rule is used, because it
22617 In other words, failures to deliver to host 'p.q.r.example' use the first
22618 rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22619 'a.b.c.example', the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22620 routing to 'a.b.c.example' suffers a temporary failure.
22623 Retry rules for specific errors
22624 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22625 cindex:[retry,specific errors; specifying]
22626 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22627 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22630 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the %hosts_require_auth%
22631 list in an ^smtp^ transport.
22634 A 4##'xx' error was received for an outgoing RCPT command. Either the first or
22635 both of the x's can be given as specific digits, for example: `rcpt_45x` or
22636 `rcpt_436`. For example, to recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands by a
22637 particular host, and have retries every ten minutes and a one-hour timeout, you
22638 could set up a retry rule of this form:
22640 the.host.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22642 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the ^smtp^ transport) and outgoing
22643 LMTP (either the ^lmtp^ transport, or the ^smtp^ transport in LMTP mode).
22644 Note, however, that they apply only to responses to RCPT commands.
22647 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22650 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22653 A connection was refused.
22655 %timeout_connect_MX%::
22656 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22658 %timeout_connect_A%::
22659 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22661 %timeout_connect%::
22662 A connection attempt timed out.
22665 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22666 obtained from an MX record.
22669 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22670 obtained from an MX record.
22673 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22676 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the ^appendfile^ transport.
22679 cindex:[quota,error testing in retry rule]
22680 cindex:[retry,quota error testing]
22681 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the ^appendfile^ transport,
22682 and the mailbox has not been accessed for <'time'>. For example, 'quota_4d'
22683 applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed for four days.
22689 cindex:[mailbox,time of last read]
22690 The idea of %quota_%<'time'> is to make it possible to have shorter timeouts
22691 when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally, it should
22692 be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox. However, it is
22693 not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following heuristic rules:
22695 - If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the ``atime'') is used.
22696 As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over quota),
22697 Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22699 - cindex:[maildir format,time of last read]
22700 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the _new_
22701 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22702 the _new_ subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22703 change to the _new_ subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22704 MUA moving a new message to the _cur_ directory when it is first read. The
22705 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22707 - For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22708 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22710 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22711 mechanism in the ^appendfile^ transport. The 'quota' error also applies
22712 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22717 Retry rules for specified senders
22718 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22719 cindex:[retry,rules; sender-specific]
22720 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22721 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22722 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22725 senders=<address list>
22727 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22730 * * senders=: F,1h,30m
22733 matches all temporary errors for bounce messages sent to any host. If the
22734 address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes. For example:
22736 a.domain timeout senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22738 When testing retry rules using %-brt%, you can supply a sender using the %-f%
22739 command line option, like this:
22741 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22743 If you do not set %-f% with %-brt%, a retry rule that contains a senders list
22752 cindex:[retry,parameters in rules]
22753 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22754 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22756 <letter>,<cutoff time>,<arguments>
22758 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22759 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22760 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22761 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22762 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22764 cindex:[retry,algorithms]
22765 The available algorithms are:
22767 - 'F': retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22770 - 'G': retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22771 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22772 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22774 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22775 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22776 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22777 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22778 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22779 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22780 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22781 cindex:[limit,retry interval]
22782 cindex:[retry interval, maximum]
22783 cindex:[%retry_interval_max%]
22784 %retry_interval_max% limits the maximum interval between retries.
22786 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22787 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22788 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22789 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22790 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22791 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22794 cindex:[hints database,use for retrying]
22795 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22796 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22797 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22798 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22799 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22800 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22801 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22802 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22803 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22804 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22805 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22807 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22808 'exim_dumpdb' or 'exim_fixdb' utility programs (see chapter <<CHAPutils>>). The
22809 latter utility can also be used to change the data. The 'exinext' utility
22810 script can be used to find out what the next retry times are for the hosts
22811 associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local deliveries that
22812 have been deferred.
22815 Retry rule examples
22816 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22817 Here are some example retry rules:
22819 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22820 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22821 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22822 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22823 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22824 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22826 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22827 'alice@wonderland.fict.example' when there is an over-quota error and the
22828 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22829 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22830 parts at 'wonderland.fict.example'; the absence of a local part has the same
22831 effect as supplying ``\*@''. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22832 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22835 The third rule handles all other errors at 'wonderland.fict.example'; retries
22836 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22837 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22838 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22839 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22841 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain 'lookingglass.fict.example'.
22842 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22843 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22844 were not obtained from an MX record.
22846 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22847 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22848 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22849 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22850 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22854 Timeout of retry data
22855 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22856 cindex:[timeout,of retry data]
22857 cindex:[%retry_data_expire%]
22858 cindex:[hints database,data expiry]
22859 cindex:[retry,timeout of data]
22860 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22861 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22862 set in %retry_data_expire% (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22863 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22864 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22865 failing for the first time.
22867 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
22868 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
22869 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
22870 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
22872 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
22873 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. It there is a
22874 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
22881 cindex:[delivery failure, long-term]
22882 cindex:[retry,after long-term failure]
22883 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
22884 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
22885 default retry rule:
22888 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
22891 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
22892 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
22893 failure for the recipient address that counts.
22895 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
22896 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
22897 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
22898 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
22899 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
22901 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
22902 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
22903 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
22905 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
22906 cindex:[%delay_after_cutoff%]
22907 %delay_after_cutoff% option of the ^smtp^ transport. The option is true by
22908 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
22909 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
22910 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
22911 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
22912 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
22914 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
22915 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
22916 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
22917 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
22918 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
22921 If %delay_after_cutoff% is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22922 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
22923 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22924 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
22925 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
22926 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
22927 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
22928 %delay_after_cutoff% false means that there will be many more attempts to
22929 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when %delay_after_cutoff% is
22933 Ultimate address timeout
22934 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
22935 cindex:[retry,ultimate address timeout]
22936 An additional rule is needed to cope with cases where a host is intermittently
22937 available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents its delivery when
22938 others to the same address get through. In this situation, because some
22939 messages are successfully delivered, the ``retry clock'' for the address keeps
22940 getting restarted, and so a message could remain on the queue for ever. To
22941 prevent this, if a message has been on the queue for longer than the cutoff
22942 time of any applicable retry rule for a given address, a delivery is attempted
22943 for that address, even if it is not yet time, and if this delivery fails, the
22944 address is timed out. A new retry time is not computed in this case, so that
22945 other messages for the same address are considered immediately.
22951 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22952 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22955 SMTP authentication
22956 -------------------
22957 cindex:[SMTP,authentication configuration]
22958 cindex:[authentication]
22959 The ``authenticators'' section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned with
22960 SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
22961 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
22962 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that
22963 are permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to
22964 the transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with
22967 cindex:[AUTH,description of]
22968 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
22970 - The server advertises a number of authentication 'mechanisms' in response to
22971 the client's EHLO command.
22973 - The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
22974 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
22976 - The server may issue one or more 'challenges', to which the client must send
22977 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
22978 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
22979 any challenges -- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
22980 with the AUTH command.
22982 - The server either accepts or denies authentication.
22984 - If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
22985 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
22986 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
22989 - If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
22990 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
22991 unauthenticated connection.
22993 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
22994 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
22995 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
22996 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
22999 `\$ `##*`telnet server.example 25`*
23000 `Trying 192.168.34.25...`
23001 `Connected to server.example.`
23002 `Escape character is \'^]\'.`
23003 `220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`
23004 *`ehlo client.example`*
23005 `250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`
23006 `250-SIZE 52428800`
23012 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23013 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23014 mechanisms are configured by specifying 'authenticator' drivers. Like the
23015 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23016 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23017 included by setting
23023 in _Local/Makefile_, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23024 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second can be configured to
23025 support the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism,
23026 which is not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The third
23027 authenticator supports Microsoft's 'Secure Password Authentication'
23030 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23031 section <<SECTfordricon>>). If no authenticators are required, no authentication
23032 section need be present in the configuration file. Each authenticator can in
23033 principle have both server and client functions. When Exim is receiving SMTP
23034 mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out messages over SMTP, it
23035 is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration options are provided for use
23036 in both these circumstances.
23038 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23039 %server_% and %client_% are used on option names that are specific to either
23040 the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client functions
23041 are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is to be
23042 used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using both sets
23043 of options, is required. For example:
23047 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23048 server_secret = ${if eq{$1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23050 client_secret = secret2
23052 The %server_% option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23053 %client_% options when it is acting as a client.
23055 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23056 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23057 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23062 Generic options for authenticators
23063 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23064 cindex:[authentication,generic options]
23065 cindex:[options,generic; for authenticators]
23070 %driver%, Use: 'authenticators', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
23073 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23074 authenticators is to be used.
23077 oindex:[%public_name%]
23079 %public_name%, Use: 'authenticators', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
23082 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23083 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23084 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23085 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If %public_name% is not set, it
23086 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23089 oindex:[%server_advertise_condition%]
23091 %server_advertise_condition%, Use: 'authenticators', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23094 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23095 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, ``0'', ``no'', or ``false'', the
23096 mechanism is not advertised.
23097 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23098 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23099 See section <<SECTauthexiser>> below for further discussion.
23102 oindex:[%server_debug_print%]
23104 %server_debug_print%, Use: 'authenticators', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23107 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the %-d%
23108 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23109 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23110 out the values of variables.
23111 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23112 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23115 oindex:[%server_set_id%]
23117 %server_set_id%, Use: 'authenticators', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23120 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23121 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23122 messages in the variable $authenticated_id$. It is also included in the log
23123 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23124 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23125 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23126 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23129 oindex:[%server_mail_auth_condition%]
23131 %server_mail_auth_condition%, Use: 'authenticators', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23134 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23135 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23136 driver on which %server_mail_auth_condition% is set. The option is not used
23137 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23138 remembered for later use.
23139 How it is used is described in the following section.
23145 [[SECTauthparamail]]
23146 The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands
23147 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23148 cindex:[authentication,sender; authenticated]
23149 cindex:[AUTH,on MAIL command]
23150 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23151 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23154 - If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23155 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23157 - If the value of the AUTH= parameter is ``<>'', it is ignored.
23159 - If %acl_smtp_mailauth% is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23160 running, the value of $authenticated_sender$ is set to the value obtained
23161 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield ``accept'', the value of
23162 $authenticated_sender$ is deleted. The %acl_smtp_mailauth% ACL may not
23163 return ``drop'' or ``discard''. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is given
23164 for the MAIL command.
23166 - If %acl_smtp_mailauth% is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23167 is accepted and placed in $authenticated_sender$ only if the client has
23170 - If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23171 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23172 %server_mail_auth_condition%, the condition is checked at this point. The
23173 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23174 fails, or yields an empty string, ``0'', ``no'', or ``false'', the value of
23175 $authenticated_sender$ is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23176 the value of $authenticated_sender$ is retained and passed on with the
23180 When $authenticated_sender$ is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23181 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23182 $authenticated_id$, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23183 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23185 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23186 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23187 therefore make use of $authenticated_sender$. The converse is not true: the
23188 value of $sender_address$ is not yet set up when the %acl_smtp_mailauth%
23194 Authentication on an Exim server
23195 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23196 cindex:[authentication,on an Exim server]
23197 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23198 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23201 - The client host must match %auth_advertise_hosts% (default \*).
23203 - It the %server_advertise_condition% option is set, its expansion must not
23204 yield the empty string, ``0'', ``no'', or ``false''.
23206 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23207 the mechanisms are advertised.
23209 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23210 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23211 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23212 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23213 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23214 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23215 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23217 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23219 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23221 The %server_advertise_condition% controls the advertisement of individual
23222 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23223 advertisement of a patricular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23226 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23228 If the session is encrypted, $tls_cipher$ is not empty, and so the expansion
23229 yields ``yes'', which allows the advertisement to happen.
23231 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23232 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23233 command. This is the case if
23235 - The client host does not match %auth_advertise_hosts%; or
23237 - No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23239 - Expansion of %server_advertise_condition% blocked the advertising of all the
23240 server authenticators.
23243 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by %acl_smtp_auth% in order
23244 to decide whether to accept the command. If %acl_smtp_auth% is not set,
23245 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23247 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23248 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23249 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23250 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23251 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23252 rejected with a 504 error.
23254 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23255 $received_protocol$ is set to ``esmtpa'' instead of ``esmtp'', and
23256 $sender_host_authenticated$ contains the name (not the public name) of the
23257 authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the
23258 message was received. This variable is empty if there was no successful
23264 Testing server authentication
23265 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23266 cindex:[authentication,testing a server]
23267 cindex:[AUTH,testing a server]
23268 cindex:[base64 encoding,creating authentication test data]
23269 Exim's %-bh% option can be useful for testing server authentication
23270 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23271 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23275 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23277 cindex:[binary zero,in authentication data]
23278 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23279 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23280 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23281 command line to run this script on such data might be
23283 encode '\0user\0password'
23285 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23286 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23287 whose code value is zero.
23289 *Warning 1*: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23290 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23291 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23292 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23294 *Warning 2*: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23295 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23296 example, a command such as
23298 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23300 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped ``@'' and ``\$'' characters.
23302 If you have the %mimencode% command installed, another way to do produce
23303 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23305 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23307 The %-e% option of %echo% enables the interpretation of backslash escapes in
23308 the argument, and the %-n% option specifies no newline at the end of its
23309 output. However, not all versions of %echo% recognize these options, so you
23310 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23314 Authentication by an Exim client
23315 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23316 cindex:[authentication,on an Exim client]
23317 The ^smtp^ transport has two options called %hosts_require_auth% and
23318 %hosts_try_auth%. When the ^smtp^ transport connects to a server that
23319 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23320 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23322 - For each authenticator that is configured as a client, it searches the
23323 authentication mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name
23324 matches the public name of the authenticator.
23326 - When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code.
23327 The variables $host$ and $host_address$ are available for any string
23328 expansions that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and
23329 IP address. If any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt
23331 and Exim moves on to the next authenticator.
23332 Otherwise an expansion failure causes delivery to be
23335 - If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23336 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23337 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23340 - If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5xx code), Exim carries
23341 on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if possible. If
23342 all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are no attempts
23343 because no mechanisms match
23344 (or option expansions force failure),
23345 what happens depends on whether the host matches %hosts_require_auth% or
23346 %hosts_try_auth%. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23347 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23348 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23349 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23351 cindex:[AUTH,on MAIL command]
23352 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23353 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender
23355 If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender is the one
23356 that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the incoming
23357 connection was authenticated and the %server_mail_auth% condition allowed the
23358 authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim to send a
23359 message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23360 %qualify_domain% is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23361 %authenticated_sender% option is set on the ^smtp^ transport, it overrides
23362 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23369 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23370 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23373 The plaintext authenticator
23374 ---------------------------
23375 cindex:[^plaintext^ authenticator]
23376 cindex:[authenticators,^plaintext^]
23377 The ^plaintext^ authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23378 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23379 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23380 security risk. If you use one of these mechanisms without also making use of
23381 SMTP encryption (see chapter <<CHAPTLS>>) you should not use the same passwords
23382 for SMTP connections as you do for login accounts.
23385 Using plaintext in a server
23386 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23387 cindex:[options,^plaintext^ authenticator (server)]
23388 When running as a server, ^plaintext^ performs the authentication test by
23389 expanding a string. It has the following options:
23391 oindex:[%server_prompts%]
23393 %server_prompts%, Use: 'plaintext', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23396 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23397 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23400 oindex:[%server_condition%]
23402 %server_condition%, Use: 'plaintext', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23405 This option must be set in order to configure the driver as a server. Its use
23406 is described below.
23408 cindex:[AUTH,in ^plaintext^ authenticator]
23409 cindex:[binary zero,in ^plaintext^ authenticator]
23410 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in ^plaintext^ authenticator]
23411 cindex:[base64 encoding,in ^plaintext^ authenticator]
23412 The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in response to
23413 subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte values
23414 when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as a
23415 list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), which are placed in the
23416 expansion variables $1$, $2$, etc. If there are more strings in
23417 %server_prompts% than the number of strings supplied with the AUTH
23418 command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more data. Each response from
23419 the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23421 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23422 %server_condition% is expanded.
23423 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
23424 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
23425 If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string, ``0'', ``no'', or
23426 ``false'', authentication fails. If the result of the expansion is ``1'', ``yes'', or
23427 ``true'', authentication succeeds and the generic %server_set_id% option is
23428 expanded and saved in $authenticated_id$. For any other result, a temporary
23429 error code is returned, with the expanded string as the error text.
23431 *Warning*: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23432 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23433 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23437 The PLAIN authentication mechanism
23438 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23439 cindex:[PLAIN authentication mechanism]
23440 cindex:[authentication,PLAIN mechanism]
23441 cindex:[binary zero,in ^plaintext^ authenticator]
23442 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23443 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23444 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23445 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23447 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23448 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23449 configured as follows:
23454 public_name = PLAIN
23456 server_condition = \
23457 ${if and {{eq{$2}{username}}{eq{$3}{mysecret}}}{yes}{no}}
23461 The %server_prompts% setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23462 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23463 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23464 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23468 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23470 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23472 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23473 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23477 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23478 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23480 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23481 when decoded, is <'NUL'>`username`<'NUL'>`mysecret`, where <'NUL'> represents a
23482 zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which is empty.
23483 The %server_condition% option in the authenticator checks that the second two
23484 are `username` and `mysecret` respectively.
23486 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23487 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23488 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23490 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23491 $2$ to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23492 comparison (see %crypteq% in chapter <<CHAPexpand>>). Here is a example of this
23493 approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. *Warning*: This
23494 is an incorrect example:
23497 server_condition = \
23498 ${if eq{$3}{${lookup{$2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}{yes}{no}}
23501 The expansion uses the user name ($2$) as the key to look up a password,
23502 which it then compares to the supplied password ($3$). Why is this example
23503 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23504 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23505 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23506 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23507 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23510 server_condition = ${lookup{$2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23511 {${if eq{$value}{$3}{yes}{no}}}{no}}
23514 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23515 fails, authentication fails. If %crypteq% is being used instead of %eq%, the
23516 first example is in fact safe, because %crypteq% always fails if its second
23517 argument is empty. However, the second way of writing the test makes the logic
23522 The LOGIN authentication mechanism
23523 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23524 cindex:[LOGIN authentication mechanism]
23525 cindex:[authentication,LOGIN mechanism]
23526 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23527 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23528 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23529 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23534 public_name = LOGIN
23535 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23536 server_condition = \
23537 ${if and {{eq{$1}{username}}{eq{$2}{mysecret}}}{yes}{no}}
23541 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23542 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23543 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23544 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23546 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23547 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only ``Username:'' and
23548 ``Password:''. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator which uses those
23549 strings, and which uses the %ldapauth% expansion condition to check the user
23550 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23555 public_name = LOGIN
23556 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23557 server_condition = ${if ldapauth \
23558 {user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23560 ldap://ldap.example.org/}{yes}{no}}
23561 server_set_id = uid=$1,ou=people,o=example.org
23564 Note the use of the %quote_ldap_dn% operator to correctly quote the DN for
23565 authentication. However, the basic %quote% operator, rather than any of the
23566 LDAP quoting operators, is the correct one to use for the password, because
23567 quoting is needed only to make the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the
23568 LDAP level, the password is an uninterpreted string.
23572 Support for different kinds of authentication
23573 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23574 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23575 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23576 traditionally encrypted passwords from _/etc/passwd_ (or equivalent), PAM,
23577 Radius, %ldapauth%, and 'pwcheck'. For details see section <<SECTexpcond>>.
23582 Using plaintext in a client
23583 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23584 cindex:[options,^plaintext^ authenticator (client)]
23585 The ^plaintext^ authenticator has just one client option:
23589 oindex:[%client_send%]
23591 %client_send%, Use: 'plaintext', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23594 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23595 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23596 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23597 to prompts from the server.
23599 *Note*: you cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23600 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23602 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23603 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23604 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23605 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23608 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23609 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23613 public_name = PLAIN
23614 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23616 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23617 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23618 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23622 public_name = LOGIN
23623 client_send = : username : mysecret
23625 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23626 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23632 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23633 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23635 The cram_md5 authenticator
23636 --------------------------
23637 cindex:[^cram_md5^ authenticator]
23638 cindex:[authenticators,^cram_md5^]
23639 cindex:[CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism]
23640 cindex:[authentication,CRAM-MD5 mechanism]
23641 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23642 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23643 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23644 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23645 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23646 secure than ^plaintext^. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23647 available in plain text at either end.
23650 Using cram_md5 as a server
23651 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23652 cindex:[options,^cram_md5^ authenticator (server)]
23653 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23654 authenticator as a server:
23656 oindex:[%server_secret%]
23658 %server_secret%, Use: 'cram_md5', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23661 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in ^cram_md5^ authenticator]
23662 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23663 the expansion variable $1$, and %server_secret% is expanded to obtain the
23664 password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest that the
23665 client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct string. If the
23666 expansion of %server_secret% is forced to fail, authentication fails. If the
23667 expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is returned to
23670 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23671 client is ``ph10'', and if so, uses ``secret'' as the password. For any other user
23672 name, authentication fails.
23676 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23677 server_secret = ${if eq{$1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23680 If authentication succeeds, the setting of %server_set_id% preserves the user
23681 name in $authenticated_id$.
23682 A more tyical configuration might look up the secret string in a file, using
23683 the user name as the key. For example:
23687 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23688 server_secret = ${lookup{$1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}{$value}fail}
23691 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23692 because $1$ contains an unknown user name.
23695 Using cram_md5 as a client
23696 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23697 cindex:[options,^cram_md5^ authenticator (client)]
23698 When used as a client, the ^cram_md5^ authenticator has two options:
23702 oindex:[%client_name%]
23704 %client_name%, Use: 'cram_md5', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'the primary host name'
23707 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23708 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23711 oindex:[%client_secret%]
23713 %client_secret%, Use: 'cram_md5', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23716 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23717 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23720 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23721 to $host$ or $host_address$ in the options.
23723 Forced failure of either expansion string is treated as an indication that this
23724 authenticator is not prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next
23725 configured client authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to
23726 give up trying to send the message to the current server.
23728 A simple example configuration of a ^cram_md5^ authenticator, using fixed
23733 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23735 client_secret = secret
23741 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23742 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23744 The cyrus_sasl authenticator
23745 ----------------------------
23746 cindex:[^cyrus_sasl^ authenticator]
23747 cindex:[authenticators,^cyrus_sasl^]
23748 cindex:[Cyrus, SASL library]
23749 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23750 Digital Ltd (*http://www.aldigital.co.uk[]*).
23752 The ^cyrus_sasl^ authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23753 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (``Simple Authentication and Security
23754 Layer''). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms, including
23755 PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support directly.
23756 In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23758 The ^cyrus_sasl^ authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23759 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23760 then so can the ^cyrus_sasl^ authenticator. By default it uses the public
23761 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23763 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23764 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the 'exim'
23765 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23766 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23767 depending on the driver you are using.
23770 Using cyrus_sasl as a server
23771 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23772 The ^cyrus_sasl^ authenticator has four private options. It puts the
23773 username (on a successful authentication) into $1$.
23775 oindex:[%server_hostname%]
23777 %server_hostname%, Use: 'cyrus_sasl', Type: 'string'!!, Default: `$primary_hostname`
23780 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with
23781 the library. It is up to the underlying SASL plug-in what it does with
23785 oindex:[%server_mech%]
23787 %server_mech%, Use: 'cyrus_sasl', Type: 'string', Default: `public_name`
23790 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should
23791 use. It allows you to use a different underlying mechanism from the
23792 advertised name. For example:
23795 driver = cyrus_sasl
23796 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23797 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23802 oindex:[%server_realm%]
23804 %server_realm%, Use: 'cyrus_sasl', Type: 'string', Default: 'unset'
23807 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23810 oindex:[%server_service%]
23812 %server_service%, Use: 'cyrus_sasl', Type: 'string', Default: `smtp`
23815 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23818 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23819 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23820 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23821 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23824 driver = cyrus_sasl
23825 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23829 driver = cyrus_sasl
23830 public_name = PLAIN
23834 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23835 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23836 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23841 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23842 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23844 The spa authenticator
23845 ---------------------
23846 cindex:[^spa^ authenticator]
23847 cindex:[authenticators,^spa^]
23848 cindex:[authentication,Microsoft Secure Password]
23849 cindex:[authentication,NTLM]
23850 cindex:[Microsoft Secure Password Authentication]
23851 cindex:[NTLM authentication]
23852 The ^spa^ authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's 'Secure
23853 Password Authentication' mechanism,
23854 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
23855 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
23856 taken from the Samba project (*http://www.samba.org[]*). The code for the
23857 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
23860 - After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
23861 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
23863 - The server sends back a challenge.
23865 - The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
23866 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
23868 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
23872 Using spa as a server
23873 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23874 cindex:[options,^spa^ authenticator (server)]
23875 The ^spa^ authenticator has just one server option:
23877 oindex:[%server_password%]
23879 %server_password%, Use: 'spa', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23882 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in ^spa^ authenticator]
23883 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
23884 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in $1$. For example:
23889 server_password = ${lookup{$1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}}
23891 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
23892 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
23898 Using spa as a client
23899 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23900 cindex:[options,^spa^ authenticator (client)]
23901 The ^spa^ authenticator has the following client options:
23905 oindex:[%client_domain%]
23907 %client_domain%, Use: 'spa', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23910 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
23913 oindex:[%client_password%]
23915 %client_password%, Use: 'spa', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23918 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
23921 oindex:[%client_username%]
23923 %client_username%, Use: 'spa', Type: 'string'!!, Default: 'unset'
23926 This option specifies the user name, and must be set.
23929 Here is an example of a configuration of this authenticator for use with the
23930 mail servers at 'msn.com':
23935 client_username = msn/msn_username
23936 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
23937 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
23945 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23946 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23949 [titleabbrev="Encrypted SMTP connections"]
23950 Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL
23951 ----------------------------------------
23952 cindex:[encryption,on SMTP connection]
23953 cindex:[SMTP,encryption]
23954 cindex:[TLS,on SMTP connection]
23957 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
23958 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
23959 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
23960 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
23961 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
23962 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section <<SECTinctlsssl>>). You
23963 also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial level,
23964 and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and certificates are
23967 RFC 2487 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
23968 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
23969 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
23970 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
23971 between them is encrypted.
23973 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
23974 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
23975 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
23976 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
23979 *Warning*: certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
23980 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
23981 in order to get TLS to work.
23985 Support for the legacy ``ssmtp'' (aka ``smtps'') protocol
23986 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
23987 cindex:[ssmtp protocol]
23988 cindex:[smtps protocol]
23989 cindex:[SMTP,ssmtp protocol]
23990 cindex:[SMTP,smtps protocol]
23991 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
23992 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
23993 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
23994 port. The protocol was called ``ssmtp'' or ``smtps'', and port 465 was allocated
23997 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardised, but there are
23998 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
23999 the %tls_on_connect_ports% global option. Its value must be a list of port
24000 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24002 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24004 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24005 via the daemon and via 'inetd'. You still need to specify all the ports that
24006 the daemon uses (by setting %daemon_smtp_ports% or %local_interfaces% or the
24007 %-oX% command line option) because %tls_on_connect_ports% does not add an
24008 extra port -- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24011 There is also a %-tls-on-connect% command line option. This overrides
24012 %tls_on_connect_ports%; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24022 cindex:[TLS,OpenSSL 'vs' GnuTLS]
24023 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24024 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24025 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24029 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24033 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24034 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24036 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24038 - The %tls_verify_certificates% option must contain the name of a file, not the
24039 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24041 - The %tls_dhparam% option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24042 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24043 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24045 - GnuTLS uses RSA and D-H parameters that take a substantial amount of
24046 time to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS
24047 session. Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool
24048 directory, called _gnutls-params_. The file is owned by the Exim user and is
24049 readable only by its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the
24050 RSA and D-H parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first
24051 Exim process that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file
24052 which is renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim
24053 processes do this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a
24054 file is in place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24056 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24057 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24058 Arranging this is easy; just delete the file when you want new values to be
24061 - Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24062 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24063 affects the value of the $tls_peerdn$ variable.
24065 - OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24066 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24067 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24068 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyhens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24069 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24070 %tls_require_ciphers% options (the global option and the ^smtp^ transport
24073 - The %tls_require_ciphers% options operate differently, as described in the
24074 following sections.
24079 Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL
24080 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24081 cindex:[TLS,requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)]
24082 cindex:[%tls_require_ciphers%,OpenSSL]
24083 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24084 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24085 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24086 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of %tls_require_ciphers%
24087 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24088 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24090 - It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24092 - It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24093 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24094 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24097 - Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24098 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24099 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24102 - Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by the characters `!`, `-` or
24105 If `!` is used then the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24106 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24109 If `-` is used then the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24110 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24112 If `+` is used then the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24113 option doesn't add any new ciphers it just moves matching existing ones.
24115 If none of these characters is present then the string is just interpreted as
24116 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24117 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24118 not moved to the end of the list.
24124 Requiring specific ciphers in GnuTLS
24125 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24126 cindex:[TLS,requiring specific ciphers (GnuTLS)]
24127 cindex:[%tls_require_ciphers%,GnuTLS]
24128 The GnuTLS library does not have a combined function like OpenSSL. Instead,
24129 it allows the caller to specify separate lists of key-exchange methods,
24130 main cipher algorithms, and MAC algorithms. Unfortunately, these lists are
24131 numerical, and the library does not have a function for turning names into
24132 numbers. Consequently, the list of recognized names has to be built into
24135 At present, Exim permits only the list of main cipher algorithms to be
24136 changed. The %tls_require_ciphers% option is in the same format as for
24137 OpenSSL. Exim searches each item for the name of available algorithm. For
24138 example, if the list contains RSA_AES_SHA then AES is recognized.
24140 The cipher algorithms list starts out with a default set of algorithms. If
24141 the first item in %tls_require_ciphers% does 'not' start with an
24142 exclamation mark, all the default items are deleted. Thus, only those specified
24143 can be used. If the first item in %tls_require_ciphers% 'does' start with
24144 an exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24146 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevent
24147 algorithms to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start
24148 with an exclamation mark causes the relevant algorithms to be added to the
24151 tls_require_ciphers = !RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA
24153 allows all the defaults except those that use ARCFOUR, whereas
24155 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24157 allows only cipher suites that use AES and 3DES. The currently recognized
24158 algorithms are: AES_256, AES_128, AES (both of the preceding), 3DES, and
24159 ARCFOUR_128. Unrecognized algorithms are ignored. In a server, the order of the
24160 list is unimportant; the server will advertise the availability of all the
24161 relevant cipher suites. However, in a client, the order of the list specifies a
24162 preference order for the algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24163 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24169 Configuring an Exim server to use TLS
24170 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24171 cindex:[TLS,configuring an Exim server]
24172 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24173 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match %tls_advertise_hosts%,
24174 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24175 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24176 need to set some other options in order to make TLS avaliable, and also it is
24177 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24179 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24180 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24181 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24184 554 Security failure
24186 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24187 rejected with a 554 error code.
24189 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set %tls_advertise_hosts% to
24190 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to \* to match all hosts.
24191 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24192 without some further configuration at the server end.
24194 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24195 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24197 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24198 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24200 The first file contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains
24201 the private key that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim
24202 user, and must always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if
24203 both the certificate and the key are contained within it. If %tls_privatekey%
24204 is not set, this is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also
24205 contain intermediate certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable
24206 it to authenticate the server's certificate.
24208 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24209 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24210 few comments below in section <<SECTcerandall>>.)
24212 *Note*: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client --
24213 they apply only in the case of a server. For a client, you must set the options
24214 of the same name in an ^smtp^ transport.
24216 With just these options, Exim will work as a server with clients such as
24217 Netscape. It does not require the client to have a certificate (but see below
24218 for how to insist on this). There is one other option that may be needed in
24219 other situations. If
24221 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24223 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24224 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24225 suites that the server supports. See the command
24229 for a way of generating this data.
24230 At present, %tls_dhparam% is used only when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is
24231 ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24233 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24234 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24235 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24236 in $sender_host_address$ to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24237 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24239 cindex:[cipher,logging]
24240 cindex:[log,TLS cipher]
24241 The variable $tls_cipher$ is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24242 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the 'Received:' header of an
24243 incoming message (by default -- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24244 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by ``X='',
24245 unless the %tls_cipher% log selector is turned off.
24246 The %encrypted% condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in
24249 The ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can check the name of the cipher
24250 suite and vary their actions accordingly. The cipher suite names are those used
24251 by OpenSSL. These may differ from the names used elsewhere. For example,
24252 OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other contexts
24253 is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL
24254 documentation for more details.
24258 Requesting and verifying client certificates
24259 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24260 cindex:[certificate,verification of client]
24261 cindex:[TLS,client certificate verification]
24262 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24263 session with a client, you must set either %tls_verify_hosts% or
24264 %tls_try_verify_hosts%. You can, of course, set either of them to \* to
24265 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24266 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24267 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24268 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24269 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24270 %tls_verify_certificates%.
24272 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24275 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24276 of the form <'hash'>.0, where <'hash'> is a hash value constructed from the
24277 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24279 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24281 where _/cert/file_ contains a single certificate.
24283 The difference between %tls_verify_hosts% and %tls_try_verify_hosts% is
24284 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24285 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24286 %tls_verify_certificates%. If the client matches %tls_verify_hosts%, the
24287 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24288 dropped. If the client matches %tls_try_verify_hosts%, the (encrypted) SMTP
24289 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24290 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24291 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24292 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24294 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24295 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24296 $tls_peerdn$ during subsequent processing of the message.
24298 cindex:[log,distinguished name]
24299 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24300 'Received:' header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24301 ``DN='', by setting the %tls_peerdn% log selector, and you can use
24302 %received_header_text% to change the 'Received:' header. When no certificate
24303 is supplied, $tls_peerdn$ is empty.
24306 Revoked certificates
24307 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24308 cindex:[TLS,revoked certificates]
24309 cindex:[revocation list]
24310 cindex:[certificate,revocation list]
24311 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24312 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24313 server using the global option called %tls_crl% and to an Exim client using an
24314 identically named option for the ^smtp^ transport. In each case, the value of
24315 the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a CRL
24319 Configuring an Exim client to use TLS
24320 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24321 cindex:[cipher,logging]
24322 cindex:[log,TLS cipher]
24323 cindex:[log,distinguished name]
24324 cindex:[TLS,configuring an Exim client]
24325 The %tls_cipher% and %tls_peerdn% log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24326 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24327 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24328 within the ^smtp^ transport.
24330 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the ^smtp^
24331 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24332 server, the ^smtp^ transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24333 this can be prevented by setting %hosts_avoid_tls% (an option of the
24334 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24336 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24337 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24338 %hosts_require_tls% to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24339 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24340 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24343 When the server host is not in %hosts_require_tls%, Exim may try to deliver
24344 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24345 a 5##'xx' code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24346 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24347 %tls_tempfail_tryclear% option of the ^smtp^ transport. If it is false,
24348 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24349 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4##'xx' response to
24350 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24351 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24352 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24356 The %tls_certificate% and %tls_privatekey% options of the ^smtp^ transport
24357 provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server if it
24358 requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24359 %tls_verify_hosts% or %tls_try_verify_hosts% matches the client.
24360 *Note*: these options must be set in the ^smtp^ transport for Exim to use
24361 TLS when it is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server
24362 certificate (set by the global options of the same name) should also be used
24363 when operating as a client.
24365 If %tls_verify_certificates% is set, it must name a file or,
24366 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24367 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24368 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24369 in the list defined by %tls_crl%.
24372 %tls_require_ciphers% is set on the ^smtp^ transport, it must contain a
24373 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24374 the current host is abandoned, and the ^smtp^ transport tries to deliver to
24375 alternative hosts, if any.
24377 All the TLS options in the ^smtp^ transport are expanded before use, with
24378 $host$ and $host_address$ containing the name and address of the server to
24379 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24380 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24385 Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection
24386 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24387 cindex:[multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS]
24388 cindex:[TLS,multiple message deliveries]
24389 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24390 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24391 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24392 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24393 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24394 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24395 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24396 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24397 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24399 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24400 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24401 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24402 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24403 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24404 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24405 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24406 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24407 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24409 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24410 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24411 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24412 information is recorded.
24414 There is also a manual override; you can set %hosts_nopass_tls% on the
24415 ^smtp^ transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24416 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24422 Certificates and all that
24423 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24424 cindex:[certificate,references to discussion]
24425 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24426 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24427 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24428 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24429 to Apache, currently at
24432 *http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24[]*
24435 Other parts of the 'modssl' documentation are also helpful, and have
24436 links to further files.
24437 Eric Rescorla's book, 'SSL and TLS', published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24438 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24439 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24442 *http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/[]*
24449 The file named by %tls_certificate% may contain more than one
24450 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24451 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24452 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24453 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24454 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24455 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24456 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24457 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24458 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24459 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24460 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24463 Self-signed certificates
24464 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24465 cindex:[certificate,self-signed]
24466 You can create a self-signed certificate using the 'req' command provided
24467 with OpenSSL, like this:
24470 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24474 _file1_ and _file2_ can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24475 delimited and so can be identified independently. The %-days% option
24476 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The %-nodes% option is
24477 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24478 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24479 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24480 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24482 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24483 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24484 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24486 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24487 user (also called ``leaf'' or ``site'') certificate, and not a self-signed
24488 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24489 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root 'certification
24490 authority' (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24491 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24493 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24494 user certificates, see the 'General implementation overview' chapter of the
24495 Open-source PKI book, available online at *http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/[]*.
24499 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24500 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24503 Access control lists
24504 --------------------
24505 cindex:[{ACL},description]
24506 cindex:[control of incoming mail]
24507 cindex:[message,controlling incoming]
24508 cindex:[policy control,access control lists]
24509 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24510 configuration file, headed by ``begin acl''. Each ACL definition starts with a
24511 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24512 one very small ACL:
24517 accept hosts = one.host.only
24519 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24520 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24522 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24523 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24524 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the %-bs%
24525 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24526 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24527 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24528 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24534 The %-bh% command line option provides a way of testing your ACL configuration
24535 locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact. The host
24536 'relay-test.mail-abuse.org' provides a service for checking your relaying
24537 configuration (see section <<SECTcheralcon>> for more details).
24541 Specifying when ACLs are used
24542 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24543 cindex:[{ACL},options for specifying]
24544 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24545 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24546 cindex:[AUTH,ACL for]
24547 cindex:[DATA, ACLs for]
24548 cindex:[ETRN,ACL for]
24549 cindex:[EXPN,ACL for]
24550 cindex:[HELO,ACL for]
24551 cindex:[EHLO,ACL for]
24552 cindex:[MAIL,ACL for]
24553 cindex:[QUIT, ACL for]
24554 cindex:[RCPT,ACL for]
24555 cindex:[STARTTLS, ACL for]
24556 cindex:[VRFY,ACL for]
24557 cindex:[SMTP connection, ACL for]
24558 cindex:[non-smtp message, ACL for]
24561 `--`--------------------`---------------------------------------
24562 %acl_not_smtp% ACL for non-SMTP messages
24563 %acl_smtp_auth% ACL for AUTH
24564 %acl_smtp_connect% ACL for start of SMTP connection
24565 %acl_smtp_data% ACL after DATA is complete
24566 %acl_smtp_etrn% ACL for ETRN
24567 %acl_smtp_expn% ACL for EXPN
24568 %acl_smtp_helo% ACL for HELO or EHLO
24569 %acl_smtp_mail% ACL for MAIL
24570 %acl_smtp_mailauth% ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL
24571 %acl_smtp_mime% ACL for content-scanning MIME parts
24572 %acl_smtp_predata% ACL at start of DATA command
24573 %acl_smtp_quit% ACL for QUIT
24574 %acl_smtp_rcpt% ACL for RCPT
24575 %acl_smtp_starttls% ACL for STARTTLS
24576 %acl_smtp_vrfy% ACL for VRFY
24577 ----------------------------------------------------------------
24579 For example, if you set
24581 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24583 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24584 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24585 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24586 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24587 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24588 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24589 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24594 cindex:[non-smtp message, ACL for]
24595 The non-SMTP ACL applies to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, it
24596 applies to batch SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batch SMTP is not
24597 really SMTP.) This ACL is run just before the 'local_scan()' function. Any
24598 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24599 temporary error for these kinds of message. Many of the ACL conditions (for
24600 example, host tests, and tests on the state of the SMTP connection such as
24601 encryption and authentication) are not relevant and are forbidden in this ACL.
24606 cindex:[SMTP connection, ACL for]
24607 The ACL test specified by %acl_smtp_connect% happens after the test specified
24608 by %host_reject_connection% (which is now an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers
24609 testing (if configured).
24614 cindex:[DATA, ACLs for]
24615 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24616 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24617 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by %acl_smtp_predata%
24618 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24619 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24620 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24621 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24622 are defined here are visible when the %acl_smtp_data% ACL is run.
24624 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24625 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24626 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24627 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24628 the ACL specified by %acl_smtp_data%, which is the second ACL that is
24629 associated with the DATA command.
24631 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24632 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24633 MTAs do not treat hard (5##'xx') responses to the DATA command (either
24634 before or after the data) correctly -- they keep the message on their queues
24635 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24641 The %acl_smtp_mime% option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24642 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter <<CHAPexiscan>>.
24648 cindex:[QUIT, ACL for]
24649 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the
24650 outcome of the ACL does not affect the response code to QUIT,
24651 which is always 221. Thus, the ACL does not in fact control any access.
24652 For this reason, the only verbs that are permitted are %accept% and %warn%.
24654 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24655 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24656 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24657 more %logwrite% modifiers on a %warn% verb.
24659 You do not need to have a final %accept%, but if you do, you can use a
24660 %message% modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24663 This ACL is run only for a ``normal'' QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24664 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24665 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24666 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24667 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24671 Finding an ACL to use
24672 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24673 cindex:[{ACL},finding which to use]
24674 The value of an %acl_smtp_'xxx'% option is expanded before use, so you can
24675 use different ACLs in different circumstances. The resulting string does not
24676 have to be the name of an ACL in the configuration file; there are other
24677 possibilities. Having expanded the string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
24679 - If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
24680 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
24681 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
24682 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is ``#''.
24683 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
24684 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
24687 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
24688 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
24689 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
24692 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
24693 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
24694 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
24695 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
24697 - If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
24698 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
24699 matches the string.
24701 - If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
24702 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
24703 want to have something like
24705 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
24707 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
24708 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
24715 cindex:[{ACL},return codes]
24716 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
24717 section <<SECTQUITACL>> above), the
24719 result of running an ACL is either ``accept'' or ``deny'', or, if some test
24720 cannot be completed (for example, if a database is down), ``defer''. These
24721 results cause 2##'xx', 5##'xx', and 4##'xx' return codes, respectively, to be
24722 used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return, ``error'', occurs when there is an
24723 error such as invalid syntax in the ACL. This also causes a 4'##xx' return
24726 For the non-SMTP ACL, ``defer'' and ``error'' are treated in the same way as
24727 ``deny'', because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
24728 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
24731 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return ``discard''. This
24732 has the effect of ``accept'', but causes either the entire message or an
24733 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
24734 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
24736 If the ACL for MAIL returns ``discard'', all recipients are discarded, and no
24737 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of ``discard'' in a
24738 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
24739 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
24740 run. A ``discard'' return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
24741 remaining recipients.
24743 The ``discard'' return is not permitted for the %acl_smtp_predata% ACL.
24746 cindex:['local_scan()' function,when all recipients discarded]
24747 The 'local_scan()' function is always run, even if there are no remaining
24748 recipients; it may create new recipients.
24754 cindex:[{ACL},unset options]
24755 The default actions when any of the %acl_'xxx'% options are unset are not
24756 all the same. *Note*: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
24757 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control reaches
24758 the end of the ACL statements is ``deny''.
24760 For %acl_not_smtp%, %acl_smtp_auth%, %acl_smtp_connect%, %acl_smtp_data%,
24761 %acl_smtp_helo%, %acl_smtp_mail%, %acl_smtp_mailauth%, %acl_smtp_mime%,
24762 %acl_smtp_predata%, %acl_smtp_quit%, and %acl_smtp_starttls%, the action when
24763 the ACL is not defined is ``accept''.
24765 For the others (%acl_smtp_etrn%, %acl_smtp_expn%, %acl_smtp_rcpt%, and
24766 %acl_smtp_vrfy%), the action when the ACL is not defined is ``deny''.
24767 This means that %acl_smtp_rcpt% must be defined in order to receive any
24768 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
24769 configuration file.
24774 Data for message ACLs
24775 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24776 cindex:[{ACL},data for message ACL]
24777 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running,
24778 the variables that contain information about the host and the message's sender
24779 (for example, $sender_host_address$ and $sender_address$) are set, and
24780 can be used in ACL statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or
24781 DATA), $domain$ and $local_part$ are set from the argument address.
24783 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
24784 contain information about the host are set, but $sender_address$ is not yet
24785 set. Section <<SECTauthparamail>> contains a discussion of this parameter and
24788 The $message_size$ variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
24789 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
24790 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
24791 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
24794 The $rcpt_count$ variable increases by one for each RCPT command
24795 received. The $recipients_count$ variable increases by one each time a
24796 RCPT command is accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed,
24797 it contains the number of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for
24798 both the DATA ACLs), $rcpt_count$ contains the total number of RCPT
24799 commands, and $recipients_count$ contains the total number of accepted
24807 Data for non-message ACLs
24808 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
24809 cindex:[{ACL},data for non-message ACL]
24810 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
24811 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in $smtp_command_argument$.
24812 This can be tested using a %condition% condition. For example, here is an ACL
24813 for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is encrypted, or the
24814 CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it does not permit
24815 authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on unencrypted connections.
24819 accept encrypted = *
24820 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
24822 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
24825 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
24826 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
24827 encrypted. You can use the generic %server_advertise_condition% authenticator
24828 option to do this.)
24834 cindex:[{ACL},format of]
24835 cindex:[{ACL},verbs; definition of]
24836 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
24837 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and ``modifiers''.
24838 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
24839 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
24841 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
24842 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
24843 provides a means of specifying an ``and'' conjunction between conditions. For
24846 deny dnslists = list1.example
24847 dnslists = list2.example
24849 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
24850 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
24851 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
24852 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
24853 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
24858 The ACL verbs are as follows:
24860 - cindex:[%accept%, ACL verb]
24861 %accept%: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns ``accept''. If any of
24862 the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether %endpass% appears
24863 among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition is before
24864 %endpass%, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is after
24865 %endpass%, the ACL returns ``deny''. Consider this statement, used to check a
24868 accept domains = +local_domains
24872 If the recipient domain does not match the %domains% condition, control passes
24873 to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and the
24874 command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification fails,
24875 the ACL yields ``deny'', because the failing condition is after %endpass%.
24877 - cindex:[%defer%, ACL verb]
24878 %defer%: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns ``defer'' which, in an
24879 SMTP session, causes a 4##'xx' response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
24880 %defer% is the same as %deny%, because there is no way of sending a temporary
24881 error. For a RCPT command, %defer% is much the same as using a
24882 ^redirect^ router and `:defer:` while verifying, but the %defer% verb can
24883 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
24885 - cindex:[%deny%, ACL verb]
24886 %deny%: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns ``deny''. If any of the
24887 conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
24890 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
24892 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
24894 - cindex:[%discard%, ACL verb]
24895 %discard%: This verb behaves like %accept%, except that it returns ``discard''
24896 from the ACL instead of ``accept''. It is permitted only on ACLs that are
24897 concerned with receiving messages, and it causes recipients to be discarded.
24898 If the %log_message% modifier is set when %discard% operates, its contents are
24899 added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
24901 If %discard% is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one recipient is
24902 discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
24903 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before
24904 DATA do not appear in the log line when the %log_recipients% log selector
24907 - cindex:[%drop%, ACL verb]
24908 %drop%: This verb behaves like %deny%, except that an SMTP connection is
24909 forcibly closed after the 5##'xx' error message has been sent. For example:
24911 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
24913 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
24915 There is no difference between %deny% and %drop% for the connect-time ACL. The
24916 connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
24918 - cindex:[%require%, ACL verb]
24919 %require%: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
24920 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns ``deny''. For
24921 example, when checking a RCPT command,
24923 require verify = sender
24925 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
24926 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command.
24928 - cindex:[%warn%, ACL verb]
24929 %warn%: If all the conditions are met, a header line is added to an incoming
24930 message and/or a line is written to Exim's main log. In all cases, control
24931 passes to the next ACL statement. The text of the added header line and the log
24932 line are specified by modifiers; if they are not present, a %warn% verb just
24933 checks its conditions and obeys any ``immediate'' modifiers such as %set% and
24934 %logwrite%. There is more about adding header lines in section
24935 <<SECTaddheadwarn>>.
24937 If any condition on a %warn% statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
24938 some sort of defer), no header lines are added and the configured log line is
24939 not written. No further conditions or modifiers in the %warn% statement are
24940 processed. The incident is logged, but the ACL continues to be processed, from
24941 the next statement onwards.
24943 If a %message% modifier is present on a %warn% verb in an ACL that is not
24944 testing an incoming message, it is ignored, and the incident is logged.
24946 A %warn% statement may use the %log_message% modifier to cause a line to be
24947 written to the main log when the statement's conditions are true.
24948 If an identical log line is requested several times in the same message, only
24949 one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force duplicates to be
24950 written, use the %logwrite% modifier instead.
24952 When one of the %warn% conditions is an address verification that fails, the
24953 text of the verification failure message is in $acl_verify_message$. If you
24954 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
24956 warn !verify = sender
24957 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
24959 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional %deny%.
24961 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
24962 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
24963 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
24964 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
24965 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
24969 [[SECTaclvariables]]
24972 cindex:[{ACL},variables]
24973 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
24974 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
24975 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
24976 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. There are two sets
24977 of these variables:
24979 - The values of $acl_c0$ to $acl_c9$ persist throughout an SMTP connection.
24980 They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set while receiving one message is
24981 still available when receiving the next message on the same SMTP connection.
24983 - The values of $acl_m0$ to $acl_m9$ persist only while a message is being
24984 received. They are reset afterwards. They are also reset by MAIL, RSET,
24985 EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
24987 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
24988 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
24989 time. The ACL variables are set by modifier called %set%. For example:
24991 accept hosts = whatever
24992 set acl_m4 = some value
24994 *Note*: a leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
24995 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
24996 %warn% verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25000 Condition and modifier processing
25001 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
25002 cindex:[{ACL},conditions; processing]
25003 cindex:[{ACL},modifiers; processing]
25004 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example,
25006 deny domains = *.dom.example
25007 !verify = recipient
25009 causes the ACL to return ``deny'' if the recipient domain ends in
25010 'dom.example' and the recipient address cannot be verified.
25012 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25013 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25014 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25017 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25018 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25019 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25020 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25023 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25024 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25025 different in the two cases. The %fail% in the first statement causes the
25026 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The %accept% verb
25027 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25028 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25029 and therefore the %accept% also fails.
25031 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25032 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25033 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25034 warning is generated. The %control% modifier affects the way an incoming
25035 message is handled.
25037 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25038 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25039 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25040 consider this use of the %message% modifier:
25042 require message = Can't verify sender
25044 message = Can't verify recipient
25046 message = This message cannot be used
25048 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25049 ``deny'', so it goes no further. The first %message% modifier has been seen, so
25050 its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25051 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25052 verification succeeds, the third message becomes ``current'', but is never used
25053 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25055 For the %deny% verb, on the other hand, it is always the last %message%
25056 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25057 happen. Specifying more than one %message% modifier does not make sense, and
25058 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25061 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25062 message = Invalid sender from client host
25064 The ``deny'' result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25065 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25072 cindex:[{ACL},modifiers; list of]
25073 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25075 *control*~=~<'text'>::
25076 cindex:[%control%, ACL modifier]
25077 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25078 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25079 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25080 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25081 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25082 even if the %control% modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25084 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25085 separately in section <<SECTcontrols>>. The %control% modifier can be used in
25086 several different ways. For example:
25088 - It can be at the end of an %accept% statement:
25091 accept ...some conditions
25092 control = queue_only
25095 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields ``accept'', in
25096 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25098 - It can be in the middle of an %accept% statement:
25101 accept ...some conditions...
25102 control = queue_only
25103 ...some more conditions...
25106 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25107 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25108 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield ``accept'' for the control to
25111 - It can be used with %warn% to apply the control, leaving the
25112 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25116 warn ...some conditions...
25121 This example of %warn% does not contain %message%, %log_message%, or
25122 %logwrite%, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a log
25125 - If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25126 %require% verb. For example:
25129 require control = no_multiline_response
25133 End of bulleted list, continue with variable list
25137 *delay*~=~<'time'>::
25138 cindex:[%delay%, ACL modifier]
25139 cindex:[%-bh% option]
25140 This modifier causes Exim to wait for the time interval before proceeding. The
25141 time is given in the usual Exim notation. This modifier may appear in any ACL.
25142 The delay happens as soon as the modifier is processed. However, when testing
25143 Exim using the %-bh% option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate
25144 message is output instead).
25146 Like %control%, %delay% can be used with %accept% or
25147 %deny%, for example:
25149 deny ...some conditions...
25152 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25153 ``deny''. Compare this with:
25156 ...some conditions...
25158 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The %delay% modifier can
25159 also be used with %warn% and together with %control%:
25161 warn ...some conditions...
25167 cindex:[%endpass%, ACL modifier]
25168 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in %accept%
25169 statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose failure causes
25170 control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose failure causes
25171 the ACL to return ``deny''. See the description of %accept% above.
25173 *log_message*~=~<'text'>::
25174 cindex:[%log_message%, ACL modifier]
25175 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25176 ACL denies access or a %warn% statement's conditions are true. For example:
25178 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25179 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25181 %log_message% adds to any underlying error message that may exist because of
25182 the condition failure. For example, while verifying a recipient address, a
25183 ':fail:' redirection might have already set up a message. Although the message
25184 is usually defined before the conditions to which it applies, the expansion
25185 does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be denied. This means that
25186 any variables that are set by the condition are available for inclusion in the
25187 message. For example, the $dnslist_$<'xxx'> variables are set after a DNS
25188 black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of %log_message% fails, or if the
25189 result is an empty string, the modifier is ignored.
25191 If you want to use a %warn% statement to log the result of an address
25192 verification, you can use $acl_verify_message$ to include the verification
25195 If %log_message% is used with a %warn% statement, ``Warning:'' is added to the
25196 start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested more
25197 than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is actually
25198 logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use %logwrite% instead of
25199 %log_message%. In the absence of %log_message% and %logwrite%, nothing is
25200 logged for a succesful %warn% statement.
25202 If %log_message% is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25203 example, from the failure of address verification), but %message% is present,
25204 the %message% text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25205 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25206 both %log_message% and %message%, a default built-in message is used for
25207 logging rejections.
25209 *logwrite*~=~<'text'>::
25210 cindex:[%logwrite%, ACL modifier]
25211 cindex:[logging in ACL, immediate]
25212 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25213 processing an ACL. (Compare %log_message%, which, except in the case of
25214 %warn%, is used only if the ACL statement denies access.) The %logwrite%
25215 modifier can be used to log special incidents in ACLs. For example:
25217 accept <some special conditions>
25219 logwrite = froze message because ...
25221 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25222 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25223 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25226 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25227 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25229 *message*~=~<'text'>::
25230 cindex:[%message%, ACL modifier]
25231 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as an error
25232 message if the current statement causes the ACL to deny access. The expansion
25233 happens at the time Exim decides that access is to be denied, not at the time
25234 it processes %message%. If the expansion fails, or generates an empty string,
25235 the modifier is ignored. For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the
25236 message is returned as part of the SMTP error response.
25238 The %message% modifier is also used with the %warn% verb to specify one or more
25239 header lines to be added to an incoming message when all the conditions are
25240 true. See section <<SECTaddheadwarn>> for more details. If %message% is used
25241 with %warn% in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25244 The text is literal; any quotes are taken as literals, but because the string
25245 is expanded, backslash escapes are processed anyway. If the message contains
25246 newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP response. Like %log_message%,
25247 the contents of %message% are not expanded until after a condition has failed.
25249 If %message% is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25250 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25251 However, the original message is available in the variable
25252 $acl_verify_message$, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25253 wish. In particular, if you want the text from %:fail:% items in ^redirect^
25254 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25255 use a %message% modifier, or make use of $acl_verify_message$.
25257 *set*~<'acl_name'>~=~<'value'>::
25258 cindex:[%set%, ACL modifier]
25259 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25260 <<SECTaclvariables>>).
25265 Use of the control modifier
25266 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
25267 cindex:[%control%, ACL modifier]
25268 The %control% modifier supports the following settings:
25270 *control~=~caseful_local_part*::
25273 *control~=~caselower_local_part*::
25274 cindex:[{ACL},case of local part in]
25275 cindex:[case of local parts]
25276 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by %acl_smtp_rcpt%
25277 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of $local_part$ are
25278 lower cased before ACL processing. If ``caseful_local_part'' is specified, any
25279 uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in $local_part$ for
25280 the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets ``caselower_local_part'' is
25283 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25284 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25285 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25286 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25287 configuration (see the %caseful_local_part% generic router option).
25289 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25290 containing upper case letters. For example, using $acl_m4$ to accumulate the
25294 warn control = caseful_local_part
25295 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25297 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25299 control = caselower_local_part
25302 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25303 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25305 *control~=~enforce_sync*::
25308 *control~=~no_enforce_sync*::
25309 cindex:[SMTP,synchronization checking]
25310 cindex:[synchronization checking in SMTP]
25311 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25312 is enforced. The global option %smtp_enforce_sync% specifies the initial
25313 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25314 in chapter <<CHAPmainconfig>> for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25316 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25317 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25318 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25319 %acl_smtp_connect%, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25320 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25321 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25324 *control~=~fakereject/*<'message'>::
25325 cindex:[fake rejection]
25326 cindex:[rejection, fake]
25327 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25328 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25329 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25330 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25331 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25332 the same SMTP connection.
25334 The text for the 550 response is taken from the %control% modifier. If no
25335 message is supplied, the following is used:
25337 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25338 550-kept for evaluation.
25339 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25340 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25342 This facilty should be used with extreme caution.
25344 *control~=~freeze*::
25345 cindex:[frozen messages,forcing in ACL]
25346 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25347 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25348 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25349 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25352 *control~=~no_mbox_unspool*::
25353 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25354 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25355 of it, to be written in ``mbox format'' to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25356 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25357 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25358 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25359 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25360 to be useful in production.
25362 *control~=~no_multiline_response*::
25363 cindex:[multiline responses, suppressing]
25364 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25365 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25366 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25368 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25369 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25370 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25371 (``use multiline responses for more'' it says -- ha!), and some of the responses
25372 might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a sop to
25373 broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25376 . Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25377 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically ``sender
25378 verification failed'') is sent.
25380 . If a %message% modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25384 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25385 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25387 *control~=~queue_only*::
25388 cindex:[%queue_only%]
25389 cindex:[queueing incoming messages]
25390 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25391 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25392 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25393 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25394 effect as the %queue_only% global option. However, the control applies only to
25395 the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25396 same SMTP connection.
25398 *control~=~submission/*<'options'>::
25399 cindex:[message,submission]
25400 cindex:[submission mode]
25401 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25402 latter is the one defined by %acl_smtp_predata%). Setting it tells Exim that
25403 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25404 operates in ``submission mode'', and applies certain fixups to the message if
25405 necessary. For example, it add a 'Date:' header line if one is not present.
25406 This control is not permitted in the %acl_smtp_data% ACL, because that is too
25407 late (the message has already been created).
25409 Chapter <<CHAPmsgproc>> describes the processing that Exim applies to messages.
25410 Section <<SECTsubmodnon>> covers the processing that happens in submission mode;
25411 the available options for this control are described there. The control applies
25412 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25413 the same SMTP connection.
25417 [[SECTaddheadwarn]]
25418 Adding header lines with the warn verb
25419 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
25420 cindex:[header lines,adding in an ACL]
25421 cindex:[header lines,position of added lines]
25422 cindex:[%warn%, ACL verb]
25423 cindex:[%message%, ACL modifier]
25424 The %message% modifier can be used on a %warn% statement to add an extra header
25425 line to an incoming message, as in this example:
25428 warn message = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
25429 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25430 dialup.mail-abuse.org
25433 If an identical header line is requested several times (provoked, for example,
25434 by multiple RCPT commands), only one copy is actually added to the message.
25435 If the text of the %message% modifier contains one or more newlines that are
25436 not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
25437 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; `X-ACL-Warn:` is added to the
25438 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
25440 By default, new lines are added at the end of the existing header lines.
25441 However, you can specify that any particular header line should be added right
25442 at the start (before all the 'Received:' lines), immediately after the first
25443 block of 'Received:' lines, or immediately before any line that is not a
25444 'Received:' or 'Resent-something:' header.
25446 This is done by specifying ``:at_start:'', ``:after_received:'', or
25447 ``:at_start_rfc:'' (or, for completeness, ``:at_end:'') before the text of the
25448 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
25449 to be a header name first.) For example:
25451 warn message = :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
25454 If more than one header is supplied in a single warn statement, each one is
25455 treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If you add
25456 more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they will
25457 end up in reverse order.
25459 *Warning*: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
25460 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
25461 system filter or in a router or transport.
25463 cindex:[header lines,added; visibility of]
25464 Header lines that are added by an ACL at MAIL or RCPT time are not
25465 visible in string expansions in ACLs for subsequent RCPT commands or in the
25466 %acl_smtp_predata% ACL. However, they are visible in string expansions in the
25467 ACL that is run after DATA is complete (the %acl_smtp_data% ACL). This is
25468 also true for header lines that are added in the %acl_smtp_predata% ACL.
25469 If a message is rejected after DATA, all added header lines are included in
25470 the entry that is written to the reject log.
25472 If you want to preserve data between MAIL, RCPT, and the
25473 %acl_smtp_predata% ACLs, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
25474 <<SECTaclvariables>>.
25480 [[SECTaclconditions]]
25483 cindex:[{ACL},conditions; list of]
25484 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
25485 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
25486 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
25487 content scanning in chapter <<CHAPexiscan>>.
25489 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
25490 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
25491 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
25492 done only in the ACLs specified by %acl_smtp_data% and %acl_not_smtp%. You can
25493 use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the same
25494 ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an ``and'' conjunction. The
25495 conditions are as follows:
25498 *acl~=~*<'name~of~acl~or~ACL~string~or~file~name~'>::
25499 cindex:[{ACL},nested]
25500 cindex:[{ACL},indirect]
25501 cindex:[%acl%, ACL condition]
25502 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the %acl_smtp_%##'xxx'
25503 options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns ``accept'' the condition
25504 is true; if it returns ``deny'' the condition is false. If it returns
25505 ``defer'', the current ACL returns ``defer'' unless the condition is on a
25506 %warn% verb. In that case, a ``defer'' return makes the condition false. This
25507 means that further processing of the %warn% verb ceases, but processing of the
25510 If the nested %acl% returns ``drop'' and the outer condition denies access, the
25511 connection is dropped. If it returns ``discard'', the verb must be %accept% or
25512 %discard%, and the action is taken immediately -- no further conditions are
25515 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
25516 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
25517 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
25518 for different local users or different local domains.
25520 *authenticated~=~*<'string~list'>::
25521 cindex:[%authenticated%, ACL condition]
25522 cindex:[authentication,ACL checking]
25523 cindex:[{ACL},testing for authentication]
25524 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
25525 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
25526 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
25530 *condition~=~*<'string'>::
25531 cindex:[%condition%, ACL condition]
25532 cindex:[customizing,ACL condition]
25533 cindex:[{ACL},customized test]
25534 cindex:[{ACL},testing; customized]
25535 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
25536 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
25537 ``no'' or ``false'', the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
25538 number, or one of the strings ``yes'' or ``true'', the condition is true. For
25539 any other values, some error is assumed to have occured, and the ACL returns
25542 *decode~=~*<'location'>::
25543 cindex:[%decode%, ACL condition]
25544 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25545 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only the the ACL defined by
25546 %acl_smtp_mime%. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file. For
25547 details, see chapter <<CHAPexiscan>>.
25549 *dnslists~=~*<'list~of~domain~names~and~other~data'>::
25550 cindex:[%dnslists%, ACL condition]
25551 cindex:[DNS list,in ACL]
25552 cindex:[black list (DNS)]
25553 cindex:[{ACL},testing a DNS list]
25554 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
25555 ``RBL lists'', after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
25556 use of the lists at 'mail-abuse.org' now carries a charge. There are too many
25557 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
25558 <<SECTmorednslists>>--<<SECTmorednslistslast>> for details.
25560 *domains~=~*<'domain~list'>::
25561 cindex:[%domains%, ACL condition]
25562 cindex:[domain,ACL checking]
25563 cindex:[{ACL},testing a recipient domain]
25564 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
25565 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
25566 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
25567 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in $domain_data$ until the next
25570 *encrypted~=~*<'string~list'>::
25571 cindex:[%encrypted%, ACL condition]
25572 cindex:[encryption,checking in an ACL]
25573 cindex:[{ACL},testing for encryption]
25574 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
25575 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
25576 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
25580 *hosts~=~*<'~host~list'>::
25581 cindex:[%hosts%, ACL condition]
25582 cindex:[host,ACL checking]
25583 cindex:[{ACL},testing the client host]
25584 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
25585 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
25586 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
25588 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
25590 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
25591 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
25592 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
25593 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
25594 %accept% statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
25595 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
25597 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
25598 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
25600 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
25601 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
25603 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
25604 is not in the list, so the first %accept% statement fails. The second statement
25605 can then check the IP address.
25607 If a %hosts% condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
25608 of the lookup is made available in the $host_data$ variable. This
25609 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
25611 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
25612 message = $host_data
25614 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
25616 *local_parts~=~*<'local~part~list'>::
25617 cindex:[%local_parts%, ACL condition]
25618 cindex:[local part,ACL checking]
25619 cindex:[{ACL},testing a local part]
25620 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
25621 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
25622 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
25623 result of the lookup is placed in $local_part_data$ until the next
25624 %local_parts% test.
25626 *malware~=~*<'option'>::
25627 cindex:[%malware%, ACL condition]
25628 cindex:[{ACL},virus scanning]
25629 cindex:[{ACL},scanning for viruses]
25630 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25631 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
25632 viruses. For details, see chapter <<CHAPexiscan>>.
25634 *mime_regex~=~*<'list~of~regular~expressions'>::
25635 cindex:[%mime_regex%, ACL condition]
25636 cindex:[{ACL},testing by regex matching]
25637 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25638 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only the the ACL defined by
25639 %acl_smtp_mime%. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match with
25640 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter <<CHAPexiscan>>.
25642 *recipients~=~*<'address~list'>::
25643 cindex:[%recipients%, ACL condition]
25644 cindex:[recipient,ACL checking]
25645 cindex:[{ACL},testing a recipient]
25646 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
25647 recipient address against a list of recipients.
25649 *regex~=~*<'list~of~regular~expressions'>::
25650 cindex:[%regex%, ACL condition]
25651 cindex:[{ACL},testing by regex matching]
25652 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25653 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a
25654 match with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
25657 *sender_domains~=~*<'domain~list'>::
25658 cindex:[%sender_domains%, ACL condition]
25659 cindex:[sender,ACL checking]
25660 cindex:[{ACL},testing a sender domain]
25661 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
25662 domain list. *Note*: the domain of the sender address is in
25663 $sender_address_domain$. It is 'not' put in $domain$ during the testing of this
25664 condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain lists.
25665 It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a RCPT
25666 command, the recipient's domain (which is in $domain$) can be used to influence
25667 the sender checking.
25669 *senders~=~*<'address~list'>::
25670 cindex:[%senders%, ACL condition]
25671 cindex:[sender,ACL checking]
25672 cindex:[{ACL},testing a sender]
25673 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
25674 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
25678 *spam~=~*<'username'>::
25679 cindex:[%spam%, ACL condition]
25680 cindex:[{ACL},scanning for spam]
25681 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25682 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
25683 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter <<CHAPexiscan>>.
25685 *verify~=~certificate*::
25686 cindex:[%verify%, ACL condition]
25687 cindex:[TLS,client certificate verification]
25688 cindex:[certificate,verification of client]
25689 cindex:[{ACL},certificate verification]
25690 cindex:[{ACL},testing a TLS certificate]
25691 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
25692 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
25693 server requests a certificate only if the client matches %tls_verify_hosts% or
25694 %tls_try_verify_hosts% (see chapter <<CHAPTLS>>).
25696 *verify~=~header_sender/*<'options'>::
25697 cindex:[%verify%, ACL condition]
25698 cindex:[{ACL},verifying sender in the header]
25699 cindex:[header lines,verifying the sender in]
25700 cindex:[sender,verifying in header]
25701 cindex:[verifying,sender in header]
25702 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
25703 received, that is, in an ACL specified by %acl_smtp_data% or %acl_not_smtp%. It
25704 checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one of the 'Sender:',
25705 'Reply-To:', or 'From:' header lines. Such an address is loosely thought of as
25706 a ``sender'' address (hence the name of the test). However, an address that
25707 appears in one of these headers need not be an address that accepts bounce
25708 messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required to accept bounces.
25709 Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you might want to
25710 arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
25712 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
25713 section <<SECTaddressverification>> (callouts are described in section
25714 <<SECTcallver>>). You can combine this condition with the %senders% condition to
25715 restrict it to bounce messages only:
25718 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
25719 !verify = header_sender
25721 *verify~=~header_syntax*::
25722 cindex:[%verify%, ACL condition]
25723 cindex:[{ACL},verifying header syntax]
25724 cindex:[header lines,verifying syntax]
25725 cindex:[verifying,header syntax]
25726 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
25727 received, that is, in an ACL specified by %acl_smtp_data% or %acl_not_smtp%. It
25728 checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain lists of addresses
25729 ('Sender:', 'From:', 'Reply-To:', 'To:', 'Cc:', and 'Bcc:'). Unqualified
25730 addresses (local parts without domains) are permitted only in locally generated
25731 messages and from hosts that match %sender_unqualified_hosts% or
25732 %recipient_unqualified_hosts%, as appropriate.
25734 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
25735 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
25739 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
25740 common as they used to be.
25743 cindex:[%verify%, ACL condition]
25744 cindex:[{ACL},verifying HELO/EHLO]
25745 cindex:[HELO,verifying]
25746 cindex:[EHLO,verifying]
25747 cindex:[verifying,EHLO]
25748 cindex:[verifying,HELO]
25749 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
25750 client host, and its contents have been verified. Verification of these
25751 commands does not happen by default. See the description of the
25752 %helo_verify_hosts% and %helo_try_verify_hosts% options for details of how to
25755 *verify~=~recipient/*<'options'>::
25756 cindex:[%verify%, ACL condition]
25757 cindex:[{ACL},verifying recipient]
25758 cindex:[recipient,verifying]
25759 cindex:[verifying,recipient]
25760 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
25761 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
25762 <<SECTaddressverification>>. After a recipient has been verified, the value of
25763 $address_data$ is the last value that was set while routing the address. This
25764 applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being verified
25765 is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new address,
25766 and in that case, the subsequent value of $address_data$ is the value for the
25769 *verify~=~reverse_host_lookup*::
25770 cindex:[%verify%, ACL condition]
25771 cindex:[{ACL},verifying host reverse lookup]
25772 cindex:[host,verifying reverse lookup]
25773 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
25774 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
25775 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched %host_lookup%.)
25776 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
25777 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
25778 original IP address.
25780 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
25781 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
25783 *verify~=~sender/*<'options'>::
25784 cindex:[%verify%, ACL condition]
25785 cindex:[{ACL},verifying sender]
25786 cindex:[sender,verifying]
25787 cindex:[verifying,sender]
25788 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
25789 message has been received (the %acl_smtp_data% or %acl_not_smtp% ACLs). If the
25790 message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the condition is
25791 true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
25793 If there is data in the $address_data$ variable at the end of routing, its
25794 value is placed in $sender_address_data$ at the end of verification. This
25795 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
25796 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
25797 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
25799 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
25800 <<SECTaddressverification>>. Exim caches the result of sender verification, to
25801 avoid doing it more than once per message.
25803 *verify~=~sender=*<'address'>*/*<'options'>::
25804 cindex:[%verify%, ACL condition]
25805 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
25806 verified as a sender.
25810 [[SECTmorednslists]]
25813 cindex:[DNS list,in ACL]
25814 cindex:[black list (DNS)]
25815 cindex:[{ACL},testing a DNS list]
25816 In its simplest form, the %dnslists% condition tests whether the calling host
25817 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
25818 address in one or more DNS domains. For example, if the calling host's IP
25819 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
25822 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
25823 dialups.mail-abuse.org
25826 the following records are looked up:
25828 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25829 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
25831 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
25832 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an ``or'' conjunction. If you want to
25833 test that a host is on more than one list (an ``and'' conjunction), you can use
25834 two separate conditions:
25836 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25837 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
25839 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
25840 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
25841 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
25844 This is usually the required action when %dnslists% is used with %deny% (which
25845 is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from blocking
25846 mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the following
25847 special items in the list:
25849 cindex:[`+include_unknown`]
25850 cindex:[`+exclude_unknown`]
25851 cindex:[`+defer_unknown`]
25853 `+include_unknown ` behave as if the item is on the list
25854 `+exclude_unknown ` behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
25855 `+defer_unknown ` give a temporary error
25857 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
25859 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
25862 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
25863 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
25865 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25866 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
25867 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
25870 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
25871 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
25872 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
25873 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
25877 Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup
25878 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
25879 cindex:[DNS list,keyed by explicit IP address]
25880 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
25881 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
25882 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
25884 deny dnslists = black.list.tls/192.168.1.2
25886 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
25887 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
25888 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
25889 <<SECTmulkeyfor>> below.
25894 DNS lists keyed on domain names
25895 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
25896 cindex:[DNS list,keyed by domain name]
25897 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
25898 addresses (see for example the 'domain based zones' link at
25899 *http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/[]*). No reversing of components is used with
25900 these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by listing
25901 it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
25903 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
25904 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
25906 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
25907 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
25908 example) the message's sender is 'user@tld.example' the name that is looked
25909 up by this example is
25911 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
25913 A single %dnslists% condition can contain entries for both names and IP
25914 addresses. For example:
25917 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25918 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
25921 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
25922 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
25928 Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list
25929 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
25930 cindex:[DNS list,multiple keys for]
25931 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
25932 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
25933 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
25934 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
25935 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
25936 either to double the separators like this:
25938 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
25940 or to change the separator character, like this:
25942 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
25944 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
25945 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
25946 occurs. Consider this condition:
25948 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
25950 The DNS lookups that occur are:
25952 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
25953 a.domain.black.list.tld
25955 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
25956 address, if specified -- see section <<SECTaddmatcon>>), no further lookups are
25957 done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains or
25958 IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
25959 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
25960 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
25961 error for a previous item.
25963 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
25964 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
25966 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
25967 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
25969 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
25970 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
25973 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
25974 $sender_address_domain \
25975 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
25977 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
25978 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
25979 $sender_address_domain} }} }
25982 Note the use of `>|` in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
25983 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
25984 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
25985 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
25987 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
25989 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
25990 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
25996 Data returned by DNS lists
25997 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
25998 cindex:[DNS list,data returned from]
25999 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26000 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26001 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26002 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26007 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26009 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26010 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26011 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26014 Some DNS lists may return more than one address record.
26017 Variables set from DNS lists
26018 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26019 cindex:[DNS list,variables set from]
26020 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable $dnslist_domain$
26021 contains the name of the domain that matched, $dnslist_value$ contains the
26022 data from the entry, and $dnslist_text$ contains the contents of any
26023 associated TXT record. If more than one address record is returned by the DNS
26024 lookup, all the IP addresses are included in $dnslist_value$, separated by
26027 You can use these variables in %message% or %log_message% modifiers --
26028 although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not expanded
26029 until after it has failed. For example:
26032 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26033 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26035 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26042 Additional matching conditions for DNS lists
26043 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26044 cindex:[DNS list,matching specific returned data]
26045 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a %dnslists% domain name in
26046 order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26049 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26051 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26052 any address record is considered to be a match. If more than one address record
26053 is found on the list, they are all checked for a matching right-hand side.
26055 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26056 separator. These are alternatives -- if any one of them matches, the %dnslists%
26057 condition is true. For example:
26059 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26062 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26063 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26064 first. For example:
26067 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26068 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26072 If the character ``&'' is used instead of ``='', the comparison for each listed
26073 IP address is done by a bitwise ``and'' instead of by an equality test. In
26074 other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26075 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26076 tested. For example:
26078 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26080 matches if the address is 'x.x.x.'3, 'x.x.x.'7, 'x.x.x.'11, etc. If you
26081 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26082 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26084 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26086 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26091 Negated DNS matching conditions
26092 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26093 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a %dnslists%
26096 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26098 means ``deny if the host is in the black list at the domain 'a.b.c' and the IP
26099 address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3'',
26101 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26103 means ``deny if the host is in the black list at the domain 'a.b.c' and the IP
26104 address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3''. In other
26105 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26106 the ``='' (or the ``&'') sign.
26108 *Note*: this kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26109 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26111 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26112 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26114 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26115 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26117 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26118 Consider this example:
26121 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26123 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26127 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26130 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26132 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26133 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26134 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26137 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26142 [[SECTmorednslistslast]]
26145 cindex:[IPv6,DNS black lists]
26146 cindex:[DNS list,IPv6 usage]
26147 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26148 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26149 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26151 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26152 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26154 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26155 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26156 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26158 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26160 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26161 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26163 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26164 %condition% condition, as in this example:
26166 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26167 dnslists = some.list.example
26172 [[SECTaddressverification]]
26173 Address verification
26174 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26175 cindex:[verifying address, options for]
26176 cindex:[policy control,address verification]
26177 Several of the %verify% conditions described in section <<SECTaclconditions>>
26178 cause addresses to be verified. These conditions can be followed by options
26179 that modify the verification process. The options are separated from the
26180 keyword and from each other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters.
26183 verify = sender/callout
26184 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
26186 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
26187 address through the routers, in ``verify mode''. Routers can detect the
26188 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
26189 be varied by a number of generic options such as %verify% and %verify_only%
26190 (see chapter <<CHAProutergeneric>>). If routing fails, verification fails.
26191 The available options are as follows:
26193 - If the %callout% option is specified, successful routing to one or more remote
26194 hosts is followed by a ``callout'' to those hosts as an additional check.
26195 Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
26197 - If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
26198 normally returns ``defer''. However, if you include %defer_ok% in the options,
26199 the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
26200 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
26202 - The %no_details% option is covered in section <<SECTsenaddver>>, which discusses
26203 the reporting of sender address verification failures.
26205 cindex:[verifying address, differentiating failures]
26206 After an address verification failure, $sender_verify_failure$ or
26207 $recipient_verify_failure$ (as appropriate) contains one of the following
26210 - %qualify%: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
26211 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
26213 - %route%: Routing failed.
26215 - %mail%: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
26216 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
26217 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
26219 - %recipient%: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
26221 - %postmaster%: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
26224 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
26225 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
26231 Callout verification
26232 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26233 cindex:[verifying address, by callout]
26234 cindex:[callout,verification]
26235 cindex:[SMTP,callout verification]
26236 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
26237 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
26238 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
26239 'callback' to the sending host (for a sender address) or a 'callforward' to
26240 a subsequent host (for a recipient address), to see if the host accepts the
26241 address. We use the term 'callout' to cover both cases. This facility should
26242 be used with care, because it can add a lot of resource usage to the cost of
26243 verifying an address. However, Exim does cache the results of callouts, which
26244 helps to reduce the cost. Details of caching are in the next section.
26246 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
26247 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
26248 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver.
26249 A successful callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address
26250 would succeed; on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that
26251 a delivery would fail.
26253 If the %callout% option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
26254 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
26255 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a ^dnslookup^ or a
26256 ^manualroute^ router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
26257 router that does not set up hosts routes to an ^smtp^ transport with a
26258 %hosts% setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an ^smtp^ transport has
26259 %hosts_override% set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
26260 supplies a host list.
26262 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
26263 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
26264 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
26265 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
26268 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
26269 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
26270 following SMTP commands are sent:
26273 `HELO `<'smtp active host name'>
26275 `RCPT TO:`<'the address to be tested'>
26279 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's %protocol% option is
26282 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
26283 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
26284 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
26285 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
26286 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
26287 %use_sender% and %use_postmaster% options, described in the next section.
26289 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2'##xx' code, the verification
26290 succeeds. If it is 5##'xx', the verification fails. For any other condition,
26291 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
26292 hosts, the ACL yields ``defer'', unless the %defer_ok% parameter of the
26293 %callout% option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
26300 Additional parameters for callouts
26301 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26302 cindex:[callout,additional parameters for]
26303 The %callout% option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of optional
26304 parameters, separated by commas. For example:
26306 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
26308 The old syntax, which had %callout_defer_ok% and %check_postmaster% as
26309 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
26310 deprecated. The additional parameters for %callout% are as follows:
26313 <'a~time~interval'>::
26314 cindex:[callout timeout, specifying]
26315 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
26318 verify = sender/callout=5s
26320 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
26321 remote host. It is also used for the intial connection, unless overridden by
26322 the %connect% parameter.
26325 *connect~=~*<'time~interval'>::
26326 cindex:[callout connection timeout, specifying]
26327 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
26328 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
26330 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
26332 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
26335 cindex:[callout defer, action on]
26336 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
26337 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
26338 updated in this circumstance.
26340 *mailfrom~=~*<'email~address'>::
26341 cindex:[callout,sender when verifying header]
26342 When verifying addresses in header lines using the %header_sender% verification
26343 option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope sender
26344 addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see whether a
26345 bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the MAIL
26346 command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used as
26347 envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages (empty
26348 senders). The %mailfrom% callout parameter allows you to specify what address
26349 to use in the MAIL command. For example:
26351 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
26353 This parameter is available only for the %header_sender% verification option.
26356 *maxwait~=~*<'time~interval'>::
26357 cindex:[callout overall timeout, specifying]
26358 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
26361 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
26363 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
26364 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
26365 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
26366 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
26367 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
26371 cindex:[callout cache, suppressing]
26372 cindex:[caching callout, suppressing]
26373 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
26376 cindex:[callout,postmaster; checking]
26377 When this parameter is set, a sucessful callout check is followed by a similar
26378 check for the local part 'postmaster' at the same domain. If this address is
26379 rejected, the callout fails. The result of the postmaster check is recorded in
26380 a cache record; if it is a failure, this is used to fail subsequent callouts
26381 for the domain without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
26383 *postmaster_mailfrom~=~*<'email~address'>::
26384 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
26385 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
26388 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
26390 If both %postmaster% and %postmaster_mailfrom% are present, the rightmost one
26391 overrides. The %postmaster% parameter is equivalent to this example:
26393 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
26395 *Warning*: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
26396 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
26397 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
26398 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
26402 cindex:[callout,``random'' check]
26403 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
26404 check for a ``random'' local part at the same domain. The local part is not
26405 really random -- it is defined by the expansion of the option
26406 %callout_random_local_part%, which defaults to
26408 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
26410 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
26411 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
26412 specific local parts. If the ``random'' check succeeds, the result is saved in
26413 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
26414 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
26417 cindex:[callout,sender for recipient check]
26418 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
26420 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
26422 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command
26423 when performing the callout. The local part of the address is `postmaster`
26424 and the domain is the contents of $qualify_domain$.
26427 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
26429 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
26431 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
26432 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
26433 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
26434 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
26435 usefulness of callout caching.
26441 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
26442 command (%mailfrom%, %postmaster_mailfrom%, %use_postmaster%, or
26443 %use_sender%), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
26444 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
26445 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
26446 Therefore, it is normally safe to use %use_postmaster% or %use_sender% in
26447 these circumstances.
26449 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
26450 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
26451 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
26452 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
26453 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
26454 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
26455 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
26457 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
26458 caching. When you set %mailfrom% or %use_sender%, the cache record is keyed by
26459 the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
26460 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
26465 [[SECTcallvercache]]
26468 cindex:[hints database,callout cache]
26469 cindex:[callout,caching]
26470 cindex:[caching,callout]
26471 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
26472 used, unless you specify the %no_cache% parameter with the %callout% option.
26473 A hints database called ``callout'' is used for the cache. Two different record
26474 types are used: one records the result of a callout check for a specific
26475 address, and the other records information that applies to the entire domain
26476 (for example, that it accepts the local part 'postmaster').
26478 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
26479 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
26482 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
26483 independent, and can be set by the global options %callout_negative_expire%
26484 (default 2h) and %callout_positive_expire% (default 24h), respectively.
26486 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
26487 commands up to and including
26491 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
26492 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
26493 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
26494 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
26495 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
26496 %callout_domain_negative_expire% (default 3h) and
26497 %callout_domain_positive_expire% (default 7d).
26499 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
26500 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
26501 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
26502 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting ``random'' local parts
26503 will eventually be noticed.
26505 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
26506 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
26507 behaviour will be the same.
26512 Sender address verification reporting
26513 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26514 cindex:[verifying,suppressing error details]
26515 When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the failure are
26516 given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the relevant
26517 SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
26520 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
26522 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
26523 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
26524 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
26525 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
26526 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
26527 550 Sender verification failed
26529 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
26530 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
26531 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
26532 ``/no_details'' to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
26535 verify = sender/no_details
26540 Redirection while verifying
26541 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26542 cindex:[verifying,redirection while]
26543 cindex:[address redirection,while verifying]
26544 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
26545 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
26546 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
26547 it? Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
26549 - When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
26550 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
26551 verification also fails.
26553 - When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
26554 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
26556 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
26557 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
26558 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
26561 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
26563 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
26564 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
26565 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
26566 verification to succeed.
26570 [[SECTrelaycontrol]]
26571 Using an ACL to control relaying
26572 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26573 cindex:[{ACL},relay control]
26574 cindex:[relaying,control by ACL]
26575 cindex:[policy control,relay control]
26576 An MTA is said to 'relay' a message if it receives it from some host and
26577 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
26578 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
26579 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
26581 cindex:[``percent hack'']
26582 but a redirection as a result of the ``percent hack'' is.
26584 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed ``incoming'' and ``outgoing''.
26585 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
26586 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
26587 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
26588 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
26589 same host is fulfilling both functions,
26591 as illustrated in the diagram below,
26593 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
26594 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
26595 system to arbitrary domains.
26598 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
26599 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
26600 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
26601 example, suppose you want to do the following:
26603 - Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
26604 locally in some other way). Let's say these are 'my.dom1.example' and
26607 - Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
26608 These might be 'friend1.example' and 'friend2.example'.
26610 - Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
26611 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
26614 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
26616 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
26617 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
26618 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
26620 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
26624 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
26625 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
26627 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
26628 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
26629 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
26630 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
26631 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
26632 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
26633 in chapter <<CHAPdefconfil>>.
26638 Checking a relay configuration
26639 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26640 cindex:[relaying,checking control of]
26641 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
26642 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
26643 the %-bh% option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26645 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
26646 'relay-test.mail-abuse.org' provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
26647 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
26648 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
26649 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
26650 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
26651 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
26656 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26657 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26662 cindex:[content scanning]
26663 The content-scanning extension of Exim, formerly known as ``exiscan'', was
26664 originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code was integrated into
26665 the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to maintain it. Most
26666 of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's specification.
26668 If you want to include the content-scanning features when you compile Exim, you
26669 need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
26670 _Local/Makefile_. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
26672 - An additional ACL (%acl_smtp_mime%) that is run for all MIME parts.
26674 - Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: %decode%, %malware%, %mime_regex%,
26675 %regex%, and %spam%. These can be used in the ACL that is run at the end of
26676 message reception (the %acl_smtp_data% ACL).
26678 - An additional control feature (``no_mbox_unspool'') that saves spooled copies
26679 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
26681 - Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
26684 - Two new main configuration options: %av_scanner% and %spamd_address%.
26686 There is another content-scanning configuration option for _Local/Makefile_,
26687 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated %demime% ACL
26688 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
26690 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
26691 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
26692 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
26693 EXPERIMENTAL_ in _Local/Makefile_. Such features are not documented in
26694 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
26695 _doc/experimental.txt_.
26697 All the content-scanning facilites work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
26698 temporarily created in a file called:
26700 <spool_directory>/scan/<message_id>/<message_id>.eml
26702 The _.eml_ extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
26703 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
26704 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
26705 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
26706 removed when the %acl_smtp_data% ACL has finished running, unless
26708 control = no_mbox_unspool
26710 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
26711 same directory by default.
26716 Scanning for viruses
26717 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26718 cindex:[virus scanning]
26719 cindex:[content scanning,for viruses]
26720 cindex:[content scanning,the %malware% condition]
26721 The %malware% ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim. It
26722 supports a ``generic'' interface to scanners called via the shell, and
26723 specialized interfaces for ``daemon'' type virus scanners, which are resident in
26724 memory and thus are much faster.
26726 cindex:[%av_scanner%]
26727 You can set the %av_scanner% option in first part of the Exim configuration
26728 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
26729 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
26731 av_scanner = <scanner-type>:<option1>:<option2>:[...]
26733 If you do not set %av_scanner%, it defaults to
26735 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
26737 If the value of %av_scanner% starts with dollar character, it is expanded
26740 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
26743 cindex:[virus scanners,Kaspersky]
26744 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
26745 at *http://www.kaspersky.com[]*. This scanner type takes one option, which is
26746 the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this example:
26748 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
26751 cindex:[virus scanners,clamd]
26752 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
26753 *http://www.clamav.net/[]*. Clamd does not seem to unpack MIME containers, so
26754 it is recommended to unpack MIME attachments in the MIME ACL. It takes one
26755 option: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
26756 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
26758 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
26759 av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
26761 If the option is unset, the default is _/tmp/clamd_. Thanks to David Saez for
26762 contributing the code for this scanner.
26765 cindex:[virus scanners,command line interface]
26766 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
26767 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
26768 type takes 3 mandatory options:
26771 . The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
26772 and a placeholder (%s) for the directory to scan.
26774 . A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
26775 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
26776 absolutely sure that this expression matches on ``virus found''. This is called
26777 the ``trigger'' expression.
26779 . Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
26780 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
26781 ``name'' expression.
26784 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
26786 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
26788 For the trigger expression, we can just match the word ``found''. For the name
26789 expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match for
26790 the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
26791 configuration setting:
26794 av_scanner = cmdline:\
26795 /path/to/sweep -all -rec -archive %s:\
26801 cindex:[virus scanners,DrWeb]
26802 The DrWeb daemon scanner (*http://www.sald.com/[]*) interface takes one
26803 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
26804 separated by whitespace, as in these examples:
26806 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
26807 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
26809 If you omit the argument, the default path _/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_
26810 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
26813 cindex:[virus scanners,F-Secure]
26814 The F-Secure daemon scanner (*http://www.f-secure.com[]*) takes one argument
26815 which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
26817 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
26819 If no argument is given, the default is _/var/run/.fsav_. Thanks to Johan
26820 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
26823 cindex:[virus scanners,Kaspersky]
26824 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
26825 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see %aveserver% above). This
26826 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
26829 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
26831 The default path is _/var/run/AvpCtl_.
26834 cindex:[virus scanners,mksd]
26835 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
26836 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
26837 *http://linux.mks.com.pl/[]*. The only option for this scanner type is the
26838 maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
26839 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
26840 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
26842 av_scanner = mksd:2
26844 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
26847 cindex:[virus scanners,Sophos and Sophie]
26848 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' %libsavi% library to scan for viruses. You
26849 can get Sophie at *http://www.vanja.com/tools/sophie/[]*. The only option for
26850 this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for client
26851 communication. For example:
26853 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
26855 The default path is _/var/run/sophie_, so if you are using this, you can omit
26862 When %av_scanner% is correctly set, you can use the %malware% condition in the
26863 DATA ACL. The %av_scanner% option is expanded each time %malware% is
26864 called. This makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for
26865 an example. The %malware% condition caches its results, so when you use it
26866 multiple times for the same message, the actual scanning process is only
26867 carried out once. However, using expandable items in %av_scanner% disables
26868 this caching, in which case each use of the %malware% condition causes a new
26869 scan of the message.
26871 The %malware% condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
26872 use. It can then be one of
26874 - ``true'', ``\*'', or ``1'', in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
26875 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
26878 - ``false'' or ``0'', in which case no scanning is done and the condition fails
26881 - A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
26882 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
26883 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
26885 You can append `/defer_ok` to the %malware% condition to accept messages even
26886 if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
26888 cindex:[$malware_name$]
26889 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
26890 $malware_name$ that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
26891 %message% modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
26894 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
26895 use the %demime% condition (see section <<SECTdemimecond>>) before the %malware%
26898 Here is a very simple scanning example:
26900 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
26904 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
26906 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
26908 malware = */defer_ok
26910 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
26911 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
26913 av_scanner = $acl_m0
26915 in the main Exim configuration.
26917 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
26918 set acl_m0 = sophie
26921 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
26922 set acl_m0 = aveserver
26928 [[SECTscanspamass]]
26929 Scanning with SpamAssassin
26930 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
26931 cindex:[content scanning,for spam]
26932 cindex:[spam scanning]
26933 cindex:[SpamAssassin, scanning with]
26934 The %spam% ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's %spamd% daemon to get a spam
26935 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
26936 *http://www.spamassassin.org[]*, or, if you have a working Perl installation,
26937 you can use CPAN by running:
26939 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
26941 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
26942 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
26945 cindex:[%spamd_address%]
26946 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the %spamd% daemon.
26947 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
26948 port for %spamd%, you must set the %spamd_address% option in the global part
26949 of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
26951 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
26953 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
26954 %spamd% also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
26955 these, supply %spamd_address% with an absolute file name instead of a
26958 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
26961 You can have multiple %spamd% servers to improve scalability. These can reside
26962 on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple %spamd%
26963 servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the %spamd_address% option,
26964 separated with colons:
26967 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
26968 192.168.2.11 783 : \
26972 Up to 32 %spamd% servers are supported. The servers are
26973 queried in a random fashion. When a server fails to respond
26974 to the connection attempt, all other servers are tried
26975 until one succeeds. If no server responds, the %spam%
26978 *Warning*: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
26979 multiple %spamd% servers.
26981 Here is a simple example of the use of the %spam% condition in a DATA ACL:
26983 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
26986 The right-hand side of the %spam% condition specifies the username that
26987 SpamAssassin should scan for. If you do not want to scan for a particular user,
26988 but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide default profile, you can scan for
26989 an unknown user, or simply use ``nobody''. However, you must put something on the
26992 The username allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles. The
26993 right-hand side is expanded before being used, so you can put lookups or
26994 conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to ``0'' or ``false'', no
26995 scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
26997 The %spam% condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
26998 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
26999 %spam% condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
27000 it always return ``true'' by appending `:true` to the username.
27002 cindex:[spam scanning,returned variables]
27003 When the %spam% condition is run, it sets up the following expansion
27007 The spam score of the message, for example ``3.4'' or ``30.5''. This is useful
27008 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
27011 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
27012 example ``34'' or ``305''. This is useful for numeric comparisons in
27013 conditions. This variable is special; it is saved with the message, and written
27014 to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole life of
27015 the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or transports during
27016 the later delivery phase.
27019 A string consisting of a number of ``+'' or ``-'' characters, representing the
27020 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
27021 $spam_bar$ value of ``++++''. This is useful for inclusion in warning headers,
27022 since MUAs can match on such strings.
27025 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
27026 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
27032 The %spam% condition caches its results. If you call it again with the same
27033 user name, it does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as
27036 The %spam% condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running the
27037 message through SpamAssassin. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to
27038 the next ACL statement block), append `/defer_ok` to the right-hand side of
27039 the spam condition, like this:
27041 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
27042 spam = joe/defer_ok
27044 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a
27045 problem with %spamd%.
27047 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the %spam%
27050 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
27051 warn message = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
27053 warn message = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
27056 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
27057 # is over threshold
27058 warn message = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
27061 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
27062 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
27064 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
27070 [[SECTscanmimepart]]
27071 Scanning MIME parts
27072 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27073 cindex:[content scanning,MIME parts]
27074 cindex:[MIME content scanning]
27075 cindex:[%acl_smtp_mime%]
27076 The %acl_smtp_mime% global option defines an ACL that is called once for each
27077 MIME part of a message, including multipart types, in the sequence of their
27078 position in the message.
27080 This ACL is called (possibly many times) just before the %acl_smtp_data% ACL,
27081 but only if the message has a 'MIME-Version:' header. When a call to the MIME
27082 ACL does not yield ``accept'', ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
27083 result code is sent to the remote client. The %acl_smtp_data% ACL is not
27084 called in this circumstance.
27086 At the start of the MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
27087 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
27088 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
27089 parts whose content-type is ``message/rfc822''. If you want to decode a MIME part
27090 into a disk file, you can use the %decode% modifier. The general syntax is:
27092 decode = [/<path>/]<filename>
27094 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
27097 . ``0'' or ``false'', in which case no decoding is done.
27099 . The string ``default''. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
27100 ``default'' directory <'spool_directory'>_/scan/_<'message_id'>_/_ with a
27101 sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
27102 full path and name is available in $mime_decoded_filename$ after decoding.
27104 . A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
27105 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
27106 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
27107 the full path and file name.
27109 . If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
27110 filename, and the default path is then used.
27116 You can easily decode a file with its original, proposed filename using
27118 decode = $mime_filename
27120 However, you should keep in mind that $mime_filename$ might contain
27121 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
27122 automatically unlinked.
27124 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
27125 content-type of ``message/rfc822''), the ACL is called again in the same manner
27126 as for the primary message, only that the $mime_is_rfc822$ expansion
27127 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
27128 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
27130 The MIME ACL supports the %regex% and %mime_regex% conditions. These can be
27131 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
27132 respectively. They are described in section <<SECTscanregex>>.
27134 cindex:[MIME content scanning,returned variables]
27135 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
27136 available in the MIME ACL:
27139 If the current part is a multipart (see $mime_is_multipart$) below, it should
27140 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
27141 has no boundary parameter in the 'Content-Type:' header, this variable contains
27145 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
27146 'Content-Type:' header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
27152 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
27153 case-insensitively.
27155 $mime_content_description$::
27156 This variable contains the normalized content of the 'Content-Description:'
27157 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
27158 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
27159 only used for display purposes.
27161 $mime_content_disposition$::
27162 This variable contains the normalized content of the 'Content-Disposition:'
27163 header. You can expect strings like ``attachment'' or ``inline'' here.
27165 $mime_content_id$::
27166 This variable contains the normalized content of the 'Content-ID:' header.
27167 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
27169 $mime_content_size$::
27170 This variable is set only after the %decode% modifier (see above) has been
27171 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
27172 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
27173 has a $mime_content_size$ of zero.
27175 $mime_content_transfer_encoding$::
27176 This variable contains the normalized content of the
27177 'Content-transfer-encoding:' header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
27178 type. Typical values are ``base64'' and ``quoted-printable''.
27180 $mime_content_type$::
27181 If the MIME part has a 'Content-Type:' header, this variable contains its
27182 value, lowercased, and without any options (like ``name'' or ``charset''). Here
27183 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
27187 application/octet-stream
27191 If the MIME part has no 'Content-Type:' header, this variable contains the
27194 $mime_decoded_filename$::
27195 This variable is set only after the %decode% modifier (see above) has been
27196 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
27197 containing the decoded data.
27200 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
27201 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
27202 'Content-Type:' or 'Content-Disposition:' headers. The filename will be RFC2047
27203 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was found,
27204 this variable contains the empty string.
27206 $mime_is_coverletter$::
27207 This variable attempts to differentiate the ``cover letter'' of an e-mail from
27208 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unneccessarily encoded
27209 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
27211 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
27212 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
27216 . The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
27218 . If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter, so
27219 are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
27221 . If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
27222 and the rest are attachments.
27224 . All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
27227 As an example, the following will ban ``HTML mail'' (including that sent with
27228 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
27229 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
27231 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
27232 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
27233 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
27234 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
27236 $mime_is_multipart$::
27237 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
27238 ``multipart'', for example ``multipart/alternative'' or ``multipart/mixed''.
27239 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
27240 want to carry out specific actions on them.
27243 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
27244 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
27245 decoding is fully recursive.
27247 $mime_part_count$::
27248 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
27249 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
27250 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
27251 $mime_is_rfc822$). The counter stays set after %acl_smtp_mime% is
27252 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
27253 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
27258 Scanning with regular expressions
27259 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27260 cindex:[content scanning,with regular expressions]
27261 cindex:[regular expressions,content scanning with]
27262 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
27263 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
27265 The %regex% condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
27266 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
27267 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The %regex% condition matches
27268 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
27269 have multiline matches with the %regex% condition.
27271 The %mime_regex% condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
27272 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
27273 part has not been decoded with the %decode% modifier earlier in the ACL, it is
27274 decoded automatically when %mime_regex% is executed (using default path and
27275 filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first 32K
27276 characters are checked.
27278 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
27279 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
27280 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
27281 with more backslashes, or use the `\N` facility to disable expansion.
27282 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
27284 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
27285 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
27287 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
27288 $regex_match_string$ expansion variable is then set up and contains the
27289 matching regular expression.
27291 *Warning*: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
27298 The demime condition
27299 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27300 cindex:[content scanning,MIME checking]
27301 cindex:[MIME content scanning]
27302 The %demime% ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
27303 extension blocking. It uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
27304 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
27305 condition is deprecated and kept only for for backward compatibility. You must
27306 set the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in _Local/Makefile_ at build time to be
27307 able to use the %demime% condition.
27309 The %demime% condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
27310 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
27311 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
27312 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
27313 scanning, it is recommened that you use the %demime% condition before the
27314 antivirus (%malware%) condition.
27316 On the right-hand side of the %demime% condition you can pass a colon-separated
27317 list of file extensions that it should match against. For example:
27319 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
27320 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
27322 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
27323 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, ``disk
27324 full''), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
27325 the condition is on a %warn% verb).
27327 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
27328 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, ``false'', or
27329 zero (``0''), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
27331 The %demime% condition set the following variables:
27333 $demime_errorlevel$::
27334 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
27335 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
27336 severe the error. If this variable is unset or zero, no error occurred.
27339 When $demime_errorlevel$ is greater than zero, this variable contains a
27340 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
27342 $found_extension$::
27343 When the %demime% condition is true, this variable contains the file extension
27350 Both $demime_errorlevel$ and $demime_reason$ are set by the first call of
27351 the %demime% condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
27353 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the %demime%
27354 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass ``\*'' as the
27355 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
27358 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
27359 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
27361 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
27363 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
27364 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
27365 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
27366 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
27368 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
27369 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
27370 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
27379 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27380 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27383 [titleabbrev="Local scan function"]
27384 Adding a local scan function to Exim
27385 ------------------------------------
27386 cindex:['local_scan()' function,description of]
27387 cindex:[customizing,input scan using C function]
27388 cindex:[policy control,by local scan function]
27389 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
27390 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
27392 The content scanning extension (chapter <<CHAPexiscan>>) has facilities for
27393 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
27395 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the %condition%
27396 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
27397 non-SMTP messages (see chapter <<CHAPACL>>), but this has its limitations.
27399 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
27400 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
27401 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
27402 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
27404 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
27405 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
27406 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
27407 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
27409 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
27410 option called %local_scan_timeout% for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
27411 Zero means ``no timeout''.
27412 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
27413 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
27414 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
27415 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
27416 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
27417 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
27421 Building Exim to use a local scan function
27422 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27423 cindex:['local_scan()' function,building Exim to use]
27424 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
27425 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
27426 _Local/Makefile_. A recommended place to put it is in the _Local_
27427 directory, so you might set
27429 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
27431 for example. The function must be called 'local_scan()'. It is called by
27432 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
27433 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
27434 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
27435 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
27436 _src/local_scan.c_.
27438 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
27439 for your 'local_scan()' function, you must also set
27441 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
27443 in _Local/Makefile_ (see section <<SECTconoptloc>> below).
27449 API for local_scan()
27450 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27451 cindex:['local_scan()' function,API description]
27452 You must include this line near the start of your code:
27454 #include "local_scan.h"
27456 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
27457 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
27458 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
27459 for `unsigned char` called `uschar`.
27460 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
27461 strings and pointers to character strings:
27463 #define CS (char *)
27464 #define CCS (const char *)
27465 #define CSS (char **)
27466 #define US (unsigned char *)
27467 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
27468 #define USS (unsigned char **)
27471 The function prototype for 'local_scan()' is:
27473 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
27475 The arguments are as follows:
27477 - %fd% is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
27478 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
27479 recommended. *Warning*: You must 'not' close this file descriptor.
27481 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
27482 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
27483 id followed by `-D` and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
27484 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
27485 case this changes in some future version.
27487 - %return_text% is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
27488 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
27490 The function must return an %int% value which is one of the following macros:
27492 `LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`::
27493 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
27494 the message, and made available in the variable $local_scan_data$. No
27495 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
27496 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
27498 `LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`::
27499 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
27500 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
27502 `LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`::
27503 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
27504 queued without immediate delivery.
27506 `LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`::
27507 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
27508 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted --
27509 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to `\n`
27510 in log lines. If no message is given, ``Administrative prohibition'' is used.
27512 `LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`::
27513 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
27514 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, ``Temporary local
27517 `LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`::
27518 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
27519 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
27520 %rejected_header% log selector for just this rejection. If %rejected_header%
27521 is already unset (see the discussion of the %log_selection% option in section
27522 <<SECTlogselector>>), this code is the same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
27524 `LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`::
27525 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
27526 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
27532 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
27533 reported by writing to %stderr% or by sending an email, as configured by the
27534 %-oe% command line options.
27539 Configuration options for local_scan()
27540 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27541 cindex:['local_scan()' function,configuration options]
27542 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
27543 that set values in static variables in the 'local_scan()' module. If you
27544 want to do this, you must have the line
27546 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
27548 in your _Local/Makefile_ when you build Exim. (This line is in
27549 _OS/Makefile-Default_, commented out). Then, in the 'local_scan()' source
27550 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table to
27553 The table must be a vector called %local_scan_options%, of type
27554 `optionlist`. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
27555 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
27556 alphabetical order. Following %local_scan_options% you must also define a
27557 variable called %local_scan_options_count% that contains the number of
27558 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
27560 static int my_integer_option = 42;
27561 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
27563 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
27564 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
27565 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
27567 int local_scan_options_count =
27568 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
27570 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
27571 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
27575 my_string = some string of text...
27577 The available types of option data are as follows:
27580 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
27581 variable of type `BOOL`, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
27582 that are defined as ``1'' and ``0'', respectively. If you want to detect
27583 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
27584 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
27588 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
27589 The address should point to a variable of type `int`. The value is stored
27590 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
27593 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
27594 `int`. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
27598 This is the same as %opt_int%, except that when such a value is output in a
27599 %-bP% listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
27600 printed with the suffix K or M.
27603 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpeted as an
27604 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
27605 always output in octal.
27608 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
27609 variable that points to a string (for example, of type `uschar \*`).
27612 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
27613 type `int`. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
27619 If the %-bP% command line option is followed by `local_scan`, Exim prints
27620 out the values of all the 'local_scan()' options.
27624 Available Exim variables
27625 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27626 cindex:['local_scan()' function,available Exim variables]
27627 The header _local_scan.h_ gives you access to a number of C variables. These
27628 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
27629 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim variable by calling
27630 'expand_string()'. The exported variables are as follows:
27632 *unsigned~int~debug_selector*::
27633 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
27634 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
27635 'local_scan()'; they are defined as macros:
27638 - The `D_v` bit is set when %-v% was present on the command line. This is a
27639 testing option that is not privileged -- any caller may set it. All the
27640 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
27642 - The `D_local_scan` bit is provided for use by 'local_scan()'; it is set
27643 by the `+local_scan` debug selector. It is not included in the default set
27647 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when `+local_scan` has been
27648 selected, you should use code like this:
27650 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
27651 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
27654 *uschar~\*expand_string_message*::
27655 After a failing call to 'expand_string()' (returned value NULL), the
27656 variable %expand_string_message% contains the error message, zero-terminated.
27658 *header_line~\*header_list*::
27659 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The %header_line% structure is discussed
27662 *header_line~\*header_last*::
27663 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
27665 *uschar~\*headers_charset*::
27666 The value of the %headers_charset% configuration option.
27668 *BOOL~host_checking*::
27669 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
27670 %-bh% command line option.
27672 *uschar~\*interface_address*::
27673 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
27674 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
27676 *int~interface_port*::
27677 The port on which this message was received.
27679 *uschar~\*message_id*::
27680 This variable contains the message id for the incoming message as a
27681 zero-terminated string.
27683 *uschar~\*received_protocol*::
27684 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
27686 *int~recipients_count*::
27687 The number of accepted recipients.
27689 *recipient_item~\*recipients_list*::
27690 cindex:[recipient,adding in local scan]
27691 cindex:[recipient,removing in local scan]
27692 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length %recipients_count%.
27693 The %recipient_item% structure is discussed below. You can add additional
27694 recipients by calling 'receive_add_recipient()' (see below). You can delete
27695 recipients by removing them from the vector and adusting the value in
27696 %recipients_count%. In particular, by setting %recipients_count% to zero you
27697 remove all recipients. If you then return the value `LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`, the
27698 message is accepted, but immediately blackholed. To replace the recipients, set
27699 %recipients_count% to zero and then call 'receive_add_recipient()' as often as
27702 *uschar~\*sender_address*::
27703 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
27705 *uschar~\*sender_host_address*::
27706 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
27707 locally-submitted messages.
27709 *uschar~\*sender_host_authenticated*::
27710 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
27711 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
27713 *uschar~\*sender_host_name*::
27714 The name of the sending host, if known.
27716 *int~sender_host_port*::
27717 The port on the sending host.
27719 *BOOL~smtp_input*::
27720 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
27722 *BOOL~smtp_batched_input*::
27723 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
27726 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
27727 requests. See section <<SECTmemhanloc>> for details.
27735 Structure of header lines
27736 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27737 The %header_line% structure contains the members listed below.
27738 You can add additional header lines by calling the 'header_add()' function
27739 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
27743 *struct~header_line~\*next*::
27744 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
27747 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
27748 characters, and are documented in chapter <<CHAPspool>> of this manual. Notice
27749 in particular that any header line whose type is \* is not transmitted with the
27750 message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been rewritten, or
27751 are to be removed (for example, 'Envelope-sender:' header lines.) Effectively,
27752 \* means ``deleted''.
27755 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
27759 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
27760 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
27764 Structure of recipient items
27765 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27766 The %recipient_item% structure contains these members:
27768 *uschar~\*address*::
27769 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
27772 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
27773 the %one_time% option. It is not relevant at the time 'local_scan()' is run and
27774 must always contain -1 at this stage.
27776 *uschar~\*errors_to*::
27777 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
27778 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
27779 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the %errors_to% generic router
27780 option.) If a 'local_scan()' function sets an %errors_to% field to an
27781 unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
27782 %qualify_recipient%. When 'local_scan()' is called, the %errors_to% field is
27783 NULL for all recipients.
27787 Available Exim functions
27788 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
27789 cindex:['local_scan()' function,available Exim functions]
27790 The header _local_scan.h_ gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
27791 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
27794 *pid_t~child_open(uschar~{star}{star}argv,~uschar~{star}{star}envp,~int~newumask,~int~{star}infdptr,~int~{star}outfdptr,~BOOL~make_leader)*::
27796 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
27797 %argv%. The environment for the process is specified by %envp%, which can be
27798 NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied for
27799 the process in %newumask%.
27801 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
27802 and returned to the caller via the %infdptr% and %outfdptr% arguments. The
27803 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
27804 descriptors ``in the way'' in the new process, they are closed. If the final
27805 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
27807 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
27809 *int~child_close(pid_t~pid,~int~timeout)*::
27810 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
27811 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
27812 return value is as follows:
27816 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process ending
27821 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
27826 The process timed out.
27830 The was some other error in wait(); %errno% is still set.
27833 *pid_t~child_open_exim(int~{star}fd)*::
27834 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
27835 Exim. (Of course, you can also call _/usr/sbin/sendmail_ yourself if you
27836 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
27837 forks a subprocess that is running
27839 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
27841 and returns to you (via the `int *` argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
27842 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
27843 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
27844 recipients in 'To:', 'Cc:', and/or 'Bcc:' header lines.
27846 When you have finished, call 'child_close()' to wait for the process to
27847 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
27848 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
27849 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
27851 *void~debug_printf(char~{star},~...)*::
27852 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for '(printf()'. The
27853 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
27854 calls to 'debug_printf()' have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
27855 conditional on the `local_scan` debug selector by coding like this:
27857 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
27858 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
27860 *uschar~{star}expand_string(uschar~{star}string)*::
27861 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
27862 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
27863 The C variable %expand_string_message% contains an error message after an
27864 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
27865 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
27866 block of memory that was obtained by a call to 'store_get()'. See section
27867 <<SECTmemhanloc>> below for a discussion of memory handling.
27869 *void~header_add(int~type,~char~{star}format,~...)*::
27870 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
27871 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
27872 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
27873 substitution arguments as for 'sprintf()'. You may include internal newlines if
27874 you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
27876 *void~header_add_at_position(BOOL~after,~uschar~{star}name,~BOOL~topnot,~int~type,~char~{star}format,~...)*::
27877 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
27878 chain. The header itself is specified as for 'header_add()'.
27880 If %name% is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if %after%
27881 is true, or at the start if %after% is false. If %name% is not NULL, the header
27882 lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that matches the name. If
27883 one is found, the new header is added before it if %after% is false. If %after%
27884 is true, the new header is added after the found header and any adjacent
27885 subsequent ones with the same name (even if marked ``deleted''). If no matching
27886 non-deleted header is found, the %topnot% option controls where the header is
27887 added. If it is true, addition is at the top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to
27888 add a header after all the 'Received:' headers, or at the top if there are no
27889 'Received:' headers, you could use
27891 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
27892 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
27894 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted 'Received:' header, but
27895 there may not be if %received_header_text% expands to an empty string.
27898 *void~header_remove(int~occurrence,~uschar~{star}name)*::
27899 This function removes header lines. If %occurrence% is zero or negative, all
27900 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
27901 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
27902 match the specification, the function does nothing.
27905 *BOOL~header_testname(header_line~{star}hdr,~uschar~{star}name,~int~length,~BOOL~notdel)*::
27906 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
27907 a string comparison, because whitespace is permitted between the name and the
27908 colon. If the %notdel% argument is true, a false return is forced for all
27909 ``deleted'' headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
27911 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
27914 *uschar~{star}lss_b64encode(uschar~{star}cleartext,~int~length)*::
27915 cindex:[base64 encoding,functions for 'local_scan()' use]
27916 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
27917 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
27918 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling 'store_get()'. It is
27921 *int~lss_b64decode(uschar~{star}codetext,~uschar~{star}{star}cleartext)*::
27922 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
27923 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
27924 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
27925 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
27926 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
27927 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
27928 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
27930 *int~lss_match_domain(uschar~{star}domain,~uschar~{star}list)*::
27931 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
27932 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
27935 `OK ` match succeeded
27936 `FAIL ` match failed
27937 `DEFER ` match deferred
27940 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
27941 inability to contact a database.
27943 *int~lss_match_local_part(uschar~{star}localpart,~uschar~{star}list,~BOOL~caseless)*::
27944 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
27945 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
27946 'lss_match_domain()'.
27948 *int~lss_match_address(uschar~{star}address,~uschar~{star}list,~BOOL~caseless)*::
27949 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
27950 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
27951 matched caselessly. The return values are as for 'lss_match_domain()'.
27953 *int~lss_match_host(uschar~{star}host_name,~uschar~{star}host_address,~uschar~{star}list)*::
27954 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
27957 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
27959 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the
27960 host name is NULL, the name corresponding to $sender_host_address$ is
27961 automatically looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the
27962 list. The return values are as for 'lss_match_domain()', but in addition,
27963 'lss_match_host()' returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host
27964 name, but the lookup failed.
27966 *void~log_write(unsigned~int~selector,~int~which,~char~{star}format,~...)*::
27967 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
27968 is concerned with %log_selector%). The second argument can be `LOG_MAIN` or
27969 `LOG_REJECT` or `LOG_PANIC` or the inclusive ``or'' of any combination of them.
27970 It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
27971 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
27972 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
27975 *void~receive_add_recipient(uschar~{star}address,~int~pno)*::
27976 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
27977 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
27978 with the %qualify_recipient% domain. The second argument must always be -1.
27980 This function does not allow you to specify a private %errors_to% address (as
27981 described with the structure of %recipient_item% above), because it pre-dates
27982 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
27983 value afterwards. For example:
27985 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
27986 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
27987 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
27989 *BOOL~receive_remove_recipient(uschar~{star}recipient)*::
27990 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
27991 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
27992 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
27996 *uschar~*rfc2047_decode(uschar~{star}string,~BOOL~lencheck,~uschar~{star}target,~int~zeroval,~int~{star}lenptr,~uschar~{star}{star}error)*::
27997 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
27998 these are the contents of header lines. First, each encoded ``word'' is decoded
27999 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
28000 a charset encoding, and if the 'iconv()' function is available, an attempt is
28001 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
28002 binary string is returned with an error message.
28004 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If %lencheck% is TRUE, the
28005 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
28006 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
28008 cindex:[binary zero,in RFC 2047 decoding]
28009 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
28010 contents of the %zeroval% argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
28011 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
28013 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
28014 %lenptr% is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to which
28015 it points. When %zeroval% is 0, %lenptr% should not be NULL.
28017 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the %error%
28018 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by %error% is set
28019 to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
28020 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
28024 *int~smtp_fflush(void)*::
28025 This function is used in conjunction with 'smtp_printf()', as described
28028 *void~smtp_printf(char~{star},~...)*::
28029 The arguments of this function are like 'printf()'; it writes to the SMTP
28030 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
28031 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
28032 SMTP. This is the case when %smtp_input% is TRUE and %smtp_batched_input% is
28033 FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
28034 opposed to a local process that used the %-bs% command line option), you can
28035 test the value of %sender_host_address%, which is non-NULL when a remote host
28038 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, 'smtp_printf()' uses the TLS
28039 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
28041 Strings that are written by 'smtp_printf()' from within 'local_scan()'
28042 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
28043 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
28044 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
28045 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
28046 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
28047 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
28049 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
28050 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
28052 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
28053 the data returned via the %return_text% argument. The added value of using
28054 'smtp_printf()' is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
28055 multiple output lines.
28057 The 'smtp_printf()' function does not return any error indication, because it
28058 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
28059 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
28060 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
28061 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
28062 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call 'smtp_fflush()', which has no
28063 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
28066 *void~{star}store_get(int)*::
28067 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
28068 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
28069 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
28071 *void~{star}store_get_perm(int)*::
28072 This function is like 'store_get()', but it always gets memory from the
28073 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
28075 *uschar~{star}string_copy(uschar~{star}string)*::
28078 *uschar~{star}string_copyn(uschar~{star}string,~int~length)*::
28081 *uschar~{star}string_sprintf(char~{star}format,~...)*::
28082 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
28083 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
28084 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
28085 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
28086 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
28097 More about Exim's memory handling
28098 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28099 cindex:['local_scan()' function,memory handling]
28100 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
28101 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
28102 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
28103 to incoming SMTP connections -- other input methods can supply only one message
28104 at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process terminates.
28106 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
28107 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
28108 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
28109 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
28111 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
28112 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
28114 store_pool = POOL_PERM
28116 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
28117 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
28118 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of %store_pool% or
28119 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
28121 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
28122 'expand_string()', 'store_get()', and the 'string_xxx()' functions.
28123 There is also a convenience function called 'store_get_perm()' that gets a
28124 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
28131 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28132 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28134 [[CHAPsystemfilter]]
28135 System-wide message filtering
28136 -----------------------------
28137 cindex:[filter,system filter]
28138 cindex:[filtering all mail]
28139 cindex:[system filter]
28140 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
28141 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
28142 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
28143 they are delivered. This is called the 'system filter'.
28145 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
28146 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
28147 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because %deliver%
28148 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
28149 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
28151 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
28152 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
28153 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
28154 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
28155 of the %first_delivery% condition in an %if% command in the filter to prevent
28156 it happening on retries.
28158 *Warning*: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
28159 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as $local_part$ and
28160 $domain$, are not set, and the ``personal'' condition is not meaningful. If you
28161 want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
28162 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable ^redirect^ router, as
28163 described in section <<SECTperaddfil>> below.
28166 Specifying a system filter
28167 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28168 cindex:[uid (user id),system filter]
28169 cindex:[gid (group id),system filter]
28170 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
28171 setting %system_filter%. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
28172 other than root, you must also set %system_filter_user% and
28173 %system_filter_group% as appropriate. For example:
28175 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
28176 system_filter_user = exim
28178 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
28179 %save% or %pipe% commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
28180 specified by setting %system_filter_file_transport% and
28181 %system_filter_pipe_transport%, respectively. Similarly,
28182 %system_filter_reply_transport% must be set to handle any messages generated
28183 by the %reply% command.
28186 Testing a system filter
28187 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28188 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
28189 filter, but you should use %-bF% rather than %-bf%, so that features that
28190 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
28192 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
28193 you can use both %-bF% and %-bf% on the same command line.
28197 Contents of a system filter
28198 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28199 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
28200 files. It is described in the separate end-user document 'Exim's interface to
28201 mail filtering'. However, there are some additional features that are
28202 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
28203 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with %-bf%,
28206 cindex:[frozen messages,manual thaw; testing in filter]
28207 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
28208 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition %first_delivery%
28209 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
28210 %manually_thawed% is true only if the message has been frozen, and
28211 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
28212 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the %auto_thaw% setting does not.
28214 *Warning*: If a system filter uses the %first_delivery% condition to
28215 specify an ``unseen'' (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
28216 succeed, it will not be tried again.
28217 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
28218 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
28220 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables $n0$ --
28221 $n9$ are copied into $sn0$ -- $sn9$ and are thereby made available to
28222 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up ``scores'' to
28223 which users' filter files can refer.
28227 Additional variable for system filters
28228 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28229 The expansion variable $recipients$, containing a list of all the recipients
28230 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
28231 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
28235 Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters
28236 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28237 cindex:[freezing messages]
28238 cindex:[message,freezing]
28239 cindex:[message,forced failure]
28240 cindex:[%fail%,in system filter]
28241 cindex:[%freeze% in system filter]
28242 cindex:[%defer% in system filter]
28243 There are three extra commands (%defer%, %freeze% and %fail%) which are always
28244 available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users' filters.
28245 (See the %allow_defer%,
28246 %allow_freeze% and %allow_fail% options for the ^redirect^ router.) These
28247 commands can optionally be followed by the word %text% and a string containing
28248 an error message, for example:
28250 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
28252 The keyword %text% is optional if the next character is a double quote.
28254 The %defer% command defers delivery of the original recipients of the message.
28255 The %fail% command causes all the original recipients to be failed, and a
28256 bounce message to be created. The %freeze% command suspends all delivery
28257 attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries that are
28258 specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has run.
28260 The %freeze% command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
28261 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
28262 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
28263 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
28265 cindex:[log,%fail% command log line]
28266 cindex:[%fail%,log line; reducing]
28267 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
28268 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
28269 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
28270 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
28271 two characters `<<` and contains `>>` later. The text between these two
28272 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
28273 message. For example:
28276 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
28277 because it contains attachments that we are \
28278 not prepared to receive."
28282 cindex:[loop,caused by %fail%]
28283 Take great care with the %fail% command when basing the decision to fail on the
28284 contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include the
28285 contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the %fail% command
28286 again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this. Testing the
28287 %error_message% condition is one way to prevent this. You could use, for
28290 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
28291 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
28293 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
28294 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
28295 generated by the filter.
28297 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
28299 %freeze%, or %fail% command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were set up
28300 earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such as
28305 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
28306 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
28311 [[SECTaddremheasys]]
28312 Adding and removing headers in a system filter
28313 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28314 cindex:[header lines,adding; in system filter]
28315 cindex:[header lines,removing; in system filter]
28316 cindex:[filter,header lines; adding/removing]
28317 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
28319 headers add <string>
28320 headers remove <string>
28322 The argument for the %headers add% is a string that is expanded and then added
28323 to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the filter
28324 maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white space is
28325 ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is forced to
28326 fail, the command has no effect.
28328 You can use ``\n'' within the string, followed by white space, to specify
28329 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
28330 including ``\n'' within the string without any following white space. For
28334 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
28335 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
28339 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
28340 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
28341 space after input continuations is ignored.
28343 The argument for %headers remove% is a colon-separated list of header names.
28344 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
28345 those that are added at delivery time (such as 'Envelope-To:' and
28346 'Return-Path:') cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
28347 header with the same name, they are all removed.
28349 The %headers% command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
28350 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
28351 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
28352 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
28353 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
28354 used for all recipients of the message.
28356 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
28357 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
28358 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
28359 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
28360 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
28361 until the message is actually being written (see section <<SECTheadersaddrem>>).
28363 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
28364 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
28365 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
28366 present, but marked ``deleted'' so that they are not transported with the
28367 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the %headers% command conditional
28368 on %first_delivery% so that the set of header lines is not modified more than
28371 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
28372 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
28375 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
28376 headers remove "Subject"
28377 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
28378 headers remove "Old-Subject"
28384 Setting an errors address in a system filter
28385 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28386 cindex:[envelope sender]
28387 In a system filter, if a %deliver% command is followed by
28389 errors_to <some address>
28391 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
28392 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
28393 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
28396 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
28398 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
28399 address if its delivery failed.
28404 Per-address filtering
28405 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28406 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
28407 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
28408 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
28409 such as $local_part$ and $domain$ can be used, and indeed, the choice of
28410 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
28411 which implements such a filter:
28416 domains = +local_domains
28417 file = /central/filters/$local_part
28422 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
28423 %check_local_user% must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
28424 the local user, or the %user% option must be used to specify which user to use.
28425 If both are set, %user% overrides.
28427 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
28428 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
28429 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
28430 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
28438 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28439 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28444 cindex:[message,general processing]
28445 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
28446 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
28447 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
28448 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
28449 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
28450 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
28452 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
28453 ``locally-originated'' messages. This adjective is used to describe messages that
28454 are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on its
28455 standard input. This includes the interactive ``local SMTP'' case that is set up
28456 by the %-bs% command line option.
28458 *Note*: messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
28459 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
28460 loopback interface specially in any way.
28462 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
28463 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
28469 Submission mode for non-local messages
28470 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28471 cindex:[message,submission]
28472 cindex:[submission mode]
28473 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages can also
28474 be requested for other messages. The term ``submission mode'' is used to describe
28475 this state. Submisssion mode is set by the modifier
28477 control = submission
28479 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming SMTP message (see
28480 sections <<SECTACLmodi>> and <<SECTcontrols>>). This makes Exim treat the message
28481 as a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
28482 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
28483 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
28484 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
28486 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
28487 control = submission
28489 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
28490 is used to separate options. For example:
28492 control = submission/sender_retain
28494 Specifying %sender_retain% has the effect of setting %local_sender_retain%
28495 true and %local_from_check% false for the current incoming message. The first
28496 of these allows an existing 'Sender:' header in the message to remain, and the
28497 second suppresses the check to ensure that 'From:' matches the authenticated
28498 sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding 'Date:' and
28499 'Message-ID:' header lines if they are missing, but makes no attempt to check
28500 sender authenticity in header lines.
28502 A submission mode setting may also specify a domain to be used when generating
28503 a 'From:' or 'Sender:' header. For example:
28505 control = submission/domain=some.domain
28507 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
28508 <<SECTthefrohea>> and <<SECTthesenhea>>.
28514 [[SECTlineendings]]
28517 cindex:[line endings]
28518 cindex:[carriage return]
28520 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
28521 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
28522 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
28523 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
28524 use CRLF or just CR.
28526 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
28527 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
28528 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
28529 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
28530 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
28531 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
28532 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
28533 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
28536 - LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
28538 - CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
28541 - The sequence ``CR, dot, CR'' does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
28542 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
28545 - If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
28546 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
28547 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
28548 people trying to play silly games.
28550 - If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
28551 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
28558 Unqualified addresses
28559 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28560 cindex:[unqualified addresses]
28561 cindex:[address,qualification]
28562 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
28563 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
28564 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
28565 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
28566 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
28568 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
28569 sender or receipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
28570 %sender_unqualified_hosts% and %recipient_unqualified_hosts%. In both
28571 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
28572 value of %qualify_domain% or %qualify_recipient%, as appropriate.
28574 cindex:[%qualify_domain%]
28575 cindex:[%qualify_recipient%]
28576 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
28577 that are locally originated, unless the %-bnq% option is given on the command
28578 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
28579 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
28580 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
28581 %sender_unqualified_hosts% and %recipient_unqualified_hosts%,
28588 cindex:[``From'' line]
28589 cindex:[UUCP,``From'' line]
28590 cindex:[sender,address]
28591 cindex:[%uucp_from_pattern%]
28592 cindex:[%uucp_from_sender%]
28593 cindex:[envelope sender]
28594 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,``From'' line]
28595 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
28596 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
28597 ``From''. Examples of two common formats are:
28599 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
28600 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
28602 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
28603 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
28604 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
28605 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
28606 %ignore_fromline_hosts% or the %-bs% option was used for a local message and
28607 %ignore_fromline_local% is set. The recognition is controlled by a regular
28608 expression that is defined by the %uucp_from_pattern% option, whose default
28609 value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address that
28610 follows ``From'' into $1$.
28612 cindex:[numerical variables ($1$ $2$ etc),in ``From '' line handling]
28613 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a ``From'' line is a
28614 trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
28615 contents of %uucp_sender_address%, whose default value is ``\$1''. This is then
28616 parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
28617 qualified with %qualify_domain% unless it is the empty string. However, if the
28618 command line %-f% option is used, it overrides the ``From'' line.
28620 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the ``From'' line is recognized, but the
28621 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
28622 that are permitted to contain ``From'' lines.
28624 Only one ``From'' line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
28625 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
28626 as a header line. This also happens if a ``From'' line is present in an incoming
28627 SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
28631 Resent- header lines
28632 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28633 cindex:[%Resent-% header lines]
28634 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
28635 `Resent-` to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
28636 recipient to somebody else. These headers are 'Resent-Date:', 'Resent-From:',
28637 'Resent-Sender:', 'Resent-To:', 'Resent-Cc:', 'Resent-Bcc:' and
28638 'Resent-Message-ID:'. The RFC says:
28640 'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
28641 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'
28643 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
28644 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats %Resent-% header lines as
28647 - A 'Resent-From:' line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
28648 is automatically rewritten in the same way as 'From:' (see below).
28650 - If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
28651 %Resent-% header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
28652 'From:' also rewrites 'Resent-From:'.
28654 - For local messages, if 'Sender:' is removed on input, 'Resent-Sender:' is also
28657 - For a locally-submitted message,
28658 if there are any %Resent-% header lines but no 'Resent-Date:',
28659 'Resent-From:', or 'Resent-Message-Id:', they are added as necessary. It is
28660 the contents of 'Resent-Message-Id:' (rather than 'Message-Id:') which are
28661 included in log lines in this case.
28663 - The logic for adding 'Sender:' is duplicated for 'Resent-Sender:' when any
28664 %Resent-% header lines are present.
28669 The Auto-Submitted: header line
28670 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28671 Whenever Exim generates a bounce or a delay warning message, it includes the
28674 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
28679 The Bcc: header line
28680 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28681 cindex:['Bcc:' header line]
28682 If Exim is called with the %-t% option, to take recipient addresses from a
28683 message's header, it removes any 'Bcc:' header line that may exist (after
28684 extracting its addresses). If %-t% is not present on the command line, any
28685 existing 'Bcc:' is not removed.
28688 The Date: header line
28689 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28690 cindex:['Date:' header line]
28691 If a locally-generated
28693 message has no 'Date:' header line, Exim adds one, using the current date and
28697 The Delivery-date: header line
28698 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28699 cindex:['Delivery-date:' header line]
28700 cindex:[%delivery_date_remove%]
28701 'Delivery-date:' header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
28702 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
28703 the generic %delivery_date_add% transport option.) They should not be present
28704 in messages in transit. If the %delivery_date_remove% configuration option is
28705 set (the default), Exim removes 'Delivery-date:' header lines from incoming
28709 The Envelope-to: header line
28710 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28711 cindex:['Envelope-to:' header line]
28712 cindex:[%envelope_to_remove%]
28713 'Envelope-to:' header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
28714 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
28715 generic %envelope_to_add% transport option.) They should not be present in
28716 messages in transit. If the %envelope_to_remove% configuration option is set
28717 (the default), Exim removes 'Envelope-to:' header lines from incoming
28722 The From: header line
28723 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28724 cindex:['From:' header line]
28725 cindex:[Sendmail compatibility,``From'' line]
28726 cindex:[message,submission]
28727 cindex:[submission mode]
28728 If a submission-mode message does not contain a 'From:' header line, Exim adds
28729 one if either of the following conditions is true:
28731 - The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
28732 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
28734 - The SMTP session is authenticated and $authenticated_id$ is not empty.
28736 .. If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
28737 $authenticated_id$ and the domain is $qualify_domain$.
28739 .. If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
28740 part is $authenticated_id$, and the the domain is the specified domain.
28742 .. If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
28743 $authenticated_id$ is assumed to be the complete address.
28745 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
28747 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a 'From:' header
28748 line, Exim adds one containing the sender's address. The calling user's login
28749 name and full name are used to construct the address, as described in section
28750 <<SECTconstr>>. They are obtained from the password data by calling
28751 'getpwuid()' (but see the %unknown_login% configuration option). The address
28752 is qualified with %qualify_domain%.
28754 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
28755 'From:' header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
28756 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
28757 name as described in section <<SECTconstr>>.
28760 The Message-ID: header line
28761 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28762 cindex:['Message-ID:' header line]
28763 cindex:[message,submission]
28764 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
28765 'Message-ID:' or 'Resent-Message-ID:' header line, Exim adds one to the
28766 message. If there are any 'Resent-:' headers in the message, it creates
28767 'Resent-Message-ID:'. The id is constructed from Exim's internal message id,
28768 preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and followed by @
28769 and the primary host name. Additional information can be included in this
28770 header line by setting the
28771 cindex:[%message_id_header_text%]
28772 %message_id_header_text% and/or %message_id_header_domain% options.
28776 The Received: header line
28777 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28778 cindex:['Received:' header line]
28779 A 'Received:' header line is added at the start of every message. The contents
28780 are defined by the %received_header_text% configuration option, and Exim
28781 automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
28783 The 'Received:' header is generated as soon as the message's header lines have
28784 been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the 'Received:' header line is
28785 the time that the message started to be received. This is the value that is
28786 seen by the DATA ACL and by the 'local_scan()' function.
28788 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the 'Received:' header line is
28789 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
28790 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
28794 The Return-path: header line
28795 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28796 cindex:['Return-path:' header line]
28797 cindex:[%return_path_remove%]
28798 'Return-path:' header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
28799 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic %return_path_add%
28800 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
28801 transit. If the %return_path_remove% configuration option is set (the
28802 default), Exim removes 'Return-path:' header lines from incoming messages.
28807 The Sender: header line
28808 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28809 cindex:['Sender:' header line]
28810 cindex:[message,submission]
28811 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
28812 existing 'Sender:' header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify these
28813 actions by setting %local_sender_retain% true or %local_from_check% false.
28815 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
28816 %local_from_check% is true (the default), a check is made to see if the
28817 address given in the 'From:' header line is the correct (local) sender of the
28818 message. The address that is expected has the login name as the local part and
28819 the value of %qualify_domain% as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the
28820 local part can be permitted by setting %local_from_prefix% and
28821 %local_from_suffix% appropriately. If 'From:' does not contain the correct
28822 sender, a 'Sender:' line is added to the message.
28824 If you set %local_from_check% false, this checking does not occur. However,
28825 the removal of an existing 'Sender:' line still happens, unless you also set
28826 %local_sender_retain% to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
28827 options true at the same time.
28829 cindex:[submission mode]
28830 By default, no processing of 'Sender:' header lines is done for messages
28831 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
28832 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and %sender_retain% is
28833 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
28835 First, any existing 'Sender:' lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
28836 authenticated, and $authenticated_id$ is not empty, a sender address is
28837 created as follows:
28839 - If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
28840 $authenticated_id$ and the domain is $qualify_domain$.
28842 - If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
28843 $authenticated_id$, and the the domain is the specified domain.
28845 - If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
28846 $authenticated_id$ is assumed to be the complete address.
28848 This address is compared with the address in the 'From:' header line. If they
28849 are different, a 'Sender:' header line containing the created address is
28850 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in 'From:' can be permitted by
28851 setting %local_from_prefix% and %local_from_suffix% appropriately.
28856 [[SECTheadersaddrem]]
28857 Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports
28858 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28859 cindex:[header lines,adding; in router or transport]
28860 cindex:[header lines,removing; in router or transport]
28861 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
28862 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
28863 process the message. Section <<SECTaddremheasys>> contains details about
28864 modifying headers in a system filter.
28866 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
28867 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
28868 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
28869 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
28870 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
28871 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
28873 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a %headers_add%
28874 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
28875 newlines (coded as ``\n''). For example:
28878 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
28879 X-added-second: another added header line
28882 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
28884 The result of expanding %headers_remove% must consist of a colon-separated
28885 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
28886 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
28887 not part of the names. For example:
28889 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
28891 When %headers_add% or %headers_remove% is specified on a router, its value is
28892 expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
28893 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
28894 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
28895 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
28897 cindex:[%unseen% option]
28898 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
28899 the %unseen% option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
28900 ``unseen'' router or its predecessors apply only to the ``unseen'' delivery.
28902 Addresses that end up with different %headers_add% or %headers_remove%
28903 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
28904 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
28907 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
28908 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
28909 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
28910 recipient address(es) by %headers_remove% options in routers, and it also
28911 consults the transport's own %headers_remove% option. Header lines whose names
28912 are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
28913 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
28915 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
28916 lines that were specified by routers' %headers_add% options are written, in
28917 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
28918 header lines specified by the transport's %headers_add% option.
28920 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
28921 the following consequences:
28923 - The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
28924 remains ``visible'', in the sense that the $header_$'xxx' variables refer to
28927 - Header lines that are added by a router's
28928 %headers_add% option are not accessible by means of the $header_$'xxx'
28929 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
28931 - Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by %headers_remove% in
28932 a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
28934 - Headers added to an address by %headers_add% in a router cannot be removed by
28935 a later router or by a transport.
28937 - An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
28938 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
28940 headers_remove = subject
28941 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
28944 *Warning*: The %headers_add% and %headers_remove% options cannot be used
28945 for a ^redirect^ router that has the %one_time% option set.
28952 Constructed addresses
28953 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28954 cindex:[address,constructed]
28955 cindex:[constructed address]
28956 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
28959 <user name> <<login>@<qualify_domain>>
28963 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
28965 The user name is obtained from the %-F% command line option if set, or
28966 otherwise by looking up the calling user by 'getpwuid()' and extracting the
28967 ``gecos'' field from the password entry. If the ``gecos'' field contains an
28968 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
28969 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
28970 %gecos_name% option for a way to tailor the handling of the ``gecos'' field. The
28971 %unknown_username% option can be used to specify user names in cases when
28972 there is no password file entry.
28974 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
28975 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
28976 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
28977 including non-ASCII characters in header lines.
28978 The value of the %headers_charset% option specifies the name of the encoding
28979 that is used (the characters are assumed to be in this encoding).
28980 The setting of %print_topbitchars% controls whether characters with the top
28981 bit set (that is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or
28986 Case of local parts
28987 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
28988 cindex:[case of local parts]
28989 cindex:[local part,case of]
28990 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
28991 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
28992 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
28993 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
28994 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
28995 original case for local parts by setting the %caseful_local_part% generic
28998 cindex:[mixed-case login names]
28999 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
29000 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
29001 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
29002 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
29007 domains = +local_domains
29008 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
29009 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
29013 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
29014 (%caseful_local_part% is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
29015 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set %caseful_local_part%
29016 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
29017 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
29021 Dots in local parts
29022 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29023 cindex:[dot,in local part]
29024 cindex:[local part,dots in]
29025 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
29026 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
29027 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
29028 empty components for compatibility.
29032 Rewriting addresses
29033 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29034 cindex:[rewriting,addresses]
29035 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
29036 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
29037 in chapter <<CHAPrewrite>>. The headers that may be affected by this are 'Bcc:',
29038 'Cc:', 'From:', 'Reply-To:', 'Sender:', and 'To:'.
29040 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
29041 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
29042 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
29043 example, a header such as
29047 might get rewritten as
29049 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
29051 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
29052 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
29055 Strictly, one should not do 'any' deliveries of a message until all its
29056 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
29057 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
29058 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
29059 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
29060 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
29063 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29064 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29069 cindex:[SMTP,processing details]
29070 cindex:[LMTP,processing details]
29071 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
29072 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
29073 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
29074 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
29076 - SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or 'inetd');
29078 - SMTP over the standard input and output (the %-bs% option);
29080 - Batched SMTP on the standard input (the %-bS% option).
29082 For mail delivery, the following are available:
29084 - SMTP over TCP/IP (the ^smtp^ transport);
29086 - LMTP over TCP/IP (the ^smtp^ transport with the %protocol% option set to
29089 - LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the ^lmtp^
29092 - Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the ^appendfile^ and ^pipe^ transports with
29093 the %use_bsmtp% option set).
29095 'Batched SMTP' is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
29096 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
29097 used to contain the envelope information.
29102 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP
29103 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29104 cindex:[SMTP,outgoing over TCP/IP]
29105 cindex:[outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP]
29106 cindex:[LMTP,over TCP/IP]
29107 cindex:[outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP]
29110 cindex:[SIZE option on MAIL command]
29111 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the ^smtp^ transport.
29112 The %protocol% option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
29113 processing is the same in both cases.
29115 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
29116 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<'n'> to each subsequent MAIL
29117 command. The value of <'n'> is the message size plus the value of the
29118 %size_addition% option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
29119 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
29120 cindex:[transport,filter]
29121 cindex:[filter,transport filter]
29122 transport filter. If %size_addition% is set negative, the use of SIZE is
29125 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
29126 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
29127 required for the transaction.
29129 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
29130 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
29131 server matches %hosts_avoid_tls%. See chapter <<CHAPTLS>> for more details.
29133 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
29134 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
29135 in chapter <<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>.
29137 cindex:[carriage return]
29139 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
29140 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
29141 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
29144 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
29145 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
29146 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
29147 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
29148 of the %max_rcpts% option in the ^smtp^ transport allows, in which case they
29149 are split into groups containing no more than %max_rcpts% addresses each. If
29150 %remote_max_parallel% is greater than one, such groups may be sent in
29151 parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
29152 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
29154 When the ^smtp^ transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
29155 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
29156 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
29157 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
29159 cindex:[hints database,retry keys]
29160 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
29161 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
29162 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
29164 cindex:[SMTP,passed connection]
29165 cindex:[SMTP,batching over TCP/IP]
29166 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
29167 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
29168 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
29169 creates a new Exim process using the %-MC% option (which can only be used by a
29170 process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it so
29171 that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process does
29172 only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in turn
29173 pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
29175 The %connection_max_messages% option of the ^smtp^ transport can be used to
29176 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
29178 cindex:[asterisk,after IP address]
29179 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
29180 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
29181 square bracket of the IP address.
29187 Errors in outgoing SMTP
29188 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29189 cindex:[error,in outgoing SMTP]
29190 cindex:[SMTP,errors in outgoing]
29191 cindex:[host,error]
29192 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
29193 message errors, and recipient errors.
29195 . A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
29196 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
29199 - Connection refused or timed out,
29201 - Any error response code on connection,
29203 - Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
29205 - Loss of connection at any time, except after ``.'',
29207 - I/O errors at any time,
29209 - Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
29210 the ``.'' at the end of the data.
29213 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
29214 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
29215 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
29216 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
29217 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
29218 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
29219 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
29220 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
29222 . cindex:[message,error]
29223 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
29224 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
29225 message errors are:
29228 - Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the ``.'' that terminates
29231 - Timeout after MAIL,
29233 - Timeout or loss of connection after the ``.'' that terminates the data. A
29234 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
29235 connection at any other time.
29238 For a message error, a permanent error response (5##'xx') causes all addresses
29239 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
29240 temporary error response (4##'xx'), or one of the timeouts, causes all
29241 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
29242 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
29243 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
29244 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
29245 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
29246 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
29247 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
29249 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
29250 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE='nnn' to the MAIL command, so an
29251 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
29254 . cindex:[recipient,error]
29255 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
29256 recipient errors are:
29259 - Any error response to RCPT,
29261 - Timeout after RCPT.
29264 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5##'xx') causes the
29265 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
29266 sender. A temporary error response (4##'xx') or a timeout causes the failing
29267 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
29268 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
29269 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
29270 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
29271 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
29272 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
29273 (``message too big for this recipient'' is a possible example), other messages
29274 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
29275 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
29276 the retry clock is reset.
29278 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
29279 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
29280 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
29281 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
29282 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
29283 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
29284 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
29285 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
29286 recipient's retry time.
29292 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
29293 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
29294 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
29295 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
29296 until the next delivery attempt.
29298 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
29299 MAIL command at certain times (``insufficient space'' has been seen). It
29300 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
29301 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
29302 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
29305 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
29306 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
29307 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
29308 response had been received. A timeout after ``.'' is treated specially because
29309 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
29310 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
29311 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
29313 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
29314 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
29315 or ``.'' is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
29316 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
29317 then to be treated as a host error.
29319 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
29320 terminating ``.'' if they do not like the contents of the message for some
29321 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5##'xx' response
29322 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
29323 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
29329 Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)
29330 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29332 cindex:[Variable Envelope Return Paths]
29333 cindex:[envelope sender]
29334 Variable Envelope Return Paths -- see
29335 *ftp://koobera.math.uic.edu/www/proto/verp.txt[]* -- can be supported in Exim
29336 by using the %return_path% generic transport option to rewrite the return path
29337 at transport time. For example, the following could be used on an ^smtp^
29342 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
29343 {$1-request=$local_part%$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
29346 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on all
29347 outgoing SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
29348 ``-request'', and the domain is 'your.dom.example'. The rewriting inserts the
29349 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
29350 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
29351 'somelist-request@your.dom.example' is sent to
29352 'subscriber@other.dom.example'. In the transport, the return path is
29355 somelist-request=subscriber%other.dom.example@your.dom.example
29357 For this to work, you must arrange for outgoing messages that have ``-request''
29358 in their return paths to have just a single recipient. This can be done by
29363 in the ^smtp^ transport. Otherwise a single copy of a message might be
29364 addressed to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
29365 $local_part$ is not available (because it is not unique). Of course, if you
29366 do start sending out messages with this kind of return path, you must also
29367 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
29368 Typically this would be done by setting an %local_part_suffix% option for a
29371 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
29372 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
29373 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
29374 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
29375 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
29376 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
29381 Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP
29382 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29383 cindex:[SMTP,incoming over TCP/IP]
29384 cindex:[incoming SMTP over TCP/IP]
29387 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
29388 listening daemon, or by using 'inetd'. In the latter case, the entry in
29389 _/etc/inetd.conf_ should be like this:
29391 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
29393 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
29394 agent using the %-bs% option by checking whether or not the standard input is
29395 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
29396 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
29397 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
29398 stream and exits with an error code.
29400 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
29401 disconnects (either via the daemon or 'inetd'), unless the disconnection is
29402 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
29403 %smtp_connection% log selector.
29405 cindex:[carriage return]
29407 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
29408 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
29409 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
29411 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
29412 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
29413 sequence ``CR, dot, CR'' does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
29415 cindex:[EHLO,invalid data]
29416 cindex:[HELO,invalid data]
29417 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
29418 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
29419 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
29420 the data that is sent, so %helo_verify_hosts% is not relevant.) You can tell
29421 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting %helo_accept_junk_hosts% to
29422 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
29424 cindex:[SIZE option on MAIL command]
29425 cindex:[MAIL,SIZE option]
29426 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
29427 a MAIL command, independently of whether %message_size_limit% or
29428 %check_spool_space% is configured, unless %smtp_check_spool_space% is set
29429 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
29430 %check_spool_space% is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
29431 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
29432 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
29434 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
29435 its response to the final ``.'' that terminates the data. If the remote host logs
29436 this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
29438 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
29439 prepared to handle (see the %smtp_accept_max% option). It can also limit the
29440 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
29441 %smtp_accept_max_per_host% option). Additional connection attempts are
29442 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
29444 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
29445 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
29446 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
29447 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
29448 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
29449 sometimes see a ``defunct'' Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem; it
29450 will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
29452 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
29453 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
29454 high system load -- for details see the %smtp_accept_reserve%,
29455 %smtp_load_reserve%, and %smtp_reserve_hosts% options. The load check
29456 applies in both the daemon and 'inetd' cases.
29458 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
29459 can be varied by means of the %-odq% command line option and the
29460 %queue_only%, %queue_only_file%, and %queue_only_load% options. The number
29461 of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from SMTP
29462 input can be limited by the %smtp_accept_queue% and
29463 %smtp_accept_queue_per_connection% options. When either limit is reached,
29464 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
29465 a delivery process.
29467 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (%smtp_accept_max%,
29468 %smtp_accept_queue%, %smtp_accept_reserve%) are not available when Exim is
29469 started up from the 'inetd' daemon, because in that case each connection is
29470 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
29471 however, available with 'inetd'.
29473 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
29474 are received. See chapter <<CHAPACL>> for details. It can also be configured to
29475 rewrite addresses at this time -- before any syntax checking is done. See
29476 section <<SECTrewriteS>>.
29478 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
29479 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
29480 %smtp_ratelimit_hosts% option.
29484 Unrecognized SMTP commands
29485 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29486 cindex:[SMTP,unrecognized commands]
29487 If Exim receives more than %smtp_max_unknown_commands% unrecognized SMTP
29488 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
29489 the error response to the last command. The default value for
29490 %smtp_max_unknown_commands% is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
29491 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
29492 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
29495 Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands
29496 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29497 cindex:[SMTP,syntax errors]
29498 cindex:[SMTP,protocol errors]
29499 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
29500 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
29501 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
29502 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
29503 %smtp_max_synprot_errors% such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
29504 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
29505 default value for %smtp_max_synprot_errors% is 3. This is a defence against
29506 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
29510 Use of non-mail SMTP commands
29511 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29512 cindex:[SMTP,non-mail commands]
29513 The ``non-mail'' SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
29514 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
29515 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
29516 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
29517 client looping sending EHLO. The global option %smtp_accept_max_nonmail%
29518 defines what ``too many'' means. Its default value is 10.
29520 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
29521 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
29522 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurence of HELO
29523 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
29524 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
29527 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
29528 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
29529 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
29531 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
29532 %smtp_accept_max_nonmail% by setting
29533 %smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%. The default value is `\*`, which makes
29534 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
29535 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
29540 The VRFY and EXPN commands
29541 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29542 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
29543 runs the ACL specified by %acl_smtp_vrfy% or %acl_smtp_expn% (as
29544 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
29545 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
29547 cindex:[VRFY,processing]
29548 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
29549 called with the %-bv% option.
29551 cindex:[EXPN,processing]
29552 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
29553 EXPN is treated as an ``address test'' (similar to the %-bt% option) rather
29554 than a verification (the %-bv% option). If an unqualified local part is given
29555 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with %qualify_domain%. Rejections
29556 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
29557 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
29565 cindex:[ETRN,processing]
29566 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
29567 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
29568 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
29569 the ACL specified by %acl_smtp_etrn% in order to decide whether the command
29570 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
29572 The ETRN command is concerned with ``releasing'' messages that are awaiting
29573 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
29574 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
29575 text starts with the ``#'' prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
29576 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
29577 the %-R% option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
29578 argument. For example,
29586 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
29587 containing the text ``brigadoon''. When %smtp_etrn_serialize% is set (the
29588 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
29589 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
29590 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
29592 cindex:[hints database,ETRN serialization]
29593 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
29594 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
29595 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
29596 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
29597 a ``success'' return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get left
29598 lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this, Exim
29599 ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
29601 cindex:[%smtp_etrn_command%]
29602 For more control over what ETRN does, the %smtp_etrn_command% option can
29603 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
29604 whatever the form of its argument. For
29607 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain $sender_host_address
29609 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
29610 expansion variable $domain$ is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
29611 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
29612 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
29613 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
29614 for it to change them before running the command.
29618 Incoming local SMTP
29619 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29620 cindex:[SMTP,local incoming]
29621 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
29622 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
29623 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
29624 %-bs% option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
29625 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
29626 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
29627 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
29628 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
29629 runs for RCPT commands:
29633 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
29638 Outgoing batched SMTP
29639 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29640 cindex:[SMTP,batched outgoing]
29641 cindex:[batched SMTP output]
29642 Both the ^appendfile^ and ^pipe^ transports can be used for handling batched
29643 SMTP. Each has an option called %use_bsmtp% which causes messages to be output
29644 in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of delivery. All
29645 it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the envelope along
29648 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
29649 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
29650 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
29651 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the %message_prefix% option
29652 can be used to specify it.
29654 Because ^appendfile^ and ^pipe^ are both local transports, they accept only
29655 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
29656 to handle several addresses at once by setting the %batch_max% option. When
29657 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
29658 chapter <<CHAPbatching>> for more details.
29660 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
29661 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
29662 transport in the variable $host$. Here is an example of such a transport and
29667 driver = manualroute
29668 transport = smtp_appendfile
29669 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
29673 driver = appendfile
29674 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
29679 This causes messages addressed to 'domain.example' to be written in BSMTP
29680 format to _/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_, with only a single copy of each
29681 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
29685 [[SECTincomingbatchedSMTP]]
29686 Incoming batched SMTP
29687 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29688 cindex:[SMTP,batched incoming]
29689 cindex:[batched SMTP input]
29690 The %-bS% command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
29691 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
29692 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
29693 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
29694 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
29695 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
29696 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
29698 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
29699 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
29701 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing ``.'' at
29702 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
29703 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
29704 make some use of automatically, for example:
29706 554 Unexpected end of file
29707 Transaction started in line 10
29708 Error detected in line 14
29710 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
29713 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
29714 The error message was:
29716 501 '>' missing at end of address
29718 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
29719 The error was detected in line 12.
29720 The SMTP command at fault was:
29722 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
29724 1 previous message was successfully processed.
29725 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
29727 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
29728 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
29733 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29734 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29737 [titleabbrev="Customizing messages"]
29738 Customizing bounce and warning messages
29739 ---------------------------------------
29740 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
29741 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
29742 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
29743 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
29744 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
29746 The 'From:' and 'To:' header lines are automatically generated; you can cause
29747 a 'Reply-To:' line to be added by setting the %errors_reply_to% option. Exim
29750 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
29752 to all warning and bounce messages,
29755 Customizing bounce messages
29756 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29757 cindex:[customizing,bounce message]
29758 cindex:[bounce message,customizing]
29759 If %bounce_message_text% is set, its contents are included in the default
29760 message immediately after ``This message was created automatically by mail
29761 delivery software.'' The string is not expanded. It is not used if
29762 %bounce_message_file% is set.
29764 When %bounce_message_file% is set, it must point to a template file for
29765 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
29766 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
29767 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
29768 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
29771 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
29772 expansion variables which can be of use here: $bounce_recipient$ is set to
29773 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
29774 $return_size_limit$ contains the value of the %return_size_limit% option,
29775 rounded to a whole number.
29777 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
29779 - The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
29780 'Subject:' header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
29782 - The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
29783 failing addresses with their error messages.
29785 - The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
29786 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
29788 - The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
29789 as part of the error report.
29791 - The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
29792 truncated because it is bigger than %return_size_limit%.
29794 - The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
29796 The default state (%bounce_message_file% unset) is equivalent to the
29797 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The 'Subject:' line has been
29798 split into two here in order to fit it on the page:
29800 Subject: Mail delivery failed
29801 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}{: returning message to sender}}
29803 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
29805 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}{that you sent }{sent by
29809 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
29810 The following address(es) failed:
29812 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
29814 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers. ------
29816 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long; only the first
29817 ------ $return_size_limit or so are included here.
29822 Customizing warning messages
29823 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29824 cindex:[customizing,warning message]
29825 cindex:[warning of delay,customizing the message]
29826 The option %warn_message_file% can be pointed at a template file for use when
29827 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
29830 - The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
29831 'Subject:' header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
29833 - The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
29834 the delayed addresses.
29836 - The third item then ends the message.
29838 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that the line
29839 starting ``A message'' has been split here, in order to fit it on the page:
29841 Subject: Warning: message $message_id delayed $warn_message_delay
29843 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
29845 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
29846 {that you sent }{sent by
29850 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
29851 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
29853 The message identifier is: $message_id
29854 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
29855 The date of the message is: $h_date
29857 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
29859 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will continue for
29860 some time, and this warning may be repeated at intervals if the message
29861 remains undelivered. Eventually the mail delivery software will give up,
29862 and when that happens, the message will be returned to you.
29864 except that in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
29865 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
29866 $warn_message_delay$ is set to the delay time in one of the forms ``<''n'>
29867 minutes' or ``<''n'> hours', and $warn_message_recipients$ contains a list of
29868 recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
29869 multiple addresses with different %errors_to% settings on the routers that
29875 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29876 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29879 [titleabbrev="Common configuration settings"]
29880 Some common configuration settings
29881 ----------------------------------
29882 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
29883 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
29887 Sending mail to a smart host
29888 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29889 cindex:[smart host,example router]
29890 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a ``smart host'', you
29891 should replace the default ^dnslookup^ router with a router which does the
29892 routing explicitly:
29894 send_to_smart_host:
29895 driver = manualroute
29896 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
29897 transport = remote_smtp
29899 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
29901 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
29902 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
29903 synchronously by setting the %mua_wrapper% option (see chapter
29904 <<CHAPnonqueueing>>).
29909 [[SECTmailinglists]]
29910 Using Exim to handle mailing lists
29911 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29912 cindex:[mailing lists]
29913 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
29914 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
29915 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
29917 The ^redirect^ router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
29918 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
29919 independent manager. The %domains% router option can be used to run these
29920 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
29924 domains = lists.example
29925 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
29928 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
29931 This router is skipped for domains other than 'lists.example'. For addresses
29932 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
29933 such file, the router declines, but because %no_more% is set, no subsequent
29934 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
29936 The %forbid_pipe% and %forbid_file% options prevent a local part from being
29937 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
29940 cindex:[%errors_to%]
29941 The %errors_to% option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
29942 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
29943 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
29944 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
29946 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
29947 'dicts@lists.example' is passed on to those addresses contained in
29948 _/usr/lists/dicts_, with error reports directed to
29949 'dicts-request@lists.example', provided that this address can be verified.
29950 There could be a file called _/usr/lists/dicts-request_ containing
29951 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
29952 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the %local_part_prefix%
29953 or %local_part_suffix% options) to handle addresses of the form %owner-xxx%
29954 or %xxx-request%, are also possible.
29958 Syntax errors in mailing lists
29959 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29960 cindex:[mailing lists,syntax errors in]
29961 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
29962 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
29963 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
29964 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
29965 addresses are not rigorously checked.
29967 If the %skip_syntax_errors% option is set, the ^redirect^ router just skips
29968 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
29969 %syntax_errors_to% is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
29970 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
29971 %syntax_errors_to% to the same address as %errors_to%.
29975 Re-expansion of mailing lists
29976 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
29977 cindex:[mailing lists,re-expansion of]
29978 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
29979 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
29980 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
29981 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
29982 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
29983 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
29984 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
29985 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
29987 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the %one_time% option can be set
29988 on the ^redirect^ router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
29989 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
29990 ``top level'' addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
29991 ``delivered''. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
29992 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
29993 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
29994 pre-existing messages.
29996 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
29997 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
29998 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
29999 %all_parents% selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
30000 one level of expansion anyway.
30004 Closed mailing lists
30005 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30006 cindex:[mailing lists,closed]
30007 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
30008 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
30009 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
30010 %senders% option to restrict the router that handles the list.
30012 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
30013 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
30018 domains = lists.example
30019 local_part_suffix = -request
30020 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
30025 domains = lists.example
30026 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
30027 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
30028 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
30031 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
30036 domains = lists.example
30038 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
30041 All three routers have the same %domains% setting, so for any other domains,
30042 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
30043 %-request%. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
30046 The second router runs only if the %senders% precondition is satisfied. It
30047 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
30048 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
30049 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
30050 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
30051 not exist, the expansion of %senders% is \*, which matches all senders. This
30052 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
30053 %no_more% ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
30054 ``unrouteable address'' error.
30056 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
30057 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
30058 the address, giving a suitable error message.
30063 [[SECTvirtualdomains]]
30066 cindex:[virtual domains]
30067 cindex:[domain,virtual]
30068 The phrase 'virtual domain' is unfortunately used with two rather different
30071 - A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
30072 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
30073 top-level domains and ``vanity'' domains.
30075 - One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
30076 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
30077 have login accounts on that host.
30079 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more ``virtual'' than the
30080 second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
30081 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
30082 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
30083 whether the domain exists. The ^dsearch^ lookup type is useful here, leading
30084 to a router of this form:
30088 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
30089 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
30092 The %domains% option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
30093 is a file in the _/etc/mail/virtual_ directory whose name is the same as the
30094 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
30095 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The %no_more%
30096 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to %data% being an empty
30097 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
30099 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
30100 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
30101 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
30102 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
30104 The other kind of ``virtual'' domain can also be handled in a straightforward
30105 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
30106 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
30110 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
30111 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
30112 transport = my_mailboxes
30114 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
30115 can be found in the file. The %domains% option is used to check for the file's
30116 existence because %domains% is tested before the %local_parts% option (see
30117 section <<SECTrouprecon>>). You can't use %require_files%, because that option
30118 is tested after %local_parts%. The transport is as follows:
30121 driver = appendfile
30122 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
30125 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The %user% setting is
30126 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
30128 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
30129 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
30130 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
30131 information about the domains.
30136 Multiple user mailboxes
30137 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30138 cindex:[multiple mailboxes]
30139 cindex:[mailbox,multiple]
30140 cindex:[local part,prefix]
30141 cindex:[local part,suffix]
30142 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
30143 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
30144 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
30145 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
30146 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
30147 %local_part_prefix% and %local_part_suffix% can be used for this. For
30148 example, consider this router:
30153 file = $home/.forward
30154 local_part_suffix = -*
30155 local_part_suffix_optional
30158 It runs a user's _.forward_ file for all local parts of the form
30159 'username-\*'. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
30160 cases by testing the variable $local_part_suffix$. For example:
30162 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
30163 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
30166 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
30167 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
30168 %local_part_suffix% option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
30169 control over which suffixes are valid.
30171 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
30172 _.forward_ file -- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
30178 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
30179 local_part_suffix = -*
30180 local_part_suffix_optional
30183 If there is no suffix, _.forward_ is used; if the suffix is '-special', for
30184 example, _.forward-special_ is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
30185 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
30186 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
30187 _.forward_ file to use as a default.
30191 Simplified vacation processing
30192 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30193 cindex:[vacation processing]
30194 The traditional way of running the 'vacation' program is for a user to set up
30195 a pipe command in a _.forward_ file
30196 (see section <<SECTspecitredli>> for syntax details).
30197 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
30198 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
30200 - A local part prefix such as ``vacation-'' can be specified on a router which
30201 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the 'vacation' program, or
30202 alternatively can use Exim's ^autoreply^ transport. The contents of a user's
30203 _.forward_ file are then much simpler. For example:
30205 spqr, vacation-spqr
30207 - The %require_files% generic router option can be used to trigger a
30208 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
30209 user's home directory. The %unseen% generic option should also be used, to
30210 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
30211 to do is to create a file called, say, _.vacation_, containing a vacation
30214 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
30215 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
30219 Taking copies of mail
30220 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30221 cindex:[message,copying every]
30222 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
30223 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
30224 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
30225 each day's messages.
30227 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
30228 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
30229 delivery. This could be used, 'inter alia', to implement automatic
30230 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
30234 Intermittently connected hosts
30235 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30236 cindex:[intermittently connected hosts]
30237 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
30238 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
30239 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
30240 permanently connected.
30242 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
30243 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
30244 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
30247 Exim on the upstream server host
30248 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30249 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
30250 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
30251 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
30252 being mixed up in the same queue -- those that cannot be delivered because of
30253 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
30254 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
30255 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
30257 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
30258 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
30259 into local files in batch SMTP, ``mailstore'', or other envelope-preserving
30260 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
30261 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
30262 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
30265 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
30266 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
30267 intermittent host. For example:
30269 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
30271 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
30272 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
30273 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the %-M% or %-R%
30274 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section <<SECTETRN>>)
30275 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
30276 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
30279 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
30280 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
30281 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
30282 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
30283 avoided by unsetting %retry_include_ip_address% on the ^smtp^ transport.
30284 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
30285 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
30289 Exim on the intermittently connected client host
30290 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30291 The value of %smtp_accept_queue_per_connection% should probably be
30292 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
30293 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
30294 delivered immediately.
30296 cindex:[SMTP,passed connection]
30297 cindex:[SMTP,multiple deliveries]
30298 cindex:[multiple SMTP deliveries]
30299 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
30300 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
30301 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
30302 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
30303 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
30304 %-qq% instead of %-q%. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the first
30305 pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a normal
30306 queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those destined
30307 for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a single
30312 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30313 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30315 [[CHAPnonqueueing]]
30316 [titleabbrev="Exim as a non-queueing client"]
30317 Using Exim as a non-queueing client
30318 -----------------------------------
30319 cindex:[client, non-queueing]
30320 cindex:[smart host,queueing; suppressing]
30321 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
30322 email to be sent to a ``smart host''. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
30323 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
30324 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
30325 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
30326 _/usr/sbin/sendmail_. Furthermore, utility programs such as 'cron' submit
30329 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
30330 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
30331 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
30332 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
30333 email is not desirable.
30335 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
30336 _/usr/sbin/sendmail_ interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
30337 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
30338 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
30339 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
30340 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
30341 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
30343 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called 'ssmtp')
30344 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
30345 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
30346 before sending a message to the smart host.
30348 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
30349 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
30350 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
30352 cindex:[%mua_wrapper%]
30353 There is a Boolean global option called %mua_wrapper%, defaulting false.
30354 Setting %mua_wrapper% true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
30355 assumes that it is being used to ``wrap'' a command-line MUA in the manner
30356 just described. As well as setting %mua_wrapper%, you also need to provide a
30357 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
30358 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
30360 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
30363 - A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from 'inetd'.
30364 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
30366 - Each message is synchonously delivered as soon as it is received (%-odi% is
30367 assumed). All queueing options (%queue_only%, %queue_smtp_domains%,
30368 %control% in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process does
30369 not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
30370 successful, a zero return code is given.
30372 - Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
30373 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
30374 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
30375 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
30376 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
30379 - If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
30380 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
30381 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
30383 - Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
30384 is no distinction between 4##'xx' and 5##'xx' SMTP response codes from the
30385 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
30386 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
30387 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
30389 - If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
30390 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
30391 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
30393 - When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
30394 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
30395 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
30396 are ever generated.
30398 - No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
30400 - A number of Exim options are overridden: %deliver_drop_privilege% is forced
30401 true, %max_rcpt% in the smtp transport is forced to ``unlimited'',
30402 %remote_max_parallel% is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
30404 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
30405 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
30406 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
30407 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to 'exim' instead of setuid
30408 to 'root'. See section <<SECTrunexiwitpri>> for a general discussion about the
30409 advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
30414 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30415 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30420 cindex:[log,types of]
30421 cindex:[log,general description]
30422 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
30425 - cindex:[main log]
30426 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
30427 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
30428 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
30429 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
30430 them are optional, in which case the %log_selector% option controls whether
30431 they are included or not. A Perl script called 'eximstats', which does simple
30432 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
30435 - cindex:[reject log]
30436 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
30437 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
30438 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
30439 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
30440 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
30441 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
30442 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
30443 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
30444 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting %write_rejectlog% false.
30446 - cindex:[panic log]
30447 cindex:[system log]
30448 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
30449 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
30450 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
30451 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
30452 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a 'cron' script check it)
30453 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
30454 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
30455 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
30456 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
30458 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in this example:
30460 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed by QUIT
30462 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
30463 ways of changing this:
30465 - You can set the %timezone% option to a different time zone; in particular, if
30470 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
30472 - If you set %log_timezone% true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
30475 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
30482 Where the logs are written
30483 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30484 cindex:[log,destination]
30485 cindex:[log,to file]
30486 cindex:[log,to syslog]
30488 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
30489 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
30490 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
30491 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
30492 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
30493 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write -- on Linux
30494 this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
30496 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
30497 _Local/Makefile_ or by setting %log_file_path% in the run time
30498 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
30499 references to the host name:
30501 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
30503 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in _Local/Makefile_
30504 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
30505 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
30506 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
30507 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
30510 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or %log_file_path% is a colon-separated
30511 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
30512 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
30513 colon-separated. If an item in the list is ``syslog'' then syslog is used;
30514 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing `%s` at the
30515 point where ``main'', ``reject'', or ``panic'' is to be inserted, or be empty,
30516 implying the use of a default path.
30518 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
30519 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
30520 ``syslog''. This means that an empty item in %log_file_path% can be used to
30521 mean ``use the path specified at build time''. It no such item exists, log files
30522 are written in the _log_ subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
30523 equivalent to the setting:
30525 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
30527 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
30530 A log file path may also contain `%D` if datestamped log file names are in
30531 use -- see section <<SECTdatlogfil>> below.
30533 Here are some examples of possible settings:
30536 `LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog ` syslog only
30537 `LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog ` syslog and default path
30538 `LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s ` syslog and specified path
30539 `LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s ` specified path only
30542 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
30547 Logging to local files that are periodically ``cycled''
30548 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30549 cindex:[log,cycling local files]
30550 cindex:[cycling logs]
30551 cindex:['exicyclog']
30552 cindex:[log,local files; writing to]
30553 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardised methods for cycling
30554 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called 'exicyclog' is
30555 provided (see section <<SECTcyclogfil>>). This renames and compresses the main
30556 and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to keep
30557 can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily 'cron' job.
30559 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
30560 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required -- for
30561 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
30562 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
30563 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if 'exicyclog' or
30564 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
30565 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
30566 'stat()' on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
30567 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
30568 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
30569 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
30575 Datestamped log files
30576 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30577 cindex:[log,datestamped files]
30578 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
30579 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
30580 for example, _mainlog-20031225_. The datestamp is in the form _yyyymmdd_.
30581 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
30582 %log_file_path% option to a path that includes `%D` at the point where the
30583 datestamp is required. For example:
30585 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
30586 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
30587 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
30589 As before, `%s` is replaced by ``main'' or ``reject''; the following are examples
30590 of names generated by the above examples:
30592 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
30593 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
30594 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
30596 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
30597 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
30598 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
30599 run 'exicyclog' with this form of logging.
30601 The location of the panic log is also determined by %log_file_path%, but it
30602 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
30603 When generating the name of the panic log, `%D` is removed from the string.
30604 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
30605 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
30606 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
30608 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
30609 /var/log/exim-panic.log
30610 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
30617 cindex:[log,syslog; writing to]
30618 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
30619 except in one respect. If %syslog_timestamp% is set false, the timestamps on
30620 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
30621 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
30622 ``facility'' is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to ``exim''
30623 by default, but you can change these by setting the %syslog_facility% and
30624 %syslog_processname% options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
30625 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in _Local/Makefile_ (this is the default in
30626 _src/EDITME_), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
30627 LOG_PID flag is set so that the 'syslog()' call adds the pid as well as
30628 the time and host name to each line.
30629 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
30631 - 'mainlog' is mapped to LOG_INFO
30633 - 'rejectlog' is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
30635 - 'paniclog' is mapped to LOG_ALERT
30637 Many log lines are written to both 'mainlog' and 'rejectlog', and some are
30638 written to both 'mainlog' and 'paniclog', so there will be duplicates if
30639 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
30640 by setting %syslog_duplication% false.
30642 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its 'rejectlog'
30643 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
30644 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate 'syslog()'
30645 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
30646 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
30647 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
30648 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
30649 RFC 3164, you should set
30651 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
30653 in _Local/Makefile_ before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
30654 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in 'reject' log entries.
30656 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
30657 entry starts with a string of the form ``[<''n'>/<'m'>]' or ``[<''n'>\<'m'>]'
30658 where <'n'> is the component number and <'m'> is the total number of components
30659 in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split because it was
30660 too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \ delimiter is
30661 used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 70 instead of 1000, the
30662 following would be the result of a typical rejection message to 'mainlog'
30663 (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host name, and
30664 pid as added by syslog:
30666 $smc\{[1/3] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from [127.0.0.1] (ph10):
30667 [2/3] syntax error in 'From' header when scanning for sender: missing or ma
30668 [3/3] lformed local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.example>)\}
30670 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to ``rejectlog''
30673 $smc\{[1/14] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from [127.0.0.1] (ph10):
30674 [2/14] syntax error in 'From' header when scanning for sender: missing or ma
30675 [3\14] lformed local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.example>)
30676 [4\14] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
30677 [5\14] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
30678 [6\14] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
30679 [7\14] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
30680 [8\14] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
30682 [10\14] Subject: this is a test header
30683 [11\14] X-something: this is another header
30684 [12\14] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.example>
30686 [14/14] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100\}
30688 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
30689 without modification.
30691 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
30692 display, unless syslog is routing 'mainlog' to a file on the local host and
30693 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
30700 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
30701 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
30702 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
30703 timestamp. The flags are:
30706 `<=` message arrival
30707 `=>` normal message delivery
30708 `->` additional address in same delivery
30709 `\*>` delivery suppressed by %-N%
30710 `\*\*` delivery failed; address bounced
30711 `==` delivery deferred; temporary problem
30716 Logging message reception
30717 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30718 cindex:[log,reception line]
30719 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
30720 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
30721 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
30723 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
30724 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
30725 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
30727 The address immediately following ``<='' is the envelope sender address. A bounce
30728 message is shown with the sender address ``<>'', and if it is locally generated,
30729 this is followed by an item of the form
30733 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
30737 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
30738 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
30739 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
30740 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
30741 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
30742 %host_lookup% option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
30743 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
30744 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
30745 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
30746 name in parentheses.
30748 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
30749 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
30750 the log containing text like these examples:
30752 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
30753 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
30755 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
30758 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
30759 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
30762 cindex:[authentication,logging]
30763 cindex:[AUTH,logging]
30764 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
30765 message. This is set to ``esmtpa'' for messages received from hosts that have
30766 authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. In this case there is an
30767 additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that was used. If
30768 an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
30769 %server_set_id% option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
30770 authenticator name.
30772 The id field records the existing message id, if present.
30773 cindex:[size,of message]
30774 The size of the received message is given by the S field. When the message is
30775 delivered, headers may get removed or added, so that the size of delivered
30776 copies of the message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be
30777 different to each other).
30779 The %log_selector% option can be used to request the logging of additional
30780 data when a message is received. See section <<SECTlogselector>> below.
30786 cindex:[log,delivery line]
30787 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
30788 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote deliveries,
30789 respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order to fit
30792 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv <marv@hitch.fict.example>
30793 R=localuser T=local_delivery
30794 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => monk@holistic.fict.example
30795 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
30797 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
30798 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
30799 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
30800 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
30801 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
30803 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
30804 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
30806 ST=<shadow transport name>
30808 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
30809 parentheses afterwards.
30811 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
30812 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent
30813 addresses are flagged with `->` instead of `=>`. When two or more
30814 messages are delivered down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
30815 IP address in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
30817 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a ``delivery''
30818 to the addressee, preceded by ``>''.
30820 The %log_selector% option can be used to request the logging of additional
30821 data when a message is delivered. See section <<SECTlogselector>> below.
30825 Discarded deliveries
30826 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30827 cindex:[discarded messages]
30828 cindex:[message,discarded]
30829 cindex:[delivery,discarded; logging]
30830 When a message is discarded as a result of the command ``seen finish'' being
30831 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
30833 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
30834 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
30836 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
30837 because it is aliased to ``:blackhole:'' the log line is like this:
30839 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
30840 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
30845 Deferred deliveries
30846 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30847 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
30849 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
30850 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
30852 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
30853 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
30854 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
30856 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
30857 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
30859 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
30860 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
30861 appropriate value in %log_selector%.
30867 cindex:[delivery,failure; logging]
30868 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
30869 following form is logged:
30871 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
30872 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
30874 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
30875 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
30877 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example R=dnslookup
30878 T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer after pipelined
30879 RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host pbmail3.py.example
30880 [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0 <ace400@pb.example>...
30883 The word ``pipelined'' indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
30884 used. See %hosts_avoid_esmtp% in the ^smtp^ transport for a way of
30885 disabling PIPELINING.
30887 The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are flagged with `\*\*`.
30893 cindex:[delivery,fake; logging]
30894 If a delivery does not actually take place because the %-N% option has been
30895 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
30896 ``=>'' is replaced by ``\*>''.
30904 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
30906 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
30907 at the end of its processing.
30912 Summary of Fields in Log Lines
30913 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30914 cindex:[log,summary of fields]
30915 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
30916 the following table:
30919 `A ` authenticator name (and optional id)
30920 `C ` SMTP confirmation on delivery
30921 `CV ` certificate verification status
30922 `DN ` distinguished name from peer certificate
30923 `DT ` on `=>` lines: time taken for a delivery
30924 `F ` sender address (on delivery lines)
30925 `H ` host name and IP address
30926 `I ` local interface used
30927 `id ` message id for incoming message
30928 `P ` on `<=` lines: protocol used
30929 ` ` on `=>` and `\*\*` lines: return path
30930 `QT ` on `=>` lines: time spent on queue so far
30931 ` ` on ``Completed'' lines: time spent on queue
30932 `R ` on `<=` lines: reference for local bounce
30933 ` ` on `=>` `\*\*` and `==` lines: router name
30934 `S ` size of message
30935 `ST ` shadow transport name
30936 `T ` on `<=` lines: message subject (topic)
30937 ` ` on `=>` `\*\*` and `==` lines: transport name
30938 `U ` local user or RFC 1413 identity
30939 `X ` TLS cipher suite
30946 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
30947 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
30949 - cindex:[retry,time not reached]
30950 'retry time not reached'~~An address previously suffered a temporary error
30951 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
30952 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
30953 during the first delivery attempt.
30955 - 'retry time not reached for any host'~~An address previously suffered
30956 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
30957 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
30959 - cindex:[spool directory,file locked]
30960 'spool file locked'~~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
30961 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
30962 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
30963 'exiwhat' utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
30966 - cindex:[error,ignored]
30967 'error ignored'~~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
30970 . Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
30971 %ignore_bounce_errors_after%. The bounce was discarded.
30973 . A filter file set up a delivery using the ``noerror'' option, and the delivery
30974 failed. The delivery was discarded.
30976 . A delivery set up by a router configured with
30980 failed. The delivery was discarded.
30986 [[SECTlogselector]]
30987 Reducing or increasing what is logged
30988 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
30989 cindex:[log,selectors]
30990 By setting the %log_selector% global option, you can disable some of Exim's
30991 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
30992 %log_selector% is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
30995 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
30997 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
30998 selection marked by asterisks:
31001 ` address_rewrite ` address rewriting
31002 ` all_parents ` all parents in => lines
31003 ` arguments ` command line arguments
31004 `\*connection_reject ` connection rejections
31005 `\*delay_delivery ` immediate delivery delayed
31006 ` deliver_time ` time taken to perform delivery
31007 ` delivery_size ` add S=nnn to => lines
31008 `\*dnslist_defer ` defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
31009 `\*etrn ` ETRN commands
31010 `\*host_lookup_failed ` as it says
31011 ` ident_timeout ` timeout for ident connection
31012 ` incoming_interface ` incoming interface on <= lines
31013 ` incoming_port ` incoming port on <= lines
31014 `\*lost_incoming_connection ` as it says (includes timeouts)
31015 ` outgoing_port ` add remote port to => lines
31016 `\*queue_run ` start and end queue runs
31017 ` queue_time ` time on queue for one recipient
31018 ` queue_time_overall ` time on queue for whole message
31019 ` received_recipients ` recipients on <= lines
31020 ` received_sender ` sender on <= lines
31021 `\*rejected_header ` header contents on reject log
31022 `\*retry_defer ` ``retry time not reached''
31023 ` return_path_on_delivery ` put return path on => and \*\ lines
31024 ` sender_on_delivery ` add sender to => lines
31025 `\*size_reject ` rejection because too big
31026 `\*skip_delivery ` delivery skipped in a queue run
31027 ` smtp_confirmation ` SMTP confirmation on => lines
31028 ` smtp_connection ` SMTP connections
31029 ` smtp_incomplete_transaction` incomplete SMTP transactions
31030 ` smtp_protocol_error ` SMTP protocol errors
31031 ` smtp_syntax_error ` SMTP syntax errors
31032 ` subject ` contents of 'Subject:' on <= lines
31033 ` tls_certificate_verified ` certificate verification status
31034 `\*tls_cipher ` TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
31035 ` tls_peerdn ` TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
31037 ` all ` all of the above
31040 More details on each of these items follows:
31042 - cindex:[log,rewriting]
31043 cindex:[rewriting,logging]
31044 %address_rewrite%: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
31046 but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because such users
31047 cannot access the log).
31049 - cindex:[log,full parentage]
31050 %all_parents%: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
31051 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
31052 parentheses between them.
31054 - cindex:[log,Exim arguments]
31055 cindex:[Exim arguments, logging]
31056 %arguments%: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
31057 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
31058 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
31059 _/usr/sbin/sendmail_. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
31060 privilege because it was called with the %-C% or %-D% options. Arguments that
31061 are empty or that contain whitespace are quoted. Non-printing characters are
31062 shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
31063 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
31064 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as _util/logargs.sh_
31065 between the caller and Exim.
31067 - cindex:[log,connection rejections]
31068 %connection_reject%: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
31069 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
31071 - cindex:[log,delayed delivery]
31072 cindex:[delayed delivery, logging]
31073 %delay_delivery%: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
31074 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
31075 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
31076 process is started because %queue_only% is set or %-odq% was used.
31078 - cindex:[log,delivery duration]
31079 %deliver_time%: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
31080 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<'time'>, for example, `DT=1s`.
31082 - cindex:[log,message size on delivery]
31083 cindex:[size,of message]
31084 %delivery_size%: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
31085 the ``=>'' line, tagged with S=.
31087 - cindex:[log,dnslist defer]
31088 cindex:[DNS list,logging defer]
31089 cindex:[black list (DNS)]
31090 %dnslist_defer%: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
31091 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
31093 - cindex:[log,ETRN commands]
31094 cindex:[ETRN,logging]
31095 %etrn%: Every legal ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL is
31096 run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
31097 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
31098 selector (see %smtp_syntax_error% and %smtp_protocol_error%).
31100 - cindex:[log,host lookup failure]
31101 %host_lookup_failed%: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
31102 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
31103 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
31104 routing email addresses, but it does apply to ``byname'' lookups.
31106 - cindex:[log,ident timeout]
31107 cindex:[RFC 1413,logging timeout]
31108 %ident_timeout%: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
31109 client's ident port times out.
31111 - cindex:[log,incoming interface]
31112 cindex:[interface,logging]
31113 %incoming_interface%: The interface on which a message was received is added to
31114 the ``<='' line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and followed
31115 by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also added to
31116 other SMTP log lines, for example ``SMTP connection from'', and to rejection
31119 - cindex:[log,incoming remote port]
31120 cindex:[port,logging remote]
31121 cindex:[TCP/IP,logging incoming remote port]
31122 %incoming_port%: The remote port number from which a message was received is
31123 added to log entries and 'Received:' header lines, following the IP address in
31124 square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
31125 changing the value that is put in the $sender_fullhost$ and
31126 $sender_rcvhost$ variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
31127 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
31129 - cindex:[log,dropped connection]
31130 %lost_incoming_connection%: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
31131 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
31133 - cindex:[log,outgoing remote port]
31134 cindex:[port,logging outgoint remote]
31135 cindex:[TCP/IP,logging ougtoing remote port]
31136 %outgoing_port%: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
31137 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
31138 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
31139 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
31141 - cindex:[log,queue run]
31142 cindex:[queue runner,logging]
31143 %queue_run%: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
31145 - cindex:[log,queue time]
31146 %queue_time%: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the local
31147 host is logged as QT=<'time'> on delivery (`=>`) lines, for example,
31148 `QT=3m45s`. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
31149 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
31150 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
31151 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
31152 message has been successfully received.
31154 - %queue_time_overall%: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
31155 the local host is logged as QT=<'time'> on ``Completed'' lines, for
31156 example, `QT=3m45s`. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
31157 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
31159 - cindex:[log,recipients]
31160 %received_recipients%: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
31161 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
31162 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word ``for''. The
31163 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
31165 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
31168 - cindex:[log,sender reception]
31169 %received_sender%: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
31170 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
31171 ``from'' (before the recipients if %received_recipients% is also set).
31173 - cindex:[log,header lines for rejection]
31174 %rejected_header%: If a message's header has been received at the time a
31175 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
31176 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
31177 rejected by the 'local_scan()' function (see section <<SECTapiforloc>>).
31179 - cindex:[log,retry defer]
31180 %retry_defer%: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a retry
31181 time has not yet been reached. However, this ``retry time not reached'' message
31182 is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
31185 - cindex:[log,return path]
31186 %return_path_on_delivery%: The return path that is being transmitted with
31187 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
31188 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
31189 or if delivery is to _/dev/null_ or to `:blackhole:`.
31191 - cindex:[log,sender on delivery]
31192 %sender_on_delivery%: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
31193 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for ``from'').
31194 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
31195 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
31197 - cindex:[log,size rejection]
31198 %size_reject%: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because it
31201 - cindex:[log,frozen messages; skipped]
31202 cindex:[frozen messages,logging skipping]
31203 %skip_delivery%: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
31204 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
31206 cindex:[``spool file is locked'']
31207 The message that is written is ``spool file is locked''.
31209 - cindex:[log,smtp confirmation]
31210 cindex:[SMTP,logging confirmation]
31211 %smtp_confirmation%: The response to the final ``.'' in the SMTP dialogue for
31212 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form ``C="<''text'>"'. A
31213 number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this response.
31215 - cindex:[log,SMTP connections]
31216 cindex:[SMTP,logging connections]
31217 %smtp_connection%: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
31218 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
31219 %hosts_connection_nolog%. (In contrast, %lost_incoming_connection% applies only
31220 when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
31221 processes that use %-bs% as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
31222 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
31223 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
31224 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
31226 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
31227 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
31228 reset if the daemon is restarted.
31229 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
31230 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
31231 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
31232 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
31233 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
31235 - cindex:[log,SMTP transaction; incomplete]
31236 cindex:[SMTP,logging incomplete transactions]
31237 %smtp_incomplete_transaction%: When a mail transaction is aborted by
31238 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
31239 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
31240 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
31242 - cindex:[log,SMTP protocol error]
31243 cindex:[SMTP,logging protocol error]
31244 %smtp_protocol_error%: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
31245 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
31246 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
31247 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
31248 it, and therefore it does not count ``expected'' errors (for example, RCPT
31249 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
31251 - cindex:[SMTP,logging syntax errors]
31252 cindex:[SMTP,syntax errors; logging]
31253 cindex:[SMTP,unknown command; logging]
31254 cindex:[log,unknown SMTP command]
31255 cindex:[log,SMTP syntax error]
31256 %smtp_syntax_error%: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
31257 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
31258 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
31259 using %-bs% the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
31261 - cindex:[log,subject]
31262 cindex:[subject, logging]
31263 %subject%: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
31264 preceded by ``T='' (T for ``topic'', since S is already used for ``size'').
31265 Any MIME ``words'' in the subject are decoded. The %print_topbitchars% option
31266 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
31267 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
31269 - cindex:[log,certificate verification]
31270 %tls_certificate_verified%: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
31271 when TLS is in use. The item is `CV=yes` if the peer's certificate was
31272 verified, and `CV=no` if not.
31274 - cindex:[log,TLS cipher]
31275 cindex:[TLS,logging cipher]
31276 %tls_cipher%: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted connection,
31277 the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
31279 - cindex:[log,TLS peer DN]
31280 cindex:[TLS,logging peer DN]
31281 %tls_peerdn%: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted connection,
31282 and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is added to the
31283 log line, preceded by DN=.
31289 cindex:[message,log file for]
31290 cindex:[log,message log; description of]
31291 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
31292 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
31294 cindex:[_msglog_ directory]
31295 they are kept in the _msglog_ sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
31296 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
31297 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
31298 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
31301 cindex:[%preserve_message_logs%]
31302 unless %preserve_message_logs% is set, but this should be used only with
31303 great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
31305 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
31306 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
31307 %message_logs% option false.
31311 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31312 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31318 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
31319 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
31320 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
31324 ,<<SECTfinoutwha>> , 'exiwhat' , list what Exim processes are doing
31325 ,<<SECTgreptheque>> , 'exiqgrep' , grep the queue
31326 ,<<SECTsumtheque>> , 'exiqsumm' , summarize the queue
31327 ,<<SECTextspeinf>> , 'exigrep' , search the main log
31328 ,<<SECTexipick>> , 'exipick' , select messages on various criteria
31329 ,<<SECTcyclogfil>> , 'exicyclog' , cycle (rotate) log files
31330 ,<<SECTmailstat>> , 'eximstats' , extract statistics from the log
31331 ,<<SECTcheckaccess>> , 'exim_checkaccess', check address acceptance from given IP
31332 ,<<SECTdbmbuild>> , 'exim_dbmbuild' , build a DBM file
31333 ,<<SECTfinindret>> , 'exinext' , extract retry information
31334 ,<<SECThindatmai>> , 'exim_dumpdb' , dump a hints database
31335 ,<<SECThindatmai>> , 'exim_tidydb' , clean up a hints database
31336 ,<<SECThindatmai>> , 'exim_fixdb' , patch a hints database
31337 ,<<SECTmailboxmaint>>, 'exim_lock' , lock a mailbox file
31342 Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)
31343 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31345 cindex:[process, querying]
31347 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
31348 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
31349 a line describing what it is doing to the file _exim-process.info_ in the
31350 Exim spool directory. The 'exiwhat' script sends the signal to all Exim
31351 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
31352 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
31353 order to run 'exiwhat' successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
31354 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
31356 *Warning*: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
31357 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
31358 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
31361 Unfortunately, the 'ps' command that 'exiwhat' uses to find Exim processes
31362 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
31363 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
31364 system configuration options that configure exactly how 'exiwhat' works. If it
31365 doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time options:
31368 `EXIWHAT_PS_CMD ` the command for running 'ps'
31369 `EXIWHAT_PS_ARG ` the argument for 'ps'
31370 `EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG ` the argument for 'egrep' to select from 'ps' output
31371 `EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG ` the argument for the 'kill' command
31374 An example of typical output from 'exiwhat' is
31376 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
31377 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
31378 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example [10.19.42.42]
31379 (editor@ref.example)
31380 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
31381 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
31383 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
31384 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
31389 Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)
31390 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31391 cindex:['exiqgrep']
31392 cindex:[queue,grepping]
31393 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
31397 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
31398 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
31399 options are available:
31402 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
31403 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
31408 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
31412 Match against the size field.
31415 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
31418 Match messages that are older than the given time.
31421 Match only frozen messages.
31424 Match only non-frozen messages.
31430 The following options control the format of the output:
31433 Display only the count of matching messages.
31436 Long format -- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
31440 Display message ids only.
31443 Brief format -- one line per message.
31446 Display messages in reverse order.
31452 There is one more option, %-h%, which outputs a list of options.
31457 Summarising the queue (exiqsumm)
31458 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31459 cindex:['exiqsumm']
31460 cindex:[queue,summary]
31461 The 'exiqsumm' utility is a Perl script which reads the output of 'exim
31462 -bp' and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
31463 running a command such as
31465 exim -bp | exiqsumm
31467 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
31468 it, as in the following example:
31470 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
31472 Each line lists the number of
31473 pending deliveries for a domain, their total volume, and the length of time
31474 that the oldest and the newest messages have been waiting. Note that the number
31475 of pending deliveries is greater than the number of messages when messages
31476 have more than one recipient.
31478 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
31479 domain name, but 'exiqsumm' has the options %-a% and %-c%, which cause the
31480 output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages, respectively.
31482 The output of 'exim -bp' contains the original addresses in the message, so
31483 this also applies to the output from 'exiqsumm'. No domains from addresses
31484 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the %one_time% option
31485 of the ^redirect^ router has been used to convert them into ``top level''
31492 Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)
31493 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31495 cindex:[log,extracts; grepping for]
31496 The 'exigrep' utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
31497 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
31498 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
31499 match the pattern. Thus, 'exigrep' can extract complete log entries for a
31500 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
31502 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is always
31503 included in 'exigrep''s output.
31506 exigrep [-l] [-t<n>] <pattern> [<log file>] ...
31508 The %-t% argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
31509 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
31510 they spent more than <'n'> seconds on the queue.
31512 The %-l% flag means ``literal'', that is, treat all characters in the
31513 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
31514 regular expression. The pattern match is case-insensitive. If no file names are
31515 given on the command line, the standard input is read.
31517 If the location of a 'zcat' command is known from the definition of
31518 ZCAT_COMMAND in _Local/Makefile_, 'exigrep' automatically passes any
31519 file whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through 'zcat' as it searches
31524 Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)
31525 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31527 John Jetmore's 'exipick' utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
31528 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details,
31537 Cycling log files (exicyclog)
31538 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31539 cindex:[log,cycling local files]
31540 cindex:[cycling logs]
31541 cindex:['exicyclog']
31542 The 'exicyclog' script can be used to cycle (rotate) 'mainlog' and
31543 'rejectlog' files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
31544 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
31545 <<SECTdatlogfil>>). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms for
31546 log cycling, and these can be used instead of 'exicyclog' if preferred.
31548 Each time 'exicyclog' is run the file names get ``shuffled down'' by one. If
31549 the main log file name is _mainlog_ (the default) then when 'exicyclog' is
31550 run _mainlog_ becomes _mainlog.01_, the previous _mainlog.01_ becomes
31551 _mainlog.02_ and so on, up to a limit which is set in the script, and which
31552 defaults to 10. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
31553 logs are handled similarly.
31555 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
31556 _mainlog.001_, _mainlog.002_, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
31557 to one that is greater, or 'vice versa', you will have to fix the names of
31558 any existing log files.
31561 If no _mainlog_ file exists, the script does nothing. Files that ``drop off''
31562 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
31563 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
31564 setting in _Local/Makefile_. It is usual to run 'exicyclog' daily from a
31565 root %crontab% entry of the form
31567 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
31569 assuming you have used the name ``exim'' for the Exim user. You can run
31570 'exicyclog' as root if you wish, but there is no need.
31575 Mail statistics (eximstats)
31576 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31577 cindex:[statistics]
31578 cindex:['eximstats']
31579 A Perl script called 'eximstats' is provided for extracting statistical
31580 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
31581 Exim log files are also suported by the 'Lire' system produced by the
31582 LogReport Foundation (*http://www.logreport.org[]*).
31584 The 'eximstats' script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
31585 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
31586 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
31587 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
31588 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
31590 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
31592 By default, 'eximstats' extracts information about the number and volume of
31593 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
31594 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
31595 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
31596 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
31597 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
31598 also produced per user.
31600 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
31601 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
31602 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
31603 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
31604 as a single delivery by 'eximstats'.
31606 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
31607 have multiple recipients), it is possible for 'eximstats' to report more
31608 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
31609 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
31610 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
31611 an entirely separate message.
31613 'eximstats' always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
31614 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
31615 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
31616 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
31617 least one address that failed.
31619 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
31620 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
31621 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
31622 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
31623 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
31624 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
31625 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
31627 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
31628 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
31629 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
31631 There are quite a few options for 'eximstats' to control exactly what it
31632 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
31633 by running the command ^perldoc^ on the script. For example:
31635 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
31639 [[SECTcheckaccess]]
31640 Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)
31641 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31642 cindex:['exim_checkaccess']
31643 cindex:[policy control,checking access]
31644 cindex:[checking access]
31645 The %-bh% command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
31646 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
31647 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
31648 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of %-bh%, and
31649 sometimes you just want to answer the question 'Does this address have
31650 access?' without bothering with any further details.
31652 The 'exim_checkaccess' utility is a ``packaged'' version of %-bh%. It takes
31653 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
31655 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
31657 The utility runs a call to Exim with the %-bh% option, to test whether the
31658 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
31659 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
31660 is either the word ``accepted'', or the SMTP error response, for example:
31663 550 Relay not permitted
31665 When running this test, the utility uses `<>` as the envelope sender address
31666 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
31667 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
31668 that the test is to be run with the sender address 'himself@there.example'
31672 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
31673 -f himself@there.example
31676 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
31677 mandatory arguments.
31679 Because the %exim_checkaccess% uses %-bh%, it does not perform callouts while
31680 running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using %-bhc%,
31681 but this is not yet available in a ``packaged'' form.
31686 Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)
31687 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31688 cindex:[DBM,building dbm files]
31689 cindex:[building DBM files]
31690 cindex:['exim_dbmbuild']
31691 cindex:[lower casing]
31692 cindex:[binary zero,in lookup key]
31693 The 'exim_dbmbuild' program reads an input file containing keys and data in
31694 the format used by the ^lsearch^ lookup (see section <<SECTsinglekeylookups>>).
31695 It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias names as keys and the
31696 remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing can be prevented by
31697 calling the program with the %-nolc% option.
31699 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
31700 the ^dbm^ lookup type. However, if the option %-nozero% is given,
31701 'exim_dbmbuild' creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
31702 strings or the data strings. The ^dbmnz^ lookup type can be used with such
31705 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
31706 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
31707 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
31711 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
31712 configuration file -- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
31713 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
31714 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
31716 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
31718 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
31721 In systems that use the 'ndbm' routines (mostly proprietary versions of Unix),
31722 two files are used, with the suffixes _.dir_ and _.pag_. In this
31723 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
31724 'exim_dbmbuild', so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
31725 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
31726 recommended), because in that case it adds a _.db_ suffix to the file name.
31728 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
31729 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the %-noduperr% option
31730 is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used -- this
31731 makes it compatible with ^lsearch^ lookups. There is an option %-lastdup%
31732 which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead. There is also
31733 an option %-nowarn%, which stops it listing duplicate keys to %stderr%. For
31734 other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the return code is 2.
31740 Finding individual retry times (exinext)
31741 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31742 cindex:[retry,times]
31744 A utility called 'exinext' (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to fish
31745 specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
31746 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
31747 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
31748 is obtained by running 'exim_dumpdb' (see below) and post-processing the
31749 output. For example:
31751 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
31752 kanga.milne.fict.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
31753 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
31754 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
31755 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
31756 roo.milne.fict.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
31757 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
31758 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
31759 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
31760 past final cutoff time
31762 You can also give 'exinext' a local part, without a domain, and it
31763 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
31764 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
31765 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
31766 suffers a message-specific error (see section <<SECToutSMTPerr>>). 'exinext' is
31767 not particularly efficient, but then it isn't expected to be run very often.
31769 The 'exinext' utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
31770 of the spool directory. The utility has %-C% and %-D% options, which are
31771 passed on to the 'exim' commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
31772 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
31773 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
31774 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
31780 Hints database maintenance (exim_dumpdb, exim_fixdb, exim_tidydb)
31781 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31782 cindex:[hints database,maintenance]
31783 cindex:[maintaining Exim's hints database]
31784 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
31785 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
31786 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
31787 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as
31790 - 'retry': the database of retry information
31792 - 'wait-'<'transport name'>: databases of information about messages waiting
31795 - 'callout': the callout cache
31797 - 'misc': other hints data
31799 The 'misc' database is used for
31801 - Serializing ETRN runs (when %smtp_etrn_serialize% is set)
31803 - Serializing delivery to a specific host (when %serialize_hosts% is set in an
31810 cindex:['exim_dumpdb']
31811 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
31812 'exim_dumpdb' program, which has no options or arguments other than the
31813 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
31815 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
31817 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
31819 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
31820 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
31822 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
31823 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
31824 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
31825 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
31826 address (unless %no_retry_include_ip_address% is set on the ^smtp^
31827 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
31828 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
31829 and a textual description of the error.
31831 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
31832 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
31833 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
31836 Each output line from 'exim_dumpdb' for the 'wait-''xxx' databases
31837 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
31838 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
31839 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
31840 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
31841 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
31848 cindex:['exim_tidydb']
31849 The 'exim_tidydb' utility program is used to tidy up the contents of the
31850 hints databases. If run with no options, it removes all records from a database
31851 that are more than 30 days old. The cutoff date can be altered by means of the
31852 %-t% option, which must be followed by a time. For example, to remove all
31853 records older than a week from the retry database:
31855 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
31857 Both the 'wait-''xxx' and 'retry' databases contain items that involve
31858 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host --
31859 they were messages that were waiting for that host -- and in the latter they
31860 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
31861 types of error. When 'exim_tidydb' is run, a check is made to ensure that
31862 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
31863 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
31864 'wait-''xxx' records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are
31865 deleted. For the 'retry' database, records whose keys are non-existent
31866 message ids are removed. The 'exim_tidydb' utility outputs comments on the
31867 standard output whenever it removes information from the database.
31869 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
31870 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
31871 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
31872 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
31873 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
31875 It is important, therefore, to run 'exim_tidydb' periodically on all the
31876 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
31877 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
31878 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
31879 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
31880 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
31881 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
31884 *Warning*: If you never run 'exim_tidydb', the space used by the hints
31885 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
31892 cindex:['exim_fixdb']
31893 The 'exim_fixdb' program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
31894 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
31895 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
31896 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
31897 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
31900 If ``d'' is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
31901 except the 'retry' database, that is the only operation that can be carried
31902 out. For the 'retry' database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
31903 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
31904 by new data, for example:
31908 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
31909 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
31910 used as optional separators.
31915 [[SECTmailboxmaint]]
31916 Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)
31917 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
31918 cindex:[mailbox,maintenance]
31919 cindex:['exim_lock']
31920 cindex:[locking mailboxes]
31921 The 'exim_lock' utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
31922 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section <<SECTopappend>>.
31923 'Exim_lock' can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
31924 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
31925 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
31926 argument is run as a command (using C's 'system()' function); if there is no
31927 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
31928 is unset or empty, _/bin/sh_ is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
31929 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
31931 *-fcntl*:: Use 'fcntl()' locking on the open mailbox.
31933 *-flock*:: Use 'flock()' locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating
31934 system supports it.
31936 *-interval*:: This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds;
31937 it sets the interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
31939 *-lockfile*:: Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
31941 *-mbx*:: Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
31943 *-q*:: Suppress verification output.
31945 *-retries*:: This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to
31946 try to get the lock (default 10).
31948 *-restore_time*:: This option causes %exim_lock% to restore the modified and
31949 read times to the locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a
31950 locked mailbox (for example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the
31951 times that the user subsequently sees.
31953 *-timeout*:: This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds;
31954 it sets a timeout to be used with a blocking 'fcntl()' lock. If it is not set
31955 (the default), a non-blocking call is used.
31957 *-v*:: Generate verbose output.
31959 If none of %-fcntl%, %-flock%, %-lockfile% or %-mbx% are given, the default is
31960 to create a lock file and also to use 'fcntl()' locking on the mailbox, which
31961 is the same as Exim's default. The use of %-flock% or %-fcntl% requires that
31962 the file be writeable; the use of %-lockfile% requires that the directory
31963 containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock file does not last for ever;
31964 Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is more than 30 minutes old.
31966 The %-mbx% option can be used with either or both of %-fcntl% or %-flock%.
31967 It assumes %-fcntl% by default.
31968 MBX locking causes a shared lock to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an
31969 exclusive lock on the file _/tmp/._'n'.'m' where 'n' and 'm' are
31970 the device number and inode number of the mailbox file. When the locking is
31971 released, if an exclusive lock can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in
31974 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
31975 %-v% option causes some additional information to be given. The %-q% option
31976 suppresses all output except error messages.
31980 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
31982 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
31984 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End
31988 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
31989 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
31993 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
31994 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
31997 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
31998 second argument -- hence the quotes.
32002 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32003 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32009 cindex:[Exim monitor]
32012 cindex:[Local/eximon.conf]
32013 cindex:[_exim_monitor/EDITME_]
32014 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
32015 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
32016 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
32017 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
32018 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
32022 Running the monitor
32023 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32024 The monitor is started by running the script called 'eximon'. This is a shell
32025 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
32026 binary called _eximon.bin_. The default appearance of the monitor window can
32027 be changed by editing the _Local/eximon.conf_ file created by editing
32028 _exim_monitor/EDITME_. Comments in that file describe what the various
32029 parameters are for.
32031 The parameters that get built into the 'eximon' script can be overridden for a
32032 particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
32033 preceded by `EXIMON_`. For example, a shell command such as
32035 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
32037 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs 'eximon' with an overriding setting of the
32038 LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the
32039 environment, it overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it
32040 possible to have 'eximon' tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided
32041 that MAIL.INFO syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
32043 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
32044 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
32046 Eximon*background: gray94
32048 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
32049 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
32050 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
32051 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
32052 ``highlight'' (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
32053 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
32054 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
32057 Eximon*highlight: gray
32061 cindex:[admin user]
32062 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
32063 'eximon' must either be run as root or by an admin user.
32065 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
32066 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a ``tail'' of the
32067 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
32068 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
32069 different parts of the display.
32076 cindex:[stripchart]
32077 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
32078 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
32079 _Local/eximon.conf_ file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
32080 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
32081 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
32082 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
32083 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
32084 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
32085 parameter in the _Local/eximon.conf_ file.
32087 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
32088 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
32089 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
32090 For example, ``x2'' means that each division represents a value of 2.
32092 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
32093 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
32094 to a single partition.
32096 cindex:[%statvfs% function]
32097 This relies on the availability of the 'statvfs()' function or equivalent in
32098 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
32099 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
32100 100%, and the scale is given as ``x10%''. This chart is configured by setting
32101 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
32102 _Local/eximon.conf_ file.
32107 Main action buttons
32108 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32109 cindex:[size,of monitor window]
32110 cindex:[monitor window size]
32111 cindex:[window size]
32112 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
32113 to this is another button marked ``Size''. They are placed here so that shrinking
32114 the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count stripchart
32115 and these two buttons visible. Pressing the ``Size'' button causes the window to
32116 expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum, in which case
32117 it is reduced to its minimum.
32119 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
32120 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
32121 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
32122 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
32124 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
32125 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
32126 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
32127 The idea is copied from what the 'twm' window manager does for its
32128 'f.fullzoom' action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
32129 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in _Local/eximon.conf_.
32131 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
32132 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
32133 START_SMALL=yes in _Local/eximon.conf_.
32139 cindex:[log,tail of; in monitor]
32140 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
32141 the main log is maintained.
32142 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
32143 removing the date and, if %log_timezone% is set, the timezone.
32144 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
32145 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
32146 to 'eximon' via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
32148 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
32149 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
32150 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
32151 LOG_BUFFER in _Local/eximon.conf_, which specifies the amount of memory
32152 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded -- this is much
32153 more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has a
32154 horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
32155 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
32156 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
32157 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
32158 configuration file _Local/eximon.conf_.
32160 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
32161 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
32162 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
32163 It cannot go further back up the log.
32165 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
32166 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
32167 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
32168 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
32169 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
32170 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
32172 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
32173 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
32174 the search, and for cancelling. If the ``Search'' button is pressed, the search
32175 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
32176 ``Return'' key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
32177 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
32179 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
32180 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both ``search'' and ``replace''
32181 options. In order to suppress the unwanted ``replace'' portion for eximon, a
32182 modified version of the %TextPop% widget is distributed with Exim. However, the
32183 linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally provided version
32184 of %TextPop% when the remaining parts of the text widget come from the standard
32185 libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be unset to cut out
32186 the modified %TextPop%, making it possible to build Eximon on these systems, at
32187 the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup window.
32193 cindex:[queue,display in monitor]
32194 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
32195 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
32196 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
32197 parameters in the configuration file _Local/eximon.conf_, and the frequency
32198 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file --
32199 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
32200 there is an ``Update'' action button just above the display which can be used to
32201 force an update of the queue display at any time.
32203 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
32204 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
32205 with this situation there is a button next to ``Update'' called ``Hide''. If
32206 pressed, a dialogue box called ``Hide addresses ending with'' is put up. If you
32207 type anything in here and press ``Return'', the text is added to a chain of such
32208 texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
32209 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
32211 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
32212 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
32213 example, 'cam.ac.uk' specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
32214 'xxx@foo.com.example' specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
32215 has been set up, a button called ``Unhide'' is displayed. If pressed, it cancels
32216 all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten, a hide
32217 request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
32219 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
32220 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
32221 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
32222 pressing the ``Hide'' button.
32224 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
32225 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
32226 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
32227 a bounce message, the sender is shown as ``<>''. If there is more than one
32228 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
32229 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
32230 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
32233 cindex:[frozen messages,display]
32234 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
32236 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
32237 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
32238 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
32239 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
32240 display is updated.
32246 cindex:[queue,menu in monitor]
32247 If the %shift% key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
32248 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
32249 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
32252 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
32253 MENU_EVENT parameter in _Local/eximon.conf_ to change the default, or
32254 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
32255 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
32256 run eximon using %ctrl% rather than %shift% you could use
32258 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
32260 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
32263 - 'message log': The contents of the message log for the message are displayed in
32266 - 'headers': Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
32267 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
32268 <<CHAPspool>> for a description of the format of spool files.
32270 - 'body': The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
32271 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
32272 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
32273 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
32275 - 'deliver message': A call to Exim is made using the %-M% option to request
32276 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
32277 frozen. The %-v% option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
32278 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
32279 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
32281 - 'freeze message': A call to Exim is made using the %-Mf% option to request
32282 that the message be frozen.
32284 - cindex:[thawing messages]
32285 cindex:[unfreezing messages]
32286 cindex:[frozen messages,thawing]
32287 'thaw message': A call to Exim is made using the %-Mt% option to request that
32288 the message be thawed.
32290 - cindex:[delivery,forcing failure]
32291 'give up on msg': A call to Exim is made using the %-Mg% option to request
32292 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
32293 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
32295 - 'remove message': A call to Exim is made using the %-Mrm% option to request
32296 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
32299 - 'add recipient': A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
32300 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
32301 is set in _Local/eximon.conf_, the address is qualified with that domain.
32302 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
32303 causes a call to Exim to be made using the %-Mar% option to request that an
32304 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
32305 which case no action is taken.
32307 - 'mark delivered': A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
32308 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
32309 is set in _Local/eximon.conf_, the address is qualified with that domain.
32310 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
32311 causes a call to Exim to be made using the %-Mmd% option to mark the given
32312 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
32313 case no action is taken.
32315 - 'mark all delivered': A call to Exim is made using the %-Mmad% option to mark
32316 all recipient addresses as already delivered.
32318 - 'edit sender': A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current sender's
32319 address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the %-Mes%
32320 option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty, in which
32321 case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in bounce
32322 messages), you must specify it as ``<>''. Otherwise, if the address is not
32323 qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in
32324 _Local/eximon.conf_, the address is qualified with that domain.
32326 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the %-v% output is displayed. In
32327 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
32328 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
32329 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
32330 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
32331 _Local/eximon.conf_, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
32332 if no output is generated.
32334 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
32335 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
32336 _Local/eximon.conf_. In this case the ``Update'' button has to be used to force
32337 an update of the display after one of these actions.
32339 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
32340 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
32341 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
32348 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32349 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32352 Security considerations
32353 -----------------------
32355 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
32356 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
32358 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
32359 Exim as a ``particularly secure'' mailer. Perhaps it is because of the existence
32360 of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the chapter is
32361 simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain security concerns,
32362 not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of its security as
32363 compared with other MTAs.
32365 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
32366 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
32367 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
32368 as soon as possible.
32371 Building a more ``hardened'' Exim
32372 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32373 cindex:[security,build-time features]
32374 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in _Local/Makefile_
32375 to create Exim binaries that are ``harder'' to attack, in particular by a rogue
32376 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
32377 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
32379 - ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
32380 start of any file names used with the %-C% option. When it is set, these file
32381 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence ``/../''. (However, if the
32382 value of the %-C% option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
32383 _Local/Makefile_, Exim ignores %-C% and proceeds as usual.) There is no
32384 default setting for %ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%.
32386 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
32387 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
32388 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
32389 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
32391 - If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for %-C%
32392 and %-D% only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
32393 also use %-C% and %-D% and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
32394 the possibility of testing a configuration using %-C% right through message
32395 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
32396 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
32397 privilege for the delivery, the use of %-C% causes privilege to be lost.
32398 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
32399 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
32401 - If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the %-D% command line option
32404 - FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
32405 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the %never_users% runtime
32406 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
32407 to the list. The default setting is ``root''; this prevents a non-root user who
32408 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
32416 cindex:[root privilege]
32417 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
32418 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
32419 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
32420 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
32421 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
32422 is required for two things:
32424 - To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
32425 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from 'inetd', this privileged action is
32428 - To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' _.forward_ files and
32429 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
32432 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
32433 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
32434 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
32435 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
32436 _Local/Makefile_. These are known as ``the Exim user'' and ``the Exim group''.
32437 Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this is not
32438 recommended. Often a user called 'exim' is used, but some sites use 'mail'
32439 or another user name altogether.
32441 Exim uses 'setuid()' whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
32442 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
32443 'seteuid()' was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
32445 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
32446 uid and gid in the following cases:
32448 - cindex:[%-C% option]
32449 cindex:[%-D% option]
32450 If the %-C% option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
32451 the %-D% option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
32452 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
32453 changed to those of the calling process.
32454 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in _Local/Makefile_, only
32455 root callers may use %-C% and %-D% without losing privilege, and if
32456 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the %-D% option may not be used at all.
32458 - cindex:[%-be% option]
32459 cindex:[%-bf% option]
32460 cindex:[%-bF% option]
32461 If the expansion test option (%-be%) or one of the filter testing options
32462 (%-bf% or %-bF%) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
32465 - If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
32466 process or a process for testing address routing (started with %-bt%), the uid
32467 and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
32468 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
32469 testing address verification
32470 cindex:[%-bv% option]
32471 cindex:[%-bh% option]
32472 (the %-bv% option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the %-bh%
32475 - For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
32476 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
32482 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
32484 - A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
32485 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The 'initgroups()'
32486 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
32487 will be used during message reception.
32489 - A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
32490 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
32492 - A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
32493 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
32494 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
32495 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
32496 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
32497 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
32498 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
32499 generating bounce and warning messages.
32501 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
32502 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
32503 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
32504 gid. A system filter is run as root unless %system_filter_user% is set.
32506 - A process that is testing addresses (the %-bt% option) runs as root so that
32507 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
32512 [[SECTrunexiwitpri]]
32513 Running Exim without privilege
32514 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32515 cindex:[privilege, running without]
32516 cindex:[unprivileged running]
32517 cindex:[root privilege,running without]
32518 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
32519 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
32520 by the global option %deliver_drop_privilege%. When this is set, the uid and
32521 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
32522 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
32523 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
32526 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting %deliver_drop_privilege% means
32527 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
32528 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
32530 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
32532 If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root process. (Calling
32533 Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does when it is setuid
32534 root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a SIGHUP signal because
32535 it cannot regain privilege.
32537 It is still useful to set %deliver_drop_privilege% in this case, because it
32538 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
32539 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
32542 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if %mua_wrapper% is set,
32543 or 'inetd' is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid to the
32544 Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
32546 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
32547 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
32548 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
32549 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
32550 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
32551 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
32552 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
32553 address this problem at this time.
32555 For this reason, the recommended approach for ``mostly unprivileged'' running is
32556 to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set %deliver_drop_privilege%.
32557 This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to be used in the most
32558 straightforward way.
32560 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
32561 number of restrictions on what you can do:
32563 - You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
32564 %user% and %group% options to override routers or local transports that
32565 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
32566 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
32567 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
32569 - Use of _.forward_ files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
32570 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
32572 - Users who wish to use _.forward_ would have to make their home directory and
32573 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
32574 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
32575 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
32577 - Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
32578 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
32580 * They must be owned by the Exim group and be writable by that group. This
32581 implies you must set %mode% in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
32582 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
32584 * You must set %no_check_owner%, since most or all of the files will not be
32585 owned by the Exim user.
32587 * You must set %file_must_exist%, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
32588 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
32589 mailboxes need to be created manually.
32591 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
32592 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
32593 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting %deliver_drop_privilege%
32594 gives more security at essentially no cost.
32596 If you are using the %mua_wrapper% facility (see chapter <<CHAPnonqueueing>>),
32597 %deliver_drop_privilege% is forced to be true.
32602 Delivering to local files
32603 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32604 Full details of the checks applied by ^appendfile^ before it writes to a file
32605 are given in chapter <<CHAPappendfile>>.
32609 IPv4 source routing
32610 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32611 cindex:[source routing,in IP packets]
32612 cindex:[IP source routing]
32613 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
32614 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
32615 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
32616 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
32620 The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP
32621 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32622 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
32623 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
32630 cindex:[trusted user]
32631 cindex:[admin user]
32632 cindex:[privileged user]
32633 cindex:[user,trusted]
32634 cindex:[user,admin]
32635 Exim recognises two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
32636 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
32637 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
32638 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
32639 permit a remote host to be specified.
32641 cindex:[%-f% option]
32642 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the %-f% command line option in
32643 the special form %-f <>% to indicate that a delivery failure for the message
32644 should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope, but it
32645 does not affect the 'Sender:' header. Untrusted users may also be permitted to
32646 use specific forms of address with the %-f% option by setting the
32647 %untrusted_set_sender% option.
32649 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
32650 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
32651 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
32652 as any user listed in the %trusted_users% configuration option, or under any
32653 group listed in the %trusted_groups% option.
32655 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
32656 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
32657 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
32658 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
32659 includes the contents of files on the spool.
32661 cindex:[%-M% option]
32662 cindex:[%-q% option]
32663 By default, the use of the %-M% and %-q% options to cause Exim to attempt
32664 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
32665 restriction can be relaxed by setting the %no_prod_requires_admin% option.
32666 Similarly, the use of %-bp% (and its variants) to list the contents of the
32667 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
32668 setting %no_queue_list_requires_admin%.
32670 Exim recognises an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
32671 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
32672 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
32673 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
32674 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
32675 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
32682 cindex:[spool directory,files]
32683 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
32684 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
32685 _Local/Makefile_ configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
32686 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
32692 Exim examines the last component of %argv[0]%, and if it matches one of a set
32693 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
32694 with the last component of %argv[0]% set to ``rsmtp'' is exactly equivalent to
32695 calling it with the option %-bS%. There are no security implications in this.
32699 Use of %f formatting
32700 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32701 The only use made of ``%f'' by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
32702 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
32703 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
32710 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
32711 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
32712 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
32713 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
32719 cindex:['sprintf()']
32720 A large number of occurrences of ``sprintf'' in the code are actually calls to
32721 'string_sprintf()', a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
32722 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
32723 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
32724 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
32726 The remaining uses of 'sprintf()' happen in controlled circumstances where
32727 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
32732 Use of debug_printf() and log_write()
32733 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32734 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
32735 formatting by calling the function 'string_vformat()', which runs through
32736 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
32740 Use of strcat() and strcpy()
32741 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32742 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
32743 enough to hold the result.
32748 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32749 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32752 Format of spool files
32753 ---------------------
32754 cindex:[format,spool files]
32755 cindex:[spool directory,format of files]
32756 cindex:[spool files, format of]
32757 cindex:[spool files, editing]
32758 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
32759 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
32760 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
32761 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
32762 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
32763 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
32764 themselves are recoverable.
32766 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
32767 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
32768 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
32770 - You must use the 'exim_lock' utility to ensure that Exim does not try to
32771 deliver the message while you are fiddling with it. The lock is implemented
32772 by opening the -D file and taking out a write lock on it. If you update the
32773 file in place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename
32774 it, the lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
32776 - If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
32777 $body_linecount$, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect.
32779 - If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
32781 - If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
32785 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the _input_ directory (or
32786 its subdirectories when %split_spool_directory% is set). These are journal
32787 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
32788 the course of a delivery run. At the end of the run, the -H file is updated,
32789 and the -J file is deleted.
32792 Format of the -H file
32793 ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
32794 cindex:[uid (user id),in spool file]
32795 cindex:[gid (group id),in spool file]
32796 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
32797 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
32798 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
32799 message. For a message received over TCP/IP, it is normally the Exim user.
32801 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
32802 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
32803 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
32804 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
32805 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
32806 %qualify_domain%. However, this can be overridden by the %-f% option or a
32807 leading ``From'' line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
32808 ``<>'' or an address that matches %untrusted_set_senders%.
32810 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
32811 was received, in the conventional Unix form -- the number of seconds since the
32812 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
32813 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
32815 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
32816 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
32818 %-acl% <'number'> <'length'>::
32819 A line of this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The
32820 number identifies the variable; the %acl_c%*x* variables are numbered 0--9 and
32821 the %acl_m%*x* variables are numbered 10--19. The length is the length of the
32822 data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of the
32823 next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
32826 %-active_hostname% <'hostname'>::
32827 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
32828 $smtp_active_hostname$ was different to the value of $primary_hostname$.
32830 %-allow_unqualified_recipient%::
32831 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
32832 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
32833 transport time). Local messages that were input using %-bnq% and remote
32834 messages from hosts that match %recipient_unqualified_hosts% set this flag.
32836 %-allow_unqualified_sender%::
32837 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
32838 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
32839 time). Local messages that were input using %-bnq% and remote messages from
32840 hosts that match %sender_unqualified_hosts% set this flag.
32842 %-auth_id% <'text'>::
32843 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
32844 -- the value of the $authenticated_id$ variable.
32846 %-auth_sender% <'address'>::
32847 The address of an authenticated sender -- the value of the
32848 $authenticated_sender$ variable.
32850 %-body_linecount% <'number'>::
32851 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
32854 %-body_zerocount% <'number'>::
32855 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
32856 present if the number is greater than zero.
32858 %-deliver_firsttime%::
32859 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
32860 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
32862 %-frozen% <'time'>::
32863 cindex:[frozen messages,spool data]
32864 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <'time'>.
32866 %-helo_name% <'text'>::
32867 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
32870 %-host_address% <'address'>.<'port'>::
32871 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
32872 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
32875 %-host_auth% <'text'>::
32876 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
32877 the name of the authenticator -- the value of the $sender_host_authenticated$
32880 %-host_lookup_failed%::
32881 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
32882 address failed. It corresponds to the $host_lookup_failed$ variable.
32884 %-host_name% <'text'>::
32885 cindex:[reverse DNS lookup]
32886 cindex:[DNS,reverse lookup]
32887 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
32888 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
32889 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
32891 %-ident% <'text'>::
32892 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
32893 unless it was a trusted user and the %-oMt% option was used to specify an ident
32894 value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
32895 supplied by the remote host, if any.
32897 %-interface_address% <'address'>.<'port'>::
32898 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
32899 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
32900 generated messages.
32903 The message is from a local sender.
32906 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
32908 %-local_scan% <'string'>::
32909 This records the data string that was returned by the 'local_scan()' function
32910 when the message was received -- the value of the $local_scan_data$ variable.
32911 It is omitted if no data was returned.
32914 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
32915 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
32918 A testing delivery process was started using the %-N% option to suppress any
32919 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
32922 %-received_protocol%::
32923 This records the value of the $received_protocol$ variable, which contains the
32924 name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32926 %-sender_set_untrusted%::
32927 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
32928 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
32930 %-spam_score_int% <'number'>::
32931 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
32932 of $spam_score_int$.
32934 %-tls_certificate_verified%::
32935 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
32936 certificate was verified by the server.
32938 %-tls_cipher% <'cipher name'>::
32939 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
32940 name of the cipher suite that was used.
32942 %-tls_peerdn% <'peer DN'>::
32943 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
32944 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
32951 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
32952 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
32953 line when the %-t% option is used and %extract_addresses_remove_arguments%
32954 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
32955 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
32956 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
32957 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
32958 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
32959 addresses are complete.
32961 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
32962 the text ``XX''. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
32963 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
32964 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
32965 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
32966 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
32968 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
32969 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
32970 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
32972 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
32973 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
32974 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
32975 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
32979 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
32980 darcy@austen.fict.example
32982 alice@wonderland.fict.example
32984 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
32985 result of the use of the %one_time% option on a ^redirect^ router, each line
32986 is of the following form:
32989 <'top-level address'> <'errors_to address'> <'length'>,<'parent number'>#<'flag bits'>
32992 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
32993 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
32994 fields. The <'parent number'> is the offset in the recipients list of the
32995 original parent of the ``one time'' address. The first two fields are the
32996 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
32997 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
32998 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a ^redirect^ router
32999 that has an %errors_to% setting.
33002 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
33003 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
33004 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
33005 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
33006 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
33010 `-`--------`----------------------------------------------
33011 <'blank'>header in which Exim has no special interest
33015 `I` 'Message-id:' header
33016 `P` 'Received:' header -- P for ``postmark''
33017 `R` 'Reply-To:' header
33018 `S` 'Sender:' header
33020 `*` replaced or deleted header
33021 ----------------------------------------------------------
33023 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
33024 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
33025 typical set of headers:
33027 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
33028 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
33029 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
33030 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
33031 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
33032 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
33033 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
33034 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
33035 109T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.fict.example,
33036 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
33037 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
33039 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, 'From:' header, and
33040 'To:' header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
33041 unqualified domain 'foundation'.
33046 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33047 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33049 [titleabbrev="Adding drivers or lookups"]
33050 Adding new drivers or lookup types
33051 ----------------------------------
33052 cindex:[adding drivers]
33053 cindex:[new drivers, adding]
33054 cindex:[drivers,adding new]
33055 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
33056 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
33058 . Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
33059 existing name; I will use ``newdriver'' in what follows.
33061 . Add to _src/EDITME_ the line
33063 <type>_NEWDRIVER=yes
33065 where <'type'> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
33066 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
33067 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
33069 . Add to _src/config.h.defaults_ the line
33071 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
33073 . Edit _src/drtables.c_, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
33074 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
33076 . Edit _Makefile_ in the appropriate sub-directory (_src/routers_,
33077 _src/transports_, _src/auths_, or _src/lookups_); add a line for the new
33078 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
33080 . Create _newdriver.h_ and _newdriver.c_ in the appropriate sub-directory of
33083 . Edit _scripts/MakeLinks_ and add commands to link the _.h_ and _.c_ files
33084 as for other drivers and lookups.
33086 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
33087 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
33088 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
33089 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
33090 searched using a binary chop procedure.
33092 There is a _README_ file in each of the sub-directories of _src_ describing
33093 the interface that is expected.
33098 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33099 ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33101 [title="Option index",role="option"]
33105 [title="Concept index",role="concept"]
33109 ///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33110 Nothing needs to be included here except "Index" as pseudo chapter headings.
33111 ///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////